82558 The World Bank Legal Review Volume 5 Fostering Development through Opportunity, Inclusion, and Equity The World Bank Legal Review Volume 5 Fostering Development through Opportunity, Inclusion, and Equity The World Bank Legal Review is a publication for policy makers and their advis- ers, judges, a orneys, and other professionals engaged in the field of interna- tional development with a particular focus on law, justice, and development. It offers a combination of legal scholarship, lessons from experience, legal de- velopments, and recent research on the many ways in which the application of the law and the improvement of justice systems promote poverty reduction, economic development, and the rule of law. The World Bank Legal Review is part of the World Bank Law, Justice and De- velopment Series managed by the Research and Editorial Board of the Bank’s Legal Vice Presidency. Publication of The World Bank Legal Review, Volume 5 was made possible with support from the OPEC Fund for International Development. The World Bank Legal Review Volume 5 Fostering Development through Opportunity, Inclusion, and Equity Hassane Cissé N. R. Madhava Menon Marie-Claire Cordonier Segger Vincent O. Nmehielle Editors THE WORLD BANK Washington, D.C. © 2014 International Bank for Reconstruction and Development / The World Bank 1818 H Street NW, Washington DC 20433 Telephone: 202-473-1000; Internet: www.worldbank.org Some rights reserved 1 2 3 4 16 15 14 13 This work is a product of the staff of The World Bank with external contributions. The findings, interpretations, and conclusions expressed in this work do not necessarily reflect the views of The World Bank, its Board of Executive Directors, or the governments they represent. The World Bank does not guarantee the accuracy of the data included in this work. The boundaries, colors, de- nominations, and other information shown on any map in this work do not imply any judgment on the part of The World Bank concerning the legal status of any territory or the endorsement or acceptance of such boundaries. Nothing herein shall constitute or be considered to be a limitation upon or waiver of the privileges and immunities of The World Bank, all of which are specifically reserved. Rights and Permissions This work is available under the Creative Commons A ribution 3.0 Unported license (CC BY 3.0) h p://creativecommons.org/licenses/by/3.0. Under the Creative Commons A ribution license, you are free to copy, distribute, transmit, and adapt this work, including for commercial pur- poses, under the following conditions: AĴribution—Please cite the work as follows: Cissé, Hassane, N. R. Madhava Menon, Marie-Claire Cordonier Segger, and Vincent O. Nmehielle, eds. 2014. The World Bank Legal Review, Volume 5. Fostering Development through Opportunity, Inclusion, and Equity. DOI: 10.1596/978-1-4648-0037-5 License: Creative Commons A ribution CC BY 3.0 Translations—If you create a translation of this work, please add the following disclaimer along with the a ribution: This translation was not created by The World Bank and should not be considered an official World Bank translation. The World Bank shall not be liable for any content or error in this translation. Third Party Content--The World Bank does not necessarily own each component of the content contained within this work. The World Bank therefore does not warrant that the use of any third- party-owned individual component or part contained in this work will not infringe on the rights of those third parties. The risk of claims resulting from such infringement rests solely with you. If you wish to re-use a component of this work, it is your responsibility to determine whether permission is needed for that re-use and to obtain permission from the copyright owner. Note that The World Bank’s copyright over chapter 10 (by Emilio C. Viano) is limited to English language only. The International Development Law Organization has copyright over chapters 13 (by Nicholas Joseph), 15 (by Marie-Claire Cordonier Segger and Yolanda Saito), and 27 (by David Pa erson, Elisa Sla ery, and Naomi Burke-Shyne) of the work. Notwithstanding, The World Bank has permission to include these chapters in the work and make them available under the CC BY license. See note at the end of these chapters. All queries on rights and licenses should be addressed to the Office of the Publisher, The World Bank, 1818 H Street NW, Washington, DC 20433, USA; fax: 202-522-2625; e-mail: pubrights@ worldbank.org. ISBN (paper): 978-1-4648-0037-5 eISBN (electronic): 978-1-4648-0038-2 DOI: 10.1596/978-1-4648-0037-5 Cover photo: ©iStockphoto.com/ponsulak; Cover design: Nigel Quinney Library of Congress Cataloging-in-Publication Data has been requested. The World Bank Legal Review Volume 5 Fostering Development through Opportunity, Inclusion, and Equity EDITORS Hassane Cissé Deputy General Counsel, Knowledge and Research, World Bank N. R. Madhava Menon Hon. Professor & IBA Chair in Continuing Legal Education, National Law School of India, Bangalore Marie-Claire Cordonier Segger DPhil (Oxon), MEM (Yale), BCL & LLB (McGill) Senior Legal Expert, Sustainable Development, International Development Law Organization (IDLO) Vincent O. Nmehielle Professor of Law and Head of the Wits Programme on Law, Justice and Development in Africa School of Law, University of the Witwatersrand, Johannesburg, South Africa PRODUCTION EDITOR Elizabeth Hassan Associate Counsel, World Bank This page intentionally left blank Contents Foreword xi Jan Eliasson, Deputy Secretary-General of the United Nations Preface xiii Anne-Marie Leroy, Senior Vice President and Group General Counsel, The World Bank Contributors xv Introduction Opportunity, Inclusion, and Equity as Imperatives for Meaningful Law and Justice-Guided Development 3 Vincent O. Nmehielle and N. R. Madhava Menon PART I: Law and the Economy Keeping Public-Private Partnership Infrastructure Projects on Track: The Power of Multistakeholder Partnering Commi ees and Dispute Boards in Emerging-Market Infrastructure Projects 21 Patricia O. Sulser and Cyril Chern Protecting Traditional Practices and Country of Origin in Developing Countries through Fair Trade and Intellectual Property Rights 41 Beth Anne Hoffman and Charles Boudry Tools for More Sustainable Trade Treaties with Developing Countries 63 Markus W. Gehring The Treatment of Insolvency of Natural Persons in South African Law: An Appeal for a Balanced and Integrated Approach 91 André Boraine and Melanie Roestoff The Role of Personal Insolvency Law in Economic Development: An introduction to the World Bank Report on the Treatment of the Insolvency of Natural Persons 111 José M. Garrido Specialized Insolvency Regimes for Islamic Banks: Regulatory Prerogative and Process Design 127 Hdeel Abdelhady viii Contents The Role of Law in the Green Economy: Challenges and Opportunities for the Liberalization of Environmental Goods and Services 147 Fabiano de Andrade Correa PART II: Justice and Rule of Law Reform Institutional Responses to Social Demands: Enhancing Access to Justice in Colombia 165 David F. Varela and Anne e Pearson The Role of Access to Information in Promoting Development 189 Sean Fraser The Search for Opportunity and Inclusion: Insecurity and Migration 211 Emilio C. Viano Toward a National Framework Law on Water for India 231 N. R. Madhava Menon Targeting Justice Sector Services to Promote Equity and Inclusion for the Poor in Jordan 245 Paul Pre itore Serving the Justice Needs of the People: Adopting an Access to Justice Approach in Somalia’s Rule of Law Reform 263 Nicholas Joseph PART III: Environmental and Natural Resources Law The Challenges of Reforming the Urban Legal Framework: A Critical Assessment of Brazil’s City Statute Ten Years Later 279 Edesio Fernandes Innovative Legal Measures for Climate Change Response in Green Economy: Integrating Opportunity, Inclusion, and Equity 293 Marie-Claire Cordonier Segger and Yolanda Saito The Constitutional Basis of Public Participation in Environmental Governance: Framing Equitable Opportunities at National and County Government Levels in Kenya 307 Robert Kibugi Planning Laws, Development Controls, and Social Equity: Lessons for Developing Countries 329 Rachelle Alterman Land Use Law and the City: Toward Inclusive Planning 351 Ma hew Glasser Contents ix PART IV: Governance and Anticorruption Fighting Corruption in Education: A Call for Sector Integrity Standards 367 Mihaylo Milovanovitch The Ba le between Corruption and Governance in India: Strategies for Tipping the Scale 381 Sriram Panchu and Avni Rastogi Leveling the Playing Field: A Race to the Top 399 Bart Stevens and Robert Delonis The World Bank Group Sanctions System and Access to Justice for Small and Medium-Size Enterprises 417 Frank Fariello and Giovanni Bo Private Civil Actions: A Tool for a Citizen-led Ba le against Corruption 437 William T. Loris Fostering Opportunity through Development Finance in Africa: Legal Perspectives from the African Development Bank 453 Kalidou Gadio PART V: Empowerment and Equity for Diverse Communities Nation Building, State Reconstruction, and Inclusiveness: Issues on South Sudan as a New State and Somalia as a Failed but Reemerging State 483 Vincent O. Nmehielle and John-Mark Iyi Enabling Equal Opportunities for Women in the World of Work: The Intersections of Formal and Informal Constraints 505 Jeni Klugman and Ma hew Morton The Role of Law in Promoting the Right to Health for Diverse Communities 523 David Pa erson, Elisa Sla ery, and Naomi Burke-Shyne The Right to Health and Development: The Case of Uganda 545 Siobhán McInerney-Lankford and Moses Mulumba Mainstreaming the Marginalized in Development: Conceptualizing the Challenges in India 581 Pulapre Balakrishnan The Right to Information as a Tool for Community Empowerment 599 Anupama Dokeniya x Contents Conclusion A Challenging New Era for Law, Justice, and Development 615 Hassane Cissé and Marie-Claire Cordonier Segger Afterword 639 Irene Khan, Director-General, International Development Law Organization Index 641 Foreword JAN ELIASSON DEPUTY SECRETARY-GENERAL OF THE UNITED NATIONS We are at a crucial moment for shaping the world we want. The Report of the High-Level Panel of Eminent Persons on the Post-2015 Development Agenda sets out an ambitious yet practical vision for tackling poverty and sustainable development. It reflects a growing realization that the rule of law is funda- mental for responsive institutions and is a driving force for development. This understanding was confirmed when the United Nations General As- sembly held its first High-level Meeting on the rule of law in September 2012. The resulting Declaration recognizes that rule of law and development are strongly interrelated and mutually reinforcing and should be reflected in the post-2015 international development agenda. The Declaration also reaffirmed that the rule of law is indispensable for upholding peace and security, as well as respect for human rights. The World Bank Legal Review highlights the breadth of reach of the rule of law and, most critically, its centrality to development. The theme, Fostering Development through Opportunity, Inclusion, and Equity, speaks to the holistic nature of development and its relationship to the rule of law. Reflecting the World Bank’s work to mainstream law and justice into the development process, the authors explore innovative ways in which the rule of law can be used to help achieve opportunity, inclusion, and equity. The United Nations Secretary-General has also made it a priority to mainstream the rule of law across the work of the United Nations system. The rule of law is a concept at the very heart of development and people’s daily life across the world. It is the land deed in the hands of the farmer, the entrepreneur’s legitimate contract, the badge of a trusted police officer, and the birth certificate that lets a child be counted. But the rule of law also ranges well beyond these particular ma ers. The World Bank rightfully applies a justice lens to the protection of the environ- ment, anticorruption, the economy, and the empowerment of marginalized groups and communities. This edition of The World Bank Legal Review is a significant contribution to scholarship on the rule of law and comes at a critical time. Our shared chal- lenge—and obligation—is to build a future guided by the rule of law as a vehicle for people’s security, rights, and economic well-being. xi This page intentionally left blank Preface ANNE-MARIE LEROY SENIOR VICE PRESIDENT AND GROUP GENERAL COUNSEL THE WORLD BANK The world is confronted by a wide array of complex challenges that demand a ention. They range from fragile and conflict situations to the alarming pro- gression of climate change, from the worrisome state of food security to the persistent inequities and societal imbalances that limit people’s access to and enjoyment of public goods. In some countries, political instability is threat- ening the sustainability of development outcomes that have taken years of painstaking effort to achieve. Addressing these challenges is a top priority for development institutions today. The World Bank is striving to meet the increasing needs of its member countries not only through its lending instruments but also by providing tech- nical assistance, knowledge sharing, and advisory services. Institutionally, the change process is strategically designed to reposition the Bank to carry out its mandate more efficiently while evolving with the times. The twin goals of eradicating extreme poverty and boosting shared prosperity have also set the Bank on a path to not only secure positive outcomes in its operations, but also ensure that such outcomes translate to be er lives for all, especially the poor. The Legal Vice Presidency is actively supporting the Bank as it works to meet its obligations. With the help and expertise of its team of lawyers, legal analysts, and global partners, the Legal Vice Presidency is devising creative, viable, and sustainable legal solutions that will help transform development aspirations into reality. The World Bank Legal Review is one such effort. This year’s volume, subtitled Fostering Development through Opportunity, Inclusion, and Equity, explores critical issues affecting development, emphasizing that we stand a be er chance of achieving more meaningful impact when develop- ment processes are inclusive and equitable, and provide adequate opportuni- ties for all. Now is a time not only for action but also for reflection, as the internation- al community strives to set the post-2015 development agenda. The peoples of the world are clamoring for a louder voice and greater participation in the process of reform at the national, regional, and international levels; and re- cent actions by the international community indicate a willingness to engage more actively in that process. At the same time, lessons learned over the years equip us with the tools we need to create more targeted, proactive, and, con- sequently, successful engagement. To realize our ambitions, law and justice xiii xiv Preface must play an enhanced and overarching role, as demonstrated by the chapters in this volume. This, the fifth volume of The World Bank Legal Review, has greatly benefited from the input of seasoned development experts under the guidance of our distinguished editors: Deputy General Counsel for Knowledge and Research, Hassane Cissé; Professor N. R. Madhava Menon of the National Law School of India University (NLSIU); Dr. Marie-Claire Cordonier Segger of the Inter- national Development Law Organization (IDLO), Rome; and Professor Vincent O. Nmehielle of the University of Witwatersrand, South Africa. I sincerely thank Jan Eliasson, the Deputy Secretary-General of the United Nations, and Irene Khan, the Director-General of IDLO, who graciously wrote this volume’s foreword and afterword, respectively. Now more than ever, overcoming global challenges requires enhanced commitment and multi- stakeholder partnerships among development institutions. Jan Eliasson’s and Irene Khan’s valuable insights have greatly enriched this volume. I also thank all the contributors for their impressive and well-researched contributions. Their thoughts, perspectives, and recommendations are as important as they are timely. My sincere appreciation also goes to Dr. Nigel Quinney for his stellar and invaluable editorial assistance. This volume’s chapters have been organized under five main headings: law and the economy, justice and rule of law reform, environmental and natu- ral resources law, governance and anticorruption, and empowerment and eq- uity for diverse communities. Each of these five parts contains interesting and insightful discussions on the role of law and justice in development, offering innovative and dynamic recommendations on how a synergy among law, jus- tice, and development can inspire and facilitate more viable and sustainable solutions to development challenges. Contributors Hdeel Abdelhady is Founder and Principal of MassPoint Legal and Strat- egy Advisory PLLC, a boutique law and strategy firm in Washington, D.C., representing banks, companies, and organizations in market entry, finance and corporate transactions, investment disputes, and regulatory compliance. Ms. Abdelhady has practiced law in Washington and in Dubai with interna- tional law firms and as in-house (secondment) counsel to financial institutions. Her legal experience spans industries, cultures, and legal environments; she has worked on ma ers involving the United States, Africa, Asia, Europe, Latin America, and the Middle East. Before law school, Ms. Abdelhady worked with an award-winning Washington political media strategy firm, where she was responsible for research and analysis of congressional, gubernatorial, and mayoral campaigns and elections; ballot referenda; and corporate issues me- dia. Ms. Abdelhady holds a J.D. from The George Washington University Law School, where she is a Professorial Lecturer in law, and a B.A. (political science and history) from the University of Pi sburgh. Rachelle Alterman is the Founding President (2006–2010) of the International Academic Association on Planning, Law and Property Rights. Holding de- grees in planning and in law from Canadian and Israeli universities, Professor Alterman specializes in cross-national comparative analysis of planning laws, land use regulations, and property rights. Her most recent book is Takings In- ternational: A Comparative Perspective on Land Use Regulations and Compensation Rights (American Bar Association Press, 2010). Professor Alterman is based at the Technion–Israel Institute of Technology, where she holds the Azrieli Chair in Town Planning. She serves on the editorial boards of leading aca- demic journals. As visiting professor, she has taught at major American and Dutch universities. The Association of European Schools of Planning named her Honorary Member (the fifth person so honored). Professor Alterman has also served as a consultant for the United Nations, the Organisation for Eco- nomic Co-operation and Development, the World Bank, and a variety of other public bodies. See h p://alterman.technio.ac.il. Fabiano de Andrade Correa is a Brazilian lawyer and holds a Ph.D. in interna- tional law from the European University Institute in Florence, Italy. Currently, he serves as Legal Specialist at the International Development Law Organi- zation (IDLO), in Rome, providing expertise for program development and implementation on issues related to trade and sustainable economic develop- ment. Mr. de Andrade Correa is a qualified lawyer with the Brazilian Bar As- sociation, and before joining IDLO he practiced law with a leading Brazilian law firm and clerked with the Court of Justice of the state of Rio Grande do Sul, in Porto Alegre, Brazil. He is also a member of the Brazilian Branch of the International Law Association, serving as alternate representative to the Commi ee on International Law and Sustainable Natural Resources Manage- xv xvi Contributors ment, and an Associate Fellow with the Centre for International Sustainable Development Law (CISDL). He holds a law degree (LL.B., UFRGS, Brazil) and a master’s degree in international relations (Escuela Diplomatica/Universidad Complutense de Madrid, Spain). Pulapre Balakrishnan is Professor of Economics at the Centre for Develop- ment Studies, Thiruvananthapuram, of which he is currently the director. He has wri en in the professional journals and is the author of the books Pricing and Inflation in India (Oxford University Press, 1991) and Economic Growth in India: History and Prospect (Oxford University Press, 2010). Mr. Balakrishnan has held appointments at the University of Oxford, the Indian Statistical In- stitute at Delhi, and the Indian Institute of Management at Kozhikode and has served as Country Economist for Ukraine at the World Bank. See h p:// pulaprebalakrishnan.in. Giovanni Bo is an Associate Counsel with the Operations Policy Practice Group of the World Bank’s Legal Vice Presidency. He joined the Bank’s Legal Department in 2010 and worked, as an advisory lawyer, in the Environmental and International Law Practice Group and, as an operational lawyer, in the Latin America and the Caribbean Practice Group. Prior to joining the Bank, he was legal researcher at Human Rights Watch and worked for the European Commission, in Brussels. He has also practiced European Union law in the Brussels office of Pavia & Ansaldo. A foreign-trained a orney admi ed to practice law in the state of New York, he holds an LL.M. in international and comparative law from The George Washington University Law School (2009), an advanced degree in European Union law from the University of Bologna (2007), a Certificate in legal studies from University College London (2004), and an LL.B. from the University of Genoa (2004). His recent publications in- clude “The US Challenge to the Inclusion of Aviation Activities within the EU Emissions Trading Scheme: A US-EU Dispute with Global Repercussions” (World Bank, 2011) and “Activities in the Seabed and Ocean Floor beyond the Limits of National Jurisdiction: The Responsibilities and Obligations of States and International Organizations” (World Bank, 2011). André Boraine is the Dean of the Faculty of Law at the University of Pretoria. Over the years he has taught a variety of law subjects at both undergraduate and postgraduate levels, and he supervises doctoral students on a continuous basis. He is on the roll of practicing a orneys and is involved in practical legal training programs of candidate a orneys as well as insolvency practitioners. He was the INSOL Scholar for 2008 and has been recognized as an exceptional achiever at the University of Pretoria. He is also a National Research Federa- tion–rated researcher. His current research interests include insolvency law, the law of civil procedure, and aspects of property law and consumer pro- tection. He has published widely and regularly presents papers at local and international conferences. During 2011, he served as a consultant to the World Bank in relation to an ROSC analysis of the South African insolvency law sys- tem. Mr. Boraine is a coauthor of a leading book on insolvency in South Africa: Meskin: Insolvency Law (LexisNexis). Contributors xvii Charles Boudry served as an Associate Counsel in the Environmental and International Law Unit in the Legal Vice Presidency of the World Bank. Before joining the Bank, Mr. Boudry worked for the Swiss law firm of Bär & Karrer in the litigation and international arbitration practice group. He holds an LL.M. from Duke Law School (Duke-Geneva Scholar, 2011) and a master’s in eco- nomic law from the University of Geneva. Naomi Burke-Shyne is an Australian lawyer with 10 years’ experience in law and human rights. She joined the International Development Law Organiza- tion’s HIV and Health Law Initiative in 2009. Under this program, Ms. Burke- Shyne worked extensively across Asia and the Pacific, managing technical as- sistance initiatives in Bangladesh, India, Indonesia, Nepal, Pakistan, Papua New Guinea, the Philippines, Sri Lanka, and Timor-Leste. She has a strong background in the rights of marginalized populations and has worked close- ly with people living with HIV, men who have sex with men, transgender people, and sex workers on discrimination and the right to health. Ms. Burke- Shyne practiced as a lawyer in Australia prior to joining IDLO and holds a master’s degree in international and community development from Deakin University, Australia, and an LL.B. from the University of Queensland. Cyril Chern, the Secretary of the Dispute Board Federation (DBF), Geneva, is also a Barrister at Crown Office Chambers, London, and a Chartered Ar- chitect, Chartered Arbitrator, Accredited Mediator, and Adjudicator and holds the degrees of B.Arch. in architecture and engineering and J.D. He is a Fellow of both the Chartered Institute of Arbitrators and the Dispute Board Federation and is on both the FIDIC President’s List of Adjudicators and its Assessment Panel and is a dispute board trainer for FIDIC, the DBF, and the International Chamber of Commerce. Dr. Chern is the author of Chern on Dis- pute Boards (1st and 2nd editions, Wiley-Blackwell), International Commercial Mediation (Informa), and The Law of Construction Disputes (Informa). He is also the coauthor of Emden’s Construction Law and its “ADR and Dispute Boards” section (LexisNexis). His newest books, The Commercial Mediator’s Handbook and Construction Delay and Damage, will be published in early 2014. Hassane Cissé joined the World Bank in 1997 after serving for seven years as Counsel at the International Monetary Fund. He has been Deputy General Counsel, Knowledge and Research, of the Bank since 2009. In this capacity, he provides intellectual leadership on strategic legal issues facing the Bank, oversees advisory services on law and justice reforms, and leads the Bank’s knowledge agenda on law, justice, and development. He is the editor-in-chief of the World Bank’s Law, Justice and Development Series; has authored sev- eral papers on international economic law and law, justice, and development; and coedited the 2012 and 2013 volumes of The World Bank Legal Review. Prior to his current position, Mr. Cissé served for several years as Chief Counsel for Operations Policy of the World Bank. In this capacity, he contributed to the modernization and simplification of the Bank’s legal and policy framework, and as legal adviser on governance and anticorruption, he led the exercise that resulted in the adoption by the Bank in 2006 of an expanded policy framework xviii Contributors for sanctions. He was appointed in 2007 to serve as a member of the World Bank’s newly established Sanctions Board. Mr. Cissé obtained his LL.B. from Dakar University in Senegal, where he graduated at the top of his class; he also holds an LL.M. degree from Harvard Law School as well as graduate law degrees from the Universities of Paris I Panthéon-Sorbonne and Paris II Panthéon-Assas and a graduate degree in history from Paris I University. Mr. Cissé is a member of the World Economic Forum Global Agenda Council on the Rule of Law. Marie-Claire Cordonier Segger, D.Phil. (Oxon), M.E.M. (Yale), B.C.L. and LL.B. (McGill), is Senior Legal Expert, Sustainable Development, for the In- ternational Development Law Organization. She has 20 years of global trea- ty negotiations and programming experience that spans 79 countries of the Americas, Africa, and Asia Pacific, and she has published over 80 papers and 18 books in five languages, including Sustainable Development Law (Oxford University Press), Sustainable Justice (Martinus Nijhoff), and Legal Aspects of Implementing the Cartagena Protocol on Biosafety (Cambridge University Press). She coleads the World Bank Global Forum on Law, Justice and Development Thematic Working Group on Environment and Natural Resources Law and serves on the Editorial Board of The World Bank Legal Review. In an academic capacity, Dr. Cordonier Segger also coedits the Cambridge University Press series Implementing Treaties on Sustainable Development and serves as Se- nior Director for the Centre for International Sustainable Development Law (CISDL). She is an Affiliated Fellow of the Cambridge University Lauter-pacht Centre for International Law (LCIL); Visiting Professor of the University of Chile Faculty of Law; Rapporteur of the International Law Association (ILA) Experts Commi ee on International Law and Sustainable Development of Natural Resources; and Councilor of the World Future Council. Dr. Cor- donier Segger also is on the boards of ILA Canada, Nigeria’s Journal of Sus- tainable Development Law and Policy, and the Cambridge Journal of International and Comparative Law. Previously, Dr. Cordonier Segger has served as Senior Director of Research for Sustainable Prosperity, A/Director of International Af- fairs for Canada’s Ministry of Natural Resources, Americas Portfolio Director for the International Institute for Sustainable Development and UN Environ- ment Programme, and Associate Fellow of the Royal Institute for International Affairs. Robert Delonis is a Senior Litigation Specialist in the World Bank Group In- tegrity Vice Presidency (INT). He advises INT investigators regarding their inquiries into allegations of fraud, corruption, collusion, and coercion affect- ing World Bank–supported activities; argues resulting sanctions cases in the World Bank Group’s administrative sanctions system; and leads the negotia- tion of se lements in cases for which an amicable resolution is pursued. Prior to the formation of INT’s Special Litigation Unit, he was a core team member on INT’s Detailed Implementation Review of the India Health Sector and a team member (and, briefly, acting head) of INT’s Voluntary Disclosure Pro- gram. Before joining INT in 2006, he practiced law in the Washington, D.C., Contributors xix office of a multinational law firm, focusing on civil litigation. He is a graduate of Georgetown University and New York University School of Law. Anupama Dokeniya is a Governance Specialist in the Governance and Pub- lic Sector Group at the World Bank. She works on the implementation and monitoring of the Bank’s Governance and Anticorruption Strategy; leads ana- lytical work on transparency, accountability, and open governance issues; and advises country teams in these areas. She has developed and delivered sev- eral learning programs on governance and transparency issues in developing countries, consulted on the use of information and communication technol- ogy for development, and worked as a journalist. She holds a Ph.D. in com- munications and international development from Cornell University. Frank Fariello is a Lead Counsel with the Operations Policy Practice Group of the World Bank’s Legal Vice Presidency. He is the Bank’s primary legal focal point for its Governance and Anticorruption Strategy and sanctions system. Since joining the Bank in 2005, he has also worked on a range of other legal policy issues, including the Legal Harmonization Initiative, Bank engagement in the criminal justice sector, and the legal aspects of the Bank’s Middle-In- come Countries strategy. He is Vice Chair of the American Bar Association’s International Anticorruption Commi ee. His recent publications include “Coordinating the Fight against Fraud and Corruption” and “Transforming through Transparency: Opening Up the World Bank’s Sanctions System” (The World Bank Legal Review, volumes 3 and 4, respectively). He has lectured at the Joint Vienna Institute, George Mason University, and the New York Uni- versity School of Law. Prior to joining the Bank, he was Special Adviser to the Vice President of the International Fund for Agricultural Development (IFAD) and Senior Counsel in IFAD’s Office of the General Counsel. Prior to IFAD, he practiced corporate law in a number of New York–based law firms, including Skadden, Arps, Slate, Meagher & Flom. He holds a B.A. in history (magna cum laude) from Brown University (1980) and a J.D. from New York Univer- sity Law School (1983). He is admi ed to practice law in the state of New York. Edesio Fernandes (LL.M., Ph.D.) is a Brazilian legal scholar based in the United Kingdom, specializing in the legal dimensions of land, urban, housing, and environmental processes and public policies. He is a member of DPU Associ- ates and of the teaching faculty of the Lincoln Institute of Land Policy (LILP). He has worked as both a lecturer and a consultant in several countries and has published widely in English, Portuguese, and Spanish. He is the author, among other publications, of the Policy Focus Report on land regularization programs in Latin America (LILP, 2011). In 2003, he was Director of Land Af- fairs at Brazil’s Ministry of Cities, and in that capacity he coordinated the for- mulation of the National Program to Support the Sustainable Regularization of Consolidated Informal Se lements in Urban Areas. Sean Fraser is an associate with the Canadian law firm Blake, Cassels & Graydon, working in the Litigation and International Dispute Resolution practice groups. He also serves as an Associate Research Fellow with the Human Rights and Poverty Eradication Division of the Centre for International xx Contributors Sustainable Development Law. Mr. Fraser previously spent time working for the South African History Archives’ Freedom of Information Programme in Johannesburg, South Africa, where he was involved with various public edu- cation and advocacy campaigns that focused on improving the content and implementation of access to information laws in that country. He holds an LL.M. in public international law from Leiden University’s Advanced Studies program, where he specialized in peace, justice, and development, as well as a J.D. with a specialization in business law from Dalhousie University, and a B.Sc. (with distinction) from St. Francis Xavier University. Kalidou Gadio, a Mauritanian national, is the General Counsel of the African Development Bank. Prior to this position, he served within the Bank as Coun- try Director for North Africa Region I and as the Manager of the Operations Affairs Division in the Legal Department. Before joining the Bank, Mr. Gadio worked with Coudert Brothers in New York as an Associate A orney and with Jeantet et Associés, an international law firm in Paris. He holds an LL.M. from Harvard Law School (1987), an advanced degree in international law from the Sorbonne, University of Paris II, and a license en droit from the Uni- versity of Mohamed V in Morocco. Mr. Gadio is a member of the New York and Connecticut Bars and a former member of the Paris Bar. José M. Garrido is Senior Counsel at the Legal Vice Presidency of the World Bank in the Finance, Private Sector Development and Infrastructure Unit, spe- cializing in the areas of insolvency and creditor/debtor regimes. A prominent international lawyer and academic in Spain, he has held the chair in com- mercial and corporate law at the University of Castilla–La Mancha since 2001. Professor Garrido was also the General Counsel of the Spanish Securities Commission and was appointed a High Level Company Law Expert for the European Commission. He coordinated the work of the World Bank Insol- vency Task Force on the treatment of personal insolvency and has published extensively on ma ers of access to credit, particularly in the area of secured transactions. Professor Garrido holds a Ph.D. in insolvency law (University of Bologna), an LL.M. in corporate and commercial law (University of London), and a J.D. (University of Alcala). Markus W. Gehring, LL.M. (Yale University), J.D. (University of Hamburg), M.A. (University of Cambridge), is Deputy Director of the Centre for Euro- pean Legal Studies (CELS) and University Lecturer at the Faculty of Law, Uni- versity of Cambridge. He is Director of Studies in Law and a Fellow at Hughes Hall and serves as Lead Counsel for Trade, Investment and Finance Law with the Centre of International Sustainable Development Law (CISDL). Dr. Geh- ring has been a Visiting Professor at several universities around the world and is ad personam Jean Monnet Chair in Sustainable Development Law in the Faculty of Law, Civil Law Section, at the University of O awa. He is a member of the Frankfurt Bar. Selected publications include Sustainable Development in World Trade Law (Kluwer Law International, 2005) and Sustainable Development in World Investment Law (Kluwer Law International, 2010). Dr. Gehring also Contributors xxi coedits the Cambridge University Press series Implementing Treaties on Sus- tainable Development. Ma hew Glasser recently joined the World Bank’s Legal Vice Presidency. His legal career began in 1977 as a Municipal Bond Counsel and then a City A or- ney in Colorado, and he has also worked as a registered professional lobbyist in Washington, D.C., for Colorado cities. Just before joining the Bank’s urban sector team in 2003, Mr. Glasser worked as an adviser in the South African National Treasury, where he helped develop regulatory frameworks for mu- nicipal borrowing and financial emergencies. For more than 20 years he has worked with national and local governments in Africa, Asia, and Europe on policy and legislation regarding urban issues. Mr. Glasser is currently work- ing on a book exploring the legal, regulatory, and institutional framework within which the world’s cities operate. He obtained his J.D. from Cornell University Law School, Ithaca, and B.A. (cum laude) and MBA from the Uni- versity of Colorado. Beth Anne Hoffman is currently an Operations Analyst in the Environmental and International Law Unit in the Legal Vice Presidency of the World Bank. Over her 18 years in the World Bank, Ms. Hoffman has held positions in the Judicial Reform Unit of the Legal Vice Presidency and as a Public Sector Spe- cialist in the Poverty Reduction and Economic Management Unit in the Latin America and the Caribbean Region. She has worked on projects related to privatization and decentralization in Argentina, Brazil, and Chile as well as justice reform initiatives in all of the Bank’s five regions. She contributed to the justice, governance, and land law sections of “Beating the Odds: Sustaining Inclusion in a Growing Economy―A Mozambique Poverty, Gender and So- cial Assessment,” which won the Africa Region’s 2009 Chief Economist’s Best Practice Award for Economic and Sector Work. Ms. Hoffman holds a master’s degree from Georgetown University’s School of Foreign Service and a dual bachelor’s degree in politics and Spanish from Lake Forest College. John-Mark Iyi, LL.B. (Honors), B.L., LL.M., was the 2010 Webber Wen el Scholar in the School of Law, University of the Witwatersrand, Johannesburg, South Africa, where he is completing a Ph.D. He is also currently a Programme Associate at the Wits Programme on Law, Justice and Development in Africa. Mr. Iyi has also served as a Research/Teaching Associate in the school. His research focuses on public international law and international peace and se- curity from an African perspective. Mr. Iyi’s most recent publications include “The Duty of an Intervention Force to Protect Civilians: A Critical Analysis of NATO’s Intervention in Libya” (Conflict Trends, 2012); “The Legal Framework for Sub-regional Humanitarian Intervention in Africa: A Comparative Analy- sis of ECOWAS and SADC Regimes” (SADC Law Journal, 2012); “Democracy and the Development Crisis in Sub-Saharan Africa: Revisiting Some Precon- ditions for a Developmental State Alternative,’’ in International Economic Law: Voices of Africa (Siber Ink, 2012); “The AU/ECOWAS Unilateral Humanitarian Intervention Legal Regimes and the UN Charter” (African Journal of Interna- tional & Comparative Law, forthcoming); and “The Role of the African Union xxii Contributors Continental Early Warning System in Preventing Mass Atrocities,” in Africa and the Responsibility to Protect: Article 4(h) of the African Union Constitutive Act (Routledge, 2013). Nicholas Joseph is Somalia Project Officer at the International Development Law Organization (IDLO), where he undertakes a range of programming, re- search, and legal advisory tasks relating to constitution building and justice reform in support of national partners in Somalia. He coauthored a report on the implementation of the judiciary chapter of the Provisional Constitution of Somalia and supported national efforts in planning for the development of the justice sector in Somalia. Prior to his appointment as project officer, Mr. Joseph was Legal Associate at IDLO, where he authored briefings for na- tional partners in South Sudan on the design of the constitutional process and the appropriate design of governance mechanisms within the constitutional commission and wrote a report outlining the options and ramifications for extending the constitution-building process beyond the constitutionally man- dated timelines. He received his law degree from the University of Sheffield. Robert Kibugi is a Lecturer in law at the University of Nairobi’s Centre for Advanced Studies in Environmental Law (CASELAP) and School of Law. He previously taught at the Faculty of Law, University of O awa, in Canada. His legal and policy research agenda focuses on, among other subjects, public par- ticipation in natural resource governance; land use law for sustainable devel- opment; climate change, including the role of law and policy in the adaptation and mitigation of climate change; energy law; water resources management and rights; and water and sanitation. He holds an LL.B. and an LL.M. from the School of Law, University of Nairobi, and an LL.D. from the Faculty of Law, University of O awa. He is an advocate of the High Court of Kenya. Mr. Kibugi has published various chapters and articles in peer-reviewed books and journals. Jeni Klugman is the Director of Gender and Development at the World Bank Group, where she serves as lead spokesperson on gender equality issues and is responsible for developing strategic directions to support the institu- tion’s gender and development priorities. She also serves on several advisory boards, including the World Economic Forum’s Advisory Board on Sustain- ability and Competitiveness and those related to the work of the Council on Foreign Relations. Prior to taking up her position at the Bank in August 2011, Ms. Klugman was the director and lead author of three global Human Devel- opment Reports published by the United Nations Development Programme: Overcoming Barriers: Human Mobility and Development (2009), The Real Wealth of Nations: Pathways to Human Development (2010), and Sustainability and Equity: A BeĴer Future for All (2011). From 1992 to 2008 she held various positions at the Bank, focusing on poverty, inequality, and human development in low- income countries in Africa, Asia, and Europe. Ms. Klugman has published widely on topics ranging from poverty-reduction strategies and labor markets to conflict, health reform, education, and decentralization. She holds a Ph.D. in economics from the Australian National University, as well as postgraduate Contributors xxiii degrees in law and development economics from Oxford University, where she was a Rhodes Scholar. William T. Loris is Senior Lecturer and Director of the Loyola University Chi- cago LL.M. Program on Rule of Law for Development. His degrees include a J.D. from the University of Santa Clara and a master’s in international and comparative law from the Vrije Universiteit Brussel. After 10 years of service as a Legal Adviser to USAID in West and Central Africa and in Egypt, he co- founded the International Development Law Organization (IDLO). Mr. Loris served IDLO as General Counsel and as Director of Programs. He was appoint- ed as IDLO Director General for two terms, during which he became known as a leading advocate for the rule of law throughout developing countries and countries in economic transition. He has served on the World Economic Forum’s Global Agenda Council on Corruption and has been recognized by Santa Clara University for his service to his profession and to humanity and by Lithuania for his assistance during its transition. Siobhán McInerney-Lankford is Senior Counsel at the World Bank Legal Vice Presidency (Africa Practice Group) and former Senior Policy Officer, Institu- tions, Law and Partnerships for Human Rights, Nordic Trust Fund, Opera- tions Policy and Country Services Vice Presidency. She is an expert in interna- tional human rights law, advising the World Bank in this area since 2002 and regularly representing the World Bank in international human rights fora, in- cluding the United Nations, European Union, and Organisation for Economic Co-operation and Development (OECD). From 2006 to 2008, she served as chair of the OECD’s Development Assistance Commi ee Human Rights Task Team, and she was the World Bank representative to the UN High-Level Task Force on the Right to Development from 2007 to 2009 and at the UN OHCHR Vienna+20 meeting in 2013. Before joining the World Bank, she worked in pri- vate practice in Washington, D.C. She has published widely on human rights law and teaches occasionally. Dr. McInerney-Lankford holds an LL.B. from Trinity College, Dublin, an LL.M. from Harvard Law School, and a B.C.L. and D.Phil. in EU human rights law from the Law Faculty at Oxford University. N. R. Madhava Menon holds degrees from Kerala University (B.Sc. and B.L.), Aligarh Muslim University (LL.M. and Ph.D.), and Punjab University (M.A.). He was enrolled as an Advocate in the Kerala High Court in 1956 at the early age of 20. Dr. Menon left active legal practice and in 1960 joined the faculty of Aligarh Muslim University, where he continued his teaching and research until 1965, when he joined Delhi University and rose to become Professor and Head of the Campus Law Centre. During this period, he was deputed to serve as Principal of Government Law College, Pondicherry, and Secretary of the Bar Council of India Trust. In 1986, at the invitation of the Bar Council of India, Dr. Menon moved to Bangalore to set up the National Law School of India University (NLSIU) and to initiate a new model of legal education, the five-year integrated LL.B. program. He served NLSIU as its Founding Vice Chancellor for 12 years. The success of the Bangalore model led to the establishment of 15 similar law schools elsewhere in India. From 1998 to xxiv Contributors 2003, he served as the Founding Vice Chancellor of the National University of Juridical Sciences, from where the Supreme Court sought his services to set up the National Judicial Academy (NJA) at Bhopal. Dr. Menon was the Founding Director of NJA until 2006, when he retired from active employment. On his retirement, the government of India appointed him as a member of the Com- mission on Centre-State Relations (2006–2010) and decorated him with several awards, among other honors. Dr. Menon now holds the International Bar As- sociation Chair on Continuing Legal Education at the National Law School, Bangalore. He also is the Chairman of the Menon Institute of Legal Advocacy Training, an educational charity based in Trivandrum, where he lives. Dr. Me- non is the author of more than a dozen books on legal education, the legal profession, judicial training, and the administration of justice. Mihaylo Milovanovitch is Senior Policy and Systems Development Specialist at the European Training Foundation (ETF) of the European Union, and an Edmond J. Safra Network Fellow at Harvard University. Prior to joining the ETF, he was responsible for peer reviews and thematic analyses of education policies in Central Asia, Eastern Europe, Latin America, and the Middle East– North Africa region for the Organisation for Economic Co-operation and De- velopment (OECD). A major area of his work is the governance and integrity of education systems, and the development of sector-specific approaches to corruption prevention, such as the OECD integrity of education systems meth- odology for assessing education sector integrity. Past responsibilities of Mr. Milovanovitch have included the planning and coordination of educational co- operation with East Europe for the federal government of Austria and the edu- cation and youth agenda of the Stability Pact for Southeast Europe. He holds a master’s degree in advanced international studies from the Vienna Diplomatic Academy and a master’s degree from the Munich School of Philosophy. Ma hew Morton is a Young Professional in the World Bank’s Gender and De- velopment team, where he works on gender-based violence and women’s eco- nomic opportunities. Before joining the Bank, Mr. Morton served as Special Adviser to the Commissioner of the U.S. Administration on Children, Youth, and Families. There he led efforts to integrate evidence-based policy mak- ing with a focus on child trauma and youth homelessness. As a researcher, Mr. Morton served as a lecturer and investigator at the University of Oxford’s Centre for Evidence-Based Intervention, consulted for the European Commis- sion on impact evaluation, and conducted research on youth empowerment programming. He received a B.A. in political science at Stetson University and an M.Sc. and D.Phil. in evidence-based social intervention at the University of Oxford. Moses Mulumba currently heads the Center for Health, Human Rights and Development. He has previously worked in the areas of disability law and policy, environmental law and policy, and the development dimensions of intellectual property law. Mr. Mulumba’s current areas of interest include health law and policy, international human rights law, health regulation, de- velopment dimensions of intellectual property rights, access to medicines, Contributors xxv and maternal health rights. He has been an African Adviser to the HIV and the Law Commission and coordinates the health equity work within EQUI- NET in 16 East and South African Countries. His current projects include de- veloping a model for community participation in health systems, formulating goals for global health and for governance for global health post-2015, devel- oping a model law on regulatory aspects of satellite-enhanced telemedicine and eHealth for Sub-Saharan Africa (eHSA), and litigating the right to health in Uganda. He has an LL.B., a postgraduate Bar Course Diploma, an M.Phil., and an LL.M. Vincent O. Nmehielle, a Barrister and Solicitor of the Supreme Court of Nige- ria, has over 22 years of professional and academic experience. He is currently a Professor of Law and Head of the Wits Programme on Law, Justice and Development in Africa at the University of the Witwatersrand (Wits) School of Law in Johannesburg, South Africa, where he has taught since February 2002 and where he held the Bram Fischer Chair in Human Rights Law from 2002 to 2004. He was a Professorial Lecturer in law at the Oxford University and George Washington University Human Rights Program in 2003 and 2004. From 2005 to 2008, Professor Nmehielle served as the Principal Defender of the UN-backed Special Court for Sierra Leone in Freetown, Sierra Leone. He holds an LL.B. from the Rivers State University of Science and Technol- ogy, Port Harcourt, Nigeria; an LL.M. in international law from the Univer- sity of Notre Dame; and an SJ.D. in international and comparative law from The George Washington University, Washington, D.C. Professor Nmehielle specializes in international and comparative law, and his professional, aca- demic, and research interests lie within the areas of law, governance, justice, and development in Africa. He has wri en and consulted on constitutional issues, human rights, international justice, and governance in Africa. His re- cent works include Africa and the Future of International Criminal Justice (Eleven International, 2012). Sriram Panchu is a Senior Advocate in India. In 1985, he founded a citizens’ group, Citizen, Consumer and Civic Action Group, which has become in- volved in a number of public causes. He has appeared in a wide range of public interest cases, often relating to corruption and good governance, envi- ronmental protection, and consumer rights. His articles on these issues have been published in leading journals and newspapers. Mr. Panchu serves on the boards of several charitable and public institutions. He is also a mediator and has worked to make the mediation process a part of India’s legal sys- tem. He was appointed the first Honorary Organizing Secretary of the Madras High Court Mediation and Conciliation Centre, the first such center in India. Mr. Panchu has published two books on mediation. David Pa erson is head of social development programs at the International Development Law Organization (IDLO), based in Rome, Italy. He was a founding member of the Canadian HIV/AIDS Legal Network in 1993, and from 1994 to 2008, he worked with the UN system (UNAIDS and UNDP) and national and international NGOs on law, HIV, health, and development. Since xxvi Contributors 2009, Mr. Pa erson has managed IDLO’s health law program, which has sup- ported initiatives on HIV-related law and policy in 23 countries. In 2011, he addressed the UN General Assembly on IDLO’s support for legal services for people living with HIV and key affected populations. Recent work explores legal frameworks for responding to noncommunicable diseases, intellectual property law, access to medicines, and litigation as a tool to advance the right to food. Mr. Pa erson holds master’s degrees in law (McGill), and science (SOAS, London), and postgraduate qualifications in community health (Mon- treal) and development program evaluation (Carleton, World Bank). Anne e Pearson is a lawyer who has conducted postgraduate studies in criminology. She is an international consultant in the fields of criminal justice, alternative legal services, access to justice, sociolegal research, victimology, and victims’ assistance and restorative justice. Recently, she has focused on access to justice projects aimed at decentralizing, integrating, and diversify- ing justice services, as well as projects involving alternative conflict resolu- tion mechanisms for marginal communities in large cities and populations in small war-stricken towns. She has been resident in Colombia since 1975, and since 1994 she has worked closely with the Colombian Justice House Pro- gram as designer and promoter, first national coordinator, staff trainer, and an evaluator and coordinator of the U.S. Agency for International Development Agency’s project on international cooperation for community justice houses. She is a vice president of the World Society of Victimology. Paul Pre itore is a Senior Public Sector Specialist in the Public Sector Reform Unit of the Middle East and North Africa Region. He holds a J.D. from the Catholic University of America and is a member of the District of Columbia Bar Association. His work within the World Bank focuses on the justice sector and poverty, as well as on broader issues of public sector reform, account- ability, and governance. During his Bank career, he has worked on programs in Djibouti, Egypt, Iraq, Lebanon, Mongolia, Morocco, Palestine, Syria, and Yemen. Prior to joining the Bank, Mr. Pre itore was the Property Law Coor- dinator at the Office of the High Representative in Sarajevo, Bosnia and Her- zegovina, where he coordinated issues related to postconflict land restitution and human rights issues. Avni Rastogi graduated from National Law School of India University, Ban- galore, in 2010. She worked in the Corporate Affairs Department of an oil and gas public sector company in New Delhi for two years. She now works with Sriram Panchu in his mediation practice and as a researcher on mediation and governance issues. She also works as a project coordinator and researcher with Transparent Chennai, an action research group based in Chennai that creates, curates, and disseminates data on civic issues to enable be er planning. Melanie Roestoff is Professor in the Department of Mercantile Law, Univer- sity of Pretoria. She holds the degrees B.L.C., LL.B., LL.M. (cum laude), and LL.D. (2002). The title of her thesis is “A Critical Evaluation of Debt Relief Measures for Individuals in the South African Insolvency Law.” Since her ap- pointment at the University of Pretoria in 1990, Professor Roestoff has taught Contributors xxvii a variety of law subjects at both undergraduate and postgraduate levels. In 2010, she was admi ed as an a orney of the High Court. She is also author or coauthor of numerous publications in a wide variety of peer-reviewed jour- nals and has presented papers at numerous national and international confer- ences. Ms. Roestoff is coauthor of one of the leading textbooks on insolvency law in South Africa: Mars: The Law of Insolvency (9th edition; Juta). Yolanda Saito, LL.B. (cum laude; University of O awa), B.A.Sc. (University of British Columbia), is a member of New York State Bar, a Legal Specialist, Green Economy and Biodiversity, at the International Development Law Or- ganization, and leads the global initiative on Legal Preparedness for Achieving the Aichi Biodiversity Targets. She also serves as the pro bono Program Co- ordinator and as an Associate Fellow with the Human Rights and Poverty Eradication program at the Centre for International Sustainable Development Law and is a Senior Fellow with the One Justice Project. She has previously worked in litigation and administrative law with Ecojustice Canada, ECOLEX Ecuador, Canada’s Air India Inquiry, and McCarthy Tétrault LLP. She has authored briefs and publications on sustainable development law issues, and is currently working on a manuscript on the incorporation of the principles of sustainable development into the jurisprudence of international and regional courts from 1992 to 2012. Elisa Sla ery has a decade of experience working in health, law, and human rights. In September 2012, she joined the International Development Law Or- ganization (IDLO) Social Development Unit, where she has been working on disability, access to safe medicines, and health and gender issues. Prior to joining IDLO, she was the Regional Director of the Africa Program at the Center for Reproductive Rights, a nongovernmental legal organization. Her fact-finding projects in the region focused on abuses of women in health care facilities, discrimination against women living with HIV, and maternal mortality. She has extensive experience working with accountability and human rights mechanisms at the national, regional, and international levels. Ms. Sla ery holds a J.D. from Columbia Law School and an M.A. from Duke University. Bart Stevens is a Senior Communications Officer in the World Bank Group Integrity Vice Presidency, where he coordinates integrity training programs. In 2005, he was responsible for the development and implementation of the communications strategy for the launch of the Bank’s Voluntary Disclosure Program. Prior to joining the World Bank in 1999, Mr. Stevens was a Senior Communications Manager at the European Bank for Reconstruction and Development, in London, where he set up the Bank’s internal communica- tions function. Previously, he worked for more than eight years at the Exxon Chemical International headquarters in Brussels, where he focused on public affairs as well as internal and crisis communications issues. Mr. Stevens holds an M.A. in international affairs and economics from the Johns Hopkins Uni- versity School of Advanced International Studies and a law degree from the Katholieke Universiteit Leuven, Belgium. xxviii Contributors Patricia O. Sulser is a Chief Counsel at International Finance Corporation (IFC), based in Washington, D.C. She is the Global Lead Lawyer for IFC In- fraVentures, a $150 million internally managed fund established by IFC in 2008 to fund and proactively develop private and public-private partner- ship (PPP) infrastructure projects in the poorest emerging-market countries. Ms. Sulser has been involved in the financing of complex, multiparty infra- structure projects for her entire career at IFC and, before, in private practice in the New York; London; and Hong Kong SAR, China offices of Shearman & Sterling. She leads the IFC Legal Department Public-Private Partnership prac- tice group and coordinates with colleagues from the World Bank Group and other development financial institutions on the G20 and World Bank Group PPP agenda. Ms. Sulser is also a certified mediator and has provided legal support for IFC’s establishment of mediation centers around the world. In ad- dition, she actively promotes the use of alternative dispute resolution (includ- ing dispute adjudication boards) in PPP and infrastructure projects world- wide as the best means of keeping these important projects on track. She has recently been appointed to the Dispute Board Federation Advisory Panel and is a member of the Chartered Institute of Arbitrators. David F. Varela is Special Adviser to the Minister of Government of the Re- public of Colombia and the first Policy and Strategy Director of the National Agency for State Legal Defense of Colombia, which was established in 2011 to direct the legal defense activities of more than 300 public sector agencies at the federal level. Mr. Varela worked in the Public Sector Management Unit of the Latin America and the Caribbean Region of the World Bank Group from its Washington, D.C., headquarters between 2007 and 2012. He was responsible for the design and supervision of more than 20 large justice-reform projects supporting judicial authorities in numerous Latin American countries and Morocco. From 1999 to 2002, Mr. Varela worked in the Latin America and the Caribbean Division of the Legal Vice Presidency of the World Bank in Wash- ington, D.C. He received his LL.M. in international business law from the In- stitute of Comparative Law of McGill University (1989), and both a graduate degree in economics and social sciences and a J.D. from Universidad Javeriana (1984). He has wri en extensively on legal subjects and published two books on justice reform: Improving the Performance of Justice Institutions: Lessons from OECD Countries Relevant for Latin America (2011) and The Itagüí Courts: A Case Study in Leadership and Management (2002). Emilio C. Viano has an LL.B. and three master’s degrees in law, an M.A. in sociology and anthropology, and a Ph.D. (summa cum laude) in the sociol- ogy of law (New York University). Recently, he has taught and undertaken research chiefly at American University’s School of Public Affairs and Wash- ington College of Law, but he has also been a professor at the University of Paris, University of Cordoba (Argentina), Panteion University (Athens), Uni- versity of Bologna, China University of Political Science and Law (Beijing), and Shanghai International Studies University, among other institutions. His work in law, criminal justice issues, and governance has been recognized by his election as President of the Scientific Commission and as a Voting Member Contributors xxix of the Board of Directors of the International Society of Criminology (Paris). He is member of the Task Force for the Creation of the UN World Security University. He also chairs the commi ee organizing the World Congress of Criminology to be held in Mexico in August 2014. Dr. Viano has consulted worldwide, especially in the developing world and particularly on security issues. He has published extensively, often speaks at international conferences and universities, and often appears as a political analyst on television and radio stations worldwide. This page intentionally left blank The World Bank Legal Review Volume 5 Fostering Development through Opportunity, Inclusion, and Equity This page intentionally left blank Opportunity, Inclusion, and Equity as Imperatives for Meaningful Law and Justice-Guided Development VINCENT O. NMEHIELLE AND N. R. MADHAVA MENON In our globalized world, it is commonplace to throw around the concept “de- velopment” in a manner that assumes that, somehow, we all share the same understanding of what it means. In reality, there is no universally accepted definition of the concept. As has been observed,1 a broad reading of develop- ment, such as that offered by the report of the Independent Commission on International Development Issues, situates development within the context of economic growth as “desirable social and economic progress,”2 based on the idea that “without [economic] growth and social change one cannot speak of development.”3 Scholars such as Walter Rodney put people at the center of the development process. From this perspective, at the individual level, de- velopment implies “increased skill and capacity, greater freedom, creativity, self-discipline, responsibility and material well-being.”4 Despite the subjective nature of those categories, Rodney maintains that “it is indisputable that the achievement of any of those aspects of personal development is very much tied in with the state of the society as a whole.”5 The emphasis on people in the development process also received the scholarly approval of Julius Nyerere, a respected African statesman and the first president of Tanzania.6 Accord- ing to Nyerere, “roads, buildings and increased crop output are not develop- ment but tools of development”;7 for these to be development, they must help to “develop the minds and understanding of people” or be used “for other 1 Yolanda T. Chekera & Vincent O. Nmehielle, The International Law Principle of Permanent Sov- ereignty over Natural Resources as an Instrument for Development: The Case of Zimbabwean Dia- monds, 6 African J. Leg. Stud. 18 (2013) (hereinafter, Chekera & Nmehielle). 2 Independent Commission on International Development Issues, North–South: A Programme for Survival 48 (Pan Books 1980), cited in Chekera & Nmehielle, supra note 1, at 18. 3 Id. 4 Walter Rodney, How Europe Underdeveloped Africa 9 (Tanzania Publg. H.; Bogle-L’Ouverture 1972), cited in Chekera & Nmehielle, supra note 1, at 18‒19. 5 Id. 6 Julius Nyerere, Freedom and Development (Uhuru na Maendeleo): A Selection from the Writings and Speeches, 1968–1973 59 (Oxford U. Press 1974), cited in Chekera & Nmehielle, supra note 1, at 19. 7 Id. 3 4 The World Bank Legal Review things that improve the health and comfort of the people.”8 In short, the defin- ing feature of development is that it “serves the people.”9 One cannot interrogate an understanding of the concept of development without highlighting the widely acclaimed views of Amartya Sen. Sen argues that economic growth is merely one aspect of development.10 Traditional no- tions of development that conceptualize development as purely a ma er of economic growth fail to appreciate that “economic growth [is] no more than a means to some other objectives.”11 Development must concern itself with “en- titlements of people and capabilities these entitlements generate.”12 Those in- dividuals, organizations, and governments that champion development must commit themselves to reducing that which deprives people and to broadening the choices available to people.13 Sen’s views are echoed by Nayaran et al., who point out that “deprivation represents a multidimensional view of poverty that includes hunger, illiteracy, illness and poor health, powerlessness, voicelessness, insecurity, humiliation, and a lack of access to basic infrastructure.”14 Sen himself sees development in the light of whether people are empowered or disempowered: “whether they can live long, escape avoidable morbidity, be well nourished, be able to read and write and communicate, [and] take part in literary and scientific pursuits,” among other human endeavors.15 Despite the normative and ideological disagreements that exist regarding the notion of a human right to development, the 1986 United Nations Declara- tion on the Right to Development16 adopts a decidedly balanced perspective and cements the people-centered nature of the development process. As rec- ognized in Preamble 2 to the declaration, development must be understood as “a comprehensive economic, social, cultural and political process which aims at the constant improvement of the well-being of the entire population and of the individual on the basis of their active, free and meaningful participation in the development and in the fair distribution of benefits resulting therefrom.”17 8 Id. 9 Id., at 60. 10 Amartya Sen, Development: Which Way Now?, 93 Econ. J. 745, 748 (1983), cited in Chekera & Nmehielle, supra note 1, at 20. 11 Id., at 753. 12 Id., at 754. 13 E. Wayne Nafziger, From Seers to Sen: The Meaning of Economic Development 1 (paper pre- sented at the UN U./World Inst. Dev. Economics Research Jubilee Conference, June 17‒18, 2005), cited in Chekera & Nmehielle, supra note 1, at 20. 14 Deepa Narayan et al., Voices of the Poor: Can Anyone Hear Us? 4‒5 (Oxford U. Press 2000), cited in Chekera & Nmehielle, supra note 1, at 20. 15 Sen, supra note 10, at 754. 16 Declaration on the Right to Development, Res/41/128 (adopted by the U.N. General Assembly, Dec. 4, 1986), cited in Chekera & Nmehielle, supra note 1, at 21. 17 Declaration on the Right to Development, Preamble 2. Opportunity, Inclusion, and Equity as Imperatives for 5 Meaningful Law and Justice-Guided Development In a further step toward giving content to the meaning of development, the eight Millennium Development Goals (MDGs),18 as articulated in 2000 under the auspices of the United Nations and other development agencies, exem- plify global aspirations to improve the well-being of the world’s poor and reflect the general agreement of the majority of the world’s countries and de- velopment institutions regarding the tangible a ributes of development (with particular resonance in developing countries). The MDGs do not, however, define what development is or is not. Yet, while the definition of development remains protean, a clear consen- sus exists that development must serve people and society, and must priori- tize how the development process affects people, particularly the poor and the most vulnerable in society. As Peet and Hartwick argue, “human emancipation and human welfare”19 must be central to development. The title of this volume drives the message home. Fostering Development through Opportunity, Inclusion, and Equity speaks to the holistic nature of the development process, a process that should not only encourage all stakeholders to participate in the process but also directly engage them. This volume generally and this introductory chapter in particular posit that such participation must be guided by the law and accord with the broader notion of justice for development as a concept to be meaningfully appreciated today. A process that takes place without giving stakeholders an opportunity to participate, or that excludes stakeholders, is not only an unfair and inequitable process but also one that is likely to fall foul of the notion of justice in a society that is governed by the rule of law. Thus, equitable participation necessitates a careful inquiry into the conceptual underpinnings of opportunity, inclusion, and equity as law and justice tools that can be used to secure elements of meaningful development. Opportunity as Key for Development: Inclusion and Equity as Strategies for Achieving Development “Opportunity” is an important dimension of the equality guarantee enshrined in most constitutional documents. Denial of equal opportunity in terms of access to basic needs such as health, education, work, leisure, and housing, particularly in societies with a long history of discrimination and exploita- tion based on race, caste, gender, and religion, results in skewed development inimical to the rule of law and equal justice under law. Arguments based on equity and inclusion can be advanced to equalize development opportunities 18 These goals as articulated include the eradication of “extreme poverty and hunger”; the achievement of “universal primary education”; the promotion of “gender equality” and the empowerment of women; the reduction of “child mortality”; the improvement of “maternal health”; the need to “combat HIV/AIDS, malaria and other diseases”; and ensuring “envi- ronmental sustainability” and the development of “a global partnership for development.” See We Can End Poverty 2015: Millennium Development Goals—A Gateway to the UN System’s Work on the MDGs, available at h p://www.un.org/millenniumgoals/. 19 Richard Peet & Elaine Hartwick, Theories of Development: Contentions, Arguments, Alternatives, 2d ed., 1 (Guilford 2009), cited in Chekera & Nmehielle, supra note 1, at 21. 6 The World Bank Legal Review through the introduction of appropriate policies and regulations of the gov- ernments concerned. These policies relate not only to the prohibition of dis- crimination but also, and more importantly, to the creation of conditions in which equality of outcomes or substantive equality will appear in communi- ties previously long excluded from development. To a certain extent, affirma- tive action measures such as reserving a certain number of places for excluded groups in schools and universities can help to meet demands for equal oppor- tunity for those groups. In the progressive realization of the conditions that tend to ensure equality of opportunity for all, development may have to take certain forms that may not make economic sense in the short term. However, the wisdom of designing and implementing locally owned policies, laws, and institutions becomes apparent once the needs of future generations (of whose heritage we are stewards) are taken sustainably into account, especially if those local measures and actors address failures of management over global public goods, such as biodiversity and climate change. This notion of sustain- able development can be achieved through the assertion of many important principles, including through legal and institutional reform that ensures the integration of environmental and social considerations into economic decision making that affects many sectors of policy and law related to poverty reduc- tion and broader sustainable development goals.20 In essence, legal systems consciously make choices, intervening in economic planning and social recon- struction to help create conditions of equal opportunity for all. In balancing such choices with the freedom and liberty of individuals, the judiciary also plays a critical role. Inclusive growth or growth with social justice is advocated in many societies as a conceptual foundation on which to build sustainable development under the rule of law. In India and South Africa, for example, the legal system has embraced this model of law and development. When he was U.S. president during the civil rights movement, Lyndon B. Johnson spoke of the significance of “opportunity” in individual and social development: Freedom is not enough. You do not wipe away the scars of centu- ries by saying, “Now you are free to go where you want and do as you desire, and choose the leaders you please.” You do not take a person who, for years, has been hobbled by chains and liberate him, bring him up to the starting line of a race and then say, “you are free to compete with others” and still justly believe that you have been completely fair. Thus, it is not enough just to open the gates of opportunity. All our citizens must have the ability to walk through those gates. This is the next and more profound stage of the ba le for civil rights. We seek not just freedom but opportunity. We seek not just legal equity but human ability, not just equality as a right and a 20 Marie-Claire Cordonier Segger & Ashfaq Khalfan, Sustainable Development Law: Principles, Practices and Prospects (Oxford U. Press 2004); Marie-Claire Cordonier & C. G. Weeramantry eds., Sustainable Justice: Integrating Social, Economic and Environmental Law (Martinus Nijhoff 2004). Opportunity, Inclusion, and Equity as Imperatives for 7 Meaningful Law and Justice-Guided Development theory but equality as a fact and equality as a result. . . . To this end equal opportunity is essential, but not enough.21 Fifteen years earlier, the Indian social reformer and constitutional expert B. R. Ambedkar had pinpointed a contradiction between political equality, on the one hand, and social and economic equality, on the other hand. Address- ing the Constituent Assembly while presenting the draft of the republican constitution, Ambedkar said: On the 26th January, 1950 we are going to enter a life of contradic- tions. In politics we have equality and in social and economic life, we will have inequality. In politics we will be recognizing the principle of one man one vote and one vote one value. In our social and eco- nomic life, we shall, by reason of our social and economic structure, continue to deny the principle of one man one value. How long shall we continue to live this life of contradictions? How long shall we continue to deny equality in our social and economic life? If we con- tinue to deny it for long, we will do so only by pu ing our political democracy in peril.22 These statements, from two very different continents, highlight the chal- lenges that legal systems in liberal democracies have faced in guiding develop- ment without losing civil rights or political democracy. The roads traveled by such legal systems are different and the distance covered has varied. Yet, their destination is the same, namely equal opportunity for all and equality before law. The strategy they have employed has been to adhere to the rule of law while balancing rights to equality, freedom, and liberty. In the process, differ- ent jurisdictions have evolved systems of equality, jurisprudence, and access to justice that have helped to make development sustainable and inclusive. In terms of development, equity entails the manner in which “resources and opportunities are distributed in society”23—a fair manner that takes all groups and individuals into account so as to level the “playing field to achieve 21 Lyndon B. Johnson (1965), as quoted in the Report on the Equal Opportunity Commission (Min- istry of Minority Affairs, Government of India 2008). One is also reminded of the statement of British suffragist Harriot Stanton Blatch (1856‒1940) on the lack of voting opportunity for marginalized groups, as quoted by Susan B. Anthony & Ida Husted Harper in History of Woman Suffrage, vol. 4, ch. 18 (1902): I have seen in my time two enormous extensions of the suffrage to men—one in Amer- ica and one in England. But neither the negroes in the South nor the agricultural labor- ers in Great Britain had shown before they got the ballot any capacity of government; for they had never had the opportunity to take the first steps of political action. Very different has been the history of the march of women toward a recognized position in the State. We have had to prove our ability at each stage of progress, and have gained nothing without having satisfied a test of capacity. (emphasis added) Available at h p://quotes.dictionary.com/i_have_seen_in_my_time_two_enormous#zms -hfAhipiiLzWA.99. 22 Constituent Assembly Debates (vol. 11) 944‒945 (1943). 23 Josephine Tucker & Eva Ludi, Empowerment and Equity, in Poverty Reduction and Pro-poor Growth: The Role of Empowerment 227 (OECD 2012). Available at h p://doi.org/10.1787 /9789264168350-en. 8 The World Bank Legal Review equality of opportunity.”24 The emphasis on equity is particularly important in the context of global commitments to more sustainable development, in- cluding the commitment to establish regimes and regulatory instruments necessary to secure sound stewardship of natural resources in a way that is intergenerationally equitable, demonstrating respect for the needs of both present and future generations, as is increasingly recognized in international courts and tribunals.25 When opportunity, inclusion, and equity are present in a society, an enabling environment can be facilitated, which in turn can promote economic empowerment, “political voice,” access to justice, the de- livery of and “access to public services,” the reduction or extermination of “discrimination and social exclusion,” and more just and sustainable devel- opment outcomes.26 Conversely, the absence of opportunity, inclusion, and equity leads to exclusion, which lays the foundations for a heated polity of “conflict and insecurity,” with risks of ethnic war in societies in Sub-Saharan Africa (and other regions of the world) “where one or more ethnic groups face active discrimination.”27 The “Occupy” movements that followed the global economic meltdown in many developed countries, like the Arab Spring revo- lutions that started in Tunisia and blew across Libya and Egypt and into Syria, provide a glimpse into how societies can respond to various forms of lack of opportunity, exclusion, and inequity in governance. Law by its very nature is an instrument of social order, and as such it is well positioned to respond to the societal yearning for development by mainstreaming opportunity, inclusion, and equity—all elements of justice in sustainable development. Effective, strong, and functional legal and judicial institutions are essential in the global quest to accelerate development around the world. In other words, there cannot be effective development without the rule of law, which, as characterized by the World Justice Project in the Rule of Law Index, hinges on “four universal principles”: I. The government and its officials and agents are accountable under the law. II. The laws are clear, publicized, stable, and fair, and protect fun- damental rights, including the security of persons and property. III. The process by which the laws are enacted, administered and enforced is accessible, fair and efficient. IV. Justice is delivered by competent, ethical and independent rep- resentatives and neutrals who are of sufficient number, have 24 Id. 25 Marie-Claire Cordonier Segger & Yolanda Saito eds., Sustainable Development in International Courts and Tribunals (Routledge forthcoming). 26 Tucker & Ludi, supra note 23, at 227–232. 27 Id., at 232. Opportunity, Inclusion, and Equity as Imperatives for 9 Meaningful Law and Justice-Guided Development adequate resources, and reflect the makeup of the communities they serve.28 This quartet of principles reinforces the contemporary view of develop- ment as people centered, because a society based on the rule of law as articu- lated by the World Justice Project will clearly serve the interest of the society at large. To these four principles, we can add a fifth, underscored and explained in the assembled works of this volume: regulatory and institutional reforms are coherent and participatory across sectors, integrating social, economic, and environmental considerations to meet the sustainable development needs of present and future generations. While such principles are typically embodied in legislation, they are equal- ly represented in subsidiary legislation, such as regulations, as well as admin- istrative directives and policies for the implementation of various legislative endeavors, and administrative actions that eventually touch on development plans and initiatives. Deploying these principles in the development process is bound to promote equal opportunity, inclusion, and equity—all pivotal ele- ments of justice. We cannot create a be er world, one that caters to the diverse needs of our global society, without entrenching the theme of this volume in the development process. Opportunity, inclusion, and equity in global devel- opment are clearly the foundation stones of the MDGs, and their importance is growing yet greater in the context of a new post-2015 sustainable develop- ment agenda that builds on the gains of implementing the eight Millennium Development Goals while identifying new development challenges. Thematic and Specific Issues Covered in This Volume This volume is made up of 32 chapters organized into 5 thematic parts. Part I, “Law and the Economy,” includes chapters 1–7; part II, “Justice and Rule of Law Reform,” is made up of chapters 8–13; part III, “Environmental and Natural Resources Law,” spans chapters 14–18; part IV, “Governance and Anticorruption,” comprises chapters 19–24; and part V, “Empowerment and Equity for Diverse Communities,” includes chapters 25–30. The volume ends with a concluding chapter and an afterword. Law and the Economy Chapter 1, by Patricia O. Sulser and Cyril Chern, is titled “Keeping Public- Private Partnership Infrastructure Projects on Track: The Power of Multi- stakeholder Partnering Commi ees and Dispute Boards in Emerging-Market Infrastructure Projects.” The authors posit that unlike traditional public infra- structure projects, public-private partnership (PPP) projects have not gener- ally specified the use of contemporary dispute resolution methods, includ- ing facilitative mediation, dispute boards, and conciliation. They propose that stakeholders in complex, multistakeholder infrastructure projects structured 28 Mark David Agrast et al., Rule of Law Index 2012‒2013 Report 3 (World Justice Project 2012). 10 The World Bank Legal Review as PPPs or fully private sector projects in emerging markets adopt a culture and routine mechanism to anticipate, evaluate, and resolve disputes on a real- time basis through the use of “multistakeholder commi ees,” called “part- nering commi ees,” that include the appointment of a subset group, called a “standing dispute board,” empowered to identify and ultimately to resolve disputes on a real-time basis and expeditiously. Chapter 2, by Beth Anne Hoffman and Charles Boudry, is titled “Pro- tecting Traditional Practices and Country of Origin in Developing Countries through Fair Trade and Intellectual Property Rights.” The authors interrogate ways to protect traditional and local producers of commodities such as cof- fee. Specifically, the authors explore Ethiopia’s legal and policy measures to bolster coffee exports through branding and trademarking coffees on the in- ternational market that began in mid-2000. In chapter 3, “Tools for More Sustainable Trade Treaties with Develop- ing Countries,” Markus W. Gehring explains that impact assessments can be applied not only to transboundary development projects but also to develop- ment policies and plans such as trade agreements. This leading expert dis- cusses how new forms of impact assessments, mandated by law or policy, can be expanded to take into account not just physical environmental issues but also questions of equity, inclusion, and opportunity. He argues that by doing so, the processes can identify and encourage more sustainable trade treaties with developing countries. With a focus on the European Union’s Sustain- ability Impact Assessment, the author highlights the connection between law, policy, and development. André Boraine and Melanie Roestoff’s chapter, “The Treatment of Insol- vency of Natural Persons in South African Law: An Appeal for a Balanced and Integrated Approach,” addresses South Africa’s statutory and nonstatutory procedures pertaining to the insolvency of natural persons as well as aspects of the legal position regarding the regulation of insolvency practitioners and the insolvency reform initiatives currently on the table. They argue that with regard to natural persons, although the system provides for both liquidation and repayment plans for overindebted consumer debtors, presently there is no principled view and approach regarding the treatment of the insolvency of consumer debtors in South African law. José M. Garrido’s chapter, “The Role of Personal Insolvency Law in Eco- nomic Development: An Introduction to the World Bank Report on the Treat- ment of the Insolvency of Natural Persons,” puts the World Bank report in context. The chapter describes the approach taken by the report and the main issues that a personal insolvency regime needs to address in order to contribute to development and to counteract the negative side effects of increased access to finance. The author posits that the concept of discharge occupies a central role, because it provides the possibility for insolvent debtors to return to a produc- tive life for their own benefit and for the benefit of society as a whole. Opportunity, Inclusion, and Equity as Imperatives for 11 Meaningful Law and Justice-Guided Development In chapter 6, “Specialized Insolvency Regimes for Islamic Banks: Regula- tory Prerogative and Process Design,” Hdeel Abdelhady proposes the adop- tion of specialized, administratively managed resolution regimes for Islamic banks. The author argues that the proposed resolution model is substantively appropriate and multipurpose in that it addresses, in a practical way, current deficits in relevant legal and regulatory environments, advances the sharia policy of effective market regulation, incorporates banking and capital market provisions that fit the cross-market nature of Islamic banking, and advances the convergence of Islamic and conventional insolvency regimes. Part I closes with Fabiano de Andrade Correa’s chapter, “The Role of Law in the Green Economy: Challenges and Opportunities for the Liberalization of Environmental Goods and Services.” The chapter explores how law can sup- port the green economy by analyzing the challenges and opportunities related to the liberalization of trade on environmental goods and services (EGS). The author contends that trade can be a driver in the transition to a green economy by, among other relevant objectives, helping to create and strengthen mar- kets for goods and services that respond to sustainable development consid- erations. He further argues that while the inclusion of EGS liberalization in a regional context can help propel regulation and incentivize the transition to a green economy, the point remains that regional measures cannot by them- selves create an effective global regulatory framework. Justice and Rule of Law Reform Part II opens with chapter 8, “Institutional Responses to Social Demands: En- hancing Access to Justice in Colombia,” in which David F. Varela and Anne e Pearson propose a policy of rationalization for the new options for access to justice, especially by vulnerable social groups, made possible by the 1991 Con- stitution of Colombia. In chapter 9, “The Role of Access to Information in Promoting Develop- ment,” Sean Fraser examines the status of the right to development in interna- tional law and the role that access to information plays in promoting tangible human development. The author argues that although the right to develop- ment has gained acceptance among states and scholars, its practical imple- mentation has been underwhelming in light of its vast potential. He posits that the failure to maximize the benefits of the right is due, at least in part, to the inaccessibility of information that groups and individuals can use to pro- mote and protect their human rights. In chapter 10, “The Search for Opportunity and Inclusion: Insecurity and Migration,” Emilio Viano explores the impact of the lack of rule of law on mi- gration and the security of the migrant. The author argues that migrants are often caught in the middle of “the push and pull” in this regard and become very vulnerable to exploitation and victimization at all stages of the migration journey. The chapter examines measures and policies designed to alleviate the situation that leads to the trafficking, exploitation, enslavement, and servitude of migrants. The author stresses the importance of respecting the rule of law, 12 The World Bank Legal Review especially international refugee law, in the countries of destination in order to ameliorate the current situation and prevent victimization. N. R. Madhava Menon’s contribution, chapter 11, is titled “Toward a Na- tional Framework Law on Water for India” and inquires into how to meet the water demands of India’s 1.3 billion people in terms of both quantity and quality, given the constraints of geography and the country’s rainfall pa ern. Almost half the rainfall that the country receives happens during a period of only two to three weeks, and about 90 percent of river flows occur in just four months in a year. In the same vein, 70 percent of surface water is contaminat- ed by biological, toxic, organic, and inorganic pollutants. The author argues that the scheme for the distribution of powers for water management between the three levels of government has not worked well, hence the adoption of a National Water Policy and an a empt to legislate a framework law on water management that is binding on all three levels. The chapter examines the ele- ments of the framework law and the prospects of its adoption in view of the emerging crisis in water availability and governance. In chapter 12, “Targeting Justice Sector Services to Promote Equity and Inclusion for the Poor in Jordan,” Paul Pre itore examines the state of service delivery for the poor in the justice sector of Jordan. Drawing on data from a novel household survey devoted solely to justice sector issues that was con- ducted by the Jordanian Department of Statistics in 2011, the author discusses the reforms introduced to benefit poor users of court services. He assesses the current state of the delivery of justice sector services to the poor and explores policy development; the demand side of services; gaps in service delivery; new services under development; and gender aspects of service delivery. The chap- ter also highlights a number of areas in which reforms might gain traction. To end part II, Nicholas Joseph’s chapter, “Serving the Justice Needs of the People: Adopting an Access to Justice Approach in Somalia’s Rule of Law Reform,” examines the potential of “bo om-up and pro-poor approaches” in the development of access to justice in Somalia as a postconflict country. In this regard, the author discusses how the Somali government as well as inter- veners in the country can focus on equity, inclusion, and opportunity in de- veloping rule of law cultures, rather than strengthening and often solidifying the elite status of justice and legal institutions. Environmental and Natural Resources Law Part III begins with Edesio Fernandes’s chapter, “The Challenges of Reform- ing the Urban Legal Framework: A Critical Assessment of Brazil’s City Statute 10 Years Later.” The author explores the topic against the background that in development discourses, management of natural resources occupies a sig- nificant place and several principles have evolved and found universal accep- tance. Law on urban development is part of this package of principles. How- ever, there are serious shortcomings with the implementation mechanisms in place. These shortcomings are generally the result of pressure groups and of sociopolitical processes. The author points out that Brazil’s urban policy law Opportunity, Inclusion, and Equity as Imperatives for 13 Meaningful Law and Justice-Guided Development of 2001 is a case study on the subject that highlights the pitfalls in the legal regulation of urbanization and its effect on development policies. In chapter 15, “Innovative Legal Measures for Climate Change Response in the Green Economy: Integrating Opportunity, Inclusion, and Equity,” Marie-Claire Cordonier Segger and Yolanda Saito argue that for a greener economy to truly take root, participatory legal and institutional reforms are needed, as are new economic opportunities for all. The authors point out that innovative legal instruments are currently being pioneered to address climate change in many countries. However, they argue, in order for these reforms to be just and implementable, they must also resolve important challenges of in- clusion and equity, ensuring that the poorest and most vulnerable can access the benefits of climate finance and the new global green economy. The authors underline that, as recognized in “The Future We Want,” the declaration of the 2012 United Nations Commission on Sustainable Development, there is a need for countries to move away from old economic practices that externalize environmental and social costs, widening disparities in human security and wasting scarce resources, and to start implementing a new green economy that responds to pressing priorities of climate change, poverty reduction, and sustainable development. In chapter 16, “The Constitutional Basis of Public Participation in Envi- ronmental Governance: Framing Equitable Opportunities at National and County Government Levels in Kenya,” Robert Kibugi examines the 2010 Con- stitution of Kenya as an interesting example of how governance is envisaged by the general society to maximize public participation and sustainable devel- opment. The constitution provides choices and opportunities to the admin- istration to follow universally accepted principles in environmental decision making. The author argues that in the context of this constitutional provision, informed decisions can be made at all levels of government for equitable and sustainable development in Kenya. “Do planning regulations contribute to social justice or exacerbate social disputes?” is the question examined in chapter 17 by Rachelle Alterman. “Plan- ning Laws, Development Controls, and Social Equity: Lessons for Developing Countries” finds that planning regulations do exacerbate social disparities, more so in developing countries because regulations are vulnerable to greater misuse in the developing world. Focusing on development control instru- ments, the author advises decision makers in developing countries, including representatives of aid organizations, to be careful in allowing the transplanta- tion of planning laws from advanced economies to developing ones, because those laws may not take local circumstances into account. In a similar vein, Ma hew Glasser in chapter 18, “Land Use Law and the City: Toward Inclusive Planning,” draws out the relationship between urban law and development outcomes. The author posits that when the laws are in- appropriate or impractical for the majority of the city population, an informal sector vulnerable to eviction develops that raises problems of human rights protection. The contention is often about affordable access to the city, jobs, 14 The World Bank Legal Review and other opportunities that very often get protection from the courts even if the se lements are informal and therefore outside the law. He concludes that good urban law must consider affordability and access to the city. Governance and Anticorruption Corruption subverts governance, undermines the rule of law, and wreaks havoc on the lives and livelihoods of people, particularly the poor. Although anti- corruption laws are in place in most jurisdictions, their impact is generally limited. This issue is perceived in terms of access to justice and denial of basic rights and has led to organized movements seeking accountability in gover- nance. In chapter 19, “Fighting Corruption in Education: A Call for Sector In- tegrity Standards,” which begins part IV, Mihaylo Milovanovitch argues in favor of sectorwide standards of integrity and a sector-specific prevention approach to fighting corruption. The author recommends cross-border agree- ments against malpractices as an effective way to combat corruption. In chapter 20, “The Ba le between Corruption and Governance in India: Strategies for Tipping the Scale,” Sriram Panchu and Avni Rastogi focus on big-ticket corruption, given the limited resources available for the fight against corruption and the possible impact of exposing and punishing corrup- tion at the highest level of government on the lower rungs of officialdom. The authors recommend the establishment of a strong, high-profile, independent authority to oversee and discipline the leadership of the government and state bureaucracy. In chapter 21, “Leveling the Playing Field: A Race to the Top,” Bart Ste- vens and Robert Delonis submit that any strategy to fight corruption needs to ensure that the operating field is level and allows the private sector to operate in an environment of fair competition and equal treatment under the rule of law. They recommend a model of partnership between development agen- cies and private firms based on voluntary disclosure, negotiated resolution agreements, and an integrity compliance system as the best way to level the field. The authors point out that this model was evolved by the World Bank Group, which created a sanctions system that excludes firms and individuals that undermine fair competition from bidding in World Bank–supported de- velopment project contracts. It is, however, interesting to note that Frank Fariello and Giovanni Bo, in chapter 22, “The World Bank Group Sanctions System and Access to Justice for Small and Medium-Size Enterprises,” find the World Bank’s sanctions sys- tem not to be as effective vis-à-vis small and medium-size enterprises, which, unlike larger enterprises, simply refuse to engage with it, possibly because of an “access to justice” issue for such small and medium-size enterprises. The authors suggest modifications to make the system fairer and to more ad- equately address the lower capacities of small and medium-size players in accessing justice under the system. Opportunity, Inclusion, and Equity as Imperatives for 15 Meaningful Law and Justice-Guided Development As a way of dealing with corruption in governance, William T. Loris, in chapter 23, “Private Civil Actions: A Tool for a Citizen-Led Ba le against Cor- ruption,” recommends encouraging and facilitating civil actions by citizens. This could be accomplished by providing for specific remedial and recovery measures and empowering victims of corruption with support from media and civil society to fight corruption. He contends that the threat of criminal prosecution will succeed in fighting corruption only if political will and com- mitment are present along with an independent, noncorrupt judiciary. Even so, private civil actions duly sanctioned by the legal system can become an additional weapon in a citizen-led ba le against corruption. Chapter 24, “Fostering Opportunity through Development Finance in Af- rica: Legal Perspectives from the African Development Bank,” looks at inter- national economic governance and development. Kalidou Gadio proposes a purposive rather than literal construction of the mandate of the African De- velopment Bank in order to promote innovative economic interventions for sustainable development in African countries. This approach would take into account the circumstances of the various countries, some of which have been affected by conflicts and thus require innovative service delivery. Empowerment and Equity for Diverse Communities Against the background of mainstreaming the marginalized in development by providing for equal opportunities, part V begins with Vincent O. Nmehielle and John-Mark Iyi’s chapter, “Nation Building, State Reconstruction, and Incl usiveness: Issues on South Sudan as a New State and Somalia as a Failed but Reemerging State.” The authors opine that South Sudan and Somalia share some significant characteristics: both have been conflict zones in decades of civil wars; and the ethnic groups and clans of both states have a common his- tory of political exclusion, social injustice, and economic inequality. Both have also recently started out on the path of nation building and state reconstruction. The chapter examines the prospects of nation building and reconstruction in both states and uses a cause-and-effect analysis to argue for a development approach that is based on the rule of law, social justice, and equality. The authors contend that some core values of governance, when entrenched in constitutive instruments of the state, function as indispensable drivers of so- cial cohesion, political stability, and socioeconomic development; they also argue that nation building and reconstruction efforts in these countries must be anchored on these norms. For meaningful development to occur, both states must design policies that emphasize uniting factors while addressing grievances and other structural issues that, if left to fester, heighten group differences. In chapter 26, “Enabling Equal Opportunities for Women in the World of Work: The Intersections of Formal and Informal Constraints,” Jeni Klugman and Ma hew Morton argue that multiple constraints in culture, markets, and institutions inhibit women from accessing equal opportunities. They main- tain that law reform in this regard can easily be thwarted by implementation 16 The World Bank Legal Review challenges, including information gaps, institutional biases, and adverse so- cial norms. The authors contend that law reform that is supplemented by policy efforts can, to a certain extent, redress gender gaps, particularly in the world of work. David Pa erson, Elisa Sla ery, and Naomi Burke-Shyne’s chapter, “The Role of Law in Promoting the Right to Health for Diverse Communities,” finds discrimination and stigma in the delivery of health services to be a se- rious problem in realizing the right to health in diverse communities. They argue that unless proactive policies supported by legal sanctions are adopted, vulnerable groups in diverse communities will be denied the right to health. Along the same lines, Siobhán McInerney-Lankford and Moses Mulumba in chapter 28, “The Right to Health and Development: The Case of Uganda,” highlight the centrality of the right to health in shaping health policy and de- livery of health services. The authors draw out the content of that right in relation to development goals, pointing out how human rights can add value to development policies and programs. In a conceptual analysis of India’s experience in development, Pulapre Balakrishnan argues in chapter 29, “Mainstreaming the Marginalized in De- velopment: Conceptualizing the Challenges in India,” that “capability” lies at the core of freedom, opportunity, and development. The author contends that it is the marginalized sections of Indian society that lack capability. Al- though the Indian Constitution has some impressive provisions regarding building capability, they are inadequate when it comes to capacitating the marginalized. The author concludes that the “future of development in India lies squarely in the space of politics,” with concrete political action needed to implement the provisions of the constitution. The final element in part V is Anupama Dokeniya’s chapter, “The Right to Information as a Tool for Community Empowerment.” It posits that the right to information is universally acclaimed as an effective instrument to fight corrup- tion by exposing it in the public. Referencing examples from India and Mexico, the author explains how the right to information has been used as a tool to expose the corrupt practices of administrative officials and thereby mobilize people to demand corrective action. She concludes that the full potential of this tool is not yet realized in many communities because of low awareness, weak civil society groups, and the unwillingness of officials to release information. In the concluding chapter of the volume, Hassane Cissé and Marie-Claire Cordonier Segger emphasize that, now more than ever, there is an urgent need to mainstream law and justice into development, given the critical devel- opment challenges the world faces, such as state fragility and conflict, climate change, food insecurity, bad governance, and persistent gender inequality. They argue that viewing these issues through a justice lens would more ef- fectively promote the rule of law, eradicate extreme poverty, and ultimately achieve broader development goals. This approach should also guide and in- form global actions in mapping out a robust post-2015 development agenda. Opportunity, Inclusion, and Equity as Imperatives for 17 Meaningful Law and Justice-Guided Development Indeed, the issues covered in this volume highlight the fact that law is an instrument able to foster inclusion and equal opportunity in the development process. Indeed, inclusion and equal opportunity are at the root of governance, whether economic or political governance. Sustainable global development can be achieved only if the law is deployed to help develop and implement policies and programs that ensure opportunity and minimize marginalization. This page intentionally left blank PART I LAW AND THE ECONOMY This page intentionally left blank Keeping Public-Private Partnership Infrastructure Projects on Track The Power of Multistakeholder Partnering Committees and Dispute Boards in Emerging-Market Infrastructure Projects PATRICIA O. SULSER AND CYRIL CHERN Efforts to expand and improve traditional and social infrastructure and pub- lic services (such as water and sanitation; electricity generation, transmission, and distribution; roads, railways, ports, and airports; hospitals and clinics; schools; and prisons) are intrinsic to sustainable economic growth and pov- erty alleviation, especially in fragile and conflict-affected states and rural ar- eas, where the poorest communities can lack the broad and inclusive access required to enjoy a dignified existence and to graduate from extreme poverty.1 When successfully implemented, these infrastructure projects and public services can directly address issues of opportunity, inclusion, and equity, as explained in more detail below.2 It is therefore important to develop tools that enhance the successful implementation of these projects and the delivery of public services. This chapter addresses one such tool. The direct cost of building and maintaining this infrastructure is indisput- ably very high. Due to the size and complexity of these projects and the varied interests of the parties involved, disputes inevitably arise during the course of public-private partnership (PPP) and private sector infrastructure develop- ment projects. Unlike traditional public infrastructure projects, PPP projects have to date not generally specified the use of contemporary dispute resolu- tion methods, such as facilitative mediation, dispute boards, and conciliation. Left unresolved, disputes can result in enormous unplanned costs and delays, 1 The International Finance Corporation (IFC) uses the term “traditional” infrastructure to mean water; sanitation; electricity generation, transmission, and distribution; roads, rail- ways, ports, and airports; and some logistics, etc. It uses the term “social” to refer to hos- pitals, clinics and health services; educational facilities; and prisons, etc. IFC invests in and mobilizes resources for all of these kinds of projects and also provides advisory services in both the traditional and social infrastructure areas, primarily to governments but also to cor- porations, covering structuring of public-private partnerships and investment-climate work, among other things. 2 See World Bank, Infrastructure, Strategy, available at h p://web.worldbank.org/WBSITE /EXTERNAL/TOPICS/EXTINFRA/0,,contentMDK:23117980~menuPK:8497224~pagePK:641 68445~piPK:64168309~theSitePK:8430730,00.html; and 7(1) Jobs 14‒15 (2013), an IFC private sector development-solutions publication. 21 22 The World Bank Legal Review and in unnecessary damage to reputations and relationships―this in a sector that can ill afford any of these consequences. This chapter proposes that stakeholders in complex multistakeholder in- frastructure projects structured as PPPs and fully private sector projects in emerging markets adopt a culture and routine mechanism to anticipate, eval- uate, and resolve disputes on a real-time basis. This chapter further proposes that this be achieved through the use of multistakeholder commi ees called “partnering commi ees,”3 which include the appointment of a subset group, called a “standing dispute board,” which is empowered to identify and ul- timately to resolve disputes contemporaneously and expeditiously. Finally, this chapter shows how to incorporate the necessary processes into the project structure, how to select and empower the boards, how to justify the cost, and how to maximize effectiveness, all with a view to keeping projects on budget and on track, to ensuring optimal results, and to preserving the business envi- ronment for future projects. Context: Public Infrastructure and Traditional Dispute Resolution Poor infrastructure development can cost economies billions of dollars a year in missed opportunities and negative drag on economic growth.4 In fact, the International Bank for Reconstruction and Development was established to help rebuild the infrastructure of Europe after World War II because of the im- portance of infrastructure to the region’s renewed economic growth. Stated in the positive, successful implementation of infrastructure projects and delivery of public services are the engine of growth. Importantly, they also contribute directly to the promotion of opportunity, inclusion, and equity. They are typi- cally designed to provide affordable access to all segments of the population, including indigenous populations, rural communities, and the poorest and marginalized. For instance, opportunities are created through job creation as a result of the investments themselves and through increased economic de- velopment as a result of improvements to a country’s infrastructure; there is more equity when people can receive the infrastructure service involved. Gen- erally, tools that encourage and facilitate PPP and private sector investments 3 In some large and complex projects, a “steering commi ee” is appointed and meets regu- larly to take stock of the project’s progress. Such a commi ee is not typically empowered to resolve disputes and frequently does not meet physically, including at the site or even in the country. 4 See IFC Support to Infrastructure, Transactions in Power, Transport and Water (Intl. Fin. Corp. 2009), available at h p://www1.ifc.org/wps/wcm/connect/62aa5680498390a982c4d2336b93 d75f/InfrastructureBooklet_FINALweb.pdf?MOD=AJPERES&CACHEID=62aa5680498390a 982c4d2336b93d75f; see also Africa’s Infrastructure: A Time for Transformation (Agence Fran- çaise de Développement, World Bank 2010), available at h p://siteresources.worldbank.org /INTAFRICA/Resources/aicd_overview_english_no-embargo.pdf. There are myriad schol- arly articles wri en by economists on the relationship between infrastructure and economic growth, easily found by searching any of the more common Web-based search engines, such as Google, or relevant institutional and academic databases. Keeping Public-Private Partnership 23 Infrastructure Projects on Track in infrastructure would certainly increase access to basic resources and create more equity between segments of the population. Major projects for the delivery and operation of infrastructure and public services in developed countries are notoriously difficult to prioritize, plan, ap- prove, implement, and operate. They are a natural context for conflict given their high profile and the high stakes for governments, users of the services, and the public at large, the la er of which is often taxed or charged, directly or indirectly, to pay for the millions (often, billions) required for the construction and operation of these projects over the long term. Two limited examples of major infrastructure projects gone wrong are the Big Dig in Boston5 and the Channel Tunnel in England,6 each of which suffered significant delays and enormous cost overruns for various reasons, including legitimate reasons not due to any party’s fault. Implementing projects for the delivery and operation of basic infrastruc- ture and public services in emerging markets can be even more challenging given the constraints on public budgets7 and government’s technical or hu- man capacity, including the capacity to monitor and supervise works by third parties. Projects in fragile and conflict-affected states and in rural areas de- signed to provide broad and inclusive access to the poorest communities pres- ent another layer of challenges, even if projects are smaller and smaller sums are involved. Such projects have been an area of intense strategic focus for the G20, the World Bank Group, and other international-development financial institutions dedicated to the alleviation of poverty around the world.8 Given the constraints on emerging-market governments, there is consen- sus around the need to mobilize the private sector to provide financial and 5 The Central Artery/Tunnel (CA/T) project, known informally as the Big Dig, was a mas- sive project begun in 1982 in Boston that rerouted the city’s central highway into a 3.5-mile tunnel. The project also included the construction of a tunnel, a bridge, and an elevated highway. The Big Dig was the most expensive highway project in the United States and was plagued by, among other things, rising costs, delays, design flaws, and allegations of poor execution and use of substandard materials, not to mention criminal charges. The project was originally scheduled to be completed in 1998 at an estimated cost of $2.8 billion (in historical dollar values). The project was completed nearly ten years late at a cost overrun of more than $10 billion (nearly 190 percent over planned costs). 6 The Channel Tunnel from Dover/Folkestone, England to Calais, France, is a 50-kilometer undersea rail tunnel running beneath the English Channel. “From the word go, construc- tion of the channel tunnel was blighted by delays which caused a rapid escalation of costs. By the time Eurotunnel opened in May 1994, it was one year behind schedule and £2bn ($3.6bn) over budget. Before the first passenger car had boarded Le Shu le for the short trip from Folkestone to Calais, the original business plan was in ta ers.” See Jeff Randall, How Eurotunnel Went So Wrong, BBC News (June 13, 2005), available at h p://news.bbc.co.uk/2 /hi/business/4088868.stm. 7 Developing countries, especially the poorest countries and those with limited natural re- sources, have limited ability to raise funds through taxation or to charge for public services, and end users are often unable to afford tariffs charged for such services. 8 See World Bank, Infrastructure, available at h p://web.worldbank.org/WBSITE/EXTERNAL /NEWS/0,,contentMDK:20127296~menuPK:34480~pagePK:34370~theSitePK:4607,00.html. 24 The World Bank Legal Review technical support to governments for the delivery of public services, with a special emphasis on the poorest countries (especially fragile and conflict- affected states) and frontier regions and sectors in middle-income countries.9 Infrastructure projects can be publicly financed and operated (with private contractors building and delivering the works to the government, often un- der a fixed-price arrangement). Alternatively, a government may transfer the financial, commercial, construction, and operational risk wholly or partially to the private sector. The partial but significant transfer of these risks to the private sector in partnership with the government is the essence of a PPP. There is a copious amount of literature on the history and current practice involved in public procurement and PPPs, but this is not within the scope of this chapter.10 Successful implementation of the first few PPPs or privately financed infrastructure projects in a country can be critical to that country’s ongoing ability to garner public support and a ract to its infrastructure pro- gram the scarce foreign and domestic resources that are necessary to ensure its economic growth. This means assuring that the projects are structured in a balanced way, with capable partners meeting their respective obligations so as to maintain on-time, on-budget delivery and consistent and reliable opera- tions of the infrastructure in question. In reality, misunderstandings, differences of opinion, and disagreements inevitably arise among two or more stakeholders during the life of even the best-planned infrastructure projects, regardless of size. Disputes can arise at the project level, among the direct stakeholders (such as between the private construction contractor or operator and the government or the purchasers of the goods or services), or at the financing level, between investors/lenders and the private company implementing the project, or among any of those parties and the government because of political or economic events in the country. Rapid resolution of any such disputes is critical to keeping funda- mentally good projects on track and also to building and maintaining confi- dence among the many stakeholders in these complex projects—private sector players, as well as governments and the local community—so that they will be inclined to make follow-on investments in the country. The most common forms of dispute resolution, especially in countries without a track record of private sector investment in infrastructure projects and public services, are litigation in courts and, to a somewhat lesser extent, arbitration (and variations thereof).11 In these situations, a third party (a judge 9 See World Bank, Fragility, Conflict and Violence, available at h p://web.worldbank.org /WBSITE/EXTERNAL/PROJECTS/STRATEGIES/EXTLICUS/0,,menuPK:511784~pagePK:64 171540~piPK:64171528~theSitePK:511778,00.html. 10 See World Bank, PPP Infrastructure Resource Center, available at h p://ppp.worldbank.org /public-private-partnership/; see also International Finance Corporation, Advisory Services, available at h p://www1.ifc.org/wps/wcm/connect/AS_EXT_Content/What+We+Do/Advi sory+Services/About+Us/Public-Private+Partnerships. 11 Arbitration is often a preferred dispute resolution mechanism for construction projects be- cause of the ability to select arbitrators with expertise on the complex issues that are inherent in the infrastructure construction industry, and because the time and expense of arbitra- Keeping Public-Private Partnership 25 Infrastructure Projects on Track or arbitrator), who may have no expertise in the ma er at hand, evaluates past events and evidence (including the terms of the contracts), decides which party is “right” or “wrong,” and imposes a decision on the stakeholders. Proj- ects may be delayed for months or even years during the formal legal proceed- ings.12 In many developing countries, even if there is a functioning and repu- table judiciary, courts may have enormous backlogs, adding to the potential delays.13 Appointing experienced arbitrators, who often have full schedules, and agreeing on hearing dates can add to the delay. In addition to the effect of the actual delays on the project timetable, delays can often lead to significant cost overruns (time is, after all, money), in some cases making the project no longer financially and economically feasible.14 Adding the polarization of the parties and the deterioration of relationships to these delays and cost overruns can produce a nice recipe for scu ling an emerging economy’s prospects for achieving development outcomes. In public sector projects expected to cost more than $10 million and to be financed directly or indirectly by the World Bank, the parties are required to establish dispute boards15 to expedite the se lement of disputes.16 These dis- pute boards are to be formed at the beginning of the contract for the proposed works, although in practice they are often not established until a dispute arises. They are empowered to make recommendations and, in some cases, depending on which type of board they are, to provide interim decisions in tion compared to litigation are usually less. Nevertheless, not every developing country has implemented legislation for the enforcement of foreign arbitral awards. Also, arbitration can still be extremely expensive and nearly as time-consuming as litigation. Moreover, local arbi- tral procedural rules apply even to international arbitration, and these local procedural rules can often be subjective and unpredictable. 12 Construction disputes can take five to six years to resolve, even in a fast-track court sys- tem, and the project is often stopped during that period. This is the reason, in fact, that dispute boards were started after arbitration itself became stalled in the process. The Dispute Board Federation, in its Annual Board Report, June 2009, determined that the average delay, worldwide, on construction projects without an ADR or Dispute Board process averaged seven years, and in some countries, such as India, went as long as 20 years. 13 Many international investors require in their investment documentation that the parties sub- mit to the jurisdiction of the courts of New York or England for the resolution of disputes, although it is not uncommon for rights against sponsors to need to be enforced in the juris- diction of the sponsor if the sponsor has assets only in its country. Investor-state disputes often are required to be resolved in local courts. 14 Most PPPs and private sector infrastructure projects, which are often structured as limited- recourse financings (as opposed to corporate financings), are heavily dependent on timely completion and the commencement of revenue generation. Delays usually mean higher in- terest on construction loans and possibly escalation of construction costs. In addition, delays in generating revenues can mean that the ability to pay for operating and maintenance costs (including loan principal and daily costs) can be jeopardized. In some cases, governments impose an obligation on concessionaires and operators to pay liquidated damages for delays for which they are responsible to compensate the government for the cost of “cover” and lost opportunity. 15 These can be either a dispute review board that gives advisory opinions only or a dispute adjudication board that gives binding and immediately enforceable decisions. 16 See full discussion below. 26 The World Bank Legal Review respect to disputed ma ers. In PPPs and private sector projects (including ones in which the World Bank may be involved), there is often no compa- rable mechanism required to be built into the project for early and ongoing identification and resolution of disputes. The political and economic costs to countries of projects being delayed or fully derailed as a result of conflicts that end up in formal legal proceedings are enormous. Building on the idea of dispute boards as employed in publicly pro- cured projects financed by the World Bank and as contemplated in certain standard bidding and construction contracts of other institutions (see below), two proposals are made. First, the parties to PPPs and private sector proj- ects should establish a similar approach to responsive and proactive dispute resolution. This would involve a partnering commi ee being instituted at the inception of the project and remaining fully involved through the life of the project as a means of keeping stakeholders routinely and frequently apprised of progress and any unexpected challenges in meeting their respective expec- tations. Second, for large infrastructure projects, the partnering commi ee should include a dispute board from the inception of the project. In practice, on smaller projects, the dispute board can and does substitute entirely for the partnering commi ee, with each party choosing a member, and those mem- bers choosing a collective chair. In either case, the dispute board should have the power to help facilitate resolution of any dispute among the parties by encouraging the appointment of an impartial mediator (if the parties have not already pursued mediation) or to impose a decision on the parties when a negotiated se lement is not possible, ensuring that the parties have the great- est opportunity to resolve disputes promptly and to keep the project on track. The decision can be binding or nonbinding, depending on the parties’ agree- ment, as described below. The Challenge to Deliver The World Bank Group17 is at the forefront of the international-development financial institutions supporting PPPs in the traditional and social infrastruc- 17 The World Bank Group consists of five organizations: the International Bank for Recon- struction and Development lends to governments of middle-income and creditworthy low- income countries. The International Development Association provides interest-free loans— called credits—and grants to governments of the poorest countries. The International Finance Corporation is the largest global development institution focused exclusively on the private sector. It helps developing countries achieve sustainable growth by financing investment, mobilizing capital and loans in international financial markets, and providing advisory services to businesses and governments. The Multilateral Investment Guarantee Agency (MIGA) promotes foreign direct investment into developing countries to support economic growth, reduce poverty, and improve people’s lives. MIGA fulfills this mandate by offering political risk insurance (guarantees) to investors and lenders. The International Centre for Se lement of Investment Disputes provides international facilities for conciliation and arbitration of investment disputes. See World Bank, About Us, available at h p://web .worldbank.org/WBSITE/EXTERNAL/EXTABOUTUS/0,,pagePK:50004410~piPK:36602~the SitePK:29708,00.html. Keeping Public-Private Partnership 27 Infrastructure Projects on Track ture sectors in emerging markets.18 Increasingly, the World Bank Group is involved in cu ing-edge, first-of-a-kind infrastructure projects with trans- formational potential and the ability to be repeated and scaled up across the emerging world. The World Bank Group’s ability to support the successful financing and sustained implementation and operation of a sound private sec- tor or PPP project is central to enhancing investor confidence more generally in the country and thereby to boosting development outcomes. The demands and expectations to produce development results in these most challenging environments and to reach the broadest base of the population―including rural and urban environments—are high. There are even greater challenges for a developing country with limited government, judicial, financial, or tech- nical capacity, li le or no history of private investment, a nascent legal system, or a limited track record of interpreting and enforcing contracts, as can be the case in new countries or countries that have just entered a postconflict phase. Particularly because of these challenging circumstances, it is critical that the parties have an effective and efficient way to expedite resolution of the dis- putes that will inevitably arise in these high-profile, high-stakes infrastructure projects. It is also important to find an effective way to monitor the progress of the job itself, and to act as a control, such as by providing on-site monitoring, and to aid in the prevention of fraud. PPPs and Disputes That Arise Public-private partnerships in the infrastructure sector typically involve mul- tiple stakeholders. The typical “public” stakeholders might include, for ex- ample, government and/or state-owned and/or municipal enterprises as (1) grantor of a concession or license, (2) regulator, (3) purchaser or off-taker of the public services or products being generated by the private operator for distribution to consumers, and, sometimes, (4) investor. On the private sec- tor side, such a project might involve (1) a private company (the borrower or investee company that is licensed by the government to evaluate the feasibil- ity of the project and to design, construct, and operate the project on a certain timetable and at an agreed-on, often regulated, tariff); (2) private construction contractors and other service providers hired by the private operator to en- able the private operator to meet its obligations to the government under its concession, license, or off-take agreement; (3) lenders and political risk pro- viders; and (4) investors―traditional shareholders as well as private equity investors and others who have invested in, and who are therefore interested in, the financial success of, the private operator. Finally, such a project will include the ultimate beneficiaries of the public services (including potentially private, commercial, and industrial consumers or users) as well as the local community. All of these stakeholders have distinct interests in pursuing proj- ects, including anticipated “rewards” commensurate with the risks taken in the project in the case of private sector stakeholders, and “value for money” 18 See World Bank, Annual Report 2012, available at h p://siteresources.worldbank.org /EXTANNREP2012/Resources/8784408-1346247445238/AnnualReport2012_En.pdf. 28 The World Bank Legal Review in the case of government stakeholders and end users. In some cases, one or more parties may have an interest in delaying resolution of the dispute and any payment or other obligations they may have as a result of the resolution of the dispute. Most large, multiparty infrastructure projects involve not only extensive construction phases but also operations over a long period, some- times up to 50 years. Disputes might arise as a result of poor or untimely performance by the private operator; unexpected increases in costs of certain components or ser- vices that disproportionately disadvantage a particular party;19 a natural force majeure event that physically delays or impedes the project development, con- struction, delivery of equipment, or operation; disputes among shareholders of the private operator (e.g., over funding obligations); breaches by the gov- ernment or its agencies; macroeconomic changes or changes in the political or regulatory environment; or laws that make the original terms of the con- cession or license disadvantageous for one or more of the parties.20 In some cases, the local community can be negatively affected by the proposed project; for example, community members may need to be rese led or compensated, or they may not understand how their needs will be met. In either case, if disputes are left unaddressed or unresolved, relationships among the stake- holders can deteriorate and, ultimately, the project can falter. PPPs are ad- ditionally surrounded by intense public scrutiny, and when something goes wrong in the project (e.g., a unilateral renegotiation of a concession’s terms by the government,21 or a breach or unexcused deficient performance by the private operator), it often results in political fallout in the country. Lengthy and expensive litigation or investor-state or other arbitration to resolve these disputes can jeopardize the viability of the project or derail its implementation or operation, and will at a minimum be frustrating to the private operator and its contractors, investors, and lenders, as well as to the local government, end users, and local community. In addition, certainty of outcome in formal pro- ceedings (in litigation and also in arbitral proceedings) is not assured even in seemingly strong cases, particularly in local arbitral fora or courts, which may not have a long history of interpreting private commercial contracts or may seem biased. Ultimately, these frustrating and often unpredictable formal dis- pute resolution processes can seriously undermine both investor confidence and potential contractor interest in investing in the country or in a project involving the same government or local parties. 19 According to a recent World Bank study, roughly 70 percent of hydropower projects were completed with cost overruns exceeding 30 percent, and a majority of projects were finished with 50 percent overruns. One or more parties must pay for or bear these cost overruns. 20 See Renewables, Retro-active FiT Cuts in Bulgaria Cause Sector Fury, See News (Sept. 17, 2012), available at h p://renewables.seenews.com/news/retro-active-fit-cuts-in-bulgaria-cause -sector-fury-303005. 21 See Toolkit for PPPs in Roads and Highways, Contract Renegotiation and Adaptation (Public- Private Infrastructure Advisory Facility 2009), available at h p://www.ppiaf.org/sites/ppiaf .org/files/documents/toolkits/highwaystoolkit/6/pdf-version/4-37.pdf. Keeping Public-Private Partnership 29 Infrastructure Projects on Track The Need for Communication and Effective Dispute Resolution It is vital in complex infrastructure projects that the parties keep as open a dia- logue as possible in order to address contentious issues and changes in circum- stances or perspectives as they arise and, ideally, even before they turn into full-fledged disputes. While it is important that the original commercial deal among the stakeholders be respected, particularly when unforeseen “neutral” changes have arisen, a forward-looking creative solution that involves adjust- ment to the originally negotiated terms of a contract may be a reasonable, and perhaps the most favorable and sustainable, outcome. However, representa- tives of parties may become anxious about the possible fallout within their constituencies because they have suggested a solution that departs from the negotiated contract, or because they are not empowered to consider alterna- tives to the negotiated contract terms. In addition, the parties may be reluctant to appear “weak” in negotiations by suggesting a compromise solution, or they may be concerned about the risk of compromising their legal rights and remedies by agreeing to an “alternative” means of dispute resolution, such as mediation or a dispute board mechanism. Yet, without a pre-agreed-on and routine mechanism for airing and ideally resolving concerns before they turn into disputes, the disputes that result may be difficult or impossible to an- ticipate or to resolve through direct negotiations among the parties—at least not in a time frame that is reasonable given the time and resources involved (including staff and management time, external legal counsel time, etc.)—and may lead to the deterioration of the project, relationships, and trust among the parties, as described below. Dispute Resolution Proposal for PPPs Partnering Committees: Composition and Role It is therefore proposed that, as a ma er of best practice in the construction and operation of traditional and social PPPs and privately financed infrastruc- ture projects around the world, each significant stakeholder be represented on a partnering commi ee22 that conducts periodic meetings (occasionally on- site and/or in country) from the inception of the project (for example, monthly during development and construction and less frequently during operations). Thus, the partnering commi ee for a power generation project might consist of a member from each of the private developer/operators; each of the major material supply, construction, or services providers; the government (usually a representative from the lead ministry and/or their external advisers) and any government entity purchasing services from the private operator or having 22 Sometimes, these commi ees are called “steering commi ees” or “project development com- mi ees” and are included in a country’s standardized PPP contracts, together with extensive reporting obligations about the project’s progress. This mechanism is critically important, too, if the government or a government agency has an obligation to perform certain functions to enable the private operator to deliver its works or services on time; e.g., a private power plant operator’s ability to connect to the government-owned transmission line or grid. 30 The World Bank Legal Review an ownership interest in the project; possibly the regulator, the lenders, and investors; and, depending on the size, profile, and dynamics of the project, a representative from the local community. However, the membership of the partnering commi ee can vary according to the project and the desires of the stakeholders. The size and composition of the partnering commi ee needs to be sufficiently streamlined and managed to be and to remain productive and not become sidetracked on minor issues or used as a forum for complaints or delays. The specific mandate of the partnering commi ee would be (1) to keep stakeholders apprised of project progress and any obstacles that have arisen that could affect the expectations of any of the parties or the scope, price, or timing of the project; (2) to provide an early-alert mechanism to any concerns of one or more stakeholders; (3) to provide a frequent and routine forum for the parties to directly negotiate resolution of any disputes, where possible; and (4) to commit to engage a mediator to facilitate the resolution of disputes if the parties are unable to do so on their own through direct discus- sions and negotiations.23 PPP projects can and should affect the bo om-line issues of opportunity, inclusion, and equity when they allow for local-level input from those who will be using the project, those who will benefit from it, and those who will be impacted negatively by it; hearing all those voices and providing for their inclusion in the early stages of the project through a partnering commi ee will satisfy those vital needs. If used conscientiously as a means of engaging the local community, a partnering commi ee can also be an effective means of avoiding official complaints by the local community to the World Bank’s Inspection Panel and to the IFC’s and MIGA’s Office of the Compliance Adviser/Ombudsman, both independent recourse mechanisms whose mission is to address complaints by people affected by World Bank Group projects and to enhance the social and environmental accountability of the World Bank Group institutions. Active Commitment to Mediate The power of mediation is essentially accepted in the construction industry. Many financial institutions and companies involved in complex international construction and infrastructure projects routinely provide in their contracts for, and routinely use, alternative dispute resolution (ADR), and specifically mediation, as a mechanism of “first resort” when there is an incipient conflict brewing among the parties or when direct negotiations over a ripe conflict break down or are overly prolonged.24 (In this chapter, arbitration is consid- 23 Agreements to mediate can be tailored to ensure that the only disputes required to be me- diated are those that (1) are good candidates for mediation and (2) do not jeopardize the parties’ legal rights and remedies. A balance must be struck, however, between reassuring parties that they do not give up too much by agreeing to mediate and creating a situation in which the parties use the exclusions from the agreement to mediate as an excuse not to me- diate. In situations in which the parties are reluctant or refuse to mediate, the dispute board (discussed in the next section) can play an important role in urging the parties to try, at least for an agreed-on period, to mediate disputes toward a negotiated se lement. 24 Construction industry contracts standardized by the International Federation of Consulting Engineers (FIDIC) include provisions for “amicable se lement” of disputes among parties, Keeping Public-Private Partnership 31 Infrastructure Projects on Track ered a formal means of dispute resolution, much like litigation.) The Interna- tional Institute for Conflict Prevention and Resolution (CPR) reports that over 4,000 companies and 1,500 law firms have established policy and signed a for- mal pledge commi ing themselves to explore ADR options before pursuing litigation.25 These ADR mechanisms can fall along a wide-ranging continuum, between mediation on the one end and arbitration and litigation on the other. For example, such ADR mechanisms might include expert determination. In 1996, General Electric Company (GE) began the process of systematic use of mediation, and in 1998, GE initiated a company-wide Early Dispute Reso- lution (EDR) program tied to GE’s Six Sigma Quality initiative to eliminate “defects” in the company’s processes and products. As of 2011, GE routinely used mediation globally to resolve disputes of all sizes and complexity. EDR is considered by GE to address the demands of its clients through (1) mini- mal waste of executive and managerial time; (2) preservation of important business relationships; (3) maximization of outcome; and (4) predictability of results. GE’s policy of preferring mediation in the first instance for the resolu- tion of disputes is based on a hardheaded, commercial analysis of the costs of formal litigation or arbitration versus ADR mechanisms.26 Critical features of any voluntary mediation are its consensual and con- fidential nature, its flexibility in structure and process, and its adaptability to the needs and desires of the parties, including the need to control the out- come. To further expedite resolution of disputes among the parties and keep projects on track, it is therefore recommended that the parties select a few mediators on a standby basis, up front, to be available to facilitate the resolu- tion of disputes among the parties as and when disputes arise that cannot be negotiated directly toward resolution. Indeed, in large infrastructure projects, the dispute board often includes pre-agreed-on mediators, to avoid a dispute over the selection of mediators just at the time when the parties could benefit from trying mediation toward a se lement. Including a provision for mediation before or during the dispute board process―as proposed here, especially in PPP and related contracts―can be an important legal and “political” basis for parties to try mediation and thereby to avoid criticism for acting beyond their authority and outside the contract and the FIDIC generally endorses the use of ADR mechanisms to reach such an amicable set- tlement. However, there is no specific requirement to a empt an amicable se lement prior to a decision by the dispute board. In practice, if a dispute is “brewing,” the parties either ask the dispute board for its opinion on the situation or hire a mediator. If a dispute hardens and the dispute board renders a decision, there is a 56-day cooling-off period during which the parties are urged to resolve the dispute amicably (by whatever means they choose, it be- ing taken for granted that this means mediation). Then, if there is no se lement, the party in whose favor the decision was made can go to arbitration for enforcement of the decision. See infra, note 30, on subclauses 20.4 and 20.5 of FIDIC contracts. 25 See h p://www.cpradr.org. CPR’s Banking and Financial Services Commi ee is actively in- volved in the development of best practices for use of ADR among banks and other financial institutions. 26 CPR has an excellent tool kit, available online, for early case assessment. 32 The World Bank Legal Review terms. This may be especially true for government contract counterparties. To avoid further criticism, the language could also explicitly preserve the right of any party to pursue formal legal proceedings in parallel with the mediation or at any time (in case of abuse of the mediation process by any party or threat to any party’s rights or remedies of forestalling formal legal proceedings). The continued operation of the partnering commi ee and the commit- ment to mediate disputes during the life of the project are important to ensure that there is an early warning of any changes in circumstances or challenges during the operations, or any deterioration in the assets or services. In this way, the parties can more consistently preempt the development of any dis- putes or “bad blood” among the parties during perhaps the most vulnerable period of the project and resolve such disputes informally, when possible.27 The Establishment and Role of the Embedded Dispute Board It is also proposed that a standing subgroup of the partnering commi ee be established as a dispute board (DB) for the specific PPP project. The DB should be empowered to refer disputes to mediation and ultimately to adjudicate the dispute if a negotiated se lement among the parties is not possible. The DB should be able to refer a dispute to mediation either before it adjudicates the dispute or during the adjudication step, described below. The mediation and adjudication steps could run in parallel with each other, and the contract could allow mediation to continue as long as needed, even into further adju- dicative processes. The DB can be a dispute resolution board giving opinions or, in the opin- ion of the authors, it should be a dispute adjudication board with the power to effectively resolve a dispute in the event the disputing parties are unable to do so on their own. The proposed adjudicative mechanism would be structured as a hybrid of the “dispute review boards” contemplated for sizable publicly procured projects financed by the World Bank28 and the “dispute adjudica- 27 Some argue that a project is most vulnerable to interference by a government after the spon- sor has poured all its money into and completed construction of the project. Given the long life-span of some infrastructure projects, there could be a tendency for the periodic meetings to be postponed or canceled, or for stakeholder representatives to change or not participate. These factors should be taken into account in the structuring and organization of partnering commi ees and in se ing realistic expectations based on the requirements of the project. If the project is operating smoothly, there may not be a need for a partnering commi ee for the full life of the project. 28 The World Bank’s standard form contract for procurement of works financed by the World Bank is broadly based on the FIDIC documents. Under international competitive bidding, the World Bank’s Procurement Guidelines (para. 2.43) require that the conditions of contract for goods, works, and nonconsulting services include dispute se lement provisions, and, essentially as the preferred approach, further require that contracts provide for international commercial arbitration in a neutral venue “unless the Bank has specifically agreed to waive this requirement for justified reasons such as equivalent national regulations and arbitra- tion provisions, or [because] the contract has been awarded to a bidder from the Borrower’s country.” In the case of works, supply and installation, and single responsibility (including turnkey) contracts, the dispute se lement provisions shall also include “mechanisms such as dispute review boards or adjudicators, which are designed to permit a speedier dispute Keeping Public-Private Partnership 33 Infrastructure Projects on Track tion boards” that are used extensively in the private construction industry all over the world29 and that are enshrined in various model construction con- tracts, such as the widely used international procurement contracts of the In- ternational Federation of Consulting Engineers (FIDIC) for major construction works.30 Dispute adjudication boards were introduced into the FIDIC model docu- ments (there are several versions) over a decade ago and are now included in harmonized contract conditions that have been adopted by most multilateral and bilateral development financial institutions, including the World Bank, for works to be financed and procured in accordance with the rules of such institutions and using the FIDIC contracts.31 While there are slightly different structures in the different forms of FIDIC contracts, essentially the FIDIC form of dispute adjudication board includes appointment of the board at the incep- tion of the project with powers to impose interim binding decisions on the parties pending resolution through a negotiated se lement among the parties or through a final arbitral award.32 The World Bank’s comparable provision, included in its standardized contract for publicly procured works in projects costing over $10 million to be financed by the World Bank, states that “[i]n the case of works, supply and installation, and single responsibility (including turnkey) contracts, the dispute se lement provisions shall also include mech- anisms such as dispute review boards or adjudicators, which are designed se lement.” The World Bank’s Standard Bidding Documents for Works describe the details of these boards. The World Bank’s procurement guidance and template contracts are avail- able at h p://web.worldbank.org/WBSITE/EXTERNAL/PROJECTS/PROCUREMENT/0,,pa gePK:84271~theSitePK:84266,00.html. 29 Various forms of DBs have been used in the U.S. construction industry since the 1960s in connection with underground construction (such as tunneling) and water management proj- ects. Most credit the 1975 building of the Eisenhower Tunnel project in Colorado as the first such use of a DB, in the current form. See Shaun Beaton, Dispute Resolution Boards in Power Project Development, Infrastructure J. (2002), h p://www.ijonline.com/pdf/pdf/review2002 review2002_power_dispute_resolution.pdf; and Cyril Chern, Chern on Dispute Boards 8‒9 (2d ed., Wiley 2011). They are now used in other industries, as well, such as the insurance, telecoms, financial services, and maritime industries. 30 Dispute adjudication boards were introduced into the FIDIC model documents (there are several versions) over a decade ago. Subclause 20 of the FIDIC Conditions—”Red Book” (1999) and the 1999 editions of the other FIDIC contracts for major works, namely, the Conditions of Contract for Plant and Design-Build (the “Yellow Book”) and Conditions of Contract for EPC/Turnkey Projects (the “Silver Book”) (the three Books together being the “1999 FIDIC Books”), as updated and added to Design, Build and Operate (the “Gold Book”). 31 As of 2013, the FIDIC harmonized contract conditions had been adopted by the World Bank, European Bank for Reconstruction and Development, Asian Development Bank, African De- velopment Bank, Black Sea Trade and Development Bank, Caribbean Development Bank, Council of Europe Development Bank, and Inter-American Development Bank, among other institutions. See h p://fidic.org/node/321. 32 See h p://FIDIC.org; and Chern, supra note 29, at 8‒10. Note that this mechanism permits the parties to refer the dispute to formal resolution in the courts or arbitration, as the case may be. The “interim” nature of the decision of the DB is reassuring to parties who may be wor- ried about compromising their formal legal rights and remedies. 34 The World Bank Legal Review to permit a speedier dispute se lement.”33 The World Bank’s 2011 Standard Bidding Documents for Works provide a mechanism for the establishment of a similar dispute adjudication board for public works. There is a good deal of literature to explain the advantages of dispute ad- judication boards, including that the parties consider the input and decisions of their dispute board to be at least as fair and informed as those of any court or arbitral tribunal, and that they take a fraction of the time and cost of going to arbitration. In addition, the dispute board typically helps in keeping the parties “talking” and helps to “separate the people from the problem,” to use popular conflict resolution vernacular. As a result, sometimes the mere exis- tence of the dispute adjudication board is enough to preempt a dispute from escalating into an entrenched ba le among the parties. The Dispute Board Federation in Geneva has indicated, based on anecdotal research, that some- thing approaching 98 percent of all disputes referred to a dispute board have been successfully resolved. Moreover, of the dispute board decisions that have been appealed to a court or arbitral tribunal, only a small fraction have been overturned. For example, the US$2 billion Ertan Hydroelectric Dam project in China had 40 disputes referred to its dispute review board, none of which continued to arbitration. At the US$2.5 billion Katse Dam project in South Af- rica, 12 disputes were referred to the dispute board, and, of these, only 1 went on to arbitration, where the DB decision was upheld. When dispute adjudica- tion boards are not effective, it is often a result of delay in the DB’s appoint- ment because of concerns over the costs of having a standing dispute board.34 The dispute adjudication board mechanism required for public procure- ments financed by the World Bank is not specifically required for PPP con- tracts to be financed by the World Bank and is not routinely established up front, but rather is delayed to the time when a dispute has arisen.35 As a ma er of best practice, therefore, and in contrast to alternative dispute resolution 33 See Section VII, General Conditions, Clause 20, Claims, Disputes and Arbitration, which in- troduces a dispute board that may comprise one or three members, as may be determined by the employer and specified in the contract data (Part A of Section VIII, Particular Conditions) without regard to the estimated cost of the contract. 34 Chern, supra note 29, at 20‒24. 35 Depending on the project and financing structure and the World Bank’s involve- ment (e.g., a Bank loan or guaranty), PPP contracts can sometimes be procured un- der “open competitive bidding procedures” determined acceptable to the World Bank. In these types of PPP projects, the World Bank has flexibility with respect to requir- ing (or not requiring) compliance with the detailed procedures of international com- petitive bidding, including the provision for a dispute review board or similar mecha- nism contained in its standard contracts. However, a Guidance Note and Information Note on Procurement in Public-Private Partnerships do seem to suggest (specifically in the Information Note) that the contract include some mechanism for se ling disputes: Dispute Resolution • The Contract must specify a procedure for handling disputes under the terms of the Contract…. [A] common form of dispute resolution involves a three stage process as follows: Keeping Public-Private Partnership 35 Infrastructure Projects on Track mechanisms that may provide primarily for a facilitated means of reaching a negotiated se lement among the parties,36 the proposed DB for complex, multiparty PPP and private sector infrastructure projects (whether or not they use contracts or financing from institutions that require it) would involve ap- pointment―at the inception of the project―of a standing DB consisting of im- partial and independent experts who monitor the progress of the works and address―in real time―contentious issues as they arise and before they turn into true disputes. The role of the DB should be: (1) in the first instance, to refer unresolved disputes that may have arisen to mediation for an a empt at a negotiated se lement among the parties;37 (2) to recommend a proposed solution or problem-solving method, if the negotiated-se lement approach (e.g., mediation) is proving to be ineffective; and (3) when necessary, to im- pose a decision on the parties (typically after an informal opportunity for par- ties to present their positions through wri en papers, interviews with person- nel, and, in some cases, an informal hearing). It is proposed that decisions of the DB should ideally be binding on the parties, pending final resolution of • the Grantor and Concessionaire consult with each other for a fixed time period (pos- sibly involving different levels of internal consultation) in an a empt to come to a mu- tually satisfactory agreement; • if consultation fails, the parties may then (except in the case of certain types of dis- pute) put their case before an expert to decide. The expert is appointed from a panel (e.g. of construction or operation experts) whose appointment is regulated by the Con- tract. It may be appropriate in certain circumstances to substitute other forms of Alter- native Dispute Resolution (“ADR”) for this type of expert determination. Disputes re- lating to the mechanics of price variations may go to a financial expert agreed between the parties at the time, and • if either party is dissatisfied with the expert’s decision, it may refer the ma er either to arbitration (itself a form of ADR) or to the courts for a final and binding decision. The method of appointing the arbitrator should be set out in the Contract. h p://intranet.worldbank.org/WBSITE/INTRANET/OPERATIONS/INTPROCUREMENT/0 ,,contentMDK:23051237~menuPK:60000186~pagePK:60000209~piPK:60000211~theSitePK:27 8020~isCURL:Y,00.html. Note that many parties elect to skip the internal consultation requirement as they assume that it would have taken place before the dispute had escalated. Some clients elect to forgo expert determinations or make such determinations non- binding, preferring instead to rely on arbitration for binding resolution. With respect to par- tial risk guarantees of the World Bank, commercial lenders often drive the issue. Generally, the World Bank’s rules require a procurement process that meets the “economy and effi- ciency” standard, which is largely undefined and leaves some flexibility for the World Bank to determine what makes sense within the context of the particular project. 36 See Chern, supra note 29, at 6‒8. While there is a continuum of ADR techniques, ADR usu- ally has as its objective a negotiated se lement among the parties, often reached through the facilitation of a neutral third party. There is often no agreed-on mechanism for the neutral third party (mediator) to impose a decision (especially one that is binding) on the parties. 37 Judges are increasingly ordering parties to try to reach a se lement through mediation be- fore resorting to the court for resolution of the dispute. Indeed, in some jurisdictions, the law requires parties to try to resolve their disputes through mediation before pursuing a remedy in court. Not every dispute is a good candidate for ADR or mediation—especially as a sole mechanism for resolution of the dispute at hand, and there are often excellent reasons for pursuing formal legal remedies in court or in arbitration instead of, or in parallel with, ADR. There is ample literature on the advantages and disadvantages of the many mechanisms of ADR and the features that make a project a good candidate for ADR in the circumstances. It is also critical to find a quality mediator. 36 The World Bank Legal Review the ma er in accordance with a negotiated se lement among the parties or through a final judgment or arbitral award.38 A binding decision ensures that the partnering commi ee and DB process are not used as a stalling tactic. It is worth emphasizing that, with the interim binding-decision structure, once the DB has given its decision, the decision must be adhered to. As a re- sult, the project is not stalled or the timeline delayed while the unhappy party takes the dispute further to arbitration or review. In other words, delays are banished in this system. Given the expertise and independence of DB members, DB decisions are usually considered efficient, rational, and extremely well tailored to the dis- pute and project. An experienced DB can actually prevent disputes from aris- ing, by giving informal advice to the contracting parties and by encourag- ing parties to consider, in advance of any formal dispute, points of potential friction. A DB may also be creative and not necessarily tied to the le er of the underlying contract if there is some inherent deficiency or unfairness in the contract or if circumstances have fundamentally changed. As a result, DB members are often considered trusted members of the project administration and are frequently asked to give advisory opinions to the parties on some point, even before any dispute arises. Notwithstanding their flexibility in re- solving disputes, DBs may not be suitable for resolving/adjudicating all the disputes that can arise in PPP transactions; in particular, they may not be able to deal with highly charged political issues and similar problems, including a empts by any party (public or private) to use the DB to renegotiate funda- mentally sound terms on which parties based their decisions to enter into the project contracts. In a formal or informal project administration role, a DB can also influence the willingness and ability of the parties to perform their respective obligations. In some cases, DBs have been helpful in preventing corruption by supervising disbursements of moneys for agreed-on purposes throughout the life of the project and at the time of the final accounting among the parties. Use of a DB also has an important role to play in promoting the in- clusion agenda, as during hearings; the DB is not limited to hearing evidence from the contractual parties themselves. Indeed, the DB is under a duty to find out the truth from whatever source is necessary; for example, this occasion- ally can include hearing members of local tribes or other affected community members on the issues. An important feature of a DB’s ability to impose a decision on the par- ties (whether or not the decision is binding) is the speed of the dispute reso- 38 There is great debate over the advantages and disadvantages of binding vs. nonbinding deci- sions of DBs. See Chern, supra note 29, at 4‒5. Decisions of DBs as used in the United States have usually been nonbinding recommendations, whereas dispute adjudication boards used in many other parts of the world are usually empowered to render a binding decision, which can be appealed in a formal arbitration but which is binding pending a final resolution through a negotiated se lement of the parties or a final arbitral award. In its standardized documents, the International Chamber of Commerce offers parties three kinds of DBs un- der its Dispute Board Rules from which to select. See h p://www.iccwbo.org/Products-and -Services/Arbitration-and-ADR/Dispute-Boards/Standard-ICC-Dispute-Boards-Clauses/. Keeping Public-Private Partnership 37 Infrastructure Projects on Track lution. While litigation and arbitration can often take years, a standing DB can impose a decision extremely promptly in view of the members’ ongoing familiarity with the project. DBs may be able to deliver such a recommend- ed se lement or decision within as li le as one month of the full exchange of information about the dispute or hearing, with a normal time limit being 84 days from the inception of the dispute and notification to the DB. The time savings can often be critical to the project’s viability as well as to maintaining the parties’ relationships.39 It is both customary and essential that the DB include members with real- world experience, including engineering, construction, commercial, and, often, legal expertise. In larger projects, it is common for there to be three members; in smaller projects, a single member with the right skill set can be adequate. Thus, a DB might consist of one person selected by the owner, one selected by the contractor, and the third (often the chair) selected by the first two, each subject to the approval of the parties to the contract.40 The chair- person’s role is critical to the fairness, credibility, and efficiency of the DB in resolving disputes. He or she must continually take all the facts and circum- stances, and the parties’ legitimate interests and bargaining positions, into account. This can be especially important if the DB is asked to assist in the resolution of a ma er involving the affected local community. Frequency of Dispute Board Meetings During construction, the DB should meet frequently (e.g., every month or ev- ery other month), and make occasional visits to the site. Although a project is arguably more vulnerable to disputes during the construction phase, during operations, problems can also arise that threaten revenues and, potentially, the viability of the project. The operations phase is also the phase during which many stakeholders have a declining interest in the project; for example, if they have already secured their returns or, in the case of the government, if it has less capacity to continue to focus on the project. It is therefore recommended that the DB portion of the partnering commi ee remain actively involved and meet, if less frequently, at least semiannually or annually, depending on the complexity and dynamics of the project. This continuing role for the DB is important to maintaining an open environment in which to identify problems 39 For a good discussion about the complexities surrounding the enforceability of DB decisions, see Christopher R. Seppälä, An Engineer’s Dispute Adjudication Board’s Decision Is Enforceable By An Arbitral Award (White & Case Dec. 2009), available at h p://www.whitecase.com/files/ Publication/5787c9a1-5ebb-4858-aa74-b0543f0b5fec/Presentation/PublicationA achment/72 45da26-5ade-4380-b638-b361a26ac8f7/article_FIDIC_conditions_Dec09.PDF. 40 Some professionals believe that permi ing the appointment of a DB representative by each party can create a situation in which there is a “representative” of each party and only one true neutral in the DB. It is interesting to note that the Supreme Court of Colombia declared this process unconstitutional a number of years ago. Thus, a be er practice may be to have the main stakeholders agree on the names of the three DB members. Note, too, that in some eastern European countries, in long-term concessions, DBs can have varying membership for the project depending on the nature of the dispute. See Chern, supra note 29, at 11. 38 The World Bank Legal Review and a empt to resolve them before they morph into rigid disputes and ulti- mately threaten to derail or destroy the viability of the project. Dispute Board Costs DB costs should be shared equally by the contract parties. The total cost of establishing and operating a DB has been estimated to range from as li le as 0.015 percent to 0.05 percent of total project costs. Parties often consider this a reasonable price to pay to avoid not only significant project delays or cost overruns but also the delays and direct costs associated with formal le- gal proceedings. Indeed, some contractors bidding on contracts that include a dispute adjudication board process have developed a practice of adjusting downward the premium they would otherwise include in a contract tender that includes only formal dispute resolution. The cost of a DB can often be justified solely in terms of its contribution toward cementing and preserving relationships among the parties, which has a particular value for parties that may wish to do repeat business.41 Incorporating Partnering Committees and Dispute Boards into the Project It is impossible for construction and other project contracts for a PPP or pri- vate infrastructure project to anticipate all events that will arise during the project’s construction and operation. Nor can these contracts fully provide for all remedies that might be appropriate in the circumstances, even if there is a general agreement on allocation of project risks among the parties. Many proj- ect contracts provide for dispute resolution but only briefly explain a process that might be used by the parties leading up to formal legal proceedings. It is critical for the parties to incorporate partnering commi ees, mediation, and the DB structure into their project contracts to provide a road map for how the parties can anticipate and resolve disputes on a real-time basis, all within the objective of respecting the parties’ original commercial understanding and keeping the project on track. Summary Whether infrastructure projects for the delivery of public services are gov- ernment owned and operated, PPPs, or privately financed and operated, dis- putes will inevitably arise. There is growing confidence in and use of dispute adjudication boards in large infrastructure and construction projects around the world, and these structures are often already built into publicly procured projects. To preserve the expectations of the parties regarding the timing and costs of PPPs and privately financed infrastructure projects, and to keep these projects on track, it is proposed that, consistent with best practice, a partner- ing commi ee with an embedded dispute board be established and become 41 See Chern, supra note 29, at 19; and Beaton, supra note 29. Keeping Public-Private Partnership 39 Infrastructure Projects on Track active at the inception of each project. If structured to provide a meaningful flow of information among the stakeholders, including affected local commu- nity members, a partnering commi ee can, together with a dispute board, be instrumental in early identification and resolution of any disputes that arise before the parties and affected local communities become entrenched in their positions. In addition, a DB can play an important role in supporting a medi- ated se lement agreement among the parties. When necessary, a DB can also impose an interim binding decision on the contracting parties, pending reso- lution of the ma er through a negotiated se lement or a final arbitral award. The costs associated with such a mechanism are more than outweighed by the confidence that project stakeholders and investors will have in infrastructure investments generally in the country. This page intentionally left blank Protecting Traditional Practices and Country of Origin in Developing Countries through Fair Trade and Intellectual Property Rights BETH ANNE HOFFMAN AND CHARLES BOUDRY Ethiopia is widely regarded as the birthplace of coffee. With more than 30 native types of coffee plants, coffee is an integral part of Ethiopia’s cultural heritage. The Ethiopian coffees Sidamo, Yirgacheffe, and Harrar are known as some of the finest coffees in the world. Coffee makes up a large portion of Ethiopia’s economy, accounting for more than 30 percent of the country’s total export revenues. Moreover, nearly 20 percent of Ethiopia’s population earns its living through coffee. Despite coffee’s importance—both on the interna- tional market and to the domestic economy—coffee farmers in Ethiopia make approximately US$1–$2 per day. Ethiopia is a textbook example of how countries or producers can extract higher export prices on the international market through the production of specialty commodities. Since the collapse of the state-controlled coffee sec- tor, Ethiopian coffee growers have pursued different methods to gain greater profits. There is considerable experience in country in producing certified organic and/or shade-grown coffees, as well as Fair Trade–certified coffees. Most recently, the same producers have also used registered trademarks for specific Ethiopian coffee exports. In the mid-2000s, with considerable experience with the Fair Trade certifi- cation process, the Government of the Federal Republic of Ethiopia (Govern- ment of Ethiopia; GoE) chose to exercise its intellectual property rights (IPRs) on certain varieties of coffee beans. Early work on defining coffee within the framework of IPRs was done through a value chain analysis financed by the United Kingdom’s Department for International Development (DfID) and in partnership with the Ethiopian Intellectual Property Office (EIPO). It was under the DfID project that the Ethiopian coffee trademarks were registered internationally for Harrar (and Harar), Sidamo, and Yirgacheffe coffees. Dur- ing this time, much of the domestic legal framework was enacted to support the intellectual property claims. The World Bank financed a follow-up to the DfID project. Both of these projects were aimed at improving the livelihoods (and ultimately the revenues) of coffee producers in Ethiopia through Fair Trade certification and coffee name trademarking. These projects and their outcomes are described in this chapter. 41 42 The World Bank Legal Review The case of Ethiopian specialty coffees highlights the fact that accessing high-value or specialty markets through legal means can bring international recognition for traditional knowledge. IPRs can protect products on the inter- national market when trademarked. The level at which interventions of this type can achieve financial success is ultimately affected by the overall open- ness of markets, the capacity of the legal system to assert these rights in in- ternational markets, and the overall sustainability of the intervention. Other market externalities, such as land ownership, access to credit, and the partici- pation of women and children in the production process, were also factors in Ethiopian coffee production. Commodities and High-Value Markets IPRs are one way that farmers and other producers may seek to distinguish their products on the international market and earn higher profits for their products. Methods for the decommodification of coffee include Fair Trade certification, and organic, shade-grown, or sustainably grown products. Fair Trade certification is governed by standards established by private interna- tional organizations. Fair Trade standards are meant to be applied to produc- tion regardless of existing domestic legal and regulatory laws.1 Fair Trade began as a social movement in the 1960s. Its aim was to bring fair prices to producers in developing countries. Coffee was one of the first products that received the Fair Trade brand, and it remains the single most im- portant Fair Trade product.2 Produced in developing countries by smallhold- ers, coffee is well suited for this movement.3 Fair Trade promises fair prices for products by sidestepping certain perceived market failures or anomalies. Furthermore, Fair Trade has the promise of bringing the producer closer to the consumer. Fair Trade–certified products are largely marketed as providing ethical value-added for the consumer. Fair Trade is not a process governed by national laws; it is a voluntary process whereby producers adhere to 10 specific international standards that can be applied to nearly any production system as long as the Fair Trade so- cial standards are met.4 Producers pay a Fair Trade organization to certify their product’s adherence to certain criteria.5 Certification includes site visits to producer organizations to inspect production methods. In many cases, Fair Trade standards are more stringent than domestic norms, and the onus is on 1 World Development Report 2008: Agriculture for Development 132 (World Bank 2008). 2 Loraine Ronchi, Fair Trade and Market Failures in Agricultural Commodity Markets (World Bank Policy Research Working Paper No. 4011, 2006). 3 Peter Leigh Taylor, In the Market but Not of It: Fair Trade Coffee and Forest Stewardship Council Certification as Market-Based Social Change, 33(1) World Dev. 136 (2005). 4 Kristina Sorby, Production Costs and Income from Sustainable Coffee 4 (World Bank Report No. 29598, 2002). 5 The Fair Trade Labeling Organization (FLO) regulates all organizations that provide Fair Trade certifications. Protecting Traditional Practices through Fair Trade and IPRs 43 the producer organization(s) to meet the Fair Trade standards in order to be certified. The costs for the certification process are borne by the producers themselves and can be substantial relative to an individual farmer’s or small- holder’s income. Fair Trade standards are applied independently of local laws and stan- dards. Often, Fair Trade standards require a level of organization and regula- tion that may not exist in many developing countries. These standards center around 10 main issues: creating opportunities for economically disadvantaged producers; transparency and accountability; fair trading practices; payment of a fair price; ensuring no child labor and no forced labor; commitment to nondiscrimination, gender equity, and women’s economic empowerment and freedom of association; ensuring good working conditions; providing capacity building; promoting Fair Trade; and respect for the environment.6 Without a local organization or cooperative to manage the many Fair Trade standards, a smallholder or subsistence farmer may not understand their importance or how they will be evaluated during the certification or re- certification process. Implementing these standards on an isolated or individ- ual basis would be an onerous and expensive process. As a result, Fair Trade producers are generally organized in cooperatives to be er manage the risks, to deal with the resulting bureaucracy from the application of Fair Trade stan- dards, and to ensure quality. Within the Fair Trade standards, some are more easily implemented than others; this was particularly the case with Ethiopian coffees. For example, relatively few smallholders or subsistence farmers use commercial inputs— such as fertilizers—when farming, which makes managing Fair Trade’s envi- ronmental concerns relatively easy compared to meeting other standards. In the case of Ethiopian coffee farmers, it has been reported that approximately 90 percent do not use any inputs in growing their coffees, making them virtu- ally organic.7 Fair Trade studies have long posited that by adhering to Fair Trade ecological and environmental practices, growers may reap larger yields, and therefore bigger profits.8 Issues related to transparency and accountability, capacity building, fair pay and prompt payments, and the promotion of Fair Trade mainly apply to the management of a farmers collective. As such, their impact on a small- holder would be minimal, though it is conceivable that the collective would ask a premium or contribution to manage these risks. 6 See the FLO World Fair Trade Organization (WFTO) website for a complete set of the stan- dards, available at h p://www.wfto.com/?option=com_content&task=view&id=2&Itemid =14 (accessed July 31, 2013). 7 Overseas Development Institute, Ethiopia Trademarking and Licensing Initiative: Supporting a Be er Deal for Coffee Producers through Aid for Trade (2009), available at h p://r4d.dfid.gov.uk/ PDF/Outputs/TradePolicy/aidfortrade.pdf. 8 Sorby, supra note 4, at 1. 44 The World Bank Legal Review The Fair Trade standards more difficult to implement and sustain are those related to labor. In the Ethiopian coffee sector, the majority of small- holders use informal labor practices. Subsistence farming is often character- ized by a structure in which the entire family participates. This means that (pregnant) women and children are often involved in production. In many cases, domestic law permits their participation, or the law is not enforced due to the rural nature of agricultural production. Cultural norms and practices may dictate that these practices are acceptable; some of these norms and prac- tices may directly contravene prevailing law. The Fair Trade certification process, however, views gender and child la- bor standards largely in black and white. By allowing children or pregnant women to work on Fair Trade–certified farms, the local producer risks losing certification and the market premiums afforded by the Fair Trade label.9 Simi- larly, many coffee farmers depend on migrant labor when harvesting. The highly transient nature of migrant labor may make it difficult for smallhold- ers to monitor the labor supply and, ultimately, to fully adhere to Fair Trade standards.10 The issues of access to land and credit underlie the Fair Trade model but are not explicitly addressed by the Fair Trade standards. Access to land and land rights have a direct bearing on what crops are produced and how they are produced. Though Fair Trade welcomes and promotes the participation of women producers in its networks through its gender standard, it falls short of advocating for women’s land rights. Similar to the issue of labor discussed above, cultural norms and practices may contravene national laws regarding women’s inheritance of land. Without directly addressing issues of inheri- tance or a woman’s right to hold property, the Fair Trade standard on gender may miss an opportunity to build equity and capacity within producer com- munities and organizations. Linked to the issue of landholdings, access to credit can be a pressing is- sue for smallholders engaged in Fair Trade production. Access to credit allows farmers to buy new seeds or seedlings and fertilizers. Credit may also help a family ensure that a child receives health care or education. Credit for small- holders may be particularly difficult to obtain due to their geographic location and industry.11 Microcredit may be be er suited to subsistence farming, as the cooperatives themselves may be more able to provide for their members’ needs than regular commercial banks can. Given this, and the comparatively high cost of certification, it is somewhat surprising that Fair Trade organiza- 9 For an interesting discussion on child labor and adherence to the Fair Trade standards, see Leonardo Becche i & Marco Constantino, The Effects of Fair Trade on Affiliated Producers: An Impact Analysis on Kenyan Farmers, 36(5) World Development 823–842 (2008). 10 See, generally, Cathy Farnworth & Michael Goodman, Growing Ethical Network: The Fair Trade Market for Raw and Processed Agricultural Products (background paper for the World Development Report 2008). 11 World Development Report 2008, supra note 1, at 143. Protecting Traditional Practices through Fair Trade and IPRs 45 tions have not taken a more proactive approach to provide a more enabling financial environment for their producers. Credit could ultimately remove one of the biggest barriers to market entry and increase production. It could also provide a form of insurance for produc- ing families to weather market declines. Surveys of Ethiopian coffee farmers have shown that a lack of credit greatly affects their willingness to buy agri- cultural inputs to boost production. In some cases, farmers have reported not wanting to take credit at all.12 Finally, with regard to both organically grown and shade-grown products, the majority of smallholder coffee production in Ethiopia is done through sub- sistence farming. The certification process for these kinds of agricultural prod- ucts is fairly streamlined. Ethiopian coffees are largely—if not entirely—pro- duced without commercial fertilizers, GMO seeds, or other means that would degrade the environment. If coffee production were to shift from smallholders to larger farms, care would need to be taken to ensure that a commitment to organic or shade-grown farming would continue to ensure certification and, ultimately, market premiums. Intellectual Property Rights and Agricultural Products There is a range of IPRs that can be used to seek protection for an agricultural product: trademarks, geographical indications (GIs), and traditional knowl- edge (TK). Each country has its own intellectual property (IP) system, but some general rules can be delineated. As with the Fair Trade standards de- scribed above, adherence to any of the methods below will create value-added commodities for export to other markets. All are relevant legal instruments for the Ethiopian coffee case: trademarks and GIs are recognized in key export markets, such as the European Union and the United States, Ethiopia’s main export markets for coffee, and TK is receiving increasing a ention from the international community. Trademarks A trademark serves to distinguish a product or service from similar goods, products, or services. It prevents confusion among consumers about the prod- uct origin and protects the owner’s goodwill.13 A trademark does not refer to the quality of the processes used to elaborate the service or manufacture the good. It a aches to a good or services regardless of either the manufacturing 12 Samuel Gebreselassie & Eva Ludi, Agricultural Commercialisation in Coffee Growing Areas of Ethiopia (research paper prepared for the Future Agricultures Consortium, Mar. 2008), avail- able at h p://r4d.dfid.gov.uk/PDF/Outputs/Futureagriculture/coffee_paper.pdf. 13 Maria Brownell, Coffee Trademark Licensing for Farmers: Brewing a Farmer-Owned Brand, 14 Drake J. Agric. L. 299 (2009). 46 The World Bank Legal Review process or the location of the manufacturing process. The value of a trademark depends on the intrinsic quality of the product or service itself.14 Under U.S. trademark law, a party can file an application with the United States Patent and Trademark Office (USPTO) to register a word, a logo, a de- vice, a slogan, a package design, a scent, a color, or a shape. If the application is accepted, the registered trademark becomes the private property of the reg- istering party and can be used or licensed only by that party on the goods or services identified in the application.15 A trademark owner has a right to permit nonowners to use the owner’s mark, in which case the parties will enter into a license agreement. A trade- mark owner can also prevent others from using the same or a similar mark on otherwise similar products. In the United States, trademark owners must protect their trademark by policing for its unauthorized use and can actively enforce their right by excluding every other entity from using their trademark, in order to prevent it from becoming diluted or generic.16 A trademark for a geographic region raises some issues because it gives the owner the exclusive right to use the trademarked name commercially. Generally, a geographically descriptive term cannot be granted a trademark because it is only descriptive, the reason being that all place-names should remain available for use by all competitors. However, this rule has an excep- tion, and to overcome the descriptive nature of a geographic term, the term must have acquired a “secondary meaning.” A term has a secondary meaning when the product is considered significant beyond the physical location of the goods.17 Thus, when a geographic term is associated with qualities indepen- dent of its physical location, the secondary meaning test is proven, and the product can be registered. This test of secondary meaning was applied to the Ethiopian case. Geographical Indications A GI is a name or sign used on certain products that indicates the region of origin of a specific good or service and relates to some standard of quality associated with the good or service. There is no universal definition for what constitutes a GI. It can include certification marks, designated GIs, protected designations of origin, protected GIs, and appellations of origin.18 14 Mary O’Kicki, Lessons Learned from Ethiopia’s Trademarking and Licensing Initiative: Is the Euro- pean Union’s Position on Geographical Indication Really Beneficial for Developing Nations?, 6 Loy. U. Chi. Intl. L. Rev. 324–325 (2008–2009), at 319. 15 See U.S. Trademark Law: Rules of Practices and Federal Statutes (U.S. Pat. & Trademark Off., Aug. 2012), available at h p://www.uspto.gov/trademarks/law/tmlaw.pdf. 16 Brownell, supra note 13, at 300. 17 Id., at 296. 18 O’Kicki, supra note 14, at 321. Protecting Traditional Practices through Fair Trade and IPRs 47 The United States and the European Union have different approaches regarding GIs. Under U.S. trademark law, GIs are registered and protected with the USPTO as a certification mark and must meet the secondary meaning requirement to be registered. A certification mark indicates that the good or service bearing the mark possesses certain qualities or is made according to traditional methods, as determined by a party, such as a trade group or a gov- ernment entity, including state agricultural agencies, but not by a manufac- turer itself. The mark indicates that the manufacturer adhered to third-party standards when producing the product. Certification marks tend to be owned by a collective group that establishes the standard or criteria that a product must meet to bear the organization’s certification mark.19 There are several differences between a trademark and a certification mark in the U.S. IPR system. First, a certification mark is used by a third party, not by the original manufacturer itself, to indicate some a ribute or quality of the goods. Second, while trademark owners are required to prevent every other entity from using their trademark, a U.S. certification mark owner cannot ex- clude other manufacturers that meet the standards and criteria as defined by the registered certification mark. In this respect, the U.S. system of certifica- tion marks creates opportunities for new producers and enables them to be associated with a particular certification mark, which can be a very valuable asset. A study found that consumers would be willing to pay 60 percent more for a wine labeled “Napa Valley” than for a wine labeled “California.”20 In the European Union, GIs are given a registration and protection system independently of trademarks. This is a core element of the EU trade and ag- riculture policy, and the European Union established a single system for the registry of GIs for some products intended for human consumption and cer- tain foodstuffs, but not all. This system provides protection for two categories of GIs: protected designation of origin and protected GIs. The EU system also offers protection for traditional specialty guaranteed.21 A protected designation of origin covers agricultural products and food- stuffs that are produced, processed, and prepared in a given geographical area using recognized know-how. Thus, a protected designation of origin product is tied both to the land through production and to the people who process and prepare the good. It is important to note that the European Union places a high value on the human skill associated with the preparation of a good.22 In order to qualify for GI protection, at least one of the stages of production, pro- cessing, or preparation must take place in the geographical area. Because only 19 Id. 20 Id., at 321 & note 78. 21 See, generally, the European Commission’s definitions of geographical indicators and tradi- tional specialties for definitions and lists of specific products, and so on, Geographical Indica- tions and Traditional Specialties, available at h p://ec.europa.eu/agriculture/quality/schemes/ (accessed Apr. 23, 2013). 22 O’Kicki, supra note 14, at 323. 48 The World Bank Legal Review one of the three stages needs to occur within the designated region, protected GIs are not as closely tied to the land as protected designation of origins. As for the traditional specialty guaranteed protection, it highlights the traditional character, either in the composition or in means of production, and it is not directly connected to the land.23 The TRIPS Agreement and Geographical Indications Geographic origin has been cited in trade for over a century, and in their cur- rent form, GIs are governed by the 1995 WTO Agreement on Trade-Related Aspects of Intellectual Property Rights (TRIPS Agreement). Article 22.1 of the TRIPS Agreement defines GIs as “indications which identify a good as origi- nating in the territory of a Member, or a region or locality in that territory, where a given quality, reputation or other characteristic of the good is essen- tially a ributable to its geographic origin.” This broad definition encompasses many of the different permutations of GIs that are legally recognized by WTO member countries.24 Moreover, the TRIPS Agreement (Articles 41 ss.) requires that all WTO members provide a certain level of protection for IPRs, including the legal means for a member country to assert and enforce its IPRs. The TRIPS Agreement provides two levels of protection for GIs, depend- ing on the product considered. For products other than wines and spirits (Ar- ticle 22), a GI is protected to the extent it does not cause consumer confusion or mislead the public as to the origin of the product. The protection of a GI is therefore not absolute. An appellation such as “Camembert-like cheese made in Canada” is permi ed, since the origin is clearly mentioned. Wines and spir- its benefit from an additional protection under Article 23: GIs can be used only for products that originated in the place indicated by the GI in question. Thus, only producers of Champagne from the Champagne region of France can use the term “Champagne” to identify their products. “Champagne-like” and “produced by the Champagne method” are prohibited product designations under the TRIPS Agreement.25 The European Union advocates that the protec- tion granted to wines and spirits be extended to all registered GIs.26 This means that product designations such as “Camembert-like cheese made in Canada” would no longer be authorized if the European Union succeeds in its efforts. The strong legal protection granted to wine and spirit GIs under Article 23 of the TRIPS Agreement is similar to the legal protection provided by the trademark system. For example, the GoE has registered the word “Harar” as a trademark for its coffee in several countries (see below for a description of the 23 See Geographical Indications and Traditional Specialties, supra note 21. 24 O’Kicki, supra note 14. 25 Id., at 324. 26 The Special Session of the TRIPS Council in WTO discussed at length the issue of applying GI for wine. This discussion can be found at Communication from the European Commu- nities, Geographical Indications, TN/C/W/26, TN/IP/W/11 (June 14, 2005), available at h p:// www.wto.org/english/tratop_e/trips_e/gi1_docs_e.htm (accessed Apr. 23, 2013). Protecting Traditional Practices through Fair Trade and IPRs 49 Ethiopian case), so only the GoE has the legal right to use and to license the word “Harar” for coffees. “Harar-like” and “in the style of Harar” are unac- ceptable uses of the word. In the same vein, only producers from the Cham- pagne region, meeting the criteria described in the GI registration, can use the word “Champagne” in their label.27 Traditional Knowledge Traditional knowledge (TK) is not protected under the TRIPS Agreement. Cur- rently, countries seeking IP protection for TK in the international market must fit it into one of the IP categories that is protected under the TRIPS Agreement. In principle, because GIs are not “intended to reward innovation, but rather to reward members of an established group or community adhering to tra- ditional practices belonging to the culture of that community or group,” it is understandable that some developing nations would embrace the GI system as a means to protect their TK.28 In other cases, communities have sought to establish trademarks. TK has received increasing a ention in a range of recent international poli- cy discussions. There have been considerable efforts to enshrine TK protection in the law—most notably with the World Intellectual Property Organization (WIPO’s) establishment of the Intergovernmental Commi ee on Intellectual Property and Genetic Resources, Traditional Knowledge, and Folklore (the IGC).29 The IGC’s mission is to draft and reach an agreement on an internation- al legal instrument (or instruments) that will ensure the effective protection of TK, traditional cultural expressions, and genetic resources.30 The IGC suggests the following definition(s) for TK: “[refers to]/[includes]/[means] know-how, skills, innovations, practices, teachings and learnings of [indigenous [peoples] and [local communities]]/[or a state or states] that are dynamic and evolving, and that are intergenerational/and that are passed on from generation to gen- eration, and which may subsist in codified, oral or other forms.”31 Efforts to protect TK by a new system of IPRs focus almost exclusively on the knowledge of indigenous people. The proponents of a new legal regime invoke concepts of property to enhance the protection of TK. A 2009 WIPO re- port states that “holders of TK should be entitled to fair and equitable sharing 27 O’Kicki, supra note 14, at 325. 28 Id. 29 Stephen R. Munzer & Kal Raustiala, The Uneasy Case for Intellectual Property Rights in Tradi- tional Knowledge, 27 Cardozo Arts & Ent. L.J. 37, 38 (2009). 30 WIPO uses the term traditional knowledge to encompass traditional knowledge, genetic re- sources, and traditional cultural expressions. For more on how all three subtopics fit under WIPO’s TK classification, see h p://www.wipo.int/tk/en/igc/index.html (accessed Apr. 23, 2013). 31 Protection of Traditional Knowledge: Draft Articles Rev. 2 (Apr. 26, 2013), available at h p:// www.wipo.int/edocs/mdocs/tk/en/wipo_grtkf_ic_24/wipo_grtkf_ic_24_facilitators_docu ment_rev_2.pdf (accessed Aug. 5, 2013). 50 The World Bank Legal Review of benefits arising from the use of their knowledge.”32 The objectives of the TK legal protection would be to promote respect for TK; deter the misappropria- tion of TK; empower TK holders, who are typically marginalized indigenous communities; and protect tradition-based innovation.33 Proponents advocate the creation of sui generis rights via international treaties and the establish- ment of global databases of TK. There are those who oppose an establishment of a legal instrument to protect TK, voicing concern that this type of IP protec- tion would be “contrary to how many indigenous communities conceive of their cultural heritage.”34 The concept of TK will continue to evolve with the continued work of the IGC and the overall efforts of WIPO. The Case for Ethiopian Fine Coffees By the mid-2000s, the GoE already had enacted a considerable legal frame- work to protect Ethiopia’s cultural and agricultural heritage. This included, inter alia, Trademark Registration & Protection Proclamation No. 501/2006; Access to Genetic Resources and Community Knowledge and Community Rights No. 482/2006; the Plant Breeders’ Right Proclamation; Copyright and Neighboring Rights Protection Proclamation No. 410/2000; and Research and Conservation of Cultural Heritage Proclamation No. 209/2000. In the international sphere, Ethiopia has been a member of WIPO since 1998. The GoE is also a signatory to the Convention on Biological Diversity. It signed the Nagoya Protocol on Access to Genetic Resources and the Fair and Equitable Sharing of Benefits and the Cartagena Protocol on Biosafety to the Convention of Biological Diversity, as well as the International Treaty on Plant and Genetic Resources for Food and Agriculture. Coffee historically has been a major export for Ethiopia. The collapse of the International Coffee Agreements in the late 1980s and the almost simulta- neous collapse of the state-run coffee trade that occurred with the overthrow of the Derg led to disarray and a precipitous drop in coffee earnings for the country. State-run coffee cooperatives collapsed, leaving many to rebuild af- ter losing their records and premises due to looting. Over time, and with the reestablishment of coffee cooperatives and export agencies, the coffee sector began to rebuild. With market liberalization, prices paid to producers began to rise by the 1990s, and the government allowed some gourmet coffees and organics to be sold directly on the international market. Private land ownership, which had been abolished by the Derg, remained state controlled in the post-Derg (post-1991) period. This fact is important be- cause all of the country’s land belongs to the GoE and the government claims 32 WIPO, Intellectual Property and Traditional Knowledge 11 (Booklet No. 2), available at h p:// www.wipo.int/freepublications/en/tk/920/wipo_pub920.pdf; cited in Munzer & Raustiala, supra note 29, at note 3. 33 Munzer & Raustiala, supra note 29, at 39. 34 Id. Protecting Traditional Practices through Fair Trade and IPRs 51 the right to direct all economic initiatives. Recognizing that coffee would re- main one of the country’s chief exports, the GoE’s first Poverty Reduction Strategy paper—A Plan for Accelerated and Sustained Development to End Poverty (PASDEP) (2005‒2009/10) noted that due consideration will also be given to the production of high value/ cash crops like fruit and vegetables, coffee, tea and spices which could play a significant role in improving the living standards of smallholder farmers and strengthening the foreign currency earning capacity of the country.35 The PASDEP gave the GoE a strong role in supporting the coffee produc- tion. This included targeted assistance to coffee preparation industries and the provision of adequate warehouses and storage facilities both in the woredas and centrally. Moreover, maintaining the quality of the coffee exports was a priority for the GoE. In this regard, the PASDEP called for, inter alia, • Improving the quality and agricultural products to supply ex- port markets, improving existing standards and produce new ones, and ensure the introduction and control of proper obser- vation of standards; • Establishment of coffee and tea inspection and auction centers in major coffee growing woredas.36 It was against this backdrop that the GoE began to work with DfID to develop its ability to enforce and manage its IPRs internationally in the early 2000s. As part of DfID’s efforts, and in order to build capacity within the GoE to support these claims, the project provided technical assistance to the Ethio- pia Intellectual Property Office, established in 2003. The overall aim of DfID’s support was to afford coffee producers a means to negotiate coffee prices through the operation of a transparent market. The pro- ject was based on a value chain analysis and a value capture strategy that en- tailed the use of trademarks, branding and licensing, and brand management. DfID brought together the biggest actors in the national coffee market with the creation of the Ethiopian Fine Coffee Stakeholder Commi ee. This commi ee included local coffee farmers cooperatives, the relevant line min- istries, EIPO, and the Ethiopian Coffee Exports Association Board. Through the creation of this commi ee, as well from as the direct support to EIPO, the DfID project assisted in crafting trademark strategies and policies to maintain and protect the value of four high-value Ethiopian coffees—Harrar, Harar (an- other trademarked name for Harrar), Sidamo, and Yirgacheffe—on the inter- national market. 35 Government of Ethiopia, Ministry of Finance and Economic Development (MoFED), Ethiopia: Building on Progress, A Plan for Accelerated and Sustained Development to End Poverty (PASDEP) (2005/06-2009/10), vol. 1: Main Text (MoFED, Sept. 2006), available at h p://siteresources .worldbank.org/INTETHIOPIA/Resources/PASDEP_Final_English.pdf. 36 Id., at 106. 52 The World Bank Legal Review The DfID project undertook a value chain analysis for these Ethiopian coffees. The objective of the value chain analysis was to ensure that value was accrued at the production end of the coffee value chain. The DfID project also worked with a law firm on a pro bono basis to register the four coffees in 33 in- ternational markets, including the United States, the European Union, Japan, Canada, Australia, and Saudi Arabia. Early indications from this trademark- ing effort showed an increase in export prices on the order of 50–100 percent.37 Trademarks may be more lucrative for producers to use, because they require less up front as compared to Fair Trade. This is important for a farmer making only a slight margin on products and is a different approach from Fair Trade certification, which requires compliance with a number of standards and rela- tively costly site inspections before crops are certified. The DfID effort also sought to establish more transparent mechanisms for exporting. The collapse of the Derg regime and the resulting liberalization of the coffee sector resulted in the corresponding collapse of the old systems and agencies supporting Ethiopia’s coffee exports. The Ethiopian Coffee Purchase and Sales Enterprise and the Ethiopian Coffee Export Enterprise emerged as government-controlled agencies in the early post-Derg period. By the 2000s, even these state-run companies were being phased out and replaced by pri- vate entities. Work was under way in Ethiopia to create a nationwide com- modity exchange linked to various warehouses to handle coffee auctions. Maintaining the brands established with DfID assistance, however, meant that coffee farmers needed to understand and apply the brand and ensure that quality was preserved. This would be a long-term process, as historically there had been li le emphasis on coffee quality in Ethiopia. The World Bank would help finance, inter alia, a government-sponsored campaign to raise awareness among coffee farmers. Trademark Dispute with Starbucks In March 2005, the GoE filed trademark applications with USPTO for three of Ethiopia’s specialty coffees: Harrar, Sidamo, and Yirgacheffe. This appli- cation took some companies, including U.S.-based Starbucks, by surprise. In 2004, Starbucks had applied for trademark registration of a limited-edition coffee. Shirkina Sun-Dried Sidamo. Ethiopia, working with Oxfam and a U.S.- based pro bono law firm, requested that Starbucks withdraw its trademark application to allow its own trademark application to move forward. Star- bucks’ initial response to Ethiopia was that a certification mark or a GI was a more appropriate designation for Ethiopia’s heritage coffees.38 Eventually, Starbucks withdrew its application for Shirkina Sun-Dried Sidamo, stating it was a limited-edition coffee, but the dispute did not end there. 37 Overseas Development Institute, supra note 7, at 10. 38 O’Kicki, supra note 14, at 329–330. Protecting Traditional Practices through Fair Trade and IPRs 53 The National Coffee Association (NCA), representing U.S. coffee roasters, importers, retailers, and distributors, including Starbucks, objected to Ethio- pia’s applications for trademarking Harrar and Sidamo by filing notices of opposition with USPTO. The NCA contended that Sidamo and Harrar his- torically have been used in the United States. Furthermore, the NCA posted that these were generic terms for coffee from geographical regions of Ethiopia and therefore did not meet the legal criteria to qualify for trademark registra- tion. This point of view was adopted by USPTO, which did not register these trademarks.39 Ethiopia appealed this decision, arguing that the names had acquired secondary meaning to consumers (that is, consumers recognized the words as a source of quality and for characteristics of the coffee) and were not ge- neric words for coffee. Ethiopia eventually succeeded, and, in February 2008, the USPTO recognized Ethiopia’s qualification under the secondary-meaning test and granted Ethiopia a trademark for the coffee-producing regions.40 Ul- timately, Starbucks signed a licensing agreement with Ethiopia recognizing Ethiopia’s ownership of the names. The World Bank Intellectual Property Rights Project The World Bank coffee project came about at a time when the Bank was ac- tively looking into Fair Trade as a way to raise profits for farmers and induce development. In the lead-up to the 2008 World Development Report, Agricul- ture for Development (WDR), considerable research was done by the Bank on the impacts of Fair Trade. Agriculture for Development recognized the growing trend of producing high-value or niche agricultural products for export. The WDR called this trend “decommodification,” as producers sought alternative markets for these products.41 Yet, the report offered no specific policy recom- mendations on Fair Trade as a result of this research. On the contrary, the WDR cited a number of concerns about Fair Trade, related to rationing of Fair Trade products in the export markets due to saturation, and the high cost for farmers to do business with the Fair Trade organizations themselves.42 The report made recommendations for governments to establish enabling en- vironments for agriculture and agricultural exports, with specific support to smallholders through strong producer organizations and more transparent market mechanisms. IPRs fit squarely within the World Bank’s operational policies. Specifi- cally, the Bank’s Indigenous Peoples Policy (Operational Policy 4.10) of the same period endorses the use of IPRs as one of nine initiatives to support 39 See h p://tsdr.uspto.gov (case no. 78589307) for the proceedings documents; cited in O’Kicki, supra note 14, note 133. 40 An Ethiopian trademark for Yirgacheffe was awarded by the USPTO in August 2006. 41 World Development Report 2008, supra note 1, at 132. 42 Id., at 133. 54 The World Bank Legal Review development and poverty reduction.43 The policy further recognizes cultural ties to lands, as well as the species and fauna of indigenous peoples.44 The World Bank’s support for Ethiopian coffee fits well within this framework. The GoE first approached the World Bank for technical assistance with EIPO and for the protection and enforcement of the country’s IPRs. The re- quest came in as EIPO’s involvement with DfID was drawing to a close. At the time the World Bank grant was developed, the Ethiopian government claimed that Ethiopian coffee names had been misappropriated in both local and foreign markets, the most visible example of which was the U.S. trade- mark dispute with Starbucks. The GoE asserted that the country’s unique cul- tural, biotech, and agricultural assets held considerable promise as IP assets on the international market. With the proper branding and enforcement of the country’s IPRs, these products could be appropriately valued and could gen- erate the export income anticipated by the government. The promotion and enforcement of IPRs was seen as an effective policy tool to promote social and economic development in the country. The World Bank project, Managing and Enforcing Intellectual Property Rights: Creating a Driver of Growth—an Institutional Development Fund (IDF) grant—was approved in June 2006 for US$496,000.45 The project closed in October 2010. The project objective was to strengthen the capacity of EIPO to manage, brand, and protect IPRs in Western markets. Although the coun- try had considerable potential for branding other IPRs for other products, such as leather, flowers, spices, and traditional medicine knowledge, the IDF grant focused solely on coffee. The main beneficiaries of the project activities were EIPO, Ethiopian coffee growers’ organizations, and coffee growers more generally. The grant had three main activities: to assess IP assets within the country, building local capacity to undertake these types of assessments; to build the capacity of Ethiopian administrative and justice sector teams to enforce IPRs; and to empower local IPR owners. Due to delays in project approval, the IP asset valuation exercise was ultimately done with the assistance of DfID prior to that project’s closing. The Starbucks case helped transform EIPO’s role, further transforming the 43 The 2005 Indigenous Peoples Policy was important in that this version of the policy con- tained nine specific product lines for which Bank-financed projects could actively provide assistance to indigenous communities. One of these product lines dealt specifically with in- tellectual property rights. OP 4.10, para. 22(h). 44 For purposes of the World Bank–financed Ethiopian coffee project, however, the policy framework was adapted to the circumstances but not applied because the GoE does not recognize indigenous peoples. 45 This type of grant is given to build just-in-time capacity for a discrete need within the gov- ernment. Prior to 2011, the IDF gave priority to grant proposals that focused on one of five areas: public expenditure management and financial accountability; procurement; results- oriented monitoring and evaluation systems; systemic legal and judicial reforms; or nonfo- cus or other. The Ethiopia IDF grant focused on systemic legal and judicial reforms. Protecting Traditional Practices through Fair Trade and IPRs 55 agency’s responsibilities and changing the scope of many of the planned IPR activities. In mid-2007, EIPO embarked on a process of reorganization with World Bank support. It sought to broaden its responsibilities from serving as a conventional IP registry to more broadly engaging in advocacy activities on a national, regional, and international scale. EIPO placed the country’s inno- vations and products at the fore with this restructuring. As part of the reorga- nization and expansion of its activities, EIPO proposed to undertake greater outreach to small and median enterprises within Ethiopia, as well as build greater awareness of IPRs in local universities and industries. A large portion of the grant activities involved the creation of a licensing and branding program within EIPO. Originally, the World Bank project envi- sioned the creation of specialized capacities within EIPO to manage trademark registration, foreign supply chain licensing, brand management, and stake- holder engagement. Recognizing that there was low recognition and knowl- edge of IPRs within various government agencies, the World Bank project scaled back its original aim to create a licensing program within EIPO. Rather, a comprehensive training program was designed and implemented using a train-the-trainers approach. Under this initiative, four EIPO staff members were trained on issues relevant to certification. The project sought to expand the number of coffees trademarked in inter- national markets. EIPO chose to pursue the licensing of Limu and Nekemte coffees internationally, first by developing a value capture analysis for these two coffees. Brand guidelines were also drafted for these two coffees, based largely on the precedent set by the guidelines developed for Harar, Harrar, Sidamo, and Yirgacheffe coffees. The project engaged the same U.S.-based law firm that had worked on the Starbucks case and the trademark claims for the four trademarked coffees on a pro bono basis.46 At the project’s conclusion, it was estimated that the legal services provided for the trademarking of these two coffees cost close to US$1.0 million, more than twice the total amount of the grant. This figure is relatively conservative; a considerable amount of legal work was done drafting model licensing contracts and creating an umbrella brand standard and trademark. As part of EIPO’s new advocacy and outreach efforts, an Intellectual Property Rights Center was established in Addis Ababa to house information regarding IPRs. The center is open to the public. EIPO launched a website in Aramaic to describe EIPO’s role and responsibilities. In addition, the grant financed a number of outreach activities to empower local producers, includ- ing television and radio programs, as well as leaflets regarding the role of intellectual property in their own personal lives and on the role that EIPO has played in the enjoyment and enforcement of those rights. 46 Ultimately, this activity led to the registration of only one coffee in one international market. This was due to a dispute between EIPO and the pro bono law firm over minor, nonlegal fees paid by the firm in the course of licensing. EIPO disputed the firm’s claim that the gov- ernment needed to pay the charges. At the end of the project, EIPO and the firm were in a stalemate over the payment of the fees and additional licensing. 56 The World Bank Legal Review The grant’s more successful activities involved the outreach activities re- lated to IP and coffee growers themselves. A number of radio and television programs were produced and aired on local stations to empower local IPR owners on IPR protection. These activities were targeted specifically at small producers, cooperatives, local business owners, and IP lawyers. The grant was active in creating and disseminating local knowledge re- garding IPRs. EIPO delivered specific training to the coffee farmers cooper- atives and other stakeholders regarding the importance of maintaining the respective brands. Through their own experiences with producing other de- commoditized coffees—such as organics, shade-grown, and Fair Trade cof- fees—various Ethiopian coffee farmers unions47 were aware of the importance of quality and began to ensure quality in their own production. Furthermore, the licensing agreements to use the trademarked brand names of coffee were royalty free for the coffee farmers, meaning that any additional profit accrued to the coffees at the point of sale accrued to the coffee farmer. The grant had the least success in building the capacity of local Ethiopian administrative and justice sector teams. This was due in large part to the gen- eral outward/export orientation of the project. Local judges, lawyers, investi- gators, and other government officials were less involved in the enforcement of IPRs. There was li le buy-in for the project’s activities by the customs and other enforcement officials. Project Outcomes The World Bank project built on a number of crucial building blocks already in place in Ethiopia. The fact that the project implementation was not depen- dent on the passage of new laws or structures—most of which were created under the DfID project—meant that the time frames for implementation were short. Furthermore, when the project was designed, it was conceivable that the project outcomes could be met by the end of the project’s original three- year term. It was also conceivable that certain targets for capacity building within EIPO and among the coffee growers could be met during the original implementation period. The World Bank project largely succeeded due to the presence of an en- abling framework for trade within the country. On a much larger scale, and as measured by the website produced by Doing Business, it is more costly, time- consuming, and bureaucratic to export out of Sub-Saharan Africa than it is to export out of Latin America.48 Africa-specific studies, notably a World Bank 47 A number of coffee cooperatives emerged in the post-Derg era. These include the Oromia Coffee Farmers Cooperative Union, the Yirgacheffe Coffee Farmers Cooperative Union, the Sidama Coffee Farmers Cooperative Union, and the Kaffa Forest Coffee Farmers Coopera- tive Union. 48 Cf. data in Trading across Borders. Published by the Doing Business Project, World Bank Group, available at h p://www.doingbusiness.org/data/exploretopics/trading-across -borders (accessed Apr. 1, 2013). Protecting Traditional Practices through Fair Trade and IPRs 57 report on mango production in Mali, cite the need to leverage economies of scale though the creation and support of producer organizations in country.49 The DfID and World Bank projects tapped into well-organized, existing coffee farmers cooperatives to boost exports and ensure export quality. The consider- able experience in country with Fair Trade branding as well as organic brand- ing on the international market helped to create a culture of quality coffee. A Success Story: The Oromia Coffee Farmers Cooperative Union The Oromia Coffee Farmers Cooperative Union (OCFCU) was established in 1999 in Addis Ababa to facilitate the direct export of coffee produced by small farmers organized in cooperatives throughout the state. It is the old- est of the existing coffee farmers unions; it was one of the most active cof- fee farmers cooperative unions under the World Bank project. The OCFCU operates in Oromia regional state, where 65 percent of the country’s coffee is grown. It is responsible for processing, marketing, and commercializing coffee for its members. OCFCU comprises 197 primary cooperatives, repre- senting some 200,000 farming families. The OCFCU oversees quality control and a processing plant and has established a bank for cooperative members. The World Bank project also benefi ed from the Ethiopian Commodities Exchange (ECX), established in 2008. The ECX was initially supported by the GoE. The ECX provided a transparent, real-time platform for trading coffee and other commodities. It also served as an independent verification body for the qualities and types of coffees delivered. Compared to the Derg era, when the state controlled coffee trade through the creation of cooperatives, set prices, and mandated only two auctions per year, the ECX provides coffee farmers greater transparency, timeliness, and assurance that their coffee will be marketed correctly, reducing transaction costs for farmers and traders. A long-standing history of coffee exports in country, an existing culture of agricultural cooperatives, and a growing appreciation for quality within the coffee farmers cooperative unions were the main factors that were already present. Furthermore, the government’s own policies to promote specialty coffees through special pricing mechanisms, and later EIPO’s support of IPRs in international markets, helped boost exports and profits. On the whole, the use of trademarks did bring be er prices to producers and farmers in Ethiopia. Farmers saw the greatest increases in profits when producing a combination of Fair Trade, organic, and trademarked coffees. WIPO estimates that prior to the enforcement of IPRs, Ethiopian smallholders received approximately US$1 per kilo of coffee; the final market price ranged from US$20 to US$28 per kilo. WIPO also reported that Yirgacheffe farmers’ income doubled in 2007 with the use and enforcement of IPRs.50 This rise in 49 Morgane Danielou, Patrick Labaste, & Jean-Michel Voisard, Linking Farmers to Markets: Ex- porting Malian Mangoes to Europe (World Bank Africa Region Working Paper No. 60, 2003). 50 See communications of WIPO: The Coffee War: Ethiopia and the Starbucks Story, available at h p://www.wipo.int/ipadvantage/en/details.jsp?id=2621 (accessed Apr. 4, 2013). 58 The World Bank Legal Review prices had a direct impact on local coffee-farming communities and indivi- duals. The coffee unions have self-reported an increase in investments in coffee-producing communities through the provision of physical infrastruc- ture for schools, the creation of health posts, and the development of fresh- water supplies, among other developments.51 The project had mixed success when it came to promoting IP issues in- ternally. By the end of the project, there was considerable awareness among local coffee producers regarding their ability to use IP to extract a higher price on the market for their coffees. The project had more limited traction in dis- cussing these issues with government officials, such as judges and customs officials. For a majority of these officials, IP will remain a theoretical issue until clear domestic cases of IP infringement arise. Some observers have hinted at the fact that kickbacks may be at play with regard to inspectors and those in- volved in the export trade. Maintaining clear governance structures and trans- parency, with direct oversight by concerned stakeholders, will be the only way to ensure that such problems are minimized. By the end of the World Bank project, EIPO had let a number of trademark licenses lapse on the international market. Trademarks in the United States require constant policing and research to enforce. Keeping licenses and trade- marks current requires a level of internal organization, planning, and financial resources that fell outside the scope of this project. This leads to questions regarding the overall viability and sustainability of IPR interventions such as this. A Possible Way Forward Fair Trade and trademarking (through the enforcement of IPRs) can help pro- mote development within countries that pursue export-led growth. Both Fair Trade and IPRs have their strengths and their weaknesses. A combination of the two may provide the best way to promote equitable development while helping coffee farmers mitigate prevailing market risks. World Bank research has shown that Fair Trade can deliver higher prices to producers and access to high-value markets.52 The World Development Report 2008: Agriculture for Development recognized that by linking agribusiness and smallholders, there could be reductions in rural poverty.53 As illustrated by the Ethiopian case, Fair Trade certification and IPRs can complement existing trade regimes. There is evidence that Fair Trade creates real impacts at the lo- cal level through the creation of a more level playing field for coffee farmers. There is also evidence of concrete improvements in Ethiopian Fair Trade pro- 51 See the table Life Improving, published by the Oromia Coffee Farmers Cooperative Union, available at h p://www.oromiacoffeeunion.org/LifeImproving.php (accessed Apr. 4, 2013). 52 Ronchi, supra note 2, at 1. 53 World Development Report 2008, supra note 1, at 135. Protecting Traditional Practices through Fair Trade and IPRs 59 ducer communities through the building of health posts, schools, and clean drinking wells. At the same time, the same research shows that Fair Trade does not sup- plant international trade mechanisms. As a single cash crop, coffee faces a number of externalities on the international market that are difficult to over- come. Regardless of special trademarks or brands, coffee prices remain vola- tile on the international market. Like conventional coffee, Fair Trade coffee exports can face market saturation. Ethiopian smallholders, cognizant of the risk of solely producing coffee, often raise other crops as well as produce to feed their own families. Furthermore, Fair Trade mechanisms cannot wholly protect Fair Trade products from market failures. This was certainly the case for Ethiopian cof- fee in the fall of 2012, as local prices for coffee were higher than international prices. Many coffee farmers turned to the production of local consumable products to weather the drop in international prices. Without support to fur- ther diversify exports—both on a general level and with respect to the protec- tion of the country’s TK through IPRs—Ethiopia will lose market share and development potential. However noble Fair Trade’s objectives are, it can create unintended in- congruences within markets. A community risks considerable harm by losing Fair Trade certification but may feel disempowered to apply the standard for cultural or financial reasons. Indeed, the decertification process would inflict considerable financial harm on a community or producer organization, as the fees paid to the Fair Trade certifying organization are substantial. These op- portunity costs—and the level of risk involved to the producer itself—may discourage current and new entrants into the Fair Trade market. With respect to Fair Trade’s child labor standards, producers can quickly fall into trouble and lose Fair Trade certification if children perform tasks dur- ing (re)certification site visits. Some research has indicated that while labeling (such as Fair Trade) may be a deterrent for using child labor in the production of the Fair Trade goods, this labor pool may be shifted into domestic produc- tion where child labor is not an issue.54 One study of organic and Fair Trade producers in Kenya showed that they employed virtually the same (high) lev- els of child labor as conventional means of production.55 Building greater outreach on this standard, in particular by international Fair Trade groups to local producers, may go a long way toward changing at- titudes regarding these practices. Furthermore, there may be real and pressing economic needs for children to be involved in production. If Fair Trade orga- nizations would adopt a more graded or phased application of this standard, 54 Jean-Marie Baland & Cédric Duprez, Are Fair Trade Labels Effective against Child Labour?, 12 (Discussion Paper No. 6259, Ctr. Econ. Policy Research, 2007), available at h p://www.cepr .org/pubs/dps/DP6259.asp. 55 Leonardo Becche i & Marco Constantino, The Effects of Fair Trade on Affiliated Producers: An Impact Analysis on Kenyan Farmers, 36(5) World Dev. 823–842 (2008). 60 The World Bank Legal Review one where children would a end school but could also work for a prescriptive amount or period of time, communities could reap the double benefits of Fair Trade and increased human capital. In the case of the Fair Trade gender standard, its promotion of women’s rights within the production of Fair Trade–labeled goods is commendable. Yet, the standard is silent regarding the support of a woman’s right to hold land. Women, particularly in Africa, can face tremendous obstacles to own- ing and working their own farms. Although much has been wri en about large-scale land grabs in Africa, smaller land grabs within communities over inheritance tend to impact women the most. Female land ownership in Ethiopia—for example, of land received by women through post-Derg land distribution or through the death of their hus- bands—does not automatically give the women a right to cultivate their own fields. Labor restrictions do not allow women to use oxen to plow fields. Many women keep their fields in coffee production because they are able to hire migrants and temporary labor to work during the harvests more easily than if they are growing other crops.56 Continued restrictions on women working their own land, and dwindling pools of migrant workers, will have a negative, long-term impact on women heads of household if the economy continues to diversify and offers more skilled, higher-paid jobs. The IPR approach to trademarking of coffees, as noted above, has an ex- ternal focus and therefore does not have the same level of impact on social development within the coffee-producing communities. Unlike with Fair Trade certification, a farmer does not face (substantial) up-front costs to the trademark or brand using IPRs, as the Ethiopian licensing agreements are roy- alty free. The trademark approach is less interventionist for the individual coffee farmers, although coffee farmers associations may pass some of their overhead costs on to the producers through fees. The quality of the coffees is ensured through the coffee farmers associations as well as the ECX. Maintaining market share and quality have been constant problems for all producers in Ethiopia. If the country continues to pursue export-led growth through exports such as specialty coffees, the local coffee farmers coopera- tive associations must continue their outreach and capacity-building activities within communities around these issues. Additional policy supports from the GoE or capacity-building activities from international Fair Trade associations can be extremely beneficial in creating a strong culture of quality and brand adherence. To date, few cases of World Bank–financed projects have involved the en- forcement of IPRs. One reason may be the reluctance to use such a legal-based and (inherently) costly activity in pursuit of development. Unfortunately, an impact evaluation of the World Bank project’s activities fell outside the purview of the IDF grant. An evaluation of the cost-effectiveness of the IPR 56 Gebreselassie & Ludi, supra note 12, at 14. Protecting Traditional Practices through Fair Trade and IPRs 61 intervention would be useful, as the World Bank has provided a specific poli- cy recommendation to undertake protection of traditional knowledge through IPRs in its Indigenous Peoples’ Policy. From the data gathered in the World Bank project, it is apparent that some of the profits made through decommoditization have been reinvested into the community. It is difficult to measure the quantitative impact of the Bank- financed IPR intervention, either on a cost basis (cost to farmer) or a benefits basis. Furthermore, it is difficult to separate a purely Fair Trade coffee from a trademarked coffee because production is so intertwined in Ethiopia. Some anecdotal evidence points to certain economic and social gains made at the cooperative level. In the future, impact evaluations would be useful to gauge the overall effectiveness of enforcing IPRs on the international market. What is apparent from the World Bank–financed project is that IPRs re- quire specialized legal knowledge. This knowledge and capacity are often be- yond the scope of a domestic IP agency such as EIPO. It is highly unlikely that EIPO (or any national government) would be the main actor in drafting future licensing agreements. A greater appreciation by local agencies of the content of an agreement and the steps taken to file and fulfill such an agreement would go a long way toward ensuring greater sustainability of IP assets over the long term. Future twinning arrangements with (pro bono) law firms and local IP agencies would ensure greater understanding and appreciation of how these agreements and rights work on the international level. Building capacity with- in local legal communities—through specialized training provided by local bar associations, Fair Trade training and legal advisory services provided by international Fair Trade organizations, and specific courses in law schools— could help build the technical capacity to run domestic IP programs and re- duce the involvement of other international actors. This approach will take considerable time to consolidate. As noted above, some of the teaching will remain theoretical in developing countries until there is a landmark IPR case. The World Bank project brought an understanding to Ethiopian coffee growers and exporters alike that trademarks could bring value above and be- yond that of merely Fair Trade–certified coffee. As a single cash crop, coffee exports face a number of market externalities that are difficult to overcome. Without greater diversification of crops or products for export, Ethiopian cof- fee farmers will continue to weather cycles of boom and bust. Further diversi- fication of Ethiopia’s export base, including the pursuit of protecting other TK assets on the international market through trademarks, and continued adher- ence to Fair Trade standards by producer organizations in country, can bring considerable equitable development to Ethiopia while growing the economy. The gains made through Fair Trade certification and the use of trademarks positively affected those involved in the Ethiopian coffee sector. The larger question remains whether or not these gains can be sustained financially and institutionally. This page intentionally left blank Tools for More Sustainable Trade Treaties with Developing Countries MARKUS W. GEHRING The European Union has long struggled to find the right tools to integrate social, economic, and environmental priorities into its trade policies and trea- ties and to foster opportunity, inclusion, and equity. This has become more important since the Lisbon Treaty entered into force on December 1, 2009. One element of the Lisbon Treaty, the Treaty on European Union, is to “foster the sustainable economic, social and environmental development of develop- ing countries with the primary aim of eradicating poverty” (Article 25). This general objective is also binding for the EU’s international trade policy or, to be more precise, for the EU’s “common commercial policy,” per Article 205 of the Treaty on the Functioning of the European Union. One of the most important tools that the EU has implemented to achieve this objective is a detailed process of the assessment of the impact of trade treaties.1 Impact assessments are an integral part of environmental policy making and increasingly address social concerns such as health impacts.2 An earlier generation of environmental impact assessment (EIA) methodologies focused almost exclusively on the risks for the natural, biophysical environ- ment that were engendered by specific development projects.3 The prototypical EIA procedure involves a preliminary scientific or information-gathering phase and a report, which is then followed by a deci- sion to proceed with the activity (a finding of “no significant impact”) or to undertake a more in-depth assessment. An initial screening is performed to determine if a project triggers the EIA requirement.4 If an EIA is necessary, a scoping phase follows, whereby the party in charge of the EIA determines which impact should be considered as well as which alternatives should be assessed.5 Following this phase, a full assessment may be required, which 1 G. Duran & M. E. Marin, Environmental Integration in the EU’s External Relations: Beyond Mul- tilateral Dimensions 234 (Hart Publg. 2012). 2 For more information on the evolution from environmental to sustainable development as- sessment, see M. C. Cordonier Segger & A. Khalfan, Sustainable Development Law 175 (Oxford U. Press 2004). 3 See M. Gehring & M. C. Cordonier Segger, Sustainable Development through Process in World Trade Law, in Sustainable Development in World Trade Law 191, 192 (M. Gehring & M. C. Cor- donier Segger eds., Kluwer L. Intl. 2005). 4 United States National Environmental Policy Act (NEPA) and Agency Planning, 40 C.F.R. secs. 1501.3, 1501.4, 1507.3, 1508.9 (2002). 5 There are varying approaches to and varying emphases in the different stages. For example, the EIA process in the United States under NEPA is a detailed two-tier process in which 63 64 The World Bank Legal Review includes more comprehensive investigations and studies, public meetings or consultations, and the publication of more-in-depth studies supplemented with recommended measures to mitigate risks and enhance benefits (a man- agement plan).6 At national levels, the United States National Environmental Policy Act of 1969 (NEPA) is generally considered to have introduced the concept of the EIA.7 NEPA requires a report that includes an “assessment of the likely or potential environmental impacts of [a] proposed activity.”8 In the 1970s, many nations adopted NEPA-style EIA processes, including Canada (1973), Aus- tralia (1974), New Zealand (1974), Colombia (1974), Thailand (1975), France (1976), and the Netherlands (1979).9 The 1987 publication of the Brundtland Report, Our Common Future, which called for improved environmental impact assessments, also contributed to the evolution of national laws on the issue.10 By 1999, half of the 48 Sub-Saharan African countries had adopted EIA legis- lation.11 Even though political regimes, regional priorities, and cultural values are different in various countries, EIA processes tend to be consistent.12 As with other emerging themes in contemporary international law, the contours of national EIA policy and law have gained increasing normative resonance in the international arena.13 As a consequence, EIAs have been included in both an environmental assessment is conducted to determine the necessity of pursuing a full environmental impact statement. An environmental impact statement is not required if there is a finding of no significant impact (FONSI) at the end of the environmental assessment. To some extent, then, the environmental assessment combines the scoping phase and the base- line study. See 40 C.F.R. secs. 1501.3, 1501.4, 1506.6. Other jurisdictions take a more stream- lined (or less rigorous, depending on one’s perspective) approach to the scoping process that may or may not involve public participation. See, for example, Dennis Te-Chung Tang, New Developments in Environmental Law and Policy in Taiwan, 6 P. Rim L. & Policy J. 245, 257–263, 304 (1997); European Commission, Guidance on EIA Scoping pt. A (2001), available at h p:// ec.europa.eu/environment/eia/eia-guidelines/g-scoping-full-text.pdf. 6 European Commission, supra note 5, at 194. 7 NEPA, sec. 102, 42 U.S.C. sec. 4332 (2000). See Kevin R. Gray, International Environmental Impact Assessment: Potential for a Multilateral Environmental Agreement, 11 Colo. J. Intl. Envtl. L. & Policy 83, 89 (2000); Christopher Wood, Environmental Impact Assessment: A Comparative Review 1 (2d ed., Prentice Hall 2002). 8 United Nations Environment Programme (UNEP), Governing Council Decision: Goals and Principles of Environmental Impact Assessment, princ. 4, UNEP/GC.14/17 Annex III, UNEP/GC/ DEC/14/25 (June 17, 1987) (hereinafter, UNEP EIA Principles), reprinted in UNEP, Principles of Environmental Impact Assessment, 17 Envtl. Policy & L. 36 (1987). 9 Wood, supra note 7. 10 World Commission on Environment and Development, Our Common Future: Brundtland Re- port (Oxford U. Press 1987). 11 Mohammed Bekhechi & Jean-Roger Mercier, The Legal and Regulatory Framework for Environmental Impact Assessments: A Study of Selected Countries in Sub-Saharan Africa 13 (World Bank 2002). 12 Erika L. Preiss, The International Obligation to Conduct an Environmental Impact Assessment: The ICJ Case Concerning the Gabcikovo-Nagymaros Project, 7 N.Y.U. Envtl. L. J. 307, 310 (1999); Alexandre S. Timoshenko, The Problem of Preventing Damage to the Environment in National and International Law: Impact Assessment and International Consultations, 5 Pace Envtl. L. Rev. 475, 481–482 (1988). 13 After a certain amount of international consensus (see the growing literature on international Tools for More Sustainable Trade 65 Treaties with Developing Countries multilateral environmental agreements at the international level and in trade agreements at the global and regional levels. The requirement to conduct an impact assessment has become common in international law. The Convention on Environmental Impact Assessment in a Transboundary Context (Espoo Convention) specifically contains such obligations for the parties to the treaty. The obligation to undertake EIAs has, in international law, become applicable beyond the limits of national jurisdic- tion, when activities are proposed to take place in areas of “common concern” or “common heritage” of humanity. In this vein, duties to conduct a variety of EIA procedures are found in the 1991 Protocol to the Antarctic Treaty on Envi- ronmental Protection14 and under the 1982 UN Convention on the Law of the Sea (UNCLOS).15 For example, the International Tribunal on the Law of the Seas concluded in 2001 that the United Kingdom had breached its obligations under UNCLOS in relation to the authorization of the MOX (mixed oxide fuel) plant, inter alia, by refusing to carry out a proper environmental assessment of the impacts on the marine environment of a MOX plant.16 In an ITLOS case involving a proposed development in a disputed area between Singapore and Malaysia, the judges imposed provisional measures that included an impact assessment. The International Court of Justice (ICJ) has found a duty to conduct EIAs before proceeding with serious transboundary projects under customary in- ternational law as well as treaty law, in the case concerning the Danube Dam17 environmental law, e.g. Philippe Sands, Principles of International Environmental Law, 3d ed. (Cambridge U. Press 2012), on the necessities of EIAs, norms associated with the assessment policy have “filtered back” from international to national and regional laws in three man- ners: through the influence of soft law; under state obligations to implement specific inter- national obligations; and under obligations in customary international law. See M. Gehring & M. C. Cordonier Segger eds., Sustainable Development in World Trade Law 194 (Kluwer L. Intl. 2005). 14 See Antarctic Environmental Protocol, 30 I.L.M. 1461 (1991), art. 23(1). Nine parties have rat- ified the protocol to date, but all 26 Antarctic Treaty consultative parties are required to bring it into force. See also Convention on the Conservation of Antarctic Marine Living Resources (May 20, 1980), T.I.A.S. No. 10240, 1329 U.N.T.S. 48. 15 United Nations Convention on the Law of the Sea (UNCLOS), vol. 1833 U.N.T.S. 3; 21 I.L.M. 1261 (1982 preamble, arts. 192, 194). See also Agreement for the Implementation of the Provisions of the UN Convention on the Law of the Sea (Dec. 10, 1982), relating to the conservation and manage- ment of straddling fish stocks and highly migratory fish stocks, U.N. Doc. A/CONF.164/38 (1995), 34 I.L.M. 1542 (1995). Straddling Stocks Agreement, preamble and arts. 2, 5, address issues such as the inadequate management of high-seas fisheries, the overutilization of fish- ing resources, and the inadequate regulation of fishing vessels. UNCLOS states, at art. 206: “When States have reasonable grounds for believing that planned activities under their ju- risdiction or control may cause substantial pollution of or significant and harmful changes to the marine environment, they shall, as far as practicable, assess the potential effects of such activities on the marine environment and shall communicate reports of the results of such assessments in the manner provided in article 205.” 16 ITLOS, The MOX Plant Case (Ireland v. United Kingdom), Provisional Measures, [2001] ITLOS 10 (Order of Dec. 3, 2001). 17 For an expression of the customary principle, see Preiss, supra note 12, at 206. Judge Schwebel, speaking for the majority, took judicial notice of the vulnerability of the environment and the 66 The World Bank Legal Review as well as more recently and more explicitly in the Pulp Mill and Costa Rica/ Nicaragua cases. One can now persuasively argue that there are customary obligations to consult on and cooperate in the implementation of projects that might affect other states’ interests. The weight of evidence has led many legal scholars and the ICJ to find that there is a customary international law re- quirement to do an EIA when transboundary impacts could result from a pro- posed course of action.18 Transboundary EIA obligations are particularly well established with regard to international waterways. Given that 261 major river basins are shared by two or more sovereign nations, waterways constitute a significant class of transboundary environment requiring improved planning, regulation, and management.19 Questions remain as to whether and how impact assessment might be applied to broader development policies and plans, such as trade agreements, rather than simply transboundary development projects, and how new forms of impact assessments mandated by law or policy might be expanded to take into account not just physical, environmental issues but also questions of eq- uity, inclusion, and opportunity. The application of impact review and assessment tools to trade agree- ments has, from the start, been inextricably linked to questions of law, policy, and development. One of the main reasons for engaging in impact assess- ments is to increase the information base in order to avoid trade decisions that might be harmful for the environment; however, impact assessments are increasingly being performed in the context of broader development issues. The explicit sustainable development objective of virtually all assessment importance of having risks assessed on a continuous basis. These provisions were construed by Judge Weeramantry in a minority opinion as “building in” the principle of EIA. He added that a duty of EIA is to be read into treaties whose subject can reasonably be considered to have a significant impact on the environment. The Experts Group on Environmental Law of the World Commission on Environment and Development in 1984 identified EIA as an emerging principle of international law. For examples of treaty obligations in this respect, see Convention on the Law of the Non-navigational Uses of International Watercourses (Watercourses Convention) (36 I.L.M. 700 (1997), G.A. Res. 51/229, U.N. GAOR, 51st Sess., 99th mtg., U.N. Doc. A/RES/51/229 (1997): ILC, 1997); Convention on the Protection and Use of Transboundary Watercourses and International Lakes (Helsinki Water Convention) (1936 U.N.T.S.) 269; 31 I.L.M. 1312 (1992): United Nations Economic Commission for Europe (UNECE), 1992, at art. 3(1)(h), where states are required to develop, adopt, implement, and, as much as possible, render compatible relevant measures to ensure that an EIA is applied. See also International Law Commission (ILC), Draft Articles on the Non-navigational Uses of International Watercourses, U.N. Doc. A/46/10 (1991), at 161, and U.N. Doc. A/CN.4/L492 & Add. 1 (1994). 18 In the 2010 Pulp Mill on the River Uruguay ICJ case between Argentina and Uruguay, the court considered and stated that it is a requirement under “general international law” to undertake an EIA when there is a risk that the proposed industrial activity may have a sig- nificant adverse impact in a transboundary context, in particular, on a shared resource. See also Dispute Regarding Navigational and Related Rights (Costa Rica v. Nicaragua), Judgment of 13 July 2009, para. 64. In the literature, see Patricia Birnie, Alan Boyle, & Catherine Redgwell, International Law and the Environment, 3d ed. (Oxford U. Press 2009); Sands, supra note 13; Gehring & Cordonier Segger, supra note 13. 19 Aaron T. Wolf et al., International River Basins of the World, 15 Water Resources Dev. 387, 391 (1999). Tools for More Sustainable Trade 67 Treaties with Developing Countries tools applied to trade agreements underlines this trend. Trading partners now view sustainable development as a global concept that applies to their international relations. This impression is most pronounced in the European Union, where the foreign policy objective that applies to trading relations also concerns sustainable development at home and abroad. One of the first in- ternational organizations to consider such assessments was the Organisation for Economic Co-operation and Development (OECD), through its 1993 Pro- cedural Guidelines on Trade and Environment, which pinpointed “reviews” as a tool for legal and policy coherence.20 In 1994, the OECD proposed a complete methodology,21 which has had a substantive influence on the development of impact assessment tools in many countries.22 Since these early a empts, the scope and procedures of these instruments have evolved considerably.23 Several impact assessment instruments are now being applied to evaluate proposals for trade liberalization and new trade law. Trade impact assess- ments have distinct scope, requirements, a ributes, and legal foundations in different national, regional, and international contexts. The earliest types of impact assessment, typically found at the national level, were concerned with reviewing the environmental effects of trade. As a result, assessments often considered only environmental issues, making li le reference to social issues (i.e., indigenous peoples, gender, health, poverty, social development). Examples of such tools include Canadian environmental assessments and U.S. environmental reviews of new trade agreements. More recent impact assessment instruments for sustainable development seek to integrate elements of economic, environmental, and social concerns. The sustainability impact assessment methodology that is employed by the EU is one example of this approach. These distinctions are important—certain states, regions, and international organizations are simply evaluating the na- tional or international environmental effects of their potential trade policies without focusing on social equity and inclusion elements, while others are undertaking broader sustainability assessments of trade policies. These differ- ences are, at least in part, a reflection of the diversity of contexts and origins of existing assessment methods and mandates. In this chapter, when distinctions between the environmental and sustainable types of impact assessment are not relevant, the generic term “impact assessment” is used. This chapter considers current practices in impact assessments related to trade treaties, especially how these instruments place greater emphasis on 20 OECD, Procedural Guidelines on Trade and Environment (1994) (hereinafter, OECD, Procedural Guidelines). 21 OECD, Methodologies for Environmental and Trade Reviews, OCDE/GD(94)103 (hereinafter, OECD, Methodologies). 22 C. Tebar Less, The OECD Methodology for the Environmental Assessment of Trade Policies and Agreements: Types of Effects to Evaluate, in The International Experts’ Meeting on Sustainability Assessments of Trade Liberalisation—Quito, Ecuador, 6–8 March 2000, Full Meeting Report 82 (WWF 2000). 23 Gehring & Cordonier Segger, supra note 13. 68 The World Bank Legal Review opportunity, inclusion, and equity, and how, through this refinement, impact assessments can assist trade agreements be er reflect law, justice, and devel- opment concerns. The first section elaborates the rules concerning the basic structure and methodologies of impact assessments as they are being used across jurisdictions. The second section considers existing impact assessment mechanisms with relevance to trade in specific jurisdictions, such as the NAFTA environmental reviews, the U.S. and Canadian processes, the EU’s instru- ments, and those used by certain international organizations, discussing the opportunities presented by these processes. The third section analyzes the ex- isting mechanisms and their rules, considering how they might be er reflect the sustainable development principle of equity through measures to ensure greater a ention to inclusion and offering recommendations. Rules Governing Impact Assessments of Trade Agreements across Jurisdictions All impact assessment mechanisms for trade treaties share certain elements. However, differing time frames and degrees of integration between environ- mental, economic, and social considerations exist. This section explains the general analytical framework and methodology of environmental assess- ments of trade negotiations and treaty texts. Impact assessment normally follows four main steps: conduct a scop- ing exercise; perform an initial review; publish the preliminary assessment (which informs negotiators of the party that uses an impact assessment); and prepare a final assessment. Ongoing reviews may be mandated as follow-up. Most impact assessments are structured to examine the economic effects of trade liberalization scenarios that are likely to result from a new treaty, to ascertain the potential environmental effects of this liberalization, and to ana- lyze the potential significance of projected environmental impacts to provide a basis from which to identify options to enhance positive benefits while miti- gating negative effects. Impact assessments that are oriented toward sustain- able development objectives, such as those undertaken by the EU, investigate economic and environmental as well as social development implications of trade negotiations. Each trading relationship is distinct, and trade agreements have the potential to affect few or many sectors of the parties’ economies. A trade agreement may be as simple as a single tariff reduction or business nego- tiation with few environmental consequences, or it may provide the legal un- derpinnings of a full-blown economic partnership and cooperation process in which goods, services, public procurement, intellectual property, investment, competition, and other provisions are expected to be agreed to and where sev- eral potentially serious environmental and social impacts may be identified. In the case of the U.S. environmental reviews, only negotiations that reach a certain magnitude of economic relevance are subject to the next phase of the assessment, which involves increased consultation and analysis of the poten- tial environmental impact in the United States. In most other countries, as- Tools for More Sustainable Trade 69 Treaties with Developing Countries sessment might end at the initial review phase if no significant environmental impacts are foreseen, a finding of no significant impact (FONSI). The definition of “significant’’ is by no means se led. As noted by legal scholars, Agreements such as the Espoo Convention, the North American draft TEIAA264, the East African MOU, and others specifically re- quire a transboundary environmental impact assessment (TEIA) to be conducted for activities that are likely to have a “significant” impact on the environment. The definition of “significant” in these instruments varies, or is frequently vague or as-yet undetermined.24 To minimize uncertainty, international instruments or national laws often prescribe a nonexhaustive list of specific activities that require a transbound- ary or other environmental impact assessment.25 The objective of an initial review is to identify the potential impacts of the trade negotiations on the environment. The level of analysis is variegated and depends on the mandate of the impact assessment. Some environmental as- sessments merely examine the effects wrought on a domestic level (Canada), whereas others investigate transboundary impacts once a certain threshold is crossed (United States). Still other processes, such as sustainability impact as- sessments, take a global perspective in analyzing the impacts (EU). Definition of the key issues that are relevant and identification of areas in which further investigation is necessary are achieved through a broad consultation process that engages authorities from various interested government departments, as well as expert groups and academics; public stakeholders and civil society organizations, including representatives of vulnerable groups; and the private sector. In the scoping or initial review phases, experts and consultants assess the range of potential issues. Information-gathering and scientific studies typ- ify the process at this point.26 In some countries, including the United States, the public is invited to participate in the scoping stage to help identify im- pacts, alternatives, and data sources.27 The environmental impact assessment can provide an important mechanism for advancing the transparency, partici- pation, and accountability advocated by Principle 10 of the Rio Declaration,28 and may provide an opportunity for vulnerable citizens to advocate for greater inclusion of their interests and needs at the initial stages of trade negotiations. Due to this participatory element, impact assessment processes could be a 24 Angela Z. Cassar & Carl E. Bruch, Transboundary Environmental Impact Assessment in Interna- tional Watercourse Management, 12 N.Y.U. Envtl. L. J. 222 (2004). 25 Id. This article gives many examples, including appendix I of the Espoo Convention and the bilateral agreement between Estonia and Latvia. 26 See Gehring & Cordonier Segger, supra note 13, at 194. 27 Julie Teel, International Environmental Impact Assessment: A Case Study in Implementation, 31 Envtl. L. Rep. (Envtl. L. Inst.) 10,291, 10,294–10,306 (2001). 28 United Nations Conference on Environment and Development: Rio Declaration on Environment and Development (adopted June 14, 1992), U.N. Doc. A/CONF.151/5/Rev.1, 31 I.L.M. 874, 878. 70 The World Bank Legal Review tool for diverse sectors of societies to use as they seek greater economic and social inclusion. When taken seriously and effectively implemented, public participation measures can provide local and underrepresented interests an opportunity to be heard and to participate in decision making that affects their environment and livelihoods.29 In terms of further steps, in most cases, the preliminary assessment docu- ment is discussed formally, informing the negotiators as to projected economic and environmental impacts of trade liberalization in certain areas and in cer- tain processes, and in some cases requiring a formal internal or externally released reply from the responsible authority. For some countries, the report, even at this initial phase, may contain mention of mitigation proposals, par- ticularly if potential impacts are familiar from previous trade agreements. For example, if the preliminary scoping or review identifies that an importing party might be vulnerable to pressure to lower its environmental standards in order to a ract investment, the preliminary report might note that this im- pact could be addressed by the inclusion of provisions commi ing all parties not to lower standards to a ract investment. Some instruments also consider a “zero-line approach” when appropriate––the preliminary assessment may suggest ceasing negotiations on trade liberalization in a specific product area. For example, if a preliminary scoping exercise notes that the liberalization of wood and wood products holds the potential to increase rates of illegal extraction of timber from protected areas, the preliminary report might rec- ommend that the parties not increase market access by liberalizing trade in this sector without first assuring themselves that forest governance has been strengthened. To give a more specific example, the preliminary appraisal of measures for inclusion in the proposed WTO Millennium Round Agenda30 led to the initial EU sustainability impact assessment findings presented in table 1. After publication of a preliminary assessment that informs negotia- tors, a final and more detailed assessment report is prepared that addresses the issues raised in the scoping and initial review. Often, the responsible authority will need to commission in-depth studies that will result in reports on key projected impacts (positive or negative) that might be important for the negotiations and encompass the consultation of relevant authorities in other departments, including scientific and economic commissions. To continue with the earlier example, following the initial findings of the EU sustainabil- ity impact assessment of the World Trade Organization (WTO) Millennium round of trade negotiations, the most important measures that were found to hold potential for adverse or other impacts were subjected to a review and 29 Nicholas A. Robinson, International Trends in Environmental Impact Assessment, 19 B.C. Envtl. Aff. L. Rev. 591, 594 (1992). 30 Colin Kirkpatrick, Norman Lee, & O. Morrissey, WTO New Round: Sustainability Impact As- sessment Study (Phase Two Report) S.14 (Mar. 2004). Tools for More Sustainable Trade 71 Treaties with Developing Countries Table 1. Significant Sustainability Impacts of the WTO New Round According to Colin Kirkpatrick et al. Significant impacts Scenario 1 Scenario 2 Scenario 3 Impact on (business as usual) (liberalization) (moderate liberalization) A B C A B C A B C EU countries 0(-1) 0 0(-1) ±1 ±1 ±1 -1/+1 -1/+1 -1 Developing 0 0 0 ±1 ±1 ±1 -1/+1 -2/+1 -1 countries Least-developed 0 0 0 ±1 ±1 ±1 -1/+1 -2/+1 -1 countries Global 0 0 0 ±1 ±1 ±1 -1/+1 -1/+1 -1 Note: This table summarizes the outcomes of a scoping exercise. In the column headings, “A” represents economic impacts (changes in the level of average real income; net fixed capital formation; and employment); “B” represents projected social impacts (changes in level of equity and poverty, health, and education; and gender inequality); and “C” represents environmental impacts (changes in air, water, and land quality; biological diversity; and air resource stocks). In the table, “0” is a nonsignificant impact compared with the base condition; “1” denotes areas where a lesser significant impact is projected, and “2” is where a greater significant impact can be projected. The symbol “+” is used to represent a potential positive impact, whereas “-” is used to represent a negative impact, and “±” raises the potential for positive and negative impacts, meaning that the net effect is uncertain and/or varies according to context. Parentheses indicate situations in which the impact in the base situation can be compared with the existing situation. The use of -/+ notes a range indicating variation over time. presented in a general summarized report with proposed measures to enhance positive outcomes and to reduce or mitigate potential negative outcomes for the societies, environments, and economies affected. These later phases of the sustainability impact assessment took into account the outcomes of pub- lic participation processes, including consultations with nongovernmental organizations (NGOs). Numerous workshops were held both in Europe and in the developing country trading partner in every phase of the assessment, with a dedicated and accessible website used to publish reports and other documents.31 The site was promoted on social media to allow for exchanges of opinions in less formal se ings. Although, due to other factors, the WTO 31 Id. 72 The World Bank Legal Review Ministerial Conference in Sea le was ultimately unsuccessful,32 the sustain- ability impact assessment process provided opportunities for the inclusion of otherwise unheard voices, defusing certain elements of public concern and reducing the potential for conflict, as well as influencing the European Com- munity negotiation position. Most impact assessments also contain an ex post final assessment, pre- pared after the negotiations have been concluded and the final text has been approved. The closing report illustrates how some negotiation positions may have changed due to the contents of the preliminary assessment. The final re- port might illuminate the trade-offs and balance between economic liberaliza- tion and environmental protection,33 thereby explaining motives behind deci- sions that potentially have adverse environmental effects but were accepted in order to secure other benefits deemed important by the mandated decision makers. Rules Governing Impact Assessments of Trade Agreements by Jurisdiction The section above presents the main components shared by most trade agree- ment impact assessments, drawing on examples of actual environmental as- sessments and sustainability impact assessments. This section provides an il- lustrative overview of the methodologies and practical applications of impact assessments for trade agreements at national and regional levels and discusses several examples of practical applications that highlight the opportunities for law and sustainable development provided by these instruments.34 The OECD was the first international organization to address the field of environmental assessments, following studies undertaken in some of its member states.35 As early as 1994, a methodology for such assessments was proposed,36 and OECD Methodologies for Environmental and Trade Reviews was 32 See Gary Sampson, Trade, Environment and the WTO: The Post-Sea le Agenda (Overseas Dev. Council 2000). See also, P. Grady & K. Macmillan, Sea le and Beyond: The WTO Millennium Round (Global Economics Ltd 1999); Edith Brown Weiss, The Rise or the Fall of International Law, 69 Fordham L. Rev. S.345 ff. (2000). 33 Bernard Hoekman, Aaditya Ma oo, & André Sapir, The Political Economy of Services Trade Liberalization: A Case for International Regulatory Cooperation?, 23(3) Oxford Rev. Eco. Policy 367–391 (2007). 34 The fields and areas of applications are many. See Katarina Granah, Study to Inform a Subse- quent Impact Assessment on the Commission Proposal on Jurisdiction and Applicable Law in Divorce Ma ers (European Policy Evaluation Consortium 2006), or Siripen Supakankunti & Wa ana S. Janjaroen, Impact of the World Trade Organization TRIPS Agreement on the Pharmaceutical Industry in Thailand, 79(5) Bull. of the World Health Org. (2001). 35 Cristina Tebar Less, The OECD Methodology for the Environmental Assessment of Trade Policies and Agreements: Types of Effects to Evaluate, in The International Experts’ Meeting on Sustainabil- ity Assessments of Trade Liberalisation (Mar. 6–8, 2000, full meeting report, Gland 2000), S.82ff. 36 OECD, Methodologies, supra note 21. Tools for More Sustainable Trade 73 Treaties with Developing Countries adopted at a joint session of trade and environment experts.37 Before this, in 1993, the OECD ministers had adopted procedural guidelines on trade and the environment suggesting the examination and review of economic and en- vironmental policies.38 The guidelines endorse the use of reviews as a tool for legal and policy coherence: Governments should examine or review trade and environmental policies and agreements with potentially significant effects on the other policy area and identify alternative policy options for ad- dressing concerns. Governments may co-operate in undertaking such examinations and reviews. Governments should follow-up as appropriate: to implement policy options to re-examine the policy agreements and any measure in place, and to address any concerns identified in the conclusion of such re-examinations.39 Since these guidelines were drafted, there have been significant advances in thinking regarding environmental assessments that show that the OECD guidelines are flawed. The OECD’s recommendations were founded on an alternative-based approach, favoring cooperation between states on a bilateral or even multilateral level. This was not adopted in subsequent state initiatives but remains a valid suggestion. The OECD also recommended retrospective assessments following the main assessment but, again, none of the OECD member states adopted this approach. All discussed impact assessment in- struments fall short of these OECD recommendations. From another perspec- tive, the guidelines did not recommend public participation in the assessment process, which has proven to be an essential part of these assessments. Dur- ing early discussions, reviews and assessments were conceptualized as pure expert exercises rather than as opportunities for public participation and the inclusion of different sectors. The methodology adopted by the OECD builds on this approach. Without reference to public participation, these approaches constitute a violation of the principle of precaution through process. It took years to develop methodologies for environmental assessments of trade measures. Although no formal conclusions were adopted at a workshop on assessing the environmental effects of trade liberalization held in 1999, the record of discussions reveals that the 1994 OECD Methodologies for Environ- mental and Trade Reviews were still seen as a valid approach, in particular with regard to the different types of impacts that an assessment of a trade measure should address.40 The methodology has not been significantly amended since. There have been discussions in the WTO to develop a common approach, but these were overshadowed by the Doha Round discussions. So when assess- ments at the national level were first recommended in the Doha Declaration, 37 Originally founded as the OECD Joint Session of Trade and Environment Experts, now meeting as the Joint Working Party on Trade and Environment. 38 OECD, Procedural Guidelines, supra note 20. 39 Id. 40 OECD, Assessing the Environmental Effects of Trade Liberalisation Agreements: Methodologies— Proceedings of the Paris Workshop 11 (OECD 2000). 74 The World Bank Legal Review there was li le to suggest further efforts at the multilateral level.41 Gaps in methodologies were revealed in the WTO Commi ee on Trade and Environ- ment discussions. The absence of a specific methodology for assessing impacts in trade, services, and investment was subject to criticism by WTO member states. Furthermore, the need for intensified research concerning the integra- tion of social aspects into environmental assessments was identified.42 In current practice, several methodologies are being tested in parallel. This section introduces the principal instruments, providing analysis of the legal foundations of each trade impact assessment (IA) tool, including its po- litical context; the evolution of the IA tool’s scope and methodological content; a brief step-by-step outline of how the IA tool functions in practice; an expla- nation of the IA tool’s modes of public participation and consultation; and a concrete example in which the IA tool was applied to assess the impacts of a particular trade negotiation. The European Union’s Sustainability Impact Assessments on Trade The European Union, in accordance with Agenda 21 and the 1992 Rio Decla- ration, established the sustainability impact assessment, a mechanism crafted to include environmental and social concerns in economic policies to pro- mote sustainable development.43 Since the 1990s, the commission has devel- oped processes implementing the “precautionary principle” with the goal of “be er understand[ing] the benefits and costs of its policies and to manage risk, including ex-ante assessment of policies (i.e. assessment in advance of implementation).”44 Sustainability impact assessments seek to identify po- tential social, economic, and environmental impacts using indicators from all three pillars of sustainable development. In the quest for a fully developed and rigorously defined methodology, indicators and measurements have both quantitative and qualitative a ributes.45 Today, the sustainability impact as- sessment is at the vanguard of holistic impact assessment tools, showing evi- 41 Doha WTO Ministerial Declaration (4th Ministerial Conference, Doha, Qatar: WT/MIN(01)/ DEC/1; 41 I.L.M. 746 (2002), 2001), para. 6. 42 See Richard Tarasofsky, Report on the Workshop “Methodologies for Environmental Assessment of Trade Liberalisation Agreements” (WTO-Document WT/CTE/W/133, Feb. 18, 2000). 43 European Commission, Directorate-General of Trade, Draft Handbook for Sustainability Im- pact Assessment 1 (European Commn. 2005) (hereinafter, SIA Handbook), available at h p:// trade-info.cec.eu.int/doclib/docs/2005/april/tradoc_122363.doc., 44 The precautionary principle is at the intersection of three areas of law (economic, social, and environmental) within the broad rubric of international sustainable development law. The precautionary approach to risk management commits states, international organizations, and civil society, particularly the scientific and business communities, to avoid activity that may cause significant harm to human health, natural resources, or ecosystems, including in the face of scientific uncertainty. See Cordonier Segger & Khalfan, supra note 2, at 100. 45 Although the commission currently proposes to determine the methodology for each sus- tainability impact assessment, it considers the incorporation of a mix of qualitative and quantitative methods, such as case studies, modeling, statistical estimations, and expert opinion, to be beneficial. Tools for More Sustainable Trade 75 Treaties with Developing Countries dence of being a fully integrated instrument and including recommendations for enhancement and mitigation. Member-state and NGO demands leading up to the WTO Ministerial Conference in Sea le prompted the Directorate General for Trade of the EC (the DG Trade) to commission a study conducted by a research team affili- ated with the University of Manchester. This team was tasked with develop- ing a methodology for an ex ante sustainability impact assessment. After the methodology was formalized (with degrees of context-specific flexibility), the DG Trade inaugurated several studies using the framework for assessing the impact of trade policy on sustainable development. After refining, the sustain- ability impact assessment consisted of four main phases: • Screening: to determine which measures require SIA because they are likely to have significant impacts • Scoping: to establish the appropriate coverage of each SIA • Preliminary sustainability assessment: to identify potentially significant ef- fects, positive and negative, on sustainable development • Mitigation and enhancement analysis: to suggest types of improvements that may enhance the overall impact on sustainable development of new trade agreements/measures46 These phases are infused with avenues of public participation and consulta- tion with civil society organizations. Numerous workshops and consultations, both formal and informal, are held at each phase of the process. A website provides public access to reports and timely publications. One of the more unconventional and controversial features of the sustain- ability impact assessment methodology is the investigation of the impacts on the (often developing country) trading partner(s) in trade negotiations, rather than simply the impacts on the commissioning EU state. Unfortunately, re- search collaboration with trading partners is not always reciprocal. For in- stance, although strong collaborative links between researchers were possible for the sustainability impact assessment of EU-Mercosur trade negotiations and the SIA of the EU-Mediterranean trade negotiations,47 the sustainability impact assessment of the EC–Cooperation Council for the Arab States of the Gulf trade negotiations did not unfold as smoothly.48 The means of mobilizing public participation in the studies varied, from extensive debates and consulta- tions to merely an administered website. As the private consultancy noted, “The NGO world did not show a big interest in the topic, nevertheless engagement 46 See Gehring & Cordonier Segger, supra note 13, at 211. 47 See Final Report EU-Mercosur SIA (Mar. 2009), available at h p://trade.ec.europa.eu/doclib /docs/2009/april/tradoc_142921.pdf. 48 See PriceWaterhouseCoopers, Sustainability Impact Assessment (SIA) of the Negotiations of the Trade Agreement between the European Community and the Countries of the Cooperation Coun- cil for the Arab States of the Gulf (GCC) (PWC 2004), available at h p://trade-info.cec.eu.int /doclib/docs/2005/january/tradoc_121208.pdf. 76 The World Bank Legal Review was done at several moments. NGO from the Gulf Cooperation Council (GCC) have not even replied to our requests to get their view, input (sic).”49 In a recent sustainability impact assessment of the EU-Canada Comprehensive Economic and Trade Agreement (CETA), consultants obtained positive responses from the public in the EU, but comparatively li le input from Canadians. As noted in the study, possible reasons included “that domestic issues, including cli- mate and transportation policies take most importance; that CETA represents a small portion of Canada’s trade; and that Europe is generally perceived as an environmental leader. For these reasons, CETA appears to generate li le interest or worries in the environmental community.”50 If similar reasoning were transposed to a developing country context, where the possibility for consultation might be much more limited than in Canada, this would raise serious concerns as to participation and the potential value for inclusion of diverse groups and especially the most vulnerable elements of society that could be affected by the degradation of resources or other impacts of trade liberalization. The EU-Andean trade sustainability impact assessment provides a use- ful example of the methodology and its outcomes.51 In 2006, the EU and An- dean countries began negotiations for a regional trade agreement; and in 2008, pursuant to the Draft Handbook for Sustainability Impact Assessment (SIA Handbook),52 the EC commissioned a sustainability impact assessment of these negotiations. The sustainability impact assessment investigators, during the initial assessment, focused on increasing outreach, including by establishing a dedicated website that a racted more than 3,000 unique visitors. One-day consultations were conducted in Lima and other cities, and inputs were ac- tively solicited from a variety of stakeholders, ranging from local grassroots NGOs to government departments.53 The study concluded that the impact on trade for the EU was predicted to be insignificant; as for the Andean countries, an increase in trade and invest- ment flows between 3 to 10 percent was predicted. Although the methodology takes a broad-brush approach, this report nevertheless provides an example of how a sustainability impact assessment can highlight both potential impacts and opportunities for development. The analysis started with a modeling of the expected economic impact. It used two scenarios, a modest scenario of 50 percent liberalization of services and an ambitious scenario with 75 percent liberalization of services. As concluded in the sustainability impact assess- ment, the economic impact of the trade accord was positive: 49 Id., at 36. 50 Final Report for the EU-Canada Sustainability Impact Assessment (SIA) on the EU-Canada Com- prehensive Economic and Trade Agreement, footnote 11, available at h p://trade.ec.europa.eu /doclib/docs/2011/september/tradoc_148201.pdf. 51 EU-Andean Trade Sustainability Impact Assessment (hereinafter, EU-Andean Trade SIA), avail- able at h p://trade.ec.europa.eu/doclib/docs/2010/april/tradoc_146014.pdf. 52 SIA Handbook, supra note 43. 53 EU-Andean Trade SIA, supra note 51, at 136. Tools for More Sustainable Trade 77 Treaties with Developing Countries The modeling analysis shows modest income gains for all econo- mies in all se ings and scenarios, with the biggest absolute gains occurring in the EU and Colombia, where real incomes are projected to increase by up to €4 billion and €2.8 billion respectively. In rela- tive terms, the expected income gains are estimated to be highest for Bolivia and Ecuador, where real income is expected to increase by between 0.5 and 2 percent of GDP. The impact in the EU is only marginal, at less than 0.1 percent of GDP. On an aggregate level, real income across all Andean countries will increase by €5 billion under the ambitious scenario.54 In other words, economic modeling predicted large overall gains for the developed country partner and significant relative gains for the developing country partners. As the report noted, however, the trade agreement could also generate important social and environmental impacts. These might in- clude unmanaged expansion of the agricultural frontier, with the potential to exacerbate biodiversity loss and exponentially increase illegal logging, and expansion of mining and petroleum extraction, with related environmental impacts and social conflict in rural areas. The assessment identified several sustainable development opportunities, including increased monitoring and reporting on EU companies and their compliance with corporate social re- sponsibility (CSR) standards in mining, oil, and gas, as well as cooperation to strengthen education, to make forestry activity more sustainable, and to improve financial, public utilities, and environmental service sectors, among others. The assessment identified important development opportunities if the liberalization is accompanied by careful services regulation. The report stressed that, “with effective domestic regulatory control, market opening in the basic utilities sector improves access for the poor to affordable and reliable services in water, energy, communications and transportation. Liberalization of distribution may result in some reduction in prices for consumers.”55 Un- fortunately, the response by the commission after the negotiations were con- cluded was somewhat lackluster with regard to regulatory assistance: In this respect, the Commission services recall that the findings of this SIA are available to the governments of Andean countries which have the prime responsibility for the strengthening of their national and regional legislations in this area. In addition, the Commission services point out that the Commission has already been playing a substantial role in promoting this regulatory capacity building via its actions in the region.56 It is unclear if the simple fact that the sustainability impact assessment itself is available to government regulators will open new sustainable development 54 Id., at 9. 55 Id., at 108. 56 Commission Services Position Paper on the Trade Sustainability Impact Assessment (SIA) of the Multiparty Trade Agreement with Andean Countries (Nov. 2010), available at h p://trade .ec.europa.eu/doclib/docs/2010/november/tradoc_146987.pdf. 78 The World Bank Legal Review opportunities for the developing country trading partners or support partici- patory processes for inclusion of vulnerable or excluded groups. The recommendations of the EU-Andean sustainability impact assess- ment report do highlight specific development opportunities in the area of biofuels, noting the expected expansion of biofuel production in the region due to the economic treaty with the EU.57 Development opportunities such as increased market access for the export of biodiesel and bioethanol along with measures to address challenges such as the pressure to increase landholding to the detriment of social cohesion, are discussed. Environmental impacts are not neglected, and the sustainability impact assessment signals potential chal- lenges generated by conversion of tropical forest to farmlands for biofuels. The sustainability impact assessment reported that biofuels produced with tailored and appropriate technologies, sourced from existing agricultural lands without replacing food crops, could benefit the Andean countries and highlighted specific regions where this might occur. This balanced assessment seems to have benefited from significant background research and stakeholder input. Careful analysis can maximize trade and economic opportunities for the developing country partner, if accompanied by appropriate policy mea- sures, regulations, and enforcement capacity. The sustainability impact assessment gives special a ention to the needs of vulnerable groups. In the Andean countries, the focus is on the needs of indigenous populations. The sustainability impact assessment highlights the vulnerability of indigenous groups as one of the main social concerns in the region, alongside rural poverty. It establishes clear linkages between in- creased deforestation and conglomeration in the agricultural sector and the vulnerability of indigenous populations. Thus, the sustainability impact as- sessment highlights that in so far as poverty is deeper in rural areas, particularly in more re- mote areas, indigenous peoples are adversely affected by insufficient access to basic goods and services. Although li le information exists about non-contacted indigenous peoples, there is evidence that the way of life of those who inhabit the Peruvian Amazon and the tropi- cal forest of Bolivia are under constant threat, as modernization and commercial economic activity continues to penetrate these areas.58 The European Commission, in its response, took this concern into consid- eration, highlighting further cooperation initiatives and enhanced support to Andean governments to address poverty, education, and health concerns.59 This focus, coupled with new cooperation measures to promote opportunities, inclusion, and equity, is one of the most important benefits of the sustainabil- ity impact assessment process for these countries. The European Commission white paper demonstrates that despite the lack of explicit legal frameworks, 57 Id., at 74–81. 58 Id., at 32. 59 Id., at 8. Tools for More Sustainable Trade 79 Treaties with Developing Countries the de facto requirement that the commission take sustainability impact as- sessment outcomes into account can help this tool serve the interests of inclu- sion and equity. For several sustainability impact assessments, as is clear from the responses of the commission to the studies, the inputs were carefully con- sidered and influenced the negotiating position of the EU, particularly with regard to mitigation or flanking measures. The U.S. and Canadian Environmental Assessments/Reviews In 1991, the United States conducted pilot assessments on certain aspects of negotiations for the North American Free Trade Agreement (NAFTA).60 At first, U.S. NGOs litigated to apply general EIA laws to trade negotiations, ar- guing that the office of the United States Trade Representative (USTR) should conduct an environmental impact statement of its negotiation positions for NAFTA under the U.S. National Environmental Policy Act (NEPA).61 How- ever, because the final decision as to whether or not to sign a trade agreement rests with the U.S. president, the U.S. Court of Appeals found that a trade agreement could not be considered an “action of an agency” and dismissed the request.62 Several years later, on November 16, 1999,63 President Bill Clinton signed Executive Order (EO) 13.141, which codifies environmental reviews as an internally binding assessment obligation for trade negotiations, using terminology to avoid confusion with an environmental impact statement and to prevent litigants from using environmental review results in future litiga- tion.64 The political context was significant in this instance. In preparation for the Sea le WTO Ministerial Conference, the U.S. sought to strengthen inclu- sion of civil society into trade negotiations. EO 13.141 contained essentially the same phases as required under the NEPA, belonging to the same family of legal instruments as the environmental impact statement. The environmental review—an ex ante procedure laden with public participation requirements— is tripartite in character and avoids imposing any conditions on the trade ne- gotiation process. The first phase is initiated by a notice in the Federal Register describing the proposed trade agreement and soliciting public comments and statements about the scope of the environmental review. In the second phase, the environmental review is to be published where practicable and further comments are encouraged. The final phase constitutes the final environmental review, the content of which contains a compendium of public concerns that were considered by the drafting body. 60 U.S. Trade Representative (USTR), Draft Review of U.S.-Mexico Environmental Issues (USTR 1991). For a full account of the history, see J. Salzmann, Executive Order 13.141 and the Envi- ronmental Review of Trade Agreements, 95 Am. J. Intl. L. 368 (2001). 61 Public Citizen v. Office U.S. Trade Representative, 822 F. Supp. 21 (D.D.C. 1993). 62 Public Citizen v. Office U.S. Trade Representative, 5 F.3d 549 (D.C. Cir. 1993). 63 U.S. Federal Registry 64(.222) of 18.11.1999, 63.169. 64 Executive Order 13.141, sec. 7, contains the usual disclaimer for executive orders: “This order is intended only to improve the internal management of the executive branch and does not create any right, benefit, trust, or responsibility, substantive or procedural, enforceable at law or equity by a party against the United States, its agencies, its officers, or any person.” 80 The World Bank Legal Review Several features of the instrument are noteworthy for the purposes of this chapter. First, environmental reviews are primarily an instrument used to as- sess environmental, rather than social or other, impacts: The United States is commi ed to a policy of careful assessment and consideration of the environmental impacts of trade agreements. The United States will factor environmental considerations into the development of its trade negotiating objectives. Responsible agen- cies will accomplish these goals through a process of ongoing as- sessment and evaluation, and, in certain instances, wri en environ- mental reviews.65 If the environmental effects (positive and negative) are determined to be transboundary in nature and have ramifications for the United States, the as- sessment may take on a more global character.66 Edicts within the environmen- tal review procedures provide for cooperation to build the capacity of trading partners for environmental protection in order to ensure “the promotion of sustainable development.”67 Governmental actions that may impede sustain- able development are prohibited. Coordination between the administration and Congress, as well as encouragement toward participating in international environmental agreements, is included in the Trade Act of 2002. By 2013, six U.S. environmental reviews had taken place. The environ- mental review for the Central American Free Trade Agreement (CAFTA), which considered the impact of including the Dominican Republic in the trade agreement, was published in February 2005.68 The disclosure reiterated an interim review in 200369 and pronounced that the modified membership may have relatively greater effects on the economies of Central America and the Dominican Republic. In the near term, however, net changes in production and trade are expected to be relatively small because exports to the United States from these countries al- ready face low or zero tariffs. Longer term effects, through invest- 65 Executive Order 13.141, sec. 1. 66 USTR, Guidelines for Implementation of EO 13.141 (USTR 2001), app. C.G: “Transboundary and global impacts may include those on: Places not subject to national jurisdiction or subject to shared jurisdiction, such as Antarctica, the atmosphere (including ozone and climate change features), outer space, and the high seas; Migratory species, including straddling and highly migratory fish stocks and migratory mammals; Impacts relating to environmental issues identified by the international community as having a global dimension and warranting a global response; Transboundary impacts involving the boundaries of the United States; Environmental resources and issues otherwise of concern to the United States.” Available at h p://www.ustr.gov/sites/default/files/guidelines%20for%2013141.pdf. 67 Trade Act of 2002, sec. 2102(b)(11)(d). 68 USTR, Final Environmental Review of the Dominican Republic–Central America–United States Free Trade Agreement (USTR 2005), available at h p://www.ustr.gov/assets/Trade_Agreements /Bilateral/CAFTA/asset_upload_file953_7901.pdf. 69 USTR, Interim Environmental Review of the U.S.–Central America Free Trade Agreement (CAFTA) (Aug. 22, 2003), available at h p://www.ustr.gov/assets/Trade_Agreements/Bilateral/CAFTA /asset_upload_file946_3356.pdf. Tools for More Sustainable Trade 81 Treaties with Developing Countries ment and economic development, are expected to be greater but cannot currently be predicted in terms of timing, type and environ- mental implications.70 Canadian environmental assessments of trade agreements are also founded on phased analytical reviews, intergovernmental discussion procedures, and public comment periods, although the Canadian environmental assessments appear to have less scope regarding international issues than the U.S. envi- ronmental reviews do. Canada’s environmental assessments of trade agree- ments were also adopted in a particular political and historical context. In 1994, Canada carried out a brief ex post environmental review of the Uruguay Round WTO Agreements, perhaps in part to reassure the Canadian public and stakeholders as to what had been agreed on.71 In 1999, the newly consolidated Department of Foreign Affairs and International Trade (DFAIT) undertook to assess the outcomes of the Uruguay Round agreements anew, after their first four years of operation, to prepare for the expected WTO Millennium Round negotiations (later postponed by the WTO Ministerial Conference in Sea le in 2000). The Retrospective Analysis of the 1994 Canadian Environmental Review of the Uruguay Round of Multilateral Trade Negotiations was published in November 1999.72 Increasing domestic pressure from agencies, civil society groups, and oth- ers led the Canadian government to introduce the internally binding Cabi- net Directive on Strategic Environmental Assessment of Plans and Policies in 1999.73 After the positive experience of introducing an informal environmental impact statement framework in the 1980s prior to formally adopting the Ca- nadian Environmental Assessment Act (CEAA) in 1992 and its entry into force in 1995, the Canadian government may have anticipated a similar approach for environmental assessments of trade agreements.74 The 1999 cabinet direc- tive mandates that every governmental policy be assessed as to its environ- mental impact.75 Trade policy was included in Annex 1 of the cabinet direc- tive, because the CEAA is not applicable to trade policy.76 Binding guidelines were also adopted, detailing all necessary assessments and regulated public 70 Id., at para. 4. 71 Department of Foreign Affairs and International Trade (DFAIT), 1994 Canadian Environmen- tal Review of the Uruguay Round of Multilateral Trade Negotiations, available at h p://www .dfait-maeci.gc.ca/sustain/EnvironA/strategic/urugay-en.asp. 72 See DFAIT, h p://www.dfait-maeci.gc.ca/tna-nac/documents/retrospective-e.pdf. 73 See Gehring & Cordonier Segger, supra note 13, at 206. 74 Id. 75 Canadian Environmental Assessment Agency (CEAA), Strategic Environmental Assessment: The 1999 Cabinet Directive on the Environmental Assessment of Policy, Plan and Program Propos- als; Guidelines for Implementing the Cabinet Directive (CEAA 1999) (hereinafter, Guidelines for Implementing the Cabinet Directive). 76 For its history, see Canadian Environmental Assessment Agency, The Canadian Environmen- tal Assessment Act: Introduction 2d ed. (2011), available at h p://www.ceaa-acee.gc.ca/default .asp?lang=En&n=0DF82AA5-1; the complete text is available at h p://laws-lois.justice.gc.ca /eng/acts/C-15.21/page-1.html. 82 The World Bank Legal Review participation.77 Later, in addition to consultations with provinces and territo- ries, representatives from the first nations (i.e., indigenous nations), and other civil society representatives, this framework was expanded to bilateral, re- gional, and multilateral trade negotiations. The Framework for Conducting En- vironmental Assessment of Trade Negotiations was adopted through a decision of the cabinet in February 2001.78 Implementation of the cabinet directive on strategic environmental assessments in the area of trade policy was allocated to DFAIT. The Canadian environmental assessment of trade agreements consists of three primary phases. In the initial environmental assessment, a DFAIT-led interagency commi ee analyzes the scope of the negotiations and the range of potential negative or positive environmental impacts within Canada from the economic effects of the potential treaty. If these are found to be minimal, the formal assessment halts at this stage.79 If a second phase is mandated, it involves the elaboration of a draft study, with a third phase resulting in a fi- nal report. The draft environmental assessment is intended to assist Canadian trade negotiators. The final report describes the result of the trade negotia- tions and speculates on the role the assessment played in reaching the conclu- sion. All stages are guided by public participation requirements, including the publication of drafts; a website designed for interested stakeholders to comment on the assessment; interdepartmental and multilevel government consultation; and an explicit feedback loop in which concerns that have arisen are factored into the investigation. Ex post monitoring and ex post assessment might be recommended but are not mandatory.80 Several features are noteworthy. First, the Canadian environmental as- sessments focus almost exclusively on environmental issues, rather than social and development issues. Despite this narrow scope, the Canadian government refers to the assessment instrument as an indispensable decision-making tool for promoting sustainable development. Environmental assessments contrib- ute to the enhanced transparency and good governance principles of sustain- able development by encouraging “more open decision making within the federal government by engaging representatives from other levels of govern- ment, the public, the private sector and non-governmental organizations in this process.”81 The environmental assessment guidelines succinctly summa- rize these objectives: “to assist Canadian negotiators integrate environmental considerations into the negotiating process by providing information on the environmental impacts of the proposed trade agreement; and to address pub- 77 CEAA, Guidelines for Implementing the Cabinet Directive on the Environmental Assessment of Policy, Plan and Program Proposals (Privy Council Off. & CEAA 2010). 78 DFAIT, Framework for Conducting Environmental Assessments of Trade Negotiations (DFAIT Feb. 2001), available at h p://www.international.gc.ca/trade-agreements-accords-commerciaux /env/framework-cadre.aspx. 79 See Gehring & Cordonier Segger, supra note 13, at 208. 80 Id. 81 DFAIT, supra note 78. Tools for More Sustainable Trade 83 Treaties with Developing Countries lic concerns by documenting how environmental factors are being considered in the course of trade negotiations.”82 The Canadian assessment process seeks a balance between public partici- pation and new ideas and direct impact on the negotiation, that is, the ques- tion as to how the assessment results influence the negotiations. It does not assess social and developmental concerns explicitly and is restricted to envi- ronmental impacts within Canada (even though certain health issues are con- sidered). The procedure eschews any investigation of environmental impacts on the trading partner or potential implications on a global level. The environmental impact assessments of the United States and Canada are similar in their outcomes. For instance, the 2003 Initial Strategic Environ- mental Assessment Report of the Canada–Central America Four Free Trade Nego- tiations (El Salvador, Guatemala, Honduras, and Nicaragua) concluded that the small quantity of trade flows overall would have negligible economic ef- fects, and therefore, the environmental consequences were insignificant for Canada.83 Even in areas where increased exports such as high-value paper and plastics were likely, the Central America negotiations were deemed to pre- clude adverse environmental effects. The assessment did not consider effects of the negotiations on the C4 countries (El Salvador, Guatemala, Honduras, and Nicaragua), nor was a more regional approach to an environmental as- sessment considered. Given the limited scope of Canada’s environmental as- sessment process, this missed opportunity is regre able but understandable. Basic support for further studies in the C4, coupled with international coordi- nation of assessment efforts, might have enabled Canada to address impacts with regard to the trading partners. As another example, Canada’s initial environmental assessment of the proposed free trade agreement (FTA) with Andean countries concluded: While FTAs with the Andean Community are expected to provide increased market access into Canada, it is unlikely that there will be a substantial increase in trade in services as a result of these negotia- tions. Canada is already quite open in most services sectors and no domestic regulatory changes are expected as a result of FTAs with the Andean Community. There may be some increased services ex- ports to Andean countries, but it is difficult to segregate the effects of the Canada-Andean Community trade negotiations from those resulting from Canada’s other trade negotiations or implementation of existing regional or bilateral trade agreements or from unilateral liberalization. Generally speaking, while the environmental impacts are not expected to be significant, we will need to consider indirect 82 Id., at 4. 83 DFAIT, Initial Strategic Environmental Assessment Report of the Canada–Central America Four Free Trade Negotiations (El Salvador, Guatemala, Honduras and Nicaragua) (DFAIT 2003), available at h p://www.international.gc.ca/trade-agreements-accords-commerciaux/env /EAlist-listeEE.aspx. 84 The World Bank Legal Review or cumulative impacts and the synergies between environmental goods and services which may increase the impact.84 In other words, these types of assessment are less helpful to developing country partners and have less potential to identify development opportuni- ties than they are to Canada. In spite of vigorous public participation provi- sions, the restricted scope of the assessments, together with their focus on en- vironmental impacts of economic changes alone, appears to limit their ability to signal opportunities for sustainable development cooperation, inclusion, or equity in developing countries. Securing Greater Equity through Trade Impact Assessments Some observations can be made about the role that impact assessments might play in securing more equitable trade agreements. Economic Considerations Continue to Dominate Trade-Related Impact Assessment Instruments Impact assessments require economic analysis to assess the likely impact of proposed economic development in the parties to a trade negotiation or fi- nancial arrangement. An impact assessment is based on relative consensus on simple cases (for example, tariffs) that use commonly acknowledged econo- metric calculations. The influence of impact assessments extends beyond ini- tial flows of trade in goods to shape infrastructure projects (harbors, roads, airports) and facilities for trade in services such as transport, health, educa- tion, and other vulnerable social sectors. Therefore, careful consideration of equity issues, including the potential for a trade agreement to widen or nar- row existing income and other disparities, is important. The European Union: Sui Generis in Its Application of Developmental and Social Concerns in Trade-Related Environmental Impact Assessments The United Nations Environment Programme (UNEP) gave special recog- nition to the EU for its fully integrated impact assessment instrument.85 Al- though most environmental impact assessment tools fail to explicitly consider social and developmental issues, the EU’s sustainability impact assessments model amalgamates economic, social, and environmental issues using a mix of measures and indicators constantly undergoing refinement. The SIA Handbook enunciates the virtues of a flexible, context-specific methodological approach to sustainability impact assessment. In keeping with its cu ing-edge status in impact assessment innovation, the EU is considering proposals to extend 84 Canada–Andean Community Free Trade Negotiations—Initial Environmental Assessment Report (Jan. 2008), available at http://www.international.gc.ca/trade-agreements-accords -commerciaux/agr-acc/andean-andin/ea-andean-andine.aspx?lang=en. 85 UNEP, Reference Manual for the Integrated Assessment of Trade-Related Policies (UNEP 2001). Tools for More Sustainable Trade 85 Treaties with Developing Countries sustainability impact assessments to human rights. This development, from the perspective of securing increased law, justice, and development through opportunity, inclusion, and equity, is a step in the right direction. Public Participation Has Become Central, Although Successful Engagement Is Inconsistent at Best Most impact assessment mechanisms and practices rely on domestic public inputs to direct the extensiveness of the study and to identify potential envi- ronmental or social impacts of trade liberalization. Expert groups work with the public and with civil society organizations but are expected to investigate the validity of concerns raised through consultation feedback cycles. At a min- imum, initial impact assessment reports are published or available on govern- ment websites, and solicitation of comments occurs. Final drafts of impact assessments seek to incorporate issues deemed material, often addressing con- cerns that have arisen through public participation. Impact assessment proce- dures such as the EU’s sustainability impact assessment procedure integrate sustainable development concerns, taking potential social impacts into con- sideration. These impact assessments depend on strong public participation and often have a broad range of participation mechanisms instilled in their methodologies. Numerous workshops and consultations, at both formal and informal levels, are held at each phase of the assessment. Sustainability im- pact assessments hold the potential to facilitate cross-boundary consultations through a coordinated structure of transfrontier public discussions.86 As an essential tool for signaling concerns related to equity and potential disparities in the effects of a potential trade negotiation, public participation and engage- ment procedures offer an excellent starting point. However, inconsistencies remain, in part due to lack of support, in terms of capacity and resources. The DG Trade is considering the formalization of such processes, as discussed in the Draft Handbook for Sustainability Impact Assessment (SIA Handbook), and this is one area in which further development of impact assessment instruments holds the potential for equity and inclusion.87 Regulatory Reviews, a Fundamental Aspect of Environmental Impact Assessments, Seem Less Applicable in Sustainability Impact Assessments Chiefly in the case of the Canadian environmental assessments and the U.S. en- vironmental reviews of trade negotiations, regulatory reviews are an integral part of the assessment process. In contrast, the SIA Handbook has no provi- sions mandating the analysis of regulations. Indeed, EU consultants rarely give regulatory analysis a central role in the studies undertaken. Assessing the 86 Transboundary consultations, however, are not easy to organize. For example, the allocation of responsibilities for facilitating these international discussions raises important questions that could require clarification. In addition, discrepancies related to substantive and tempo- ral issues that may exist in the scoping process need to be assuaged. 87 SIA Handbook, supra note 43. 86 The World Bank Legal Review regulatory impact of trade liberalization is interesting to lawyers specifically because of the need to harmonize international commitments with the na- tional legal framework. Not surprisingly, the majority of studies undertaken merely reiterate that trade positions requiring negative modifications to na- tional environmental regulatory configurations are untenable. However, this trend may be diminishing; due to increased public awareness concerning in- vestment arbitration, recent U.S. environmental reviews have a empted to rebuff the argument that investor-state arbitration processes could be used to negatively influence U.S. environmental laws.88 Conclusions Differing methodologies and applications of impact assessment tools and sev- eral deficiencies inhibit the evolution of impact assessments of trade agree- ments into a universally utilized instrument that integrates principles of sus- tainable development, serving as a tool for opportunity, equity, and inclusion. The focus of the current instruments—principally national—has a limit- ing effect on their applicability.89 This defect is clearest in the case of Canada, where global environmental impacts of trade negotiations enter analysis only if they affect Canada. The national nature, even though endorsed by the WTO Doha Ministerial Declaration, could lead to imbalances in scenarios in which bilateral trade negotiations take place among trading partners with disparate resources and stringency of regulation. This situation may be exacerbated if parties to an existing regional trade agreement enter into a trade agreement with a third country, which then assesses the impact in a necessarily narrow way (for example, the case of the U.S.-Andean trade agreement). One potential solution to the paucity of impact assessments with a global perspective is embodied in the framework of the EU sustainability impact as- sessment, which mandates a reciprocal impact assessment on trading part- ners. Although some critics have argued that the overall effect of the sustain- ability impact assessment is limited, there is growing evidence that the EU Commission’s reports have legal value and can be referred to as administra- tive practice. On several occasions, negotiation teams amended their positions based on a sustainability impact assessment finding. Employing regional 88 The case in question was the environmental review assessing the Australia-U.S. Free Trade Agreement. The USTR took the position that regulatory alterations were not intrinsically detrimental to U.S. interests in the case of an “open economic environment and the shared legal traditions and the confidence of investors in the fairness and integrity of their respective legal systems.” For further discussion, see M. Kerr, Sustainable Development in the Australia- US Free Trade Agreement, in Gehring & Cordonier Segger, supra note 13, at 499, 510. See lengthy discussion in USTR, Final Environmental Review of the Dominican Republic–Central America–United States Free Trade Agreement (USTR 2005); USTR, Final Environmental Review of the United States–Morocco Free Trade Agreement (July 2004), available at h p://www.ustr.gov /assets/Trade_Agreements/Bilateral/Morocco_FTA/asset_upload_file569_5831.pdf. 89 Nicholas Low, Global Ethics and Environment (Routledge 1999). Tools for More Sustainable Trade 87 Treaties with Developing Countries impact assessments to overcome a lack of parity among trading partners in- volves methodological and structural innovation as well as increased informa- tion exchange. However, a empts by NAFTA trading partners to initiate an integrated assessment process at the regional level have not progressed be- yond discussions about abstract methodology issues. In fact, the EU is the sole region to produce a self-reflective environmental assessment. The multilateral forum of the WTO provides another potential solution to the inadequacies of national and bilateral impact assessments. Moving beyond the narrow focus of common impact assessments of trade, there is greater potential for applying strategic environmental assessments to negotiations. When environmental impact assessments are applied to projects, target-related indicators (performance based, specific timeline) limit the reach of enhancement and mitigation recommendations. Conversely, strategic-level assessments incorporate process-related indicators such as the soundness of institutional planning, management processes, and mechanisms. Indeed, stra- tegic environmental assessments have already been formulated and imple- mented in most states for the analysis of land use plans or policies. Broadly defined in Article 2.6 of the 2003 Protocol on Strategic Environmental Assess- ment (the Kiev Protocol), strategic environmental assessments are the evaluation of the likely environmental, including health, effects, which comprises the determination of the scope of an environmental report and its preparation, the carrying out of public participation and consultations, and the taking into account of the environmental report and the results of the public participation and consultations in a plan or programme.90 Thus, the Kiev Protocol explicitly regulates the impact assessment of plans and programs but is not binding at the policy level. This protocol is an international treaty designed to mitigate the tension between internation- ally delimited impact assessment procedures and state freedom to govern the exploitation of the environment. Trade policy and negotiations are not covered under the protocol, which mentions the importance of assessing the environmental and developmental (particularly health) impact of plans and programs. The Kiev Protocol limits the assessment of plans and programs to the following areas: agriculture; forestry; fisheries; energy;91 industry, includ- ing mining; transport; regional development; waste management; water man- agement; telecommunications; tourism; and town and country planning or land use. Other international cooperation has been based on the foundations laid out in the Kiev Protocol. UNEP adopted a more inclusive approach to impact 90 The Kiev Protocol was entered into force on July 11, 2010. By June 2013, 25 countries had ratified the protocol. It was negotiated in the context of the 1991 Espoo Convention (30 I.L.M. 800). For more information, see UNECE Components of Strategic Assessment, available at h p://www.unece.org/env/eia/sea_protocol.html. 91 Jochen Lamp, The Baltic Sea Gas Pipeline: A Transnational Infrastructure Project as Touchstone for International Environmental Standards, 58(4–5) Osteuropa 383–391 (2008). 88 The World Bank Legal Review assessments, fabricating an expanded definition that considers “the economic, environmental and social effects of trade measures, the linkages between these effects, and aims to build upon this analysis by identifying ways in which the negative consequences can be avoided or mitigated, and ways in which posi- tive effects can be enhanced.”92 UNEP avoided proposing a single methodology, suggesting instead that countries carefully tailor their assessments to the specific sector of trade and potential impacts at hand. After testing and refining integrated assessment methods through various country studies,93 UNEP developed a considerable amount of analytical data that can be used by developing countries and others seeking to undertake specific studies, but it has not developed any rules.94 The scope of these studies has been national in character. As this chapter has indicated, the inconsistencies and patchiness of the current international impact assessment regime leave plenty of room for im- provement to galvanize environmental protection and to graft sustainable de- velopment issues firmly onto trade negotiation proceedings. In this sense, the evolution of the sustainability impact assessment in the European Union can serve as an example. Given that the current scale and scope of the described assessments are restricted, a genuinely collective review mechanism is ad- visable. Broader participation is possible and necessary. Multilateral—or at least multilaterally coordinated—assessment could provide superior results because the impact on all participating members would be explored simulta- neously. Akin to the case of transnational projects, broader information and participation can drive legal innovations as ameliorative results feed more easily into the negotiation process. An expanded commitment to equity, informed by the precautionary principle, might be met procedurally by some form of impact assessment adopted at the institutional level of the WTO.95 The obligation to perform an impact assessment can be called “precaution through process.”96 Conducting simultaneous assessments at the WTO level can help overcome resource and regulatory imbalances. Perhaps the most egalitarian of the international fi- nancial institutions, the WTO operates on a do ut des basis, precluding any 92 UNEP, Reference Manual for the Integrated Assessment of Trade-Related Policies (UNEP 2001), available at h p://www.unep.ch/etb/publications/intAssessment/refmaniaFinal.pdf. 93 UNEP Economics and Trade Programme, Country Projects on Trade Liberalisation and the En- vironment and on the Design and Implementation of Economic Instruments, available at h p:// www.unep.ch/etu/etp/acts/capbld/cp.htm. 94 See UNEP, Annual Report 68 (UNEP 2006). 95 See Gehring & Cordonier Segger, supra note 13, at 191, 192. 96 See M. Gehring, Nachhaltigkeit durch Verfahren im Welthandel (diss., U. Hamburg 2005). See also C. Weeramantry’s separate opinion in New Zealand v. France; he saw the obligation to perform an environmental impact assessment as ancillary to the precautionary principle, ICJ Decision (Sep. 22, 1995), ICJ Request for an Examination of the Situation in Accordance with Paragraph 63 of the Court’s Judgment of Dec. 20, 1974 in the Nuclear Tests (New Zealand v. France) Case, ICJ Reports (1995), 344. Tools for More Sustainable Trade 89 Treaties with Developing Countries single country from swaying the outcome of negotiations. Even though a full WTO review, comprising all the negotiations and impact assessments on the 148 member states, would probably be untenable, subsets of the membership might be able to undertake such a task. However, the dearth of commitment on devising a coherent methodological framework has obstructed fruitful progress on this front. Arguably, the best place for coordinating assessment efforts within the WTO is the Trade Policy Review Mechanism (TPRM). The rationale for embedding multilateral impact assessments in the TPRM is tri- partite: congruencies in the objectives and outcomes of the tools,97 adherence to comparable principles, and feasibility within the established institutional arrangement.98 Furthermore, discussion on such an innovation may not be politically charged; information provided in a trade policy review is barred from applicability in dispute se lements. An incipient WTO strategic impact assessment body would be more likely to receive acclaim if it were molded from existing institutional structures.99 There are myriad parallels between impact assessments and current trade policy review mechanisms. Both instruments are designed to exchange and obtain information but are not teleological toward results rendered.100 More- over, both trade policy reviews and impact assessments adhere to analogous principles: trade policy reviews scrutinize the degree to which WTO mem- bers fulfill their WTO commitments; impact assessments analyze the extent to which states ponder the multifarious implications of new areas of trade. Thus, impact assessments could be considered part of the WTO pledge to support sustainable development initiatives and policies of its members. Furthermore, the transparency a ribute of trade policy reviews is shared by impact assess- ments, making impact assessments relevant in different stages of the trade policy review process. One offshoot of such coherence would be to enable members to include their latest national trade impact assessments in their mandatory country reports. As the trade policy reviews are currently con- figured, national impact assessments are considered extraneous: Swi erland included sections on trade and the environment in its 2000 trade policy review country report, but the WTO secretariat was unable to review those aspects.101 Another point of connection resulting in improved complementarity be- tween nationally derived impact assessments and trade policy reviews could 97 Bernard M. Hoekman & Will Martin, Developing Countries and the WTO: A Pro-active Agenda (Blackwell 2001). 98 Kym Anderson & Bernard M. Hoekman, The WTO’s Core Rules and Disciplines 2 (Edward Elgar, 2006). 99 Tilman Santarius et al., Balancing Trade and Environment—An Ecological Reform of the WTO as a Challenge in Sustainable Global Governance 46 (Wuppertal Paper No. 133, Wuppertal Inst. for Climate, Env., Energy, Feb. 2004). 100 Id., at 45. 101 See Trade Policy Review Body, Joint Trade Policy Review Swi erland and Liechtenstein, (Minutes of Meeting, Dec. 4 & 6, 2000, WTO-Dokument WT/TPR/M/77/Add.1 vol. 24, Jan. 2001). 90 The World Bank Legal Review be the augmented range of information gathering executed by the WTO sec- retariat. The secretariat could extend its focus on other international financial institutions to embrace environmental or developmental (including human rights—an integral aspect of sustainable development) organizations. Finally, the publication requirements of the TPRM are in line with common impact assessment tools. Concerns arising from the impact assessment consultation process could be brought to the table at the multilateral level to abet coordina- tion. Participation in these debates should be extended to NGOs, similar to the multifaceted consultation requirements of extant impact assessments.102 At a fundamental level, a truly multilateral impact assessment regime would have to ensure broad developing country participation to countervail perceptions that the innovation is yet another way to move forward with dis- guised protectionism. Some observers fear that impact assessments could be- come a precondition for trade agreements103 or could consume the diminutive resources of strained environmental ministries. Substantive inclusion of other international stakeholders and transferring elements of the process to com- petent international organizations such as UNEP and UNDP are alternatives worthy of examination.104 There are many lessons to be learned from national and regional assess- ment measures in order to facilitate greater equity and inclusion within the WTO. The framework encompassing current national impact assessments is conducive to public participation, although useful enhancement and mitiga- tion recommendations are limited by the national scope of the mechanism. Moreover, integrated impact assessments are indicative of substantive ad- vances but have uneven sway on the outcomes of national negotiation posi- tions. This chapter has highlighted the need for participation and coordina- tion efforts at the regional level for regional trade agreements, as well as the potential for progress at the multilateral level for the WTO. Inherent difficul- ties exist in efforts to innovate existing multilateral organizations and to open up proceedings and decision making to heretofore excluded participants. At- tempts by the WTO to replicate impact assessment strategies tested by other international organizations (such as the World Bank) have led to critiques from developing countries. Any innovation in institutional mandate and av- enues of participation within the fledgling impact assessment regime need to be broad based and conducted in a manner that facilitates ownership of the process for developing countries. The long-term premises of sustainable de- velopment, founded on both intragenerational and intergenerational equity, necessitate a high threshold of consensus and proactive commitment. 102 OECD, Trading Up: Economic Perspectives on Development Issues in the Multilateral Trading Sys- tem (OECD 2006). 103 USAID provided funding for the Jordanian side of the impact assessment process for the U.S.-Jordan Free Trade Agreement. 104 Frank Biermann, A World Environment Organization: Solution or Threat for Effective Interna- tional Environmental Governance? (Ashgate 2005). The Treatment of Insolvency of Natural Persons in South African Law An Appeal for a Balanced and Integrated Approach ANDRÉ BORAINE AND MELANIE ROESTOFF The increased availability of credit around the world and the recent global financial crisis have emphasized the need for modern and effective regimes for the insolvency of natural persons.1 An effective and efficient personal in- solvency regime, and hence its ability to assist in counteracting poverty, eco- nomic exclusion, and inequality, can play an important role in the economic development of a country, especially in South Africa.2 To be er understand the availability and operation of personal insolvency and debt relief measures in South Africa, one must have an understanding of the socioeconomic conditions in South Africa and the levels of overindebted- ness of natural person debtors in that society.3 South Africa can largely be classified as a developing economy, although it contains elements of a highly developed economy and elements of an ex- tremely underdeveloped economy. The differences between these two ex- tremes are stark, and there are few bridges between these two landscapes.4 As of the latest national census, South Africa had 50 million inhabitants, of whom around 25 percent were formally classified as unemployed and around 1 See Working Group on the Treatment of the Insolvency of Natural Persons, Report on the Treatment of the Insolvency of Natural Persons 2 (Insolvency and Creditor/Debtor Regimes Task Force, World Bank 2012), available at h p://www-wds.worldbank.org/external/default /WDSContentServer/WDSP/IB/2013/05/02/000333037_20130502131241/Rendered/PDF/771 700WP0WB0In00Box377289B00PUBLIC0.pdf. 2 See Michael R. Rochelle, Lowering the Penalties for Failure: Using the Insolvency Law as a Tool for Spurring Economic Growth; The American Experience, and Possible Uses for South Africa, 2 J. South African L. 315 (1996). With regard to financial inclusion in South Africa, see World Bank, South Africa Economic Update: Focus on Financial Inclusion (May 2013). As indicated in this report (at v), this topic is especially important for South Africa because it could help reduce poverty and inequality and stimulate job creation. 3 See Hermie Coe ee & Melanie Roestoff, Consumer Debt Relief in South Africa: Should the Insol- vency System Provide for NINA Debtors? Lessons from New Zealand (forthcoming). 4 For a general discussion of the socioeconomic context and social policy needs in South Af- rica, see Marius P. Olivier, Nicola Smit, & Evance R. Kalula, Social Security: A Legal Analysis (LexisNexis Bu erworths 2003). 91 92 The World Bank Legal Review 23 percent lived below the national poverty line.5 Although white South Afri- cans are generally perceived to be rich and black South Africans are generally perceived to be poor, the “new” society that has taken shape since the advent of the current democratic order in 1994 is not so clear-cut. To be sure, the former apartheid laws did exclude the majority of South Africans from many opportunities in the economy, including the credit markets. Despite this— and despite the fact that great inequalities still exist—the financial position of many black South Africans has improved over the past 20 years.6 Although the average white-headed household still earns more than 5.5 times the income of the average black-headed household, there has been a significant rise in the number of black-headed households that can be described as middle-class.7 Overindebtedness can affect—and is affecting—all communities. Of the estimated 50 million South Africans, nearly 16 million (almost a third) receive government social grants, such as children’s grants, disability grants, or old-age grants.8 However, the number of South Africans liable for personal income tax is significantly less than this figure.9 When it comes to granting credit, there was a major increase in the mi- croloan market during the 1990s, when South Africa embraced a democratic constitution. This also gave rise to a significant problem of overindebtedness, especially among black South Africans.10 Since June 2007, there has been an ongoing deterioration in the number of consumers in “good standing.” At the end of December 2012, credit bureaus had recorded 19.97 million active credit consumers, of whom 9.34 million had impaired credit records. Thus, only 5 World Bank, Poverty Headcount Ratio at National Poverty Line (% of Population), available at http://search.worldbank.org/data?qterm=national+poverty+rate&language=EN&format (accessed Apr. 10, 2013); See Quarterly Labour Force Survey (Statistical Release P0211, Statis- tics South Africa, July 31, 2012), available at h p://www.statssa.gov.za/publications/P0211 /P02114thQuarter2012.pdf (accessed Apr. 10, 2013). 6 The income-expenditure survey conducted by Statistics South Africa indicates that the an- nual household income of white-headed South African households increased by 0.4 per- cent between 2005–2006 and 2010–2011, while the corresponding figure for other population groups ranged between 28 and 37 percent. See Income and Expenditure of Households (Statisti- cal Release P0100, Statistics South Africa, 2012). 7 Murray Leibbrandt et al., Trends in South African Income Distribution and Poverty since the Fall of Apartheid (Social, Employment and Migration Working Paper No. 101, Organisation for Economic Co-operation and Development, May 28, 2010). 8 See Pravin Gordhan, 2012 Budget Speech (Feb. 22, 2012), available at h p://www.treasury.gov .za/documents/national%20budget/2012/speech/speech.pdf. (accessed Apr. 10, 2013). 9 Oupa Magashula, Address by the Commissioner of SARS to the Standing CommiĴee on Finance on the 2011 Tax Statistics (May 23, 2012), available at h p://www.sars.gov.za/home .asp?pid=63144 (accessed Apr. 12, 2013). The South African Revenue Services (SARS) report- ed a growth in the individual tax register from 1.7 million in 1994 to 6 million in 2010. A fur- ther growth to more than 12 million was reported in 2011 following a policy change to regis- ter all individuals in formal employment. However, this figure does not reflect the number of individuals actually liable for income tax because all salary earners, irrespective of whether they are liable, must now be registered with SARS. See Coe ee & Roestoff, supra note 3. 10 André Boraine, Some Thoughts on the Reform of Administration Orders and Related Issues, 36 De Jure 217, 230 (2003). The Treatment of Insolvency of Natural Persons 93 in South African Law 53.2 percent of active credit consumers were in good standing.11 Many of these overstretched or debt-stressed, if not insolvent, consumers will be subject to some kind of debt collection procedure. Certain individual debt collection procedures, including wage garnishee orders, have become notorious due to abuses in the South African system. Garnishee orders have even been blamed for labor unrest, because these or- ders are not limited to a prescribed percentage of the debtor’s income, giv- ing rise to a zero paycheck situation for some debtors.12 Debtors subject to garnishee orders are technically insolvent but are usually not able to file for sequestration with the view of ultimately obtaining a statutory discharge following rehabilitation because they do not meet the requirements set by the Insolvency Act 24 of 1936. The Insolvency Act provides for sequestration, which entails a liquidation of assets; other statutes provide for debt-restructuring procedures, namely, the Magistrates’ Courts Act 32 of 1944 (MCA) and the National Credit Act 34 of 2005 (NCA).13 In addition, voluntary debt restructuring is possible for some debtors. This chapter discusses and evaluates the statutory and nonstatutory pro- cedures pertaining to the insolvency of natural persons, the regulation of in- solvency practitioners, and the insolvency reform initiatives on the table in South Africa. The chapter demonstrates that the current South African system does not follow a balanced approach and it does not provide adequate debt relief to all insolvent or debt-stressed individuals. There is no principled view or approach regarding the treatment of the insolvency of natural persons in South African law. This chapter is therefore an appeal to South African law- makers to address this weakness; in this regard, it proposes suggestions for insolvency law reform. 11 National Credit Regulator, Credit Bureau Monitor Fourth Quarter (Dec. 2012), available at h p://www.ncr.org.za/publications/CBM%20Dec%202012.pdf (accessed Apr. 10, 2013). 12 “In incidents, entire pay checks have been absorbed for the repayment of debt through garnishee orders, while in other cases miners have been forced to repay in excess of ten times their outstanding debt.” See Malcolm Rees, Mines to Investigate Garnishes, Moneyweb (Apr. 3, 2013), available at h p://www.moneyweb.co.za/moneyweb-economic-trends/mines -to investigate-garnishees. For proposals to improve the position, see Working Document on Magistrates’ Courts Amendment Bill (Feb. 21, 2013), available at h p://www.northernlaw .co.za/Documents/magistrate_court/Working%20document%20Magistrates’%20Courts%20 Amendment%20Bill%2021Feb13.pdf. 13 For a detailed discussion of the South African statutory measures, see Melanie Roestoff & Hermie Coe ee, Consumer Debt Relief in South Africa: Lessons from America and England; and Suggestions for the Way Forward, 24 South African Mercantile L.J. 53 (2012); Lienne Steyn, Statutory Regulation of Forced Sale of the Home in South Africa 349 (L.L.D. thesis, U. of Pretoria, 2012); André Boraine, Corlia van Heerden, & Melanie Roestoff, A Comparison between Formal Debt Administration and Debt Review: The Pros and Cons of These Measures and Suggestions for Law Reform, part 1, 45(1) De Jure 80 (2012), part 2, 45(2) De Jure 254 (2012). 94 The World Bank Legal Review Sequestration under the Insolvency Act The insolvency of natural persons is primarily regulated by the Insolvency Act,14 which provides that a sequestration order can be obtained upon appli- cation to the South African High Court15 by a creditor for compulsory seques- tration of the debtor’s estate16 or upon application for voluntary surrender of his or her estate by the debtor.17 After a sequestration order is granted, the debtor is formally referred to as an “insolvent.” The granting of a sequestration order is based on a number of statutory requirements, but the “advantage for creditors” requirement is the decisive factor regarding whose estate will be sequestrated and whose will not.18 One of the most important questions used to determine compliance with this re- quirement is if the creditors will receive a pecuniary benefit.19 In practice, this relates to the question of whether unsecured concurrent creditors will receive at least a dividend based on the pari passu principle. The size of the dividend is not prescribed in the Insolvency Act, but some courts require an indication in the case of voluntary surrender that the dividend will be at least 20 cents to the rand.20 The court will consider other factors within the realm of the advantage principle, such as whether the trustee will be able to unearth other assets, and also alternative repayment measures, such as an administration order under the MCA or debt review under the NCA.21 The court hearing the ma er has discretion to grant the sequestration order.22 The requirement of the advantage of creditors plays a significant role in the exercise of this dis- 14 See, in general, Jennifer M. Kunst et al., Meskin: Insolvency Law, chs. 2–3 (LexisNexis 2012), Eberhard Bertelsmann et al., Mars: The Law of Insolvency in South Africa, chs. 3–5 (Juta 2008). 15 The sequestration procedure is therefore expensive. See Melanie Roestoff & Stéfan Renke, Debt Relief for Consumers: Insolvency and Consumer Protection Legislation pt. 2, 27 Obiter 98, 99 (2006). 16 Insolvency Act of 1936, secs. 8–12 (hereinafter Insolvency Act). 17 Id., at secs. 3–7. 18 Id., at secs. 6, 10, 12. 19 See Meskin & Co. v. Friedman (1948) 2 SA (W) 555, 559; Lynn & Main Inc. v. Naidoo (2006) 1 SA (N) 59, 68; Ex parte Bouwer & Similar Applications (2009) 6 SA (GNP) 382, 386. 20 In the past, the South African courts have set the minimum dividend at 10 cents on the rand for each concurrent creditor (Nieuwenhuizen & Another v. Nedcor Bank Ltd. [2001] 2 All SA 364 (O) 367); Ex parte Kelly [2008] 4 SA 615 (T) 617). In recent times, however, a dividend of 20 cents on the rand is generally regarded as the minimum benefit that has to be established before a sequestration application will be granted (Ex parte Ogunlaja & Others [2011] JOL 27029 (GNP) para. 9). 21 See C. H. Smith, The Recurrent Motive of the Insolvency Act: Advantage of Creditors 7 Modern Bus. L. 27 (1985). See also Jhatam v. Jhatam (1958) 4 SA 36 (N); Behrman v. Sideris (1950) 2 SA 366 (T); London Estates (Pty) Ltd. v. Nair (1957) 3 SA 591 (D); Ex parte Ford & Two Similar Cases (2009) 3 SA 376 (C). See, further, C. Van Heerden & A. Boraine, The Interaction between the Debt Relief Measures in the National Credit Act 34 of 2005 and Aspects of Insolvency Law, 12 Potchef- stroom Electronic L.J. 22 (2009). 22 Julie Whyte Dresses (Pty) Ltd. v. Whitehead (1970) 3 SA 218 (D) 219. The Treatment of Insolvency of Natural Persons 95 in South African Law cretion, and the court will not grant an order if it deems the application to be an abuse of the sequestration process.23 After sequestration, an insolvent debtor may be rehabilitated, which in principle gives the debtor a discharge of presequestration debt.24 Sequestration coupled with rehabilitation under the Insolvency Act is the only formal statu- tory procedure that provides for a discharge of debt of overburdened debtors. In some instances, unsecured creditors either will receive no payment or will receive only a trifling dividend in lieu of the original debt. Still, as a rule, the debtor will enjoy the advantage of the discharge that follows rehabilitation. The advantage to creditors is decisive in this regard. If the court cannot be con- vinced of such advantage, the estate will not be sequestrated and the debtor will not receive the statutory discharge. This situation causes a differentiation between debtors whose estates can be sequestrated and those who are overbur- dened but who cannot obtain a sequestration order due to the absence of an ad- vantage to creditors. Such differentiation may be irrational in some instances.25 This situation is illustrated by Van Rooyen v. Van Rooyen (Automutual In- vestments (EC) (Pty) Ltd., Intervening Creditor).26 In this instance, two former members of a close corporation, S and V, bound themselves as sureties for the due performance of certain contractual payments in favor of a creditor of the close corporation. The estate of S was subsequently sequestrated, but no divi- dend was paid out to the creditors. In view of the sequestration of S’s estate, V became liable for the total remaining debt of the close corporation. Because 23 See Craggs v. Dedekind; Baartman v. Baartman & Another; Van Aardt v. BorreĴ (1996) 1 SA (C) 935, 937; Ex parte Steenkamp & Related Cases (1996) 3 SA (C) 822, 825; Van Eck v. Kirkwood (1997) 1 SA (SE) 289, 290; Van Rooyen v. Van Rooyen (Automutual Investements (EC) (Pty) Ltd., Interven- ing Creditor) (2000) 2 All SA (SE) 485, 490; Beinash & Co. v. Nathan (1998) 3 SA (W) 540, 542; Lemley v. Lemley (2009) JDR 0445 (SE) 4. Because sequestration can eventually afford a debtor a discharge of his or her debts, the process of compulsory sequestration has in the past been used—or, according to some, abused—by debtors in the form of an application for a so- called friendly sequestration to obtain debt relief. See Roger G. Evans, Friendly Sequestrations, the Abuse of the Process of Court, and Possible Solutions for Overburdened Debtors, 13 South Afri- can Mercantile L.J. 485 (2001). See also Esterhuizen v. Swanepoel & Sixteen Other Cases (2004) 4 SA (W) 89, 92. This phenomenon developed because proving advantage in a compulsory se- questration application is less onerous than proving advantage in a voluntary sequestration application. Unlike voluntary surrender, which requires positive proof of advantage for cred- itors, compulsory sequestration requires only a “reasonable prospect” that it will be to the advantage of creditors—compare the wording of the Insolvency Act, secs. 10(c) and 12(1)(c). Furthermore, no formal requirements are prescribed with regard to compulsory sequestra- tion; Catherine Smith, Friendly and Not So Friendly Sequestrations, 3 Modern Bus. L. 58, 59 (1981). However, regarding applications for voluntary surrender, the South African courts have tightened their approach to thwart abuse of the process. See, for example, Ex parte Bouwer & Similar Applications, supra note 19, at 386, and, further, Bertelsmann et al., supra note 14, at 63. 24 See Insolvency Act, sec. 129. 25 See André Boraine & Roger Evans, The Law of Insolvency and the Bill of Rights, in The Bill of Rights Compendium para. 4A8 (LexisNexis 2009 update); Lee Steyn, Human Rights Issues in South African Law, 13 Intl. Insolvency Rev. 1, 11 (2004). 26 See Van Rooyen v. Van Rooyen, supra note 23. See also Boraine & Evans, supra note 25, at para 4A8; Evans, supra note 23, at 503. 96 The World Bank Legal Review V could not repay this debt, her mother brought an application for compul- sory sequestration of her estate, but the application was denied due to the fact that the court did not accept that there would be an advantage for creditors. Because her debt amounted to more than R 50,000, she could not apply for ad- ministration under Section 74 of the MCA. Debt review under the NCA, which was not an option at the stage when the Van Rooyen case was decided, would offer relief only if the debt qualified as a credit agreement as provided for by this act. As is discussed below, the alternative procedures of administration and debt review do not provide discharge for overburdened debtors. More- over, South African insolvency legislation does not provide for a procedure for dealing with assetless estates or no-income-no-asset (NINA) debtors.27 Rehabilitation and Discharge of Debt under the Insolvency Act The only statutory discharge offered to natural person debtors in South Af- rican law is provided for by Section 129 of the Insolvency Act. Sequestration followed by rehabilitation of the insolvent affords the debtor a discharge of all presequestration debts.28 An insolvent will automatically be rehabilitated after 10 years from the date of sequestration. However, any interested party is entitled to apply to the court within that 10-year period to prevent automatic rehabilitation.29 An in- solvent may also be rehabilitated by means of a court order.30 The Insolvency Act provides various conditions and different time limits before the debtor may apply for rehabilitation, but he or she usually has to wait four years from the commencement date of sequestration.31 An insolvent may apply for rehabilitation to the same court that granted the sequestration order.32 The application must be supported by an affidavit in which the insolvent declares that he or she has made a complete surrender of his or her estate and has not granted or promised any person any benefit or entered into any secret agreement with the intent to induce the trustee or any creditor not to oppose the application. The affidavit must contain in- formation relating to the dividend paid out to the creditors and the current income, expenditures, and assets of the insolvent.33 Anyone with an inter- est in the estate may object to the insolvent’s rehabilitation.34 The insolvent 27 See Roestoff & Coe ee, supra note 13; Coe ee & Roestoff, supra note 3. 28 Insolvency Act, sec. 129(1)(b). 29 Id., at sec. 127A. 30 Id., at sec. 124. 31 See the proviso to the Insolvency Act, sec. 124(2). 32 See, with regard to formal defects in aplications for rehabilitation, Ex parte Mason (1981) 4 SA 648 (D); Ex parte Anderson (1995) 1 SA 40 (SE); Ex parte Minnie et Uxor (1996) 3 SA 97 (SE); Ex parte Elliot (1997) 4 SA 292 (W); Ex parte Van Zyl (1997) 2 SA 438 (EC). 33 Insolvency Act, sec. 126. 34 Id., at sec. 127(1). The Treatment of Insolvency of Natural Persons 97 in South African Law must furnish security with the registrar of the high court in the value of at least R 500 for any costs incurred due to the opposition of the application for rehabilitation.35 The insolvent must usually also give notice to the master of the high court and/or his or her trustee, as well as in the Government GazeĴe, depending on the specific statutory ground he or she relies on, prior to bring- ing the application.36 The statutory grounds for rehabilitation by court order are as follows: • The insolvent may apply for rehabilitation after 12 months have elapsed since the date of confirmation of the first trustee’s account. The insolvent must publish a notice of the intended application in the Government Ga- zeĴe at least six weeks prior to the application.37 • When the insolvent had been sequestrated previously, he or she may apply for rehabilitation three years after date of confirmation of the trustee’s first account. Also, six weeks prior, notice must be given to the master and creditors with the publication of a notice to that effect in the Government GazeĴe.38 • When the insolvent has been convicted of any fraudulent act in relation to his or her existing or previous insolvency, or any other offense under Sections 132, 133, and 134 of the Insolvency Act, the insolvent may apply for rehabilitation after five years have elapsed from the date of conviction. Six weeks’ prior notice must be given.39 • When no claims were proved by any creditor, the insolvent has not been convicted of an offense mentioned in Section 124(2)(c), and this is the first time that his or her estate has been sequestrated, the insolvent may apply for rehabilitation six months after the application for his or her sequestra- tion. Six weeks’ prior notice must be given.40 • When a composition is agreed to as indicated in Section 119(7) of the In- solvency Act, and where the master of the high court certifies that at least 50 cents on the rand was paid in respect to all claims proved against the estate, or when security was given for such payment, the insolvent may apply for rehabilitation. The insolvent must give three weeks’ notice of the application in the Government GazeĴe, and a copy of the notice must also be handed to the trustee.41 35 Id., at sec. 125. 36 Id., at sec. 124. 37 Id., at sec. 124(2)(a). 38 Id., at sec. 124(2)(b). 39 Id., at sec. 124(2)(c). In none of the cases mentioned in sec. 124(2) will the court order rehabili- tation within four years after sequestration without the master’s recommendation—proviso to sec. 124(2). See also Ex parte Porrit (1991) 3 SA 866 (N); Ex parte Anderson (1995) 1 SA 40 (SE); Greub v. The Master (1999) 1 SA 746 (C). 40 Insolvency Act, sec. 124(3). 41 Id., at sec. 124(1). 98 The World Bank Legal Review • When all claims have been paid in full together with interest, the insolvent may, at any time after confirmation of the distribution account, apply for rehabilitation. Three weeks’ prior notice must be given to the master and the trustee.42 The court hearing the application may refuse, postpone, or grant the re- quested order for rehabilitation and may also impose conditions for rehabili- tation.43 Before granting the order, the court must be convinced that the statu- tory requirements referred to above have been met and that the rehabilitation of the debtor is indeed desirable. It is thus accepted in South African law that an insolvent does not have a right to rehabilitation but that rehabilitation is a discretionary ma er in the hands of the courts.44 Such discretion must be exercised judicially and not arbitrarily.45 It is normally expected that both the trustee and the master will provide a report as to the desirability of rehabili- tation in a particular instance. Apart from the facts stated in the application of the insolvent, the court will also consider these reports and objections to rehabilitation raised by creditors, if any.46 When exercising its discretion, the court will consider the desirability of rehabilitation in the sense of whether the insolvent deserves to be rehabilitated. In this regard, the question is if the insolvent is a person who ought to be allowed to trade with the public on the same basis as any other honest person.47 Subject to any conditions imposed by the court, rehabilitation ends se- questration; discharges all the insolvent’s presequestration debts, except those arising out of any fraud on his or her part; and relieves the insolvent of every disability resulting from sequestration.48 A claim for maintenance (alimony) is an ongoing obligation, and even a rehabilitated insolvent will remain obliged to pay maintenance out of future income. The court hearing the ma er may also impose conditions for rehabilitation, including an order that certain debts will not be discharged upon rehabilitation.49 42 Id., at sec. 124(5). 43 Id., at sec. 127(2) and (3). See, further, Kruger v. The Master (1982) 1 SA 754 (W); Ex parte Le Roux (1996) 2 SA 419 (C); Ex parte Theron; Ex parte Smit; Ex parte Webster (1999) 4 SA 136 (O); Ex parte Fourie (2008) 4 All SA 340 (D). 44 Ex parte HiĴersay (1974) 4 SA 326 (SWA). 45 Ex parte Phillips (1938) CPD 381. 46 Ex parte Goshalia (1957) 2 SA 182 (N); Ex parte Isaacs (1962) 4 SA 767 (W). 47 Ex parte Heydenreich (1917) TPD 657, 658; Greub v. The Master (1999) 1 SA 746 (C). 48 Insolvency Act, sec. 129(1). 49 Id., at sec. 129, read with sec. 127(3) and (4). The Treatment of Insolvency of Natural Persons 99 in South African Law Alternative Statutory Procedures South African law provides two statutory debt-restructuring models for natu- ral person debtors: administration order under the MCA50 and debt review under the NCA.51 Administration Orders under the MCA Natural person debtors who are unable to pay the amount of any judgment against them or to meet their financial obligations and who do not have suf- ficient assets capable of a achment to satisfy such judgment or obligations may apply to a magistrate’s court for an administration order that would, if successful, compel the creditors to accept a rearrangement or restructuring of the debt.52 Although this procedure does provide debt relief for natural person debt- ors, its application is limited in that it applies only when the debts amount to not more than R 50,000.53 The procedure offers no discharge,54 and debtors may thus remain under debt almost indefinitely. Debts that are claimable only in the future, that is, after the granting of a particular administration order, are not included in the order.55 In terms of an administration order, a court will assist the debtor by ap- pointing an administrator to take control of the debtor’s financial affairs and to manage the payment of debts due to creditors.56 In terms of the order, the debtor has an obligation to make monthly or weekly payments to the adminis- trator. The administrator, after deducting necessary expenses and a specified remuneration determined by a prescribed tariff, must in turn make a regular distribution out of such payments to all proven creditors.57 The procedure has an element of a collective judicial procedure and is therefore sometimes de- scribed as a modified form of insolvency proceedings.58 50 Administration orders are regulated by the Magistrates’ Courts Act (MCA), sec. 74. See, in general, L. T. C. Harms et al., Civil Procedure in the Magistrates’ Courts paras. 37.1–37.10 (But- terworths 1997); Torquil J. M. Paterson, Eckards’ Principles of Civil Procedure in the Magistrates’ Courts 218 (Juta 2005). 51 See National Credit Act (NCA), sec. 86. See, also, in general, C. Van Heerden, Over-indebted- ness and Reckless Credit (ch. 11) & A Practical Discussion of the Debt Counselling Process (ch. 14), in Guide to the National Credit Act (J. W. Schol ed., LexisNexis 2008); J. M. O o & R.-L. O o, The National Credit Act Explained 64 (LexisNexis 2013). 52 MCA, sec. 74(1). 53 Government Notice R1411, in Government GazeĴe 19435 (Oct. 30, 1998). 54 See MCA, sec. 74U. 55 Cape Town Municipality v. Dunne (1964) 1 SA (C) 741, 744. See, further, Carletonville Huishoude- like Voorsieners (Edms) Bpk v. Van Vuuren en ‘n Ander (1962) 2 SA (T) 296, and M. A. Greig, Administration Orders as Shark Nets, 117 S.A.L.J. 622, 624 (2000), for a discussion of in futuro debts as well as criticism of the exclusion thereof. 56 MCA, sec. 74E. 57 Id., at sec. 74I–J. 58 H. J. Erasmus & D. E. Van Loggerenberg, Jones and Buckle: The Civil Practice of the Magistrates’ 100 The World Bank Legal Review A restructuring sanctioned by court order thus basically entails a repay- ment plan that will provide for an extension of the repayment period. It is implicit in the procedure that the debtor must have a regular income, because he or she must make weekly or monthly payments to the administrator to be distributed among the creditors. The amount that the debtor must pay to the administrator is based on an approximation of the difference between the debtor’s future income and the sum of a reasonable amount required for the maintenance of the debtor and his or her dependents, periodic payments to be made under credit agreements per the NCA, payments to be made under an existing maintenance order, periodic payments to be made under a mortgage bond, and certain other future debts.59 Secured debt, insofar as it qualifies as in futuro debt, is thus excluded from an administration order, and an order for the rescheduling of such debt is therefore not possible. However, the court will usually and may at its discretion, when calculating the amount to be paid to the administrator in terms of the order, make provision for the periodic payment that a debtor is obliged to make under a credit agreement under the NCA as well as for the periodic payments under a mortgage bond.60 Administration under Section 74 of the MCA first and foremost provides for a debt-restructuring plan in the form of a repayment plan However, Sec- tion 74C(1)(b) and Section 74K allow in principle for property to be realized (by selling) by the administrator if a court authorizes such sale. However, this provision is seldom used in practice. Furthermore, if the property to be sold is subject to a credit agreement under the NCA, the wri en consent of the credit provider must first be obtained.61 Administration has become subject to severe criticism due to, among other reasons, the following: 62 • Various abuses are manifest in the system. • There are many practical difficulties, especially the lack of capacity of some courts to deal with all the applications. • There is no proper regulation of administrators. • No maximum time period for repayment or discharge is provided for. • Because no discharge or maximum period for repayment is provided for, the added administration costs and interest cause the amount of debt to escalate to such an extent that many debtors never get out of debt. Courts in South Africa 305 (Juta 1996); Weiner NO v. Broekhuysen (2003) 4 SA 301 (SCA) 305. See, further, for a diverging opinion, C. P. Joubert, Artikel 74: Magistraatshowewet 32 van 1944 Soos Gewysig, 19 Tydskrif vir Hedendaagse Romeins-Hollandse Reg 135, 138 (1956). 59 MCA, sec. 74C(2). 60 Id. 61 NCA, sec. 74C(1)(b)(i). 62 See Boraine, supra note 10, at 230. The Treatment of Insolvency of Natural Persons 101 in South African Law • Because the procedure is limited to those instances in which the debt is not more than R 50,000, many debtors are excluded from this procedure. • It is not clear to what extent this procedure and debt review under the NCA should or could coexist.63 Debt Review under the NCA Section 86 of the NCA covers debt review.64 The NCA regulates various as- pects relating to “credit agreements.” Not all types of debt are regulated by this act.65 The purpose of NCA Section 3(g) is to address and prevent over- indebtedness of consumer debtors and to provide mechanisms for resolving overindebtedness based on the principle of satisfaction by the consumer of all responsible financial obligations. The cornerstone of debt relief under the NCA is thus full satisfaction, and not to provide a discharge of any kind.66 In order to assist overindebted consumers, the NCA created the office of debt counselors, persons designated to offer and conduct the services of debt counseling and debt review that may lead to the restructuring of credit agree- ments regulated by the NCA.67 The process of debt review commences with a consumer applying to a debt counselor to be declared overindebted and to be placed under debt review.68 During the initial debt review process, the debt counselor is obliged to re- view the debtor’s credit agreements in order to determine whether the debtor is overindebted and whether reckless credit was extended.69 A consumer is overindebted if the preponderance of available information at the time of the determination indicates that the consumer is or will be unable to satisfy in a timely manner all the obligations under all the credit agreements to which he or she is party. This is determined with regard to the person’s financial means, prospects, and obligations and probable propensity to satisfy all the obligations of all his or her credit agreements in a timely manner.70 The NCA 63 See Boraine, van Heerden, & Roestoff, supra note 13, at 267. 64 NCA, sec. 86, should be read with the National Credit Regulations, reg. 24. For a detailed discussion of the debt review process, see M. Roestoff et al., The Debt Counselling Process: Clos- ing the Loopholes in the National Credit Act 34 of 2005, 23 Potchefstroom Electronic L.J. 247, 255 (2009). 65 The NCA applies only to “credit agreements” as defined in sec. 8. These are a credit facility, a credit transaction, a credit guarantee, or a combination thereof. Usually, two elements can be identified in credit agreements, namely, a deferral of payment and a charge, interest, or fee. See sec. 1 for the definitions of the different credit agreements; O o & O o, supra note 51, at 20. 66 See, further, NCA, sec. 3(i); ColleĴ v. FirstRand Bank Ltd. (2011) 4 SA 508 (SCA), at 514. 67 NCA, secs. 86–87. 68 Id., at sec. 86(1), read with the National Credit Regulations, reg. 24(1). Debt review may also be initiated by any court hearing any ma er in which a credit agreement is being considered and it is alleged that the debtor is overindebted; NCA, sec. 85. 69 NCA, sec. 86(6). 70 Id., read with NCA, sec. 79. 102 The World Bank Legal Review furthermore prescribes certain penalties for the credit provider in the case of reckless credit granting under Sections 83 and 84. An assessment by a debt counselor regarding the overindebtedness of a consumer will determine the way forward. In this regard, NCA Section 86(7) provides that if, as a result of an assessment conducted under Section 86(6), a debt counselor reasonably concludes that a consumer is not overindebted, the debt counselor must reject the application, even if he or she has concluded that a particular credit agreement was reckless at the time it was entered into.71 However, if the debt counselor concludes that the consumer is not overin- debted but is nevertheless experiencing, or likely to experience, difficulty satisfying all the consumer’s obligations under credit agreements in a time- ly manner, the debt counselor may recommend that the consumer and the respective credit providers voluntarily consider and agree on a plan of debt re-arrangement. If such a plan is accepted by (all) the credit provider(s), the debt counselor may obtain a consent order from a magistrate’s court under Section 86(8)(a) to effect the restructuring as provided for by the NCA in Section 86(7)(c)(ii). Should the debt counselor conclude that the consumer is indeed overindebted, the debt counselor may issue a proposal recommend- ing that the magistrate’s court make either or both of the following orders as provided for in the subsections of Section 86(7)(c) of the NCA: • That one or more of the consumer’s credit agreements be declared to be reckless credit, if the debt counselor has concluded that those agreements appear to be reckless • That one or more of the consumer’s obligations be rearranged by: • Extending the period of the agreement and reducing the amount of each payment due accordingly • Postponing during a specified period the dates on which payments are due under the agreement • Extending the period of the agreement and postponing during a speci- fied period the dates on which payments are due under the agreement • Recalculating the consumer’s obligations because of contraventions of NCA Part A72 or B73 of Chapter 5 or Part A74 of Chapter 6 When a debt rearrangement is ordered, the effect is usually that the amount of the installment is reduced and the payment term is extended. In practice, the debt counselor does not receive and distribute payments on be- 71 In such an instance, the debtor may, with the approval of the magistrate’s court, apply directly to the court for an order covered by NCA, sec. 86(7)(c). 72 Dealing with unlawful agreements and provisions. 73 Dealing with disclosure, form, and effect of credit agreements. 74 Dealing with collection and repayment practices. The Treatment of Insolvency of Natural Persons 103 in South African Law half of the debtor; this function is assigned to independent payment distribu- tion agents.75 Although the court has limited restructuring powers, it is empowered to force, or “cram down,” a rescheduling of debt upon creditors. The court is also empowered to order such rescheduling with regard to secured debt, which includes, inter alia, obligations with regard to home mortgages. Compared to foreign systems, such as Chapter 13 repayment plans in the U.S. Bankruptcy Code, this is revolutionary. No provision is made in the NCA for a debt counselor to realize a debtor’s assets or to make such a recommendation to a court. In practice and in view of the determination of overindebtedness under Section 79,76 assets available for realization may be taken into consideration for the purposes of debt re- structuring. In Standard Bank of South Africa Ltd. v. PanayioĴs, it was held that “financial means” under Section 79 also include assets and liabilities and that “prospects” under Section 79 include prospects of improving the consumer’s financial position, such as increases in and liquidation of assets.77 In the case of credit agreements that involve goods as the subject ma er of the agree- ment, the consumer’s financial means and prospects must therefore include the prospect of selling the goods in order to reduce the consumer’s indebted- ness.78 It therefore appears that South African courts are not willing to allow consumers to include a credit agreement in the eventual rearrangement order or to retain the subject ma er of the agreement if they believe that such goods are luxurious and unnecessary for the maintenance of the consumer and his or her dependents.79 Debt review followed by debt restructuring under the NCA is in high de- mand among South African natural person debtors due to economic woes and because the majority of their debts amount to credit agreements as regulated by the NCA. However, the process is not without difficulties. Following are the most significant:80 • Debt restructuring under the NCA does not offer a discharge. The NCA envisages full repayment of the debt, and no time limit is prescribed re- garding the rescheduling of the debt repayment period. 75 See, with regard to payment distribution agents, E. Van Zyl, Registration and the Consequences of Non-registration, in Guide to the National Credit Act para. 525 (J. W. Schol ed., LexisNexis 2008). 76 Sec. 79(1)(a) provides that the debt counselor must take into consideration the debtor’s “fi- nancial means, prospects and obligations.” 77 Standard Bank of South Africa Ltd. v. PanayioĴs (2009) 3 SA 363 (W) para. 47. 78 Id., para. 77. 79 See Boraine, van Heerden, & Roestoff, supra note 13, at 94. 80 See Roestoff & Coe ee, supra note 13, at 68–70; Boraine, van Heerden, & Roestoff, supra note 13, at 93–103. 104 The World Bank Legal Review • A particular credit agreement that has already commenced will be ex- cluded from the debt review application.81 In this regard, the Supreme Court of Appeal held that the provisions of Section 86(2) would bar the consumer from including that specific agreement in the debt review pro- cedure as soon as a Section 129(1)(a) notice has been delivered in respect to that specific agreement.82 • The fact that the procedure does not provide for a discharge causes debt- ors to remain in debt almost indefinitely and causes an escalation in the amount of the debt, due to the cost and interest factor. • As in the case of administration orders under the MCA, there seems to be a lack of capacity in some magistrates’ courts to deal with the many applications, and this causes delays in the ma ers being heard within a reasonable time. • The NCA does not specifically prescribe the procedure to be followed or the information to be disclosed when a debt review application is brought to court. It is not clear what the hearing entails. The procedure may be regarded as cumbersome, costly, and slow. • The NCA provides that a credit provider may give notice to terminate the debt review process 60 business days after the date on which the consum- er applied for the debt review.83 In this regard, the Supreme Court of Ap- peal held that a referral of a debt review ma er to the court does not bar the credit provider from terminating the debt review.84 A credit provider may therefore terminate the process in respect to a specific agreement as soon as 60 business days have elapsed, irrespective of whether the ma er is pending in court. Such termination is not necessarily a dead end for the consumer, because the NCA provides that a court may order that the debt review resume in regard to a credit agreement that is being enforced by litigation.85 However, courts are reluctant to order a resumption of debt review, and it seems that an order will be granted only if a court is con- vinced that the consumer will eventually succeed in the application for debt review.86 • Although nearly the majority of consumer debts amount to credit agree- ments under the NCA, this debt-restructuring procedure is applicable to only credit agreement debt, not to other types of debt that a consumer may have. This aspect restricts the applicability of the procedure. In practice, 81 NCA, sec. 86(2). 82 See Nedbank Ltd. v. National Credit Regulator (2011) 3 SA (SCA) 581, 590. A Section 129(1)(a) notice is a le er that a credit provider must send to a defaulting consumer before the credit provider may commence legal proceedings to enforce the agreement. 83 NCA, sec. 86(10). 84 ColleĴ v. FirstRand Bank Ltd., supra note 66. 85 NCA, sec. 86(11). 86 ColleĴ v. FirstRand Bank Ltd, supra note 66, at para. 19; Wesbank v. Schroder (2012) JOL 28767 (EL) paras. 16, 17. The Treatment of Insolvency of Natural Persons 105 in South African Law debt counselors sometimes use the voluntary distribution procedure in conjunction with the statutory procedure in order to deal with noncredit agreement debt as well.87 It is possible to restructure some debt under the NCA and other debt in terms of an administration procedure, but these procedures are not well aligned.88 • As a result of the decision in Investec Bank Ltd. v. Mutemeri and Another,89 a debtor who opts for debt review as a form of debt relief may be barred from continuing with this process when a creditor decides to apply for the compulsory sequestration of the debtor’s estate. In that case, the court held that an application for compulsory sequestration did not amount to debt enforcement under the NCA,90 and therefore did not preclude the ap- plicant creditor from proceeding with an application for sequestration.91 The debtor is therefore given no choice as to how to deal with his or her financial dilemma and will be forced to lose his or her assets and be sub- jected to the social stigma of being insolvent.92 Nonstatutory Procedures Natural person debtors may, with the cooperation of creditors, use an infor- mal creditor agreement that may amount to a voluntary debt restructuring or voluntary composition. This method is based on the contractual principle of consent, but some creditors are not prepared to participate in such a volun- tary system. When the creditors accept a rescheduling of payment, it is also referred to as a voluntary distribution. Insolvency Practitioners Although South African insolvency law in the broadest sense does not pro- vide for regulated insolvency professionals, there are a orneys, accountants, and auditors who act as such. There are also other persons without formal qualifications who take appointments as insolvency practitioners. In general, only the trustee appointed per the Insolvency Act is viewed as an insolvency 87 See Boraine, van Heerden, & Roestoff, supra note 13, at 267. 88 Id. 89 Investec Bank Ltd. v. Mutemeri and Another (2010) 1 SA 265 (GSJ). See, further, FirstRand Bank Ltd. v. Evans (2011) 4 SA 597 (KZD), and Naidoo v. Absa Bank Ltd. (2010) 4 SA 597 (SCA), con- firming the decision in Mutemeri. See the discussion of Naidoo by N. Maghembe, The Appellate Division Has Spoken: Sequestration Proceedings Do Not Qualify as Proceedings to Enforce a Credit Agreement under the National Credit Act 34 of 2005, 14 Potchefstroom Electronic L.J. 171 (2011). 90 See NCA, sec. 130(1). 91 NCA, sec. 88(3); Investec Bank v. Mutemeri, supra note 89, at 274–277. See, for a detailed discus- sion of the Mutemeri case, A. Boraine & C. Van Heerden, To Sequestrate or Not to Sequestrate in View of the National Credit Act 34 of 2005: A Tale of Two Judgments (2010), 13 Potchefstroom Electronic L.J. 84 (2010). 92 See Roestoff & Coe ee, supra note 13, at 62–63; Maghembe, supra note 89, at 177–178. 106 The World Bank Legal Review practitioner; the insolvency fraternity in South Africa does not generally view debtors who apply for alternative debt relief measures such as administration orders or debt review to make use of formal bankruptcy procedures. Although insolvency practitioners appointed to deal with the liquidation of assets per the Insolvency Act are not compelled by law to belong to a professional body, there are statutory bars against the appointment of certain persons to act as trustees under the Insolvency Act.93 With regard to the administration of a sequestrated estate, the master of the high court fulfills a supervisory role and can thus be seen as a type of regulator.94 The master has discretion to appoint a person to act as a trustee in the case of sequestration, but will in practice ap- point only persons with some expertise in the field who are not barred from such appointments. The NCA created the office of the debt counselor, a person designated to offer and conduct the service of debt review. Debt counselors are regulated by the national credit regulator (NCR), a regulatory body, and must comply with certain statutory requirements, undergo training, and register as such under the NCA before they may act as such.95 In the case of administration orders, there is no regulatory body except when the administrator is, for example, also an a orney or an accountant who might be disciplined by his or her respective professional body in the event of misconduct. However, a court has certain statutory powers96 to deal with an administrator who fails to meet his or her statutory duties.97 There are no formal requirements or disqualifications set for administrators appointed by the court under Section 74 of the MCA. All the categories of “insolvency practitioners”—namely, trustees, debt counselors, and administrators—are in principle subject to systems of pre- scribed fees, which are borne by the debtor or his or her insolvent estate in the case of sequestration.98 At present, there is no state funding available to meet these fees when the debtor or the debtor’s estate cannot meet them. If an estate is sequestrated under the Insolvency Act and there is a short- fall to meet the costs of administering such an estate, certain creditors may 93 That is, a system of negative licensing. See Insolvency Act, sec. 55. 94 The master does not supervise the debt review and administration procedures. 95 See National Credit Regulations, reg. 10. 96 See MCA sec. 74E(2). See, further, Stander v. Erasmus (2011) 2 SA 320 (GNP) 324. 97 See, for example, MCA, sec. 74J. 98 The trustee is entitled to have the remuneration be taxed by the master according to tar- iff B in the second schedule to the Insolvency Act; see Insolvency Act, sec. 63(1). The debt counselor’s remuneration consists of an initial application fee of R 50; see NCA, sec. 86(3)(a), read with sch. 2 of the regulations. A debt counselor may also claim the fees prescribed by the Debt Counselling Association of South Africa (DCASA). Currently, debt counselors are bound to this fee structure as a condition of their registration as debt counselors; Boraine, van Heerden, & Roestoff, supra note 13, at 259. In general, the remuneration of an admin- istrator is capped at 12.5 percent of the regular payments received from the debtor for the purposes of distribution among creditors; MCA, sec. 74L(2). The Treatment of Insolvency of Natural Persons 107 in South African Law become liable toward the estate to se le these costs by means of a system of contributions.99 In the case of debt review under the NCA, debtors must in principle pay the fees of debt counselors, but those who earn less than R 2,500 per month may apply for assistance from the NCR.100 Insolvency Law Reform Initiatives The South African Law Reform Commission has been working on new insol- vency legislation since 1987; it published a report and a draft Insolvency Bill in 2000.101 One of the aims of the reform project is to have one piece of insol- vency legislation that deals with the insolvency of both individuals and other entities, such as companies. In March 2003, the cabinet accepted the concept of a new unified Insolvency Act, but this initiative has stalled. Likely due to the Companies Act of 2008, a further working document containing the Draft Insolvency and Business Recovery Bill in the format of a working document was completed by the Department of Justice in 2010. It is unclear when the government will take this new piece of legislation forward. The 2010 Draft Insolvency Bill uses the term “liquidation” when refer- ring to both the liquidation of juristic persons and the sequestration of natural persons. The advantage for creditors requirement is, however, retained in the 2012 draft bill.102 However, li le changed from the Insolvency Act 24 of 1936 in principle, and the draft bill as the latest document dealing with insolvency reform in South Africa does not introduce a revolutionary new insolvency system. For all intents and purposes, the Insolvency Act 24 of 1936 is still the main piece of legislation that deals with personal insolvency insofar as it re- lates to the liquidation of assets of insolvent debtors, and at present it is still unclear when the reform initiatives as mentioned above and further discussed below will be taken forward The 2010 Insolvency Bill proposes an alternative debt relief measure to sequestration in the form of a preliquidation composition.103 The composition is supervised by the court, and provision is made for an investigation into 99 See Insolvency Act, sec. 106. See, with regard to contribution in general, David Burde e, Kontribusiepligtigheid van Skuldeisers in Insolvente Boedels, Nov. De Rebus 1004 (1993); David Burde e, New Problems Relating to Contribution in Insolvent Estates, 63 T.H.R.H.R 458 (2000). 100 NCR press release (July 2008). 101 South African Law Commission, Report on the Review of the Law of Insolvency (Project 63) vol. 1 (explanatory memorandum) and vol. 2 (draft bill) (Feb. 2000) (hereinafter 2000 Explanatory Memorandum and 2000 Insolvency bill, respectively). 102 See 2000 Insolvency Bill, cls. 7(1)(b) and 8(1)(c), and the concomitant 2000 Explanatory Memorandum, at 15. From the 2010 Insolvency Bill, it appears that the commission has not changed its mind in regard to retaining the advantage for creditors principle; see cls. 3(8)(a)(ii), 10(1)(c)(i), 11(1)(c). 103 See 2010 Insolvency Bill, cl. 118. 108 The World Bank Legal Review the affairs of the debtor.104 Although the proposed composition is in essence a debt-restructuring device, a prescribed majority of creditors can bind the minority.105 If the majority do not accept the composition and the debtor is unable to pay substantially more than what is offered in the composition, the court must declare that the proceedings have ceased and that the debtor is in the position in which he or she was prior to the commencement thereof. Al- ternatively, the court must determine if Section 74 of the MCA can be applied to the debtor; if it can be, the court must apply the provisions accordingly and within the discretion of the presiding officer.106 Administration orders became extremely popular after 1994, to such an ex- tent that they were referred to as “an industry.” Many observers feel that the unregulated nature of this industry gave rise to serious abuse. It was widely be- lieved that unscrupulous administrators were holding unsuspecting consumer- debtors at ransom—and that these debtors would never escape their financial problems. There were indications that many individuals who had to rely on so-called microlenders ended up under the administration regime, which has aggravated their debt situation rather than affording relief. In spite of the fact that a Micro Finance Regulatory Council was established in 1999 to accredit lenders and monitor their behavior, problems in this area persisted. These and other complaints prompted the Department of Justice to imple- ment a reform project in 2001.107 The Centre for Advanced Corporate and In- solvency Law, based at the University of Pretoria, conducted this project with the view of advising on reform. As a result of this preliminary investigation, which culminated in the Interim Report on the Review of Administration Orders in Terms of Section 74 of the Magistrates’ Courts Act 32 of 1944, the Department of Justice requested the South African Law Reform Commission to appoint a project commi ee to make formal proposals regarding the reform of adminis- tration orders. The project commi ee was appointed in 2003, and the project registered as Project 127, Review of Administration Orders.108 This project was eventually suspended, pending the promulgation of the NCA, but, contrary to expectations, the NCA did not deal with administration orders. 104 Id., at cl. 118(10)(e). 105 That is, a majority in number and two-thirds in value of the concurrent creditors who vote on the composition; 2010 Insolvency Bill, cl. 118(17). 106 See 2010 Insolvency Bill, subcls. 118(22)(a) and (b). The commission’s proposal in the 2000 Insolvency Bill afforded the debtor the option to convert to liquidation and rehabilitation un- der the proposed Insolvency Act in instances in which the composition was not accepted by the required majority; see the discussion of this proposal by M. Roestoff & L. Jacobs, Statutêre Akkoord voor Likwidasie: ’n Toereikende Skuldenaarremedie, 30 De Jure 189, 207 (1997). 107 See Boraine, supra note 10, at 218; Roestoff & Coe ee, supra note 13, at 66. 108 See Boraine, supra note 10, at 219. The Treatment of Insolvency of Natural Persons 109 in South African Law Conclusion The main point of criticism against the South African insolvency system for individuals is that it is largely creditor oriented despite the worldwide trend to accommodate debtors seeking relief. The South African system does not provide adequate debt relief to insolvent or debt-stressed individuals, and the proposals of the South African Law Reform Commission do not address this situation. Moreover, there is no principled view or approach regarding the treatment of the insolvency of natural persons in South African law. Even when the insolvency reform initiatives discussed above are considered, there is no sense of integrating the various procedures in order to establish an over- arching framework. For example, it is not clear if and how administration and debt review could operate in the same case. It is also not clear why provi- sion should be made for two coexisting procedures serving the same purpose, namely, to provide for debt reorganization. The legislature, when introducing the NCA in 2007, missed a golden opportunity for comprehensive reform. South African law needs a complete overhaul of its debt relief measures. Existing statutory procedures should be streamlined by eliminating the over- lap between the different procedures and the unnecessary duplication of regulators and “insolvency practitioners.” A principled approach should be adopted to deal with the liquidation of assets, debt restructuring, and asset- less estates in a coherent way. With regard to debt-restructuring measures, lawmakers should devise one single measure providing for all debt reorga- nization cases. Lawmakers should build on the existing and well-established system of debt counseling that is regulated by the NCR as the regulatory body under the NCA. The South African personal insolvency system must abandon its creditor- oriented approach. The system should provide adequate debt relief and equal treatment to all insolvent or overindebted individuals. The Van Rooyen case illustrates the plight and dilemma of many overburdened debtors in South Africa. Because many creditors do not receive significant benefit from the se- questration of the estate of their debtors, in spite of the advantage of creditors’ principle, debtors are treated inequitably, in that many are left without re- lief in the form of a statutory discharge.109 This exclusion infringes the basic constitutional right of equality under the South African Constitution110 and upholds the dualism in the South African economy.111 As Rochelle suggests, a discharge of debt and a fresh-start policy in per- sonal insolvency could be an effective tool for spurring economic growth and development. In his words: 109 See Boraine & Evans supra note 25, at para. 4A8. 110 See South African Constitution (1996), sec. 9(1); Boraine & Evans, supra note 25, at para. 4AB; Steyn, supra note 25, at 11. 111 See Coe ee & Roestoff, supra note 3. 110 The World Bank Legal Review Improving the citizen’s economic lot is a central priority for most national governments. Insolvency laws can have a significant role to play in this work. Were the penalties for failure lowered from their current levels in South Africa, citizens and companies would take more economic risks to succeed. More businesses would start, more jobs would be created, and society as a whole would benefit. Those who fail would not become modern lepers, but instead would re- ceive another chance to be productive for themselves and society..112 112 Supra note 2, at 315. The Role of Personal Insolvency Law in Economic Development An Introduction to the World Bank Report on the Treatment of the Insolvency of Natural Persons JOSÉ M. GARRIDO The association between insolvency law and economic development is fre- quently overlooked. The idea of insolvency evokes failure and poverty, which is indicative of a lack of economic development. However, the role of insol- vency law is broad, and insolvency law serves several important functions in an economy. It is a useful instrument to reallocate assets to more productive uses, and an appropriate reorganization or debt-restructuring framework pro- vides instruments to preserve valuable businesses under distress. Traditional business insolvency regimes, however, tend to lack the appropriate treatment of the indebtedness of natural persons. An effective personal insolvency re- gime provides solutions for indebted persons while a aining broader goals for inclusive economic development. A couple examples illustrate the connection between personal insolvency law and economic development. In India, the indebtedness of farmers has re- sulted in severe social problems, with an alarming number of farmers com- mi ing suicide.1 In Hungary, the crisis created by the expansion of mortgage credit denominated in foreign currencies, especially in Swiss francs, resulted in the default of one-quarter of all mortgage loans in the country, creating an enormous social conflict.2 Both examples show that the connections between financial stability and personal indebtedness have become stronger and that the issue of personal insolvency is at the forefront of an agenda for inclusive economic development and shared prosperity in both developed and devel- oping nations. This chapter provides an introduction to the work undertaken by the Working Group of the World Bank’s Insolvency Task Force. The first section 1 See K. Nagaraj, Farmers’ Suicides in India: Magnitudes, Trends and Spatial Pa erns (2008), avail- able at h p://www.macroscan.org/anl/mar08/pdf/farmers_suicides.pdf, reporting 190,753 suicides from 1995 to 2006, and considering the figure an underestimation; see also A. R. Va- savi, Shadow Space: Suicides and the Predicament of Rural India (Three Essays Collective 2012), referring to 199,132 suicides in the period 1997‒2008, according to official records, which tend to underestimate the real number of suicides. Although there is a constellation of causes for this suicide epidemic, personal indebtedness is considered to be one of the major factors. 2 See Tamas Egedy, The Effects of Global Economic Crisis in Hungary, 61(2) Hungarian Geograph- ical Bull., 155, 162–163 (2012). 111 112 The World Bank Legal Review provides background on the project. The second section describes the issues covered in the World Bank’s Report on the Treatment of the Insolvency of Natural Persons (hereinafter World Bank report) and the contribution of the report to a be er understanding of the essential issues in the treatment of the insolvency of natural persons.3 A short conclusion examines possible future develop- ments in this area. Background to the World Bank’s Involvement in Personal Insolvency Law The World Bank developed its insolvency and creditor rights (ICR) initiative as part of the standards and codes initiative of the international financial ar- chitecture. Per the mandate of the Financial Stability Forum, the World Bank developed a standard for the assessment of ICR regimes, known as the ICR standard.4 This standard comprises the World Bank Principles for Effective Insolvency and Creditor Rights Systems5 and the recommendations from the United Nations Commission for International Trade Law (UNCITRAL) Leg- islative Guide on Insolvency Law.6 The World Bank is responsible for the de- velopment of the standard and for the assessment of the legal, regulatory, and institutional frameworks in business insolvency. Those assessments are conducted under the program of reports on the observation of standards and codes (ROSC), which has covered more than 60 countries. The experiences of the ROSC program have been positive, and the program has contributed to numerous reforms in various legal systems, which have resulted in more efficient insolvency systems responsive to the needs of developing economies and contributed to the solution of crises in the corporate and financial sectors. The original focus of the ICR initiative was exclusively on business insol- vency systems. There is a clear justification for this: at the time the insolvency initiative was launched and the first version of the World Bank Principles was passed, the main concern was to deal with the aftermath of the Asian and Latin American corporate and financial crises of the late 1990s. These crises affected the corporate sectors first, and the contagion then spread to the fi- nancial sector. Efficient mechanisms to restructure loans and to reorganize businesses were identified as a main element missing in the countries that suf- 3 World Bank, Report on the Treatment of the Insolvency of Natural Persons, para. 7 (hereinaf- ter, World Bank report), available at h p://www-wds.worldbank.org/external/default /WDSContentServer/WDSP/IB/2013/05/02/000333037_20130502131241/Rendered/PDF/7717 00WP0WB0In00Box377289B00PUBLIC0.pdf. 4 See Creditor Rights and Insolvency Standard (2005), h p://siteresources.worldbank.org/GILD /ConferenceMaterial/20774191/ICR_Standard_21_Dec_2005_Eng.pdf. 5 See World Bank, Principles for Effective Insolvency and Creditor/Debtor Regimes, available at h p://siteresources.worldbank.org/INTGILD/Resources/ICRPrinciples_Jan2011.pdf. The principles were originally formulated in 2001 and revised in 2005 and 2011. 6 United Nations Commission for International Trade Law, Legislative Guide on Insolvency Law, parts 1‒2 (United Nations 2004), available at www.uncitral.org/pdf/english/texts /insolven/05-80722_Ebook.pdf. The Role of Personal Insolvency Law in Economic Development 113 fered the consequences of the crises most intensely. Some scholars have com- mented that financial stability is the first precondition for economic growth,7 and therefore the focus on business insolvency and on restructuring mecha- nisms for distressed companies is entirely justified. As a result of the efforts of the international community in dealing with insolvency and restructuring frameworks in systemic crises, a comprehensive and flexible standard is now available for all countries and there is a growing body of knowledge and expe- rience about the effectiveness of institutions and rules dealing with business insolvency. However, the global financial crisis in 2008 showed a very different pic- ture: in many of the countries where the crisis had the worst impact, the crisis originated in the financial sector and subsequently affected both businesses and individuals. The crisis also showed, for the first time, the connections between personal indebtedness and a systemic crisis: the origination of the financial crisis in the subprime lending practices in the U.S. market demon- strated clear links between unlimited credit expansion to businesses and in- dividuals and macroeconomic financial stability.8 This was particularly ap- parent in certain countries, such as the Baltic states.9 Analyses of the global financial crises have concluded that the indebtedness of natural persons and the lack of proper mechanisms to deal with it may have serious social and economic repercussions.10 There are further considerations on the importance of personal insolvency law.11 Insolvency is a phenomenon that occurs only in societies in which credit is widespread. Without credit, there is no insolvency and there is no need for an insolvency regime. Yet, the need for an insolvency framework manifests it- self in all societies in which access to credit becomes the foundation for the de- velopment of economic activities. This is the explanation for the development of the first insolvency regimes in the Middle Ages.12 But in medieval socie- ties, access to credit was restricted to merchants and the aristocratic class. In modern society, access to credit is a fundamental tool for every individual. It is the basis for the acquisition of housing, for the development of professional 7 See, for example, William C. Dudley, president and chief executive officer, Federal Reserve Bank of New York, Speech, Financial Stability and Economic Growth (Bre on Woods Comm., Intl. Council Meeting 2011, Washington, DC, Sept. 23, 2011), available at h p://www.bis.org /review/r110927c.pdf. In the words of Dudley, “A stable financial system is a prerequisite for sustainable economic growth.” 8 See Stijn Claessens et al., Cross-Country Experiences and Policy Implications from the Global Financial Crisis, 25 Econ. Policy 267 (2010). 9 On the crisis in the Baltic states, see, generally, Gediminas Macys, The Crisis and Economic Recovery in Baltic Countries, 2 Intl. J. Humanities & Soc. Sci. 202 (2012). 10 See Nick Huls, Consumer Bankruptcy: A Third Way between Autonomy and Paternalism in Private Law, 3 Erasmus L. Rev. 7 (2010). 11 Throughout this chapter, and in the World Bank report, the expressions “personal insol- vency” and “insolvency of natural persons” are used interchangeably. 12 See Louis E. Levinthal, The Early History of Bankruptcy Law, 66 U. Pa. L. Rev. 223 (1918). 114 The World Bank Legal Review and economic activities, for education, and for the satisfaction of consumption needs. Access to credit and entrepreneurial skills are motors of economic de- velopment.13 A modern economy is based on credit, with many positive effects for development; but a credit-based economy means that individuals sustain considerable levels of debt,14 and this results in higher rates of personal insol- vency.15 In essence, the rise in consumer bankruptcies is a by-product of the rise of consumer credit.16 Strategies for economic growth and poverty reduction are frequently based on the expansion of available credit, especially for small and medium- size enterprises and households. The increase of the importance of access to finance and the development of financial intermediation have created the need for an insolvency regime. Greater access to credit brings about more economic opportunities while allowing more possibilities for individuals to incur debts and to default on payments. Constructive solutions to the negative consequences of indebtedness are useful tools for sustainable and inclusive economic development. The regulation of personal insolvency has an influ- ence on how individuals perceive and deal with risks in their economic activ- ity, and determines whether and how individuals suffering from an excessive debt burden can return to a productive economic life. The increasingly recognized importance of personal insolvency law has a racted the a ention of academic researchers17 and several regional orga- nizations and international associations.18 It is in this context that the World 13 See Huw Lloyd-Ellis & Dan Bernhardt, Enterprise, Inequality and Economic Development, 67 Rev. Econ. Stud. 147 (2000). 14 See International Monetary Fund (IMF), Dealing with Household Debt, chap. 3 in World Eco- nomic Outlook: Growth Resuming, Dangers Remain, vol. 1 (IMF 2012). See also Yan Liu & Chris- topher Rosenberg, Dealing with Private Debt Distress in the Wake of the European Financial Crisis: A Review of the Economics and Legal Toolbox (IMF Working Paper WP/13/44, 2013). 15 See House of Commons, Public Accounts Commi ee, Helping Over-Indebted Consumers (UK Parliament, 2010). According to the report, UK consumers had some £1,459 billion of out- standing debt as of November 2009, and personal borrowing represented 160 percent of household annual pretax income. 16 See the pioneering work of Teresa Sullivan, Elizabeth Warren, & Jay Lawrence Westbrook, As We Forgive Our Debtors (Oxford U. Press 1989); David A. Moss & Gibbs A. Johnson, The Rise of Consumer Bankruptcy: Evolution, Revolution, or Both, 73 Am. Bankr. L. J. 311 (1999). 17 See Jacob Ziegel, Comparative Consumer Insolvency Regimes: A Canadian Perspective (Hart 2003); Johanna Niemi, Iain Ramsay, & William Whitford eds., Consumer Bankruptcy in Global Perspective (Hart 2003); Kent Anderson, The Explosive Growth of Personal Insolvency and the Concomitant Birth of the Study of Comparative Consumer Bankruptcy, 42 Osgoode Hall L.J. 661 (2004); Jason Kilborn, Comparative Consumer Bankruptcy (Carolina Academic Press 2007). 18 See Johanna Niemi-Kiesiläinen & Ann-Sofie Henrikson, Report on Legal Solutions to Debt Prob- lems in Credit Societies (report prepared for the Bureau of the European Commi ee on Le- gal Co-operation, 2005), available at h p://www.coe.int/t/e/legal_affairs/legal_co-operation /steering_commi ees/cdcj/cj_s_debt/CDCJ-BU_2005_11e%20rev.pdf; Udo Reifner et al., Consumer Overindebtedness and Consumer Law in the European Union: Final Report (report pre- sented to the Commn. of the European Communities, Health and Consumer Protec. Direc- torate-General, Sept. 2003), available at h p://news.iff-hh.de/media.php?id=1886; INSOL International, Consumer Debt Report: Report of Findings and Recommendations (2001), avail- able at h p://www.insol.org/pdf/consdebt.pdf (a second version of the INSOL report was The Role of Personal Insolvency Law in Economic Development 115 Bank Insolvency Task Force, in sessions held in Washington, D.C., in January 2011, considered the topic of the insolvency of natural persons. The task force reviewed a survey covering 59 countries that highlighted, among other as- pects, the lack of personal insolvency systems in the low- and middle-income countries included in the survey.19 The data, together with an analysis of the global financial crisis and its connections with the indebtedness of individu- als, prompted the task force to create a working group to study the treatment of the insolvency of natural persons.20 The working group comprised academics, judges, practitioners, and policy makers from many countries. The working group was formed to “study the issue of the insolvency of natural persons and produce a reflective report on this ma er, suggesting guidance for the treatment of the different issues in- volved, taking into account different policy options and the diverse sensitivi- ties around the world.”21 Within the working group, a drafting commi ee was established, comprising specialists in comparative approaches to personal insolvency regimes.22 The drafting commi ee produced successive versions of the report that were submi ed to the working group. The working group commented on those drafts and debated them in meetings held in Washing- ton, D.C., in November 2011 and December 2012, when the substantive work of the working group was concluded. The World Bank Report on the Treatment of the Insolvency of Natural Persons The objective of the working group was to produce a document that could serve as guidance for policy makers considering reforms in the area of per- sonal insolvency law. However, the issue of personal insolvency presents published in 2011). See also Nick Huls, Toward a European Approach to Overindebtedness of Consumers 16 J. Consumer Policy 215 (1993); European Commission, Enterprise Directorate General, Best Project on Restructuring, Bankruptcy and a Fresh Start, Final Report of the Expert Group (2003), available at h p://ec.europa.eu/enterprise/policies/sme/files/sme2chance/doc /failure_final_en.pdf; European Commission, Towards a Common Operational European Defi- nition of Over-Indebtedness (2008), available at h p://ec.europa.eu/social/BlobServlet?docId =5093&langId=en. 19 The survey was directed by Adolfo Rouillon at the World Bank. The results of the survey are available at h p://siteresources.worldbank.org/EXTGILD/Resources/Jan11-CI-Rouillon.pdf. The full name of the task force is World Bank Insolvency and Debtor/Creditor Regimes Task Force. 20 See the concluding remarks of the task force meeting by Vijay S. Tata (chief counsel, LEGPS, World Bank), available at h p://siteresources.worldbank.org/EXTGILD/Resources/WB_TF _2011_Consumer_Insolvency.pdf. See also Susan Block-Lieb, Best Practices in the Insolvency of Natural Persons, available at h p://siteresources.worldbank.org/EXTGILD/Resources /WB_TF_2011_Consumer_Insolvency.pdf. 21 See World Bank report, supra note 3, para. 7. 22 The drafting commi ee included Jason Kilborn, from the John Marshall Law School of Chi- cago (chairman); Jose M. Garrido, senior counsel at the World Bank (secretariat); Charles D. Booth, from the University of Hawaii; Johanna Niemi, from the University of Helsinki; and Iain Ramsay, from the University of Kent. 116 The World Bank Legal Review challenges and does not lend itself easily to a unified or uniform treatment. A itudes to personal insolvency law are embedded in the society, the culture, and the history of a particular country. Whereas business insolvency law re- sponds to a set of common problems in modern economies, albeit using differ- ent legal techniques, the social implications of the policy options in business insolvency are less intense than those of personal insolvency law.23 Therefore, although the problems of personal indebtedness are virtually universal, there are substantial differences in the way those problems are treated.24 The working group recognized the difficulties of creating a standard in the area of personal insolvency law. Even a standard such as the one used for business insolvency (the ICR standard), which is eminently functional and al- lows for important variations, would be too rigid for the development of solu- tions to the problem of personal indebtedness in different parts of the world. It was clear from the start, therefore, that the result of the working group would not be a model, a template, or a standard for the regulation of personal insol- vency. Instead, the approach favored was nonprescriptive, based on the idea that an organized report could arrange all the important topics that a personal insolvency system needs to address and show the advantages and disadvan- tages of different, tested approaches to the problems that typically arise in the development of such systems. In this way, the report acknowledges that a list of best practices in personal insolvency law may be premature, but it offers a catalogue of problems and solutions. Policy makers can use the report as a checklist for the topics to address in a reform or as an analytical tool for an already-existing system. Another task for the working group was to determine the relation be- tween a report on the treatment of the insolvency of natural persons and the ICR standard, which applies to business insolvency regimes. The difficulty lies in the fact that the ICR standard applies not only to companies and other legal persons but also to natural persons engaged in business activities. The insolvency law was initiated with the insolvency of merchants, long before companies became the main vehicle for organized economic activity. Tradi- tional insolvency systems are not designed to deal with the problems of in- debtedness of natural persons in a modern society. There are important dif- ferences between systems developed to address the insolvency of traders and 23 There is an exception to this general observation: the treatment of workers in the insolvency of businesses tends to be a topic in which opposing policies and traditions clash. In practice, the international standard offers only very general guidance on how to solve the issues of worker protection in the insolvency of businesses. 24 This is demonstrated by the existence of a rich comparative legal literature on the subject: See, for a variety of countries and methodological approaches, Jason Kilborn, The Innovative German Approach to Consumer Debt Relief: Revolutionary Changes in German Law, and Surprising Lessons for the United States, 24 Nw. J. Intl. L. & Bus. 257 (2004); Jason Kilborn, Out with the New, In with the Old: As Sweden Aggressively Streamlines Its Consumer Bankruptcy System, Have U.S. Reformers Fallen Off the Learning Curve?, 80 Am. Bankr. L.J. 435 (2007); Junichi Matsu- shita, Japan’s Personal Insolvency Law, 42 Texas Intl. L.J. 765 (2007); Rafael Efrat, Global Trends in Personal Bankruptcy, 76 Am. Bankruptcy L.J. 81 (2002); Iain Ramsay, Comparative Consumer Bankruptcy, U. Ill. L. Rev. 241 (2007). The Role of Personal Insolvency Law in Economic Development 117 merchants, on one hand, and systems designed to treat the insolvency of natu- ral persons, on the other hand. In some states, a distinction has been drawn between the insolvency of merchants and the insolvency of consumers.25 This distinction may be fea- sible—and effective—in a number of legal systems, but the line between consumers and entrepreneurs is increasingly blurred in both developed and developing economies. In fact, a common pa ern in developing economies is the existence of a high percentage of self-employed persons.26 Taking into account that the distinction between entrepreneurs and consumers is not use- ful in most economies, the question is how to draw a relevant distinction be- tween a standard designed for business insolvency and the issues raised by the insolvency of natural persons. No clear dividing line categorizes persons according to the degree of sophistication or complexity of their economic ac- tivities, and the definitions of traders, typical of the commercial codes in 19th- century Europe, are an unsuitable basis for different regimes. The distinction lies, instead, in the different approaches that the law takes toward insolvency. Defined as such, the function of the World Bank report is not to create a dif- ferent standard for the insolvency of natural persons as opposed to a standard for business insolvency, but to analyze the questions that refer to insolvent debtors as persons, rather than paying a ention to other considerations. What distinguishes a system for the regulation of personal insolvency, as opposed to business insolvency, is that the personal element occupies the central position in such a system. Of course, personal insolvency systems have implications for the economy of a country, as the most recent financial crises have shown, but the main considerations in the design of a personal insol- vency system exceed the purely economic aspects and must focus, first and foremost, on the human element present in these insolvencies. This concept colors the World Bank report and distinguishes clearly the subject ma er and the approach followed from the documents in which the business insolvency standard is based.27 In essence, the World Bank report recognizes that there are overlapping areas in the regime of business insolvency and in a personal insol- vency regime: both regimes aim for “increasing and more fairly distributing payment to creditors, streamlining procedures, and enhancing economic per- formance for the ultimate benefit of society,”28 but the difference is that busi- ness insolvency focuses on credit protection and the preservation of enterprise 25 For example, in the United States, the words “consumer bankruptcy” are most frequently used to refer to the insolvency of natural persons. Paradoxically, there are many procedures in the U.S. Bankruptcy Code that apply to both consumers and business actors. 26 See Carlo Pietrobelli, Roberta Rabello i, & Ma eo Aquilina, An Empirical Study of the Deter- minants of Self-Employment in Developing Countries, 16 J. Intl. Dev. 803 (2004). 27 The World Bank report states clearly that it does not conflict with the business insolvency standard. In fact, the report takes a different look at the issues that the insolvency of indi- viduals creates, and it explicitly refers to the standard in all cases in which the insolvency of a natural person does not present peculiarities and can be adequately treated in accordance with the approaches recommended in the standard. 28 See World Bank report, supra note 3, at para. 51. 118 The World Bank Legal Review value, whereas an insolvency regime for natural persons places the human elements of indebtedness problems at the center of the system, with the main goal of alleviating those problems for the benefit of debtors and society as a whole. The Benefits of an Effective Personal Insolvency System The World Bank report raises awareness about the importance of a personal insolvency system by examining the benefits produced by a well-designed regime for the treatment of personal insolvency.29 There are substantial dif- ferences as compared with business insolvency systems, where the protection of credit is the overriding concern. A personal insolvency system represents a balanced solution to the problems of indebtedness of individuals, taking into account not only the interests of creditors but, more important, the interests of debtors and the interests of society as a whole. A personal insolvency regime provides relief to “honest but unfortunate” debtors and their families, and it benefits society as a whole by addressing wider social issues.30 The World Bank report cites numerous benefits flowing from the exis- tence of an efficient insolvency system. These benefits can be grouped un- der common themes, showing how personal insolvency can benefit creditors, debtors, and society as a whole. A sound financial sector benefits from an effective personal insolvency system. A well-functioning personal insolvency system encourages proper valuation of accounts, because it forces creditors—especially financial insti- tutions—to recognize the loss of value of their claims and to take remedial action. A personal insolvency system reduces wasteful collection costs and ef- forts, and it can also reduce the destruction of value that results from fire sales, especially in systemic crises. The existence of a personal insolvency system encourages responsible lending. Such a system reduces negative externali- ties produced by inaccurate risk assessment31 and helps concentrate losses on those who are prepared to deal with losses in an efficient and effective way. Even more important, an effective system for the treatment of the insol- vency of natural persons directly benefits the debtors and their families, pro- viding them with incentives to continue being productive and to solve their indebtedness problems. These benefits flow to society as a whole in a number of ways: by reducing social costs of illness, crime, and unemployment;32 by 29 Id., at para. 58ff. 30 On the challenges faced by personal insolvency systems from a social point of view, see Teresa Sullivan, Elizabeth Warren, & Jay Lawrence Westbrook, The Fragile Middle Class: Americans in Debt (Yale U. Press 2000). 31 See Jason J. Kilborn, Twenty-Five Years of Consumer Bankruptcy in Continental Europe: Internal- izing Negative Externalities and Humanizing Justice in Denmark, 18 Intl. Insolv. Rev. 155 (2009). 32 See INSOL report (2001), supra note 18, at 4: “Solving consumer debt problems can be very complex. Unfortunately, these problems are frequently caused by or in relation to socio- psychological factors, such as divorce, redundancy, job loss, addiction, disability etc. These situations interfere with the quality of life and in many respects may have serious conse- The Role of Personal Insolvency Law in Economic Development 119 increasing the production of taxable income; by maximizing economic activity and encouraging entrepreneurship; and by enhancing stability and predict- ability in the financial system and the economy. An effective and efficient personal insolvency regime, therefore, both avoids waste and increases productivity, and it contributes to a healthier and more stable economy. These benefits deserve careful consideration by policy makers and provide a justification for the importance of developing adequate regimes for the treatment of the insolvency of natural persons. The World Bank report considers the impediments in achieving the objectives of a personal in- solvency system. Those impediments are identified as fraud, stigma, and moral hazard. These factors may operate at different levels of intensity, reducing the benefits of a personal insolvency system.33 Cultural and historical peculiarities of each society may require different responses to these issues,34 but the experi- ence of a number of systems shows that these concerns may be overcome. Core Legal Attributes of an Insolvency Regime for Natural Persons The World Bank report describes the main a ributes of a personal insolvency regime.35 In including such a description, the report makes no a empt to promote any particular system as the “ideal” regime for the treatment of the insolvency of natural persons. The report includes the essential elements of a system, with different possibilities and options and their corresponding advantages and disadvantages, as experienced in numerous legal systems of both developed and developing countries. The report acknowledges that the design of a personal insolvency regime needs to take into account the pe- culiar traits of a nation—social, economic, and cultural—in a more marked fashion than a business insolvency system does. A one-size-fits-all approach is expressly discarded. Another important concept is that personal insolvency law does not exist in a vacuum: it is essential to consider connections with the general insolvency regime and connections with the regulation of consumer and commercial credit. The World Bank report concentrates on the legal a ributes that are ger- mane to personal insolvency regimes. There are numerous issues—for in- stance, the regulation of avoidance actions or the regulation of insolvency pro- fessionals—for which the solutions provided by general insolvency regimes require practically no additional consideration. The report focuses on aspects that may require special treatment in a regime for the treatment of the insol- vency of natural persons: the general design of the regime; the relationship quences for the health of the debtor and his or her family and the way they live. They may become socially isolated or retreat from life altogether.” 33 See Rafael Efrat, Personal Bankruptcy in the 21st Century: Emerging Trends and New Challenges; The Evolution of Bankruptcy Stigma, 7 Theoretical Inq. L. 365 (2006). 34 See Iain Ramsay, Between Neo-liberalism and the Social Market: Approaches to Debt Adjustment and Consumer Insolvency in the EU, 35 J. Consumer Policy, 421 (2012). 35 See World Bank report, supra note 3, at para. 126ff. 120 The World Bank Legal Review of the formal insolvency regime with alternative informal solutions; the role of courts, agencies, and intermediaries; the conditions for access to the insol- vency process; and the solutions to the insolvency process and the discharge of the debtor. General Regime Design: Procedural Options and the Relation with Informal Workouts There are many options for the design of a personal insolvency regime: in some countries, a special statute for the treatment of consumer indebtedness represents the way in which a separate insolvency regime is introduced. In other countries, there is a closer integration with the general insolvency re- gime, and the general insolvency statute includes a regime that either is flex- ible enough to accommodate the needs of natural persons or incorporates spe- cial rules and procedures for natural persons.36 The decision regarding which options to use depends mostly on the characteristics of the national legal sys- tem and the political implications of enacting a special statute for consumers or individual debtors. In any case, a formal insolvency regime can serve as the backdrop for informal negotiations, as creditors and debtors “bargain in the shadow of insolvency law.”37 It is important that an insolvency regime provide for the possibility of resolving insolvency through informal negotiations, often called workouts, with subsequent savings in costs, fees, and administrative and judi- cial resources. There are important advantages to negotiated solutions: apart from lower costs, the most noticeable ones are the avoidance of stigma and a less adverse impact on debtors’ scores in credit information systems. There are also advantages in the fact that informal negotiations tend to yield be er outcomes for creditors and can provide for greater flexibility to accommodate the needs of both the debtor and the creditor, taking into account, addition- ally, that financial institutions generally prefer to renegotiate loans than to resort to formal enforcement or insolvency proceedings. There are obstacles to voluntary negotiations, however. Some creditors refuse to negotiate and, in so doing, boyco a negotiated solution to the in- solvency of the debtor. Other creditors do not engage actively in negotiations, exhibiting considerable apathy.38 As with creditor apathy in business insol- vency, the law can provide mechanisms to deal with holdout and inactive creditors by imposing the binding force of agreements on those creditors. The experience in the few systems in which informal alternatives to insol- vency have been successful suggests that several elements perform a useful 36 Id., at para. 139ff. 37 Following the classic expression of Robert H. Mnookin & Lewis Kornhauser, Bargaining in the Shadow of the Law: The Case of Divorce, 88 Yale L.J. 950 (1979). 38 The phenomenon is similar in some of its traits to that of rational apathy of shareholders in corporate law: see Robert C. Clark, Vote Buying and Corporate Law, 29 Case W. Res. L. Rev. 776 (1978–1979). The Role of Personal Insolvency Law in Economic Development 121 role in promoting negotiations, such as professional assistance in negotiations at a very low cost, or without cost, and a standstill agreement so that there is no immediate threat of the enforcement of claims. The Institutional Framework An essential part of a personal insolvency system is a well-functioning insti- tutional framework.39 Ideally, the institutional framework reduces the overall costs of the system by minimizing errors in the treatment of insolvent debtors and by providing for timely resolution of cases, with predictable results for all parties. The design of an institutional structure for a personal insolvency sys- tem must take into account the context of existing institutions and the avail- ability of professional intermediaries in any particular country. A factor in personal insolvency systems is the large number of cases.40 The high number of individual insolvents, together with the relative homogeneity of many of these cases, allows for standardized systems of treatment and re- quires a reconsideration of the costs and resources necessary to resolve cases in which the legal controversies tend to be less complex than those that arise in corporate or business insolvencies. The institutional framework to be adopted depends on the capability of the state. In some institutional frameworks, an administrative agency is in charge of the insolvency procedures; others are characterized by hybrid public- private systems in which public insolvency procedures coexist with private restructuring alternatives; and still others are court-based systems. Although the majority of countries have court-based systems, some countries have adopted administrative approaches, with courts taking a role only in disputed cases. Intermediaries are very important in most systems. In several countries, public agencies play a significant role in the insolvency of natural persons. Hybrid public-private models exist in which the primary actors are insolvency practitioners who perform several functions in the personal insolvency pro- cess under the supervision of a public regulator.41 Access to the Formal Insolvency Regime A main challenge in implementing a personal insolvency regime is the cre- ation of enough incentives for honest and unfortunate debtors so that they are 39 See World Bank report, supra note 3, at para. 152ff. 40 See, for example, Edward J. Janger, Crystals and Mud in Bankruptcy Law: Judicial Competence and Statutory Design, 43 Ariz. L. Rev. 559, 615 (2001), which highlights the well-known fact that every year there are more than one million consumer bankruptcy cases in the United States. 41 In this regard, the English individual voluntary arrangement, which consists of a payment plan agreed to outside the court with the assistance of an insolvency practitioner, provides a good example; see Adrian Walters, Individual Voluntary Arrangements: A “Fresh Start” for Salaried Consumer Debtors in England and Wales?, 18 Intl. Insolv. Rev. 5 (2009). 122 The World Bank Legal Review able to use the insolvency process without being deterred by stigma or by the costs of the procedure itself.42 The World Bank report lists the main approaches used to finance personal in- solvency processes. Those approaches include state funding; cross-subsidiza- tion of low-value insolvencies by higher-value estates; state subsidies to pro- fessionals involved in the process and write-off of court costs when there is an inability to repay; levies on creditors, such as taxation of distressed debt to fund cases for which individuals have no ability to pay; and no state support beyond general public funding of the court system. On the issue of standards for access to individual insolvency, the World Bank report emphasizes that standards should be transparent and certain and should ensure against improper use by creditors or debtors. There are dif- ferent philosophies on this issue. On the one hand, open access represents an approach whereby any individual who meets an insolvency test gains ac- cess to an insolvency procedure that allows an ultimate discharge of debts. On the other hand, numerous systems include additional requirements, with the purpose of addressing the problems of moral hazard and debtor fraud. When high barriers to access are used, the risk is that they can result in a large number of individuals being driven out of the formal economy, with negative consequences for themselves, for creditors, and for society. It is possible to ad- dress the problems of abuse of process, or of questionable conduct within the process itself, by imposing sanctions or denying some or all of the benefits of the insolvency process. Payment through Liquidation or through a Payment Plan Personal insolvency law comprises many of the features of traditional busi- ness insolvency law: it is a collective process in which creditors participate to protect their interests, and one of main goals of the process is the satisfaction of claims. However, in personal insolvencies, creditor participation is reduced due to a lack of incentives for creditors to take part in procedures in which the absence of valuable assets is the rule. This lack of resources does not justify a complex structure of creditor participation through creditors’ meetings or creditor commi ees. Regarding payment to creditors, there are important qualifications in per- sonal insolvency law. There are two fundamental approaches to payment, as in business insolvency: creditors may receive a payment through the liqui- dation of the debtor’s assets, or they may receive a payment through a plan funded with the debtor’s future income. Payment presents one of the most intense conflicts in personal insolvency law. If personal insolvency aims at the preservation of the person, allowing the debtor to resume a productive life, then a liquidation cannot include all 42 See World Bank report, supra note 3, at para. 186ff. The Role of Personal Insolvency Law in Economic Development 123 the assets of the debtor nor can a payment plan absorb all the future income of the debtor. In most legal systems, natural persons are allowed to keep some of their essential assets. Exemptions, therefore, represent a relevant aspect of the per- sonal insolvency regime and of the debt enforcement regime in general.43 Typically exempt assets are automobiles, household furnishings, postcom- mencement salaries, retirement plans, and professional equipment. Differ- ences in the treatment of exemptions can create incentives and disincentives for debtors, although the effects of those incentives and disincentives on the conduct of actual debtors have often been overstated.44 The family home is an exemption in some legal systems, but this exemption can be alleged by the debtor against unsecured creditors and does not affect the rights of mortgage creditors to enforce their security. The social problem caused by the loss of housing as a result of mortgage foreclosures may require extraordinary mea- sures, especially in the context of a systemic crisis.45 Exemptions are clearly connected to the notion of a fresh start. When debt- ors exit from insolvency, discharge their debts, and obtain a fresh start, they should own sufficient property to meet their basic needs. In some systems, exemptions have provided the only relief to debtors, in the absence of a dis- charge, but experience shows that exemptions alone, without the extinction of debt, are insufficient to provide debtors with the opportunity of resuming a normal, productive life. Because available assets of natural person debtors often have li le or no value, personal insolvency regimes increasingly incorporate payment plans based on the future income of debtors. In some cases, a payment plan is an alternative to traditional liquidation, but in other cases, the most valuable as- sets of debtors are liquidated and the payment plan is a subsequent phase of the procedure. The requirement of a payment plan based on future income in exchange for the discharge of debt has given rise to the notion of earned start, rather than a simple fresh start.46 However, including future income in the insolvency of natural persons raises a number of other issues. For example, a personal insolvency system cannot achieve its basic goals if debtors do not preserve a sufficient portion of their income to cover their basic needs. In this regard, 43 Id., at para. 223ff. 44 See William J. Woodward Jr. & Richard S. Woodward, Exemptions as an Incentive to Voluntary Bankruptcy: An Empirical Study, 57 Am. Bankr. L.J. 53 (1983); see also Susan Block-Lieb & Edward J. Janger, The Myth of the Rational Borrower: Rationality, Behavioralism, and the Misguided “Reform” of Bankruptcy Law, 84 Texas L. Rev. 1481 (2006). 45 See Michelle J. White, Bankruptcy: Past Puzzles, Recent Reforms, and the Mortgage Crisis (NBER Working Paper No. 14549, Dec. 2008), available at h p://www.nber.org/papers/w14549; Adam J. Levitin & Joshua Goodman, Mortgage Market Sensitivity to Bankruptcy Modification (paper presented at the 2008 Am. L. & Economics Assn. Conference), available at h p://law .bepress.com/cgi/viewcontent.cgi?article=2485&context=alea. 46 See World Bank report, supra note 3, at para. 262ff. 124 The World Bank Legal Review the discussion mirrors the debate on property exemptions. But additional is- sues need to be considered in the design of a personal insolvency system, and perhaps the most important one is the duration of payment plans. There are substantial differences in the duration of plans that can be linked to social and cultural issues. Although from a purely logical perspective, longer payment plans should result in higher payments to creditors, the experience in several systems suggests that payment plans extending over periods of many years create disincentives for debtors and do not result in significantly higher rates of repayment to creditors. Debtors who have no valuable assets and cannot generate significant disposable income are known as NINAs (no income, no assets). These debtors may have no access to the formal insolvency system, and, if they are granted access, they may be unable to comply with the re- quirements of a payment plan. In those cases, the main goals of the insolvency system may not be achieved if these persons cannot receive relief. This obser- vation illustrates the broader issue of the crisis of payment plans. Payment plans can be regarded not primarily as an instrument to extract a higher pay- ment from debtors, but rather as a mechanism that prevents moral hazard and abuse of the insolvency system and that inculcates the notions of payment responsibility and financial discipline. Some systems have introduced incentives for the productivity of debtors in payment plans. This is an interesting approach, because persons who are producing virtually all excess income for third parties—the creditors—can easily devote their efforts to covering only their basic needs, rendering the payment plan ineffective. Combining incentives with penalties can create a positive dynamic in payment plans. A payment plan requires monitoring tools, and it may need to provide for the necessity of revising the circumstances of the debtor and modifying the plan, especially when the insolvency regime establishes a long rehabilitation period for debtors. Discharge Discharge is the essential feature and one of the most salient characteristics of modern systems for the regulation of the insolvency of natural persons.47 One of the principal purposes of an insolvency system for natural persons is to reestablish the debtor’s economic capability, in other words, economic rehabilitation,48 and discharge is the most effective way in which the debtor can resume productive activity for society. It is also the most effective incen- tive for the use of a personal insolvency regime.49 47 See Thomas H. Jackson, The Fresh-Start Policy in Bankruptcy, 98 Harv. L. Rev. 1393 (1985); Margaret Howard, A Theory of Discharge in Consumer Bankruptcy, 48 Ohio St. L.J. 1047 (1987); John C. McCoid II, Discharge: The Most Important Development in Bankruptcy History, 70 Am. Bankr. L.J. 163 (1996). 48 See, for instance, Richard M. Hynes, Why (Consumer) Bankruptcy?, 56 Ala. L. Rev. 121 (2004). 49 See Emily Kadens, The Last Bankrupt Hanged: Balancing Incentives in the Development of Bank- ruptcy Law, 59 Duke L.J. 1229 (2010). The Role of Personal Insolvency Law in Economic Development 125 The World Bank report analyzes the three main elements in a rehabilita- tion policy.50 Discharge of debts is the most important one, but two additional elements are connected to the treatment of indebtedness: debtors should not be discriminated against after having been subject to an insolvency process (principle of nondiscrimination); and debtors should be in a position to avoid excessive indebtedness in the future, which may require the adoption of mea- sures to change debtors’ a itudes concerning the use of credit, depending on the circumstances of each case.51 In some systems, debtors are not allowed into the insolvency system again until the passage of a period of time. The discharge of debt provides a fresh start for the debtor by extinguish- ing unpaid debts. This notion is contrary to traditional principles of the law of obligations, however, and many legal systems reject the notion of a straight discharge. Most systems try to favor “honest but unfortunate” debtors over persons responsible for fraudulent or reckless behavior, but these distinctions are not always easy to draw. A requirement of good faith of the debtor is important to justify the loss of creditor rights caused by the discharge. Addi- tionally, debtors need to “earn” a discharge by surrendering their nonexempt assets to creditors and/or by complying with a payment plan for a specified period of time. To be effective, a discharge should include as many debts as possible. Cer- tain debts may be excluded from the discharge due to social or economic con- siderations, including child and spousal support, fines and other sanctions, and taxes; the examples differ depending on the country. A more problematic issue that affects the effectiveness of discharge is the sureties given by mem- bers of the debtor’s family. Because discharge generally affects only individual debtors, family members who have guaranteed debts may find themselves in a difficult situation. There is a trend toward greater flexibility in the treatment of guarantees, although the issue presents numerous challenges. Conclusion Insolvency is an inevitable consequence of credit. As economies grow and ac- cess to credit becomes widespread, the need for an effective personal insol- vency law will become more apparent. Developing an effective insolvency regime that provides solutions to the complex and sensitive problems of the indebtedness of natural persons and assists in returning debtors to a produc- tive life requires a deep knowledge of legal techniques and considerable expe- rience in their implementation. The World Bank report condenses knowledge 50 See World Bank report, supra note 3, at para. 354ff. 51 Prevention of overindebtedness requires policies that are broader than the regulation of in- solvency. See Claudia Lima Marques, Fundamentos Científicos da Prevenção e Tratamento do Superendividamento, in Prevenção e Tratamento do Superendividamento 15 (Claudia Lima Mar- ques, Clarissa Costa Lima, & Káren Bertoncello eds., Departamento de Proteção e Defesa do Consumidor & Sistema Nacional de Defesa do Consumidor 2010). 126 The World Bank Legal Review and experience in this area and is an extremely useful instrument for research- ers and policy makers. The World Bank report is not prescriptive, and it does not purport to offer solutions that are applicable to all countries. Instead, the purpose of the report is to provide a comprehensive list of issues to consider in the design of a per- sonal insolvency system and an analysis of the positive and negative effects of the different policy choices available in the configuration of the legal regime. In this regard, the report represents an approach that is very different from that of international standards. The report acknowledges the impact of cul- tural, legal, and social differences; policy makers can assess the consequences of their policy choices, and the implicit message that emerges favors a more humane and equitable treatment of debtors. Indeed, the history of bankruptcy law evidences a clear trend toward a more humane treatment of debtors. There has been a long evolution from the extreme treatment of debtors un- der primitive Roman law, which included the (possibly figurative) killing and dismemberment of debtors.52 The contrast with modern insolvency systems is striking: debtors are provided an opportunity to restart a productive activity and are assisted by social and educational programs. A personal insolvency system has become an important element for the promotion of equity and inclusion in modern societies. Recently, Colombia became the first Latin American country to introduce a personal insolvency regime with the notion of the discharge of debts as a core element.53 The Colombian regime provides for discharge through liqui- dation or through the completion of a payment plan. The drafters of the new law have declared that the World Bank report was a valuable element in their analysis of the reform and a useful tool to guide choices among different policy options with the ultimate goal of designing an effective system. It is hoped that policy makers in other countries will rely on the World Bank report, and that the treatment of personal indebtedness and personal insolvency becomes an essential element in policies that seek to achieve inclusive and sustainable economic development. 52 See Geoffrey MacCormack, Partes Secanto, 36 Tijdschrift voor Rechtsgescheidenis 509 (1968); see also S. Laurence Shaiman, The History of Imprisonment for Debt and Insolvency Laws in Pennsylvania as They Evolved from the Common Law, 4 Am. J. Leg. Hist. 205 (1960). Although the killing and dismemberment of the debtor seems to be fictional, the alternative of selling the debtor as a slave was used, not to mention the practice of imprisonment for debts, which was common in European countries for many centuries. 53 See Ley 1564 (2012) (Colombian General Code of Procedure), secs. 531ff. Specialized Insolvency Regimes for Islamic Banks Regulatory Prerogative and Process Design HDEEL ABDELHADY The failures of large financial institutions in 2007 and 2008 revealed the inad- equacy of existing insolvency regimes to resolve failed firms while limiting the impact to the financial system, public funds, and market confidence.1 In response, governments have studied and adopted measures to be er manage the insolvency of financial institutions, with a focus on systemically impor- tant financial institutions (SIFIs) and a ention to smaller firms. In the United States, the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act cre- ated a special framework for the resolution of systemically important finan- cial companies.2 In the United Kingdom, the Banking Act 2009 established a Special Resolution Regime to facilitate the swift and orderly resolution of failed firms.3 Multilaterally, the G20 Financial Stability Board has moved to strengthen and standardize resolution frameworks.4 These measures share common policy objectives; namely, the timely detection of risk, early regula- tory intervention, the avoidance of government bailouts and related moral hazard, and enhanced market discipline. 1 In this chapter, Arabic terms such as mudaraba, mudarib, and Shari’ah appear with alterna- tive phonetic spellings, due to differences in spelling between the author and some quoted sources. Because the differences are minor and the meanings remain clear, source spellings are intact. The terms Shari’ah and Islamic law are used interchangeably. 2 Orderly Liquidation Authority (OLA) under Title II of the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act, Pub. L. No. 111-203, 124 Stat. 1376 (2010) (codified as amended in sca ered sections of 12 U.S.C. and 15 U.S.C.) (hereinafter Dodd-Frank). In this chapter, OLA, a substantively harmonized and administratively managed resolution regime, is dis- cussed as a framework of reference for the design of insolvency regimes for Islamic banks, which, like some financial companies subject to OLA, straddle banking and capital markets and are well-suited for insolvency frameworks that combine banking and capital market rules and administratively managed insolvency processes 3 Banking Act 2009, 2009, ch. 1, secs. 90–122 (Eng.). See also, for a brief overview, Her Majesty’s Treasury, Banking Act 2009 and the Establishment of the Special Resolution Regime, available at h p://www.hm-treasury.gov.uk/fin_stability_bankingact_srr.htm (accessed May 2, 2013). Notably, the Special Resolution Regime includes resolution mechanisms used in the United States for decades, such as bridge banks and regulator-brokered transfers of failed bank as- sets and liabilities to healthy firms. 4 See, for example, Financial Stability Board, Key A ributes of Effective Resolution Regimes for Fi- nancial Institutions (Oct. 2011), enumerating the “core elements . . . necessary for an effective resolution regime.” 127 128 The World Bank Legal Review Notably, Islamic banks and other Islamic financial institutions have been absent from recent discussions on the resolution of failed banks.5 This is not unexpected. Islamic financial institutions are not—individually or collective- ly—sufficiently large or interconnected to qualify for SIFI status.6 But there is no reason to wait for Islamic banks to become systemically important to adopt regimes for their resolution. Islamic banks are not yet “too big to fail,” but they are too young to risk failure.7 Many governments, in Muslim-majority and other jurisdictions, have embraced Islamic banks, but only half-heartedly: they have taken steps to a ract funds through Islamic finance, but have yet to construct the legal and regulatory infrastructure needed to support its sustain- able growth within their borders. This approach has proved passable, but it is neither legally sustainable nor economically optimal. Particularly in Muslim- majority jurisdictions, Islamic banking has the potential to boost economic and finance sector development and financial inclusion. To realize this po- tential, enabling legal and regulatory environments are required to facilitate the sustainable growth of Islamic banking. Such environments must include insolvency regimes for Islamic banks that, like other well-crafted regimes promote market confidence, allow for early detection of risk and regulatory intervention, and impose market discipline on Islamic banks and their coun- terparties, including by necessitating, if not mandating, improved disclosure and contracting practices. 5 Although the World Bank and the Islamic Financial Services Board (IFSB), an Islamic finan- cial services standard-se ing body, have explored “[e]ffective insolvency regimes for Islamic financial institutions,” with a focus on framing some of the issues. 6 Information about the systemic importance of Islamic banks has been, and is, relatively scant. For example, the authors of a 2008 International Monetary Fund (IMF) publication believed their paper was “the first to provide a cross-country empirical analysis of the role of Islamic banks in financial stability.” Martin Čihák & Heiko Hesse, Islamic Banks and Financial Stability: An Empirical Analysis 3 (International Monetary Fund Working Paper No. WP/08/16, 2008). Available literature on Islamic banks and financial stability is based on theoretical models, rather than on “formal empirical analysis.” (Id., at 5.) 7 Uncertainty as to the nature of Islamic financial instruments and investor rights at default has had a chilling effect. For example, the sukuk market was adversely affected by a lead- ing Shari’ah scholar’s 2007 opinion raising doubts about the legality of some sukuk (com- monly described as “Islamic bonds”) then on the market. See, for example, Robin Wiggles- worth, Sharia Boards: Scholars Hold Sway over the Success of Products, Financial Times (May 5, 2009), available at h p://www.ft.com/cms/s/0/91c1636e-3836-11de-9211-00144feabdc0 .html#axzz2UMouSeaW (accessed May 5, 2013). Dubai World’s November 2009 request to halt debt repayments, including payments to holders of a $3.5 billion sukuk issued by the property developer Nakheel, exposed uncertainty as to the legal rights and obligations of sukuk holders in default or other distress. See, for example, Heiko Hesse & Andreas Jobst, Debriefing Nakheel: Wider Implications for the Sukuk Market, Roubini Global Economics, Econo- monitor (Apr. 29, 2010), available at h p://www.economonitor.com/blog/2010/04/debriefing -nakheel-wider-implications-for-the-sukuk-market/ (accessed May 5, 2013). In banking, some Egyptian consumers and regulators remain skeptical of Islamic banking as a result of decades-old fraud cases involving Islamic institutions. See, for example, Flirting with Islamic Finance, infra note 21 (“For many years, Egyptians have had reservations against Islamic fi- nance, after firms like Al-Rayan and Al-Saad stripped thousands of Egyptians of millions of pounds in Ponzi schemes in the mid-1980s”). Specialized Insolvency Regimes for Islamic Banks 129 This chapter advocates the adoption of specialized, administratively man- aged (nonjudicial) resolution regimes for Islamic banks, for the following reasons:8 • Insolvency regimes must mirror the unique features of Islamic banking; profit-sharing investment accounts are discussed as an example of those unique features. • Early intervention and expeditious resolution at failure are necessary to protect consumers, maintain confidence in banks, and preserve the as- sets of failing or failed banks. These objectives would be best met through nimble, administratively managed processes rather than through the courts and subject to generic bankruptcy laws, particularly in jurisdic- tions in which the courts and/or insolvency laws are not suited for bank failures or where existing procedures might lead to ad hoc outcomes.9 • Islamic banking is, where Shari’ah compliance is concerned, effectively self-regulating, at both the firm and industry levels. Self-enforced Shari’ah compliance is appropriate given the relative youth of Islamic banking and the potential innovation benefits of laissez-faire approaches. But because Shari’ah shapes all aspects of Islamic banking, self-regulation must be tempered by robust process-based and outcome-driven regimes that dis- allow the monopolization of information to an extent that regulators are limited in their ability to obtain, process, validate, and act on information pertinent to the health of Islamic banks. Importantly, the positions advanced in this chapter are premised on the view that defining legal outcomes through specialized insolvency regimes for Islamic banks will propel―as a ma er of necessity―Islamic banks, standard- se ing bodies, and regulators to improve existing Islamic banking regula- tion, with much needed policy direction and urgency. Islamic Banking Islamic banking has grown rapidly in the past 35 years,10 reaching an esti- mated value of $1.1 trillion in 2012.11 Since 2008, growth has accelerated even 8 This chapter is concerned only with Islamic banks, and not with Islamic windows of conven- tional banks. 9 In some jurisdictions, bank resolution can be ad hoc, even where the law provides for the regulation of banks by a single authority. For example, in the United Arab Emirates, “on- shore” banks are supervised by the Central Bank. The Central Bank may appoint a liquida- tor and not itself liquidate insolvent banks (which are also subject to generally applicable insolvency laws). Such a framework does not ensure uniformity of outcomes. See United Arab Emirates Union Law No. 10 of 1980, Concerning the Central Bank, the Monetary System, and Organization of Banking. 10 Since shortly after the establishment of Dubai Islamic Bank in 1975. The first modern Islamic bank was Mit Ghamr, established in 1963 in Egypt. The establishment of Dubai Islamic Bank is used as a time marker here given the bank’s comparatively large size, wider commercial banking mandate, and greater visibility. 11 Camilla Hall, Islamic Banking: Impressive Growth Underscores Success, Financial Times (Mar. 27, 2012), available at h p://www.ft.com/cms/s/0/09a99422-7291-11e1-9be9-00144 130 The World Bank Legal Review faster. By some estimates, Islamic banking broke $1 trillion in 2009, from $947 billion in 2008.12 “One potential scenario” predicts that “global Islamic banking assets with commercial banks . . . [will] reach $1.8 trillion in 2013 . . . representing average annual growth of 17%.”13 In the Middle East and North Africa, Islamic banking assets are projected to more than double to $990 bil- lion by 2015, from $416 billion in 2010.14 In Gulf Cooperation Council states, Islamic banks have “crossed the . . . important 25% [market share] threshold which means . . . [they] are competing in the conventional market as well.”15 At the firm level, it is expected that Islamic banks will take near-term steps to achieve scale through mergers and expansion.16 The growth of Islamic banks should be welcome. They have the potential to facilitate financial inclusion, including by meeting the needs of financially marginalized individuals and small and medium-size enterprises (SMEs) and capturing assets traditionally beyond the reach of formal economies. Accord- ing to the World Bank, approximately “2.5 billion adults lack access to formal financial services, limiting their ability to benefit from economic opportuni- ties, improve their health and education, and raise their income levels.”17 In the Middle East and North Africa, a natural market for Islamic banks, “only 18% of adults have a bank account.”18 In Egypt, the most populous Arab state, fewer than 10 percent of Egyptians have bank accounts, according to some es- timates.19 In Indonesia, the largest Muslim country by population, SMEs “are facing a credit crunch,” notwithstanding the relative liquidity of Indonesia’s commercial banks.20 In other majority-Muslim jurisdictions, the market poten- feab49a.html#axzz2UKZvZVYt (accessed May 5, 2013). This is a conservative estimate. Ernst & Young, for example, estimates the 2011 value of global Islamic banking assets at $1.334 tril- lion. Ernst & Young, World Islamic Banking Competitiveness Report 2013: Growing beyond DNA of Successful Transformation, 6 (Dec. 2012), available at h p://www.mifc.com/index.php?ch =151&pg=735&ac=818&bb=file1 (accessed May 3, 2013). 12 Pejman Abedfar, Philip Molyneux, & Amine Tarazi, Risk in Islamic Banking 2 (LAPE working paper, May 3, 2012). Cumulative estimates include both wholly Islamic banks and Islamic windows of conventional banks. 13 Ernst & Young, supra note 11, at 6. 14 Ernst & Young, The World Islamic Banking Competitiveness Report: A Brave New World of Sus- tainable Growth 2011–2012 8 available at h p://www.ey.com/Publication/vwLUAssets/IBCR _Report/$FILE/IBCRReport2011(LR)%20Final.pdf (accessed May 3, 2013). 15 Id., at 19. 16 Id., at 66, 70. 17 World Bank, Financial Inclusion: Helping Countries Meet the Needs of the Under-Banked and Under-Served, available at h p://www.worldbank.org/en/results/2013/04/02/financial -inclusion-helping-countries-meet-the-needs-of-the-underbanked-and-underserved (ac- cessed May 3, 2013). 18 Id. 19 Business Today Egypt, Payroll Potential, available at h p://www.businesstodayegypt.com /index.php?url=news/display/article/artId:39/payroll-potential/secId:3 (Jan. 1, 2011) (ac- cessed May 3, 2013). 20 Jay K. Rosengard, If the Banks Are Doing So Well, Why Can’t I Get a Loan? Regulatory Constraints to Financial Inclusion in Indonesia 1 (Kennedy Sch. of Govt., Mossavar-Rahmani Ctr. for Bus. Specialized Insolvency Regimes for Islamic Banks 131 tial for Islamic banking is strong due to religion-based demand.21 In minority- Muslim jurisdictions, regulators are keen to develop Islamic banking and finance to cater to small Muslim populations and to a ract foreign funds.22 With the growth of Islamic banking and its potential comes the need for substantively appropriate regulation and effective enforcement. An Interna- tional Monetary Fund (IMF) study on Islamic banks and financial stability found that “Islamic banks pose risks to the financial system that . . . differ from those posed by conventional banks . . . [due to] the specific features of Islamic contracts, and the overall legal, governance, and liquidity infrastructure of Is- lamic finance.”23 The same study concluded that large Islamic banks, compared to small Islamic and small and large conventional banks, were the least stable of the group.24 “[L]arge Islamic banks . . . [had] significantly lower z-scores [a stability measure] than small Islamic banks,” while large conventional banks were found to have “significantly higher z-scores than small commercial banks.”25 The growth of Islamic banks in number and size necessitates and underscores the importance of tailored regulation and insolvency frameworks. & Govt. Working Paper No. 2011-15, Harv. U. 2011). 21 Some research has shown a preference among Muslim consumers for Islamic banking when it is available and perceived to be truly Shari’ah compliant. This sentiment was illustrated in an article about an Egyptian consumer who planned to transfer her savings to Islamic banks “after spending the last 15 years unwillingly investing her money in interest-bearing invest- ment certificates . . . [and feeling that her profits were] never blessed.” Sherine Abdel-Razek, Flirting with Islamic Finance, 1092, Al-Ahram Weekly (Apr. 5–11, 2012), available at h p:// weekly.ahram.org.eg/2012/1092/ec1.htm (hereinafter Flirting with Islamic Finance). The article reflects the preference of some Muslim consumers for Islamic banking, as well as their skep- ticism, noting the view of some Egyptians that “even Islamic banks in Egypt did not apply Sharia law completely.” 22 For example, in South Africa, where 2 percent or less of the population is Muslim, authorities are working to position the country as an Islamic finance hub. Xola Potelwa, S. Africa’s FNB Hires New Sharia Commi ee, Faces Regulation Challenges, Reuters (Apr. 30, 2013), available at h p://www.reuters.com/article/2012/08/28/safrica-fnb-sharia-idAFL5E8JQ3OM20120828 (accessed May 3, 2013). Similarly, in Zambia, where approximately 12 percent (or less) of the population is Muslim, the country’s central bank governor explained that Zambia’s relatively small Muslim population includes “ ‘high value businessmen who control a very significant share of the Zambian economy,’ making their exclusion from the banking sector hurtful to the economy.” Other Muslim-minority jurisdictions, such as the United Kingdom; Hong Kong SAR, China; and Singapore, have pursued Islamic finance with varying degrees of ambition. 23 Čihák & Hesse, supra note 6, at 4–5, countering the minority view that Islamic banking, as practiced, for example, in Malaysia, “is not very different from conventional banking . . . [and thus] for purposes of financial section analysis, Islamic banks should be treated simi- larly to their commercial [conventional] counterparts.” 24 Id., at 13–16 and generally. Finding also that Islamic banks—small and large—“appeared to be more stable than commercial banks . . . [a] result [that] seem[ed] driven by small Islamic banks that have higher z-scores than small commercial banks (indicating higher stability), while large Islamic banks have lower z-scores than large commercial banks.” (Id., at 13‒14.) 25 Id., at 14 & note 12, noting that these findings were at 1 percent. The authors indicate a positive correlation between “greater income diversity” (i.e., nonlending-based income) and increases in z-scores in large Islamic banks, “suggesting that a move from lending-based operation to other sources of income might improve stability in those banks.” (Id., at 17.) 132 The World Bank Legal Review Islamic Banks in Practice Four of the bedrock principles of Shari’ah that shape Islamic banking are • The prohibition of riba, a term commonly described as interest but that more broadly connotes the predetermination of fixed and guaranteed re- turns with elements of excessive risk asymmetry26 • Profit and loss sharing (PLS) • The avoidance of gharar; that is, uncertainty to a degree that would obfus- cate or frustrate economic or contractual purpose27 • The avoidance of speculation As to the prohibition of interest, the Accounting and Auditing Organisation for Islamic Financial Institutions (AAOIFI) has a standard on the conversion of banks from conventional to Islamic that is emphatic. That standard requires as a prerequisite of conversion that “[a]ll traces of conventional transactions whereby the bank originated monetary assets and is liable to pay interest for them must be liquidated.”28 The prohibition of interest—the primary measure of profit and marker for managing assets and liabilities in conventional bank- ing—in principle distinguishes Islamic banks in all aspects of their operations. Islamic Banking: Commercial Landscape To compete with conventional counterparts, Islamic banks often benchmark profit margins to prevailing interest rates (e.g., Libor), both in extending credit and in sourcing funding through deposits. For example, ijarah (lease finance) and murabaha (cost-plus-profit sale-based financing) transactions (on the asset side of the banks’ balance sheets) are typically benchmarked to interest rates. On the liability side of the balance sheet, Islamic banks raise funds through 26 The concept of riba is well elucidated, as follows: [R]iba—a term literally meaning “an excess” and interpreted as “any justifiable increase of capital whether in loans or sales”—is the central tenet of the [Islamic] system . . . riba covers not only usury but also the charging of “interest” as widely practiced. This prohibition is based on arguments of social justice, equality, and property rights. Is- lamic law encourages the earning of profits but forbids the charging of interest because profits, determined ex post, symbolize successful entrepreneurship and creation of ad- ditional wealth, whereas interest, determined ex ante, is a cost that is accrued irrespec- tive of the outcome of business operations. . . . Social justice demands that borrowers and lenders share rewards as well as losses . . . and that the process of accumulating and distributing wealth in the economy be fair and representative of true productivity. Hennie Van Greuning & Zamir Iqbal, Risk Analysis for Islamic Banks 7 (International Bank for Reconstruction and Development/World Bank 2008). 27 AAOIFI, a key standard-se ing body, defines gharar as “a state of uncertainty that exists when the process of concluding a transaction involves an unknown aspect . . . gharar refers to the status of results that may or may not materialize.” AAOIFI, Shari’a Standards for Islamic Financial Institutions, Shari’a Standard No. (31), Controls on Gharar in Financial Transactions, para. 2/1 (Accounting and Auditing Organisation for Islamic Financial Institutions 1432H- 2010) (entire compilation, hereinafter AAOIFI Shari’a Standards). 28 AAOIFI Shari’a Standards, supra note 27, Shari’a Standard No. (6), Conversion of a Conventional Bank to an Islamic Bank, para. 6/1. Specialized Insolvency Regimes for Islamic Banks 133 PLS-based investment accounts (discussed below), which often are managed to achieve competitiveness with conventional interest-bearing deposit ac- counts.29 Such practices have not gone without criticism. Both from within and outside the Islamic finance industry, Islamic banks have been accused of mimicking conventional products, rather than providing truly Shari’ah -compliant offerings. Critics often cite the practice of benchmarking profits to interest rates as proof. Some Muslim consumers are skeptical as to the authenticity of Islamic banking products and refrain from Islamic banking for that reason. Legal Landscape: Gaps and Gray Zones Most of the jurisdictions in which Islamic banks operate, including those in which Shari’ah is a source of law, have yet to adopt comprehensive legal frame- works tailored to Islamic banking. Where Islamic banking contracts have been litigated under civil law, results have been confusing and unhelpful to the extent that litigation has not yielded Shari’ah precedent.30 Although standard- se ing bodies such as AAOIFI and the Islamic Financial Services Board pro- duce helpful frameworks, these frameworks are generally nonbinding and are not always timely.31 As noted above, Islamic banks are largely self-regulating where Shari’ah compliance is concerned: substantive decisions as to the Shari’ah soundness of products and governance are made by Shari’ah super- visory boards that comprise Shari’ah scholars who are recruited and remuner- ated by the banks they supervise and whose decisions are often proprietary. 29 See, for example, V. Sundararajan, Profit Sharing Investment Accounts—Measurement and Control of Displaced Commercial Risk (DCR) in Islamic Finance, 19(1) Islamic Econ. Studies, 42 (2011) (hereinafter Sundararajan 2011) noting commercial pressures on Islamic banks to pro- vide “market related returns that might deviate from the underlying asset returns to which IAH are contractually entitled.” In marketing mudaraba-based accounts, some Islamic banks indicate, but do not commit to, expected returns comparable to prevailing interest-based returns on functionally similar conventional products. Other observations on the likeness of Islamic and conventional banking are at, for example, Abedfar et al., supra note 12, at 10–11, discussing findings from Malaysia that “only 0.5% of Islamic bank finance is based on PLS principles”; from Pakistan, that mudaraba companies that “are supposed to operate in the form of PLS mainly follow non-PLS modes of finance”; from Indonesia, where “PLS modes of finance accounted for 35.7% in the financing of Islamic banks . . . by the end of 2008”; and, noting one interesting finding that “while Islamic banks appear to refrain from practicing PLS modes of finance they face possible greater withdrawal risks than conventional banks.” 30 See, for example, Hdeel Abdelhady, Islamic Law in Secular Courts (Again): Teachable Moments from the Journey, 18 Intl. L. News (Fall 2009), discussing Shamil Bank of Bahrain EC v. Beximco Pharmaceuticals Ltd. (2004) All E.R. 1072; Shamil Bank of Bahrain v. Beximco Pharmaceuticals Ltd. (2003) All E.R. (Comm.) 849; Hdeel Abdelhady, The Front Office Generates Revenue, the Back Office Creates Value: Operational Excellence Is the Key to Unlocking Lasting Value in Islamic Finance (ABA & Hawkamah, the Inst. of Corp. Governance [DIFC] white paper). Both pub- lications are available at h p://www.masspointpllc.com/#!masspointnews-and-publications /c17jc (accessed May 3, 2013). 31 For example, AAOIFI’s standard on the important subject of distribution of profit from PSIAs was issued in 2009, more than six years after AAOIFI’s Shari’ah Board decided, in 2003, to issue a standard on the subject. AAOIFI Shar’ia Standards, Shari’a Standard No. (40), Distribution of Profit in Mudarabah-Based Investment Accounts, App. A: Historical Note on Preparation of Standard (hereinafter AAOIFI 40). 134 The World Bank Legal Review Such deficient and sometimes incongruous legal environments breed ambigu- ity as to the rights and obligations of Islamic banks and their counterparties, generally and at insolvency. The profit-sharing investment account (PSIA), a deposit product that yields no interest but is often managed to compete with interest-based deposits, is discussed here as an example of the issues that ex- ist and can arise in jurisdictions lacking clear Islamic banking regulation and insolvency regimes. PSIAs: A Unique “Liability” of Islamic Banks Like their conventional counterparts, Islamic banks rely on customer deposits as a source of core funding. However, Islamic banks do not offer interest or other fixed, guaranteed returns on deposits (demand deposits32 and others), but rather provide nonfinancial incentives to current account holders, such as bill payment, checkbooks, and debit cards.33 Of interest here are PSIAs, which, from the consumer perspective, are functionally similar to, for example, con- ventional savings or certificate of deposit accounts.34 Based on mudaraba,35 PSIAs are of two kinds: “restricted” and “unrestricted.”36 They constitute a 32 Current (or checking) accounts are known as amanah accounts. Amanah, an Arabic term, means, inter alia, “trust,” and its definition includes “deposited in trust” and “a deposit.” The Hans Wehr Dictionary of Modern Wri en Arabic 35, 36 (J. Milton Cowan ed., 4th ed., Spo- ken Language Services, Inc. 1994) (hereinafter Wehr Dictionary). From the Shari’ah perspec- tive, Islamic banks are custodians of funds held in such accounts. Appropriately, an absolute reserve requirement a aches to amanah accounts. 33 See, for example, Rodney Wilson, Legal, Regulatory and Governance Issues in Islamic Finance 41 (Edinburgh U. Press 2012), discussing current account services offered by Dubai Islamic Bank. 34 Mudaraba-based Islamic banking accounts are referred to by some key regulators as PSIAs, a term that is used herein to refer only to mudaraba-based accounts. See, for example, Dubai Financial Services Authority (DFSA), The DFSA’s Islamic Finance Regulatory Regime, available at h p://www.dfsa.ae/Pages/DoingBusinesswithDFSA/IslamicFinance/IFRR.aspx (accessed May 2, 2012); and Bank Negara Malaysia, Guidelines on Musharakah and Mudharabah Contracts for Islamic Banking Institutions, available at h p://www.bnm.gov.my/guidelines/01_banking /04_prudential_stds/15_mnm.pdf (accessed May 2, 2012). The DFSA is the regulator of finan- cial (conventional and Islamic) and related activities in the Dubai International Financial Centre. Bank Negara Malaysia is Malaysia’s central bank. 35 Mudaraba is a form of Islamic partnership between one or more providers of capital (rab al- maal, pl. arbab al-maal) and one or more parties providing labor or other services, such as in- vestment management (the mudarib). Mudaraba generally and mudaraba-based bank products are discussed in AAOIFI Shari’a Standards, supra note 27, Shari’a Standard No. (13), Mudaraba (hereinafter AAOIFI 13), and AAOIFI 40, supra note 31. Mudaraba-based investments also appear on the asset side of Islamic banks’ balance sheets (with the Islamic bank as capital provider and a third party as mudarib). Like PSIA holders, Islamic banks risk the loss of their capital in such arrangements, which raises separate but related regulatory and insolvency risk issues that are not discussed in this chapter. 36 Restricted mudaraba accounts typically are held by more sophisticated customers (e.g., in the High Net Worth bracket). Unlike unrestricted accounts, restricted mudaraba transactions are limited to certain investments (e.g., specific projects, industries) per the instruction of or agreement with the capital provider; thus bank discretion is limited. Importantly, restricted mudaraba accounts are not balance sheet liabilities for Islamic banks. Specialized Insolvency Regimes for Islamic Banks 135 significant portion of Islamic banks’ liabilities. By one estimate, more than 60 percent of Islamic banks’ funding derives from PSIAs.37 PSIAs are generally available to all classes of customers, regardless of sophistication, and often with relatively small opening or minimum balance requirements.38 Funds deposited are pooled with bank funds and invested by the bank at its discretion. Profits, if any, are distributed between the bank and PSIA depositors, according to pre-agreed-on percentages. Risk between the bank and PSIA depositors must be shared coextensively. According to AAO- IFI: It is not permissible for the capital provider to give the mudarib two amounts of capital on condition that the profit earned on one of the two amounts would be taken by the mudarib while the capital pro- vider would take the profit earned on the other amount. It is not also permissible for the capital provider to state that the profit of one financial period would be taken by the mudarib and the capital provider would take the profit of the following financial period.39 Similarly, it is not permissible to assign the profit from a particular transaction to the mudarib and the profit from another transaction to the capital provider.40 37 Sundararajan 2011, supra note 29, at 42. “A survey of [a]nnual [r]eports of Islamic banks in different countries showed that about 62% of total assets of those banks were funded, on average, by profit sharing investment accounts.” (Id., at note 1.) See also V. Sundararajan, Risk Measurement and Disclosure in Islamic Finance and the Implications of Profit Sharing Invest- ment Accounts, Proceedings of 6th International Conference on Islamic Economics and Finance 118 (Munawar Iqbal et al. eds., Islamic Development Bank 2007) (unrestricted mudaraba accounts represented “nearly zero to 80%” of the total deposits of some Islamic banks). 38 For example, Mashreq al Islami, the Islamic banking arm of Mashreq Bank, according to its website, requires an initial minimum deposit amount of AED 3,000 (roughly $816 per May 2013 exchange rates) to open a mudaraba-based “savings account,” the mechanics of which are described on the website as follows: Under the Mudarabah (Fund management) arrangement, depositor (Rab Al-Mal) au- thorizes the bank (Mudareb) to invest the deposit according to the unrestricted Muda- rabah. Funds of the term investment and Savings accounts are invested according to unrestricted Mudarabah basis in the joint investing pool between the depositors and the shareholders and the realized profits from the joint investment pool are distributed between the depositors according to their respective shares in investment. Mashreq al Islami, Personal Banking, Savings Accounts, available at h p://www.mashreqalislami .com/english/personal/accounts/savings-account/#faq-47573 (accessed May 4, 2013). 39 Interestingly, however, AAOIFI provides that “when loss is incurred in one mudarabah op- eration, it can be covered from the profits of other operations, and if it exceeds the profits it should be covered from capital. What should really ma er is the final result of the liquidation at the end of the financial period specified by the institution.” AAOIFI 40, supra note 31, at para. 3/2/1. Shari’ah merits aside, this allowance should come with explicit requirements for disclosures to PSIA depositors and regulators and policies for management and accounting. 40 AAOIFI 13, supra note 35, at para. 8/6. The Shari’ah requirement of coextensive risk is el- emental. For example, in agricultural investment and sharecropping, the “Prophet [Muham- mad (PBUH)] . . . prohibited speculative sharecropping arrangements, such as agreements giving parties rights to yields from specific tracts of agricultural land or specific produce from sharecropped land . . . [and] required that parties agree to apportion the total agri- cultural produce, whether in percentages or by other measures.” Hdeel Abdelhady, Islamic 136 The World Bank Legal Review Owing to their nature and objectives, PSIAs have been likened to open- ended mutual funds and other collective investment schemes. But because they are offered by deposit-taking banks, regulatory classification of PSIAs varies. In the Dubai International Financial Centre, PSIAs are classified spe- cially for regulatory purposes. In the United Kingdom, bank-offered PSIAs are treated as “deposits,” a classification necessitated by the deposit-taking function of the offering bank but incompatible with the nature of the prod- uct.41 AAOIFI describes PSIAs as “demand deposits” in one standard,42 and likens the role of mudarib to an asset or fund manager in another standard.43 In theory, PSIA depositors bear the risk of loss of principal, except in cases of bank negligence, misconduct, or breach of contract. Therefore, no reserve requirement a aches to PSIAs.44 In reality, however, Islamic banks engage in “return smoothing” to avoid depositor withdrawals in response to losses and to achieve parity with returns offered by conventional banks. They do this by various means, including • Maintaining profit equalization reserve (PER) accounts and investment risk return (IRR) accounts, essentially rainy-day funds in which excess pe- riodic profits are held to cover periodic profit shortfalls and capital losses45 • Forgoing, in favor of PSIA depositors, a portion of the bank’s pre-agreed- on percentage of profits (as mudarib) Finance as a Mechanism for Bolstering Food Security in the Middle East: Food Security Waqf, 13(1) Sustainable Dev. L. & Policy 29, 33 (2012), available at h p://digitalcommons.wcl.american .edu/cgi/viewcontent.cgi?article=1524&context=sdlp (accessed June 11, 2013). 41 The Islamic Bank of Britain, for example, was required by the now-defunct Financial Services Authority to offer capital certainty to PSIA depositors as a condition of offering PSIA “deposit” accounts. To bridge the gap between Shari’ah and banking regulations, the Financial Services Authority and the Islamic Bank of Britain agreed to a two-step process whereby PSIA de- positors were entitled, as a ma er of law, to capital certainty at the time of account opening and thereafter could, by agreement with the Islamic Bank of Britain, forgo capital certainty. Andrew Henderson, Islamic Financial Institutions, in Islamic Finance: Law and Practice 54, 69 (Craig R. Netherco & David M. Eisenberg eds., Oxford U. Press 2012). This two-step pro- cess, expedient on the front end, could lead to uncertainty in the absence of explicit, effective disclosure. For example, would depositors’ waivers of capital certainty have been acceptable and effective only upon their having verifiably received and agreed to express disclosures as to the nature and consequences of such waivers? Would the waivers, particularly those given by retail customers, be enforceable against customers in the event of bank insolvency (thus foreclosing any claims to deposit insurance)? Even if yes, would or should public policy tolerate, or allow a repeat of, such an outcome, to the detriment of consumer confidence? 42 AAOIFI 40, supra note 31, at para. 2. 43 AAOIFI 13, supra note 35, at para. 9/4. This original Shari’ah standard on mudaraba, under the heading “Duties and Powers of the Mudarib,” states that “the mudarib must carry out all the work that any similar asset or fund manager would be liable.” 44 See Greuning & Iqbal, supra note 26, at 19–20. 45 PER and IRR accounts are employed to further a common objective, but their mechanics dif- fer. Excess profits are reserved in PER accounts to cover future shortfalls in profit. Funds are reserved in IRR accounts to compensate for losses of principal. Specialized Insolvency Regimes for Islamic Banks 137 • Deducting from profits owed to shareholders to bolster returns to PSIA depositors46 The transfer of profits from shareholders to PSIA depositors is known as dis- placed commercial risk, because the risk of loss is “displaced” to shareholders to maintain a competitive position.47 PSIAs raise a number of issues for Islamic bank insolvency and supervi- sion, not only because of the risk of loss borne by depositors, but also because of the way these accounts are managed. The Dubai Financial Services Author- ity (DFSA) highlighted some of these issues in its comments to the G20 Finan- cial Stability Board on effective insolvency regimes for SIFIs: The structures used in Islamic finance raise substantial questions [in insolvency] about depositor preference and deposit insurance. A common structure in Islamic banking is the . . . (PSIA), which in market terms plays a similar role to a conventional deposit account. It is in principle an investment product, in which both return and principal are at risk, but in practice, banks use various smoothing mechanisms to provide a return very similar to a conventional de- posit and often mirroring conventional interest rates in the same market. Some regulators therefore follow the underlying principle, and treat PSIAs as investments; others treat them as deposits. Views in this area tend to be strongly held, and the situation is further com- plicated by the fact that there has been no legal test of this position in an insolvency.48 In addition to the classification of PSIA accounts, determinations of de- positor preference, and rights to deposit insurance (where available), im- portant questions about PSIA depositor treatment vis-à-vis Islamic banks, nondepositor creditors, and other PSIA depositors must be addressed.49 For example, should less sophisticated PSIA depositors be treated more favor- ably than their more sophisticated counterparts? Retail consumer protection would require this result.50 Should all PSIA holders be given low or no priority 46 See, for example, Sundararajan 2011, supra note 29, at 48–49. In an extreme case, “the Interna- tional Islamic Bank for Investment and Development in Egypt . . . distributed all of its profits to investment account holders and nothing to shareholders from the middle to late 1980s.” Greuning & Iqbal, supra note 26, at 176–177. 47 Sundararajan 2011, supra note 29, at 48. 48 G20 Financial Stability Board, Press Release, Comments Received on the FSB Consultative Docu- ment on Effective Resolutions of SIFIs, DFSA Draft Comment Le er to the FSB (hereinafter DFSA Comments), available at h p://www.financialstabilityboard.org/press/c_110909t.pdf (ac- cessed May 3, 2013). 49 A rudimentary question is whether PSIA depositors are creditors at all, particularly in the absence of bank negligence, misconduct, or breach of contract (events that would trigger different kinds of claims and perhaps render them judgment creditors). 50 Consumer protection and the maintenance of market confidence would justify strict dis- closure requirements and depositor priority preferences tied to the relative sophistication of PSIA holders, using, for example, proxy measures of “sophistication,” such as the net worth or annual income criteria, applied to determine accredited investor status in the 138 The World Bank Legal Review because they assumed risk of loss? If so, are prevailing standards of disclosure sufficient to justify this outcome?51 If yes, would the policy objectives of con- sumer protection and market confidence outweigh a contract-based assign- ment of responsibility at insolvency? In addition, there are insolvency-related issues relevant to return smoothing practices. For example, are PER and IRR accounts the property of the bank, or do PSIA holders have some claim to those funds in insolvency? If the la er is the case, how and in what percentag- es should PSIA depositor claims to PER and IRR accounts be fixed? More im- portant, do regulators understand return smoothing and related accounting and distribution practices sufficiently to isolate claims to them in insolvency? At what point should the Islamic bank’s profit for managing PSIAs be consid- ered realized, and how does this factor into insolvency?52 And do regulators have the information needed to determine if an insolvency is a ributable to negligence or misconduct, which would trigger clear PSIA depositor claims? These are just some of the questions surrounding PSIAs in insolvency. Ques- tions about the nature of Islamic banking and the classification and preference of claims in insolvency are numerous and have yet to be clearly answered or comprehensively identified.53 United States for purposes of allowing exemptions from registration requirements. See, for example, United States Securities & Exchange Commission, Accredited Investors, available at h p://www.sec.gov/answers/accred.htm (accessed May 3, 2013). 51 Typically, parties that contract for the least risk (e.g., secured creditors) are accorded higher priority in bankruptcy. Shareholders, commensurate with their risk and presumed exertion of control, have low priority. In such creditor hierarchies, PSIA depositors occupy a legal no-man’s-land because they share risk like shareholders but have no control and are treated as depositors but have no capital certainty. 52 Related to these questions are AAOIFI standards on the realization of distributable prof- its, including that “realization of profit in investment accounts does not take place before protecting the capital” (AAOIFI 40, supra note 31, at para. 3/1/1); “[r]ealization of profit in investment accounts does not take place before . . . [inter alia] [l]iquidation of mudarabah assets, which can be either actual liquidation . . . or legal liquidation” (id., at para. 3/1/2/1); “[i]t is permissible to pay advance amounts to the holders of accounts before actual or legal liquidations so that final se lement can be made later on [and] [a]fter actual or legal liqui- dation the institution is commi ed to make necessary additions to, or deductions from, the advanced amounts so that each holder of an investment account receives his exact share of the profit” (id., at para. 5/3). As these and other mudaraba standards make clear, a ribution of entitlement to profit requires meticulous and transparent accounting and reporting that is very specific as to, inter alia, time and finality. 53 With respect to return smoothing, neither the size of PER and IRR accounts nor the internal policies governing their management are sufficiently clear. What checks are in place to en- sure that PER and IRR accounts are properly used and accurately represented in regulatory disclosures, annual reports, and customer documentation? Publicly available information does not facilitate ready verification that PER and IRR funds are consistently managed and distributed in strict accordance with PSIA account documentation, articulated policies, and applicable standards. Could PER and IRR funds be appropriated for other purposes, such as to raise firm value or shareholder returns? One study of Islamic banks showed that “Is- lamic banks [generally] yield lower stock returns for their investors . . . but [yielded higher returns] during the crisis [period of Q4-2007 and Q4-2008].” Thorsten Beck, Asli Deirguc- Kunt, & Ouarda Merrouche, Islamic vs. Conventional Banking: Business Model, Efficiency and Stability 21 (World Bank Policy Research Working Paper No. 5446, World Bank 2010). These authors state that the “higher liquidity reserves and be er capitalization [of Islamic banks] can explain the higher stock returns.” But it is reasonable to question what, if any, role funds Specialized Insolvency Regimes for Islamic Banks 139 Specialized Insolvency Regimes for Islamic Banks Insolvency regimes for Islamic banks should reflect the nature of Islamic banking,54 comport with Shari’ah insolvency rules, and further Shari’ah-based objectives for market regulation. In dual jurisdictions in which Islamic and conventional banks operate side by side, considerations of judicial economy are particularly relevant.55 The design of resolution regimes should compen- sate for any general weaknesses of legal and regulatory infrastructure, such as the inexperience or inadequacy of courts or regulators to expeditiously man- age bank insolvencies in the absence of specialized frameworks. In designing insolvency regimes for Islamic banks, it is not sufficient to focus only on achieving convergence of Shari’ah and conventional insolvency rules. Shari’ah insolvency rules developed and applied in the context of single debtors, bilateral relationships, or relatively small groups are not, by themselves, sufficient to inform resolution regimes for Islamic banks. Rather, Shari’ah insolvency rules must be interpreted in accordance with, and fur- ther the objectives of, Islamic legal and historical views of market regulation, which require that regulators be empowered to ensure lawful market con- duct, impose market discipline, promote transparency, and protect consum- ers. Similarly, it is insufficient to examine conventional insolvency regimes applicable only to banks, because Islamic banking encompasses banking and capital market activities. The remainder of this chapter focuses on some fundamental Shari’ah insolvency rules, the nature and objectives of Shari’ah market regulation, and an example from the United States of a substantively harmonized, administratively managed insolvency regime. reserved in PER and IRR accounts could play in such an atypical performance, particularly at times in which PSIA depositor expectations for returns might be low (such as during a financial crisis). Although it is accepted that Islamic banks were not directly exposed to losses incurred by conventional banks in the 2007–2008 period (an obvious explanation for the atypically be er return to shareholders), it is also accepted that Islamic banks typically yield lower returns to shareholders. Such issues underscore the need for robust, uniform accounting rules and practices, meaningful reporting requirements, and effective disclosure. Without verifiable information, the conclusiveness of some empirical analyses of Islamic banks’ performance (however measured) is open to doubt. 54 Regulators need to decide whether to tailor insolvency frameworks to Islamic banking as understood in theory or as practiced, where there is divergence. As indicated above, Islamic banking theory and practice are not always or reliably the same. Presumably, regulators prefer that Islamic banking be truly Islamic, to justify and promote competition with and to secure the benefits of Islamic banking. But regulations must be practical. This is yet another policy question that is crystallized by insolvency considerations. 55 The author is aware of only two wholly Islamic banking systems, one in Sudan and one in Iran. 140 The World Bank Legal Review Shari’ah View: Insolvency (Taflīs) and Regulatory Prerogative (Hisba) Insolvency regimes for Islamic banks must conform to, or be compatible with, Shari’ah rules on bankruptcy (taflīs)56 and Shari’ah generally. But the extraction of rules from one area of Shari’ah (bankruptcy) without consideration of other relevant areas (market conduct and regulation) is an approach that lacks pol- icy direction. This section discusses some of the basic elements of Shari’ah in- solvency and market regulation, which together should inform policy choices on ma ers such as depositor and other creditor priority in bankruptcy. Shari’ah Foundational Principles on Insolvency Shari’ah bankruptcy rules share common principles with what are regarded as modern insolvency rules. The rules of taflīs and varying opinions of clas- sical Shari’ah scholars were articulated not long after the advent of Islam.57 Islamic law recognizes insolvency as a legal status that triggers both creditor standing to bring claims and judicial authority to intervene in the financial af- fairs of debtors.58 Classical Shari’ah jurists recognized both balance sheet and cash flow insolvency, and courts (judges) were authorized to “interdict” debt- ors (declaring the debtor insolvent as a ma er of law) and prohibit the sale or other disposition of assets during the pendency of insolvency proceedings.59 Shari’ah deals also with creditors’ rights and respective priorities, but there are questions as to how those priorities would play out in contemporary prac- tice. The DFSA has highlighted some of the issues: [W]e note that thinking about insolvency in the context of Shari’a law is at a relatively rudimentary level. . . . To give just one exam- ple, traditionally creditors are only those with matured debt, which clearly limits the ability of many who would normally be deemed creditors to take part in insolvency proceedings. One important feature of traditional Shari’a thinking is that all unsecured creditors rank pari passu, which clearly limits the ability to establish a hierar- chy of claims. More work will therefore need to be done to consider 56 The Arabic taflīs means bankruptcy or insolvency, or the “declaration of bankruptcy.” Wehr Dictionary, supra note 32, at 850. 57 As evidenced by Ibn Rushd’s writing discussed here, infra note 58. 58 Ibn Rushd, The Distinguished Jurist’s Primer, vol. 2 (Bidāyat al-Mujtahid wa Nihāyat al-Muqtahid), The Book of Taflīs (Insolvency; Bankruptcy), 341–352 (Imran Ahsan Khan Nyazee trans., Garnet 2000) (hereinafter Ibn Rushd). Ibn Rushd, full name Abū al-Walīd Muhammad ibn Ahmad ibn Rushd, or Averöes, as he is referred to in Western literature, was a distinguished jurist and a judge (qādī) in Cordova. This work is a book on khilāf (Arabic term that, in this context, means different views or disagreement), that is, a “discipline that records and analyzes the differences among Muslim jurists.” (Id., at 33.) It is the equivalent of a modern treatise or restatement of law that catalogs majority and minority views on points of Islamic law. The purpose of the book was, in Ibn Rushd’s words, “for guidance of the (would-be) mujtahid [jurist] in whatever he may encounter of the [legal] issues of this book.” (Id.) 59 Id., at 342–344. “The term iflās [bankruptcy], in the law . . . [has] two meanings. First, when the debts completely cover the assets of the debtor, and his wealth does not suffice to pay his debts. Second, when he does not have any known wealth at all.” (Id., at 341.) Specialized Insolvency Regimes for Islamic Banks 141 how effective resolution regimes can be implemented in countries where Shari’a law is a significant element of the legal system. There may also be instances in Islamic finance where Shari’a may be held to apply to particular transactions even within a common or civil law system.60 The DFSA is correct, except that more work is needed to do more than just “consider how effective resolution regimes can be implemented in countries where Shari’a law is a significant element of the legal system.” More funda- mentally, work is needed to fashion Shari’ah-compliant insolvency rules that reflect the reality that Islamic banks deal with the public and intermediate on a large scale. Shari’ah-based market regulation is instructive in this respect. Shari’ah-Based Market Regulation: Hisba61 Islamic law and historical practice favor a strong role for regulators in se ing binding standards of market conduct and carrying out market supervision. The Islamic framework of government includes the office of the market su- pervisor (al Muhtasib), the mandate of which is, broadly, “to promote good . . . and prohibit evil.”62 Bound by law and possessing delegated authority, the Muhtasib’s function, like that of the modern regulator, is decidedly executive in nature.63 The Muhtasib’s powers are greatest in the areas of commerce and trade.64 In the markets, the Muhtasib is duty-bound to promote transparency 60 DFSA Comments, supra note 48. As to creditor priority, this interpretation is not entirely rep- resentative (and neglects Shari’ah views on market regulation, which should influence in- terpretations as to creditor priority and other ma ers). For example, Shari’ah accords higher priority, assuming certain conditions exist, to parties that have sold or financed property to a debtor but have yet to be paid in full at the time of the debtor’s insolvency. For example, “If the corpus of the thing [the property] itself, because of which the creditor has a claim against the insolvent, has expired, the debt exists as a liability of the insolvent. If, however, the thing exists and has not expired, but the creditor did not take possession of the price (thaman) . . . [some jurists held that] the owner . . . has a prior right to it, unless he relinquishes it and participates in the liquidation.” (Id., at 341.) 61 Hisba derives from the Arabic root hasb, meaning, inter alia, “reckoning or opinion.” Simi- larly, the terms hisāb (meaning, inter alia, “accounting”) and muhtasib (meaning “accountant, bookkeeper, comptroller, auditor”) share the same lineage. Wehr Dictionary, supra note 32, at 205–207. 62 Abū al-Hasan Al-Māwardi, The Ordinances of Government (Al-Ahkām al-Sulhāniyya w’ al- Wilāyāt al-Dīniyya), 260–280, 260 (Wafaa H. Wahba trans., Garnet 2000) (hereinafter, Al- Māwardi). “The market supervision, or public morals office . . . is an injunction to promote good if obviously forsaken, and prohibit evil if manifestly done. As God, exalt Him, says: ‘Let there be among you a nation who invite the good, enjoin kindliness, and forbid inde- cency’ ” (citing the Qur’an 3:104). 63 Id., at 260–280, discussing the role of the Muhtasib as an official office of the state in respect to both public morals and the regulation and supervision of commerce in the marketplace. See also Karen Stilt, Islamic Law in Action: Authority, Discretion, and Everyday Experiences in Mam- luk Egypt (Oxford U. Press 2011), discussing historical accounts of the Muhtasib in Mamluk Egypt (hereinafter, Stilt). The role of the Muhtasib encompasses both the oversight and regu- lation of commercial activities and the oversight and regulation of public morals (related to such ma ers as public prayer). This chapter is concerned only with market regulation. 64 Al-Māwardi, supra note 62, at 262. 142 The World Bank Legal Review and market discipline, ensure lawful market conduct, maintain market confi- dence, and protect consumers65 against unlawful and deceptive practices.66 To achieve these ends, the Muhtasib is required to formulate rules based on practi- cal knowledge of the marketplace.67 According to one historical account of the Muhtasib’s rule-making role during the Mamluk period in Egypt (1215–1517): For all of their detailed rules . . . the fiqh [i.e., law or jurisprudence] books did not offer much guidance on how the muhtasib should identify infractions and punish them. . . . A muhtasib needed to know the tricks [of the market] and how to identify them, and the [Muhta- sib’s] manuals gave very practical advice on how to detect fraud in the various trades. On a daily basis, the muhtasib himself added an- other layer of discretion in deciding how to approach the regulation of the markets.”68 At the same time, the Muhtasib, consistent with the principle of freedom of contract in Islamic law, respected market participants’ contracts, so long as their transactions were understood by them and not harmful to others (in con- temporary practice, this position would support, for example, strict disclosure and the restriction of some products to sophisticated consumers). This brief description of the Muhtasib indicates that the role of the regu- lator, from the Shari’ah perspective, is clear, requiring practical regulation, consumer protection, responsiveness to market realities, and respect for the rights of qualified parties to contract as they see fit. The approaches and objec- tives of Shari’ah market regulation should be reflected in insolvency regimes for Islamic banks. Specialized Insolvency Regimes for Islamic Banks: Administrative Management and Substantive Hybridization Because Islamic bank operations are complex in the sense that they encom- pass traditional banking and capital market activities, and because they offer sophisticated products to both sophisticated and unsophisticated customers, specialized regimes for their resolution should be multifaceted, with banking and capital market components and strong consumer protection objectives.69 65 “Consumer protection was a core part of the muhtasib’s job.” Stilt, supra note 63, at 127, explaining that in Mamluk Egypt, “the [muhtasib’s] appointment decree from the sultan fo- cuses almost exclusively on market-related behavior, indicating a strong interest in com- mercial transactions. From the sultan’s perspective, ensuring that the markets were running smoothly was more than a concern for the average person’s welfare.” 66 Al-Māwardi, supra note 62, at 261–262. 67 Id., at 279–280. “The market supervisor does not avoid reasoning based on customary prac- tice, although he refrains from reasoning in jurisprudence.” (Id., at 279.) 68 Stilt, supra note 63, at 127. 69 Indeed, the post–financial crisis adoption of OLA is testament to the need for timely adop- tion of insolvency regimes that fit the realities of the market and financial firm operations. Arguably, revisions to U.S. bankruptcy laws and processes should have been made in tan- dem with or not long after the enactment of the Gramm Leach Bliley Act in 1999, a law that, Specialized Insolvency Regimes for Islamic Banks 143 An instructive example of such a specialized, substantively harmonized, and administratively managed framework is the Orderly Liquidation Authority (OLA) regime under Dodd-Frank.70 The multiparty and multidisciplinary pro- cess by which OLA was formulated is also instructive because the process of designing Islamic bank insolvency regimes should include Shari’ah experts, regulators, standard se ers, and Islamic banks.71 The remainder of this chapter discusses aspects of the OLA framework, with a focus on some of the powers of the FDIC as receiver (separately of deposit-taking banks and OLA-eligible financial companies) and the treatment of insolvent broker-dealers (also a part of the OLA framework). inter alia, repealed the “affiliation” sections of the Banking Act of 1933 (commonly known as the Glass-Steagall Act), and thereby removed the statutory wall separating banks, securities firms, and insurance companies in the United States and opening the door for their affilia- tion and competition. See Gramm-Leach-Blilely Act, Pub. L. No. 106-102, sec. 101, 113 Stat. 1338, 1341 (1999). 70 This chapter does not suggest that Islamic banks and OLA-eligible entities have the same operations or are exposed to or pose the same risks. It is important to note that orderly liq- uidation is a last resort option available only when it is determined that, inter alia, orderly liquidation is necessary to avoid damage to the financial system and protect public funds from bailout scenarios. Furthermore, OLA-eligible financial entities, particularly bank hold- ing companies, conduct different business lines through subsidiaries. Islamic banks conduct traditional banking and capital market operations via a single entity, and such organization- al differences have implications at resolution. Finally, it is worth noting that the OLA frame- work has not been unanimously embraced; for example, doubts have been raised about the FDIC’s ability to orderly liquidate financial behemoths subject to OLA and the constitu- tionality of OLA itself. See, for example, Stephen J. Lubben, The Flaws in the New Liquidation Authority, N.Y. Times (April 18, 2012), available at h p://dealbook.nytimes.com/2012/04/18 /the-flaws-in-the-new-liquidation-authority (accessed May 5, 2013); United States House of Representatives Commi ee on Financial Services, July 9, 2013, Subcommi ee on Oversight and Investigations Hearing titled “Examining Constitutional Deficiencies and Legal Uncertainties in the Dodd Frank Act,” available at h p://financialservices.house.gov/uploadedfiles/070913 _oi_memo.pdf (accessed July 9, 2013). Views on the merits of OLA in the U.S. context aside, the framework is instructive for Islamic bank insolvency design as a substantively harmo- nized, administratively managed resolution regime. And, in any case, the components of OLA discussed herein, for example, SIPA liquidation and FDIC resolution mechanisms, are instructive as stand-alone features of U.S. bankruptcy and resolution regimes. 71 See, for example, Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System, Study on the Resolution of Financial Companies under the Bankruptcy Code, 1 (July 2011), explaining that Dodd-Frank required the board of governors of the Federal Reserve System, in consultation with the Administrative Office of the United States Courts, to conduct a study of various options for a resolution framework. Multiple federal agencies, such as the Securities and Exchange Commission and the Commodities Futures Trading Commission, which have exclusive or shared subject-ma er authority over OLA-eligible entities, have a role in the rule-making and orderly liquidation process. 144 The World Bank Legal Review FDIC Resolution of Deposit-Taking Banks The FDIC-administered resolution regime72 provides for a number of mecha- nisms that aid in furthering three primary policy objectives: • To maintain public confidence in banks and the financial system • To preserve and, where practicable, maximize failed bank assets and li- abilities by, for example, the transfer of liabilities and assets to a healthy institution (purchase and assumption) or by establishing a bridge bank • To minimize the cost of resolution to deposit insurance funds73 In addition, in FDIC resolution, the FDIC has the power to repudiate contracts, disallow claims, and recover assets fraudulently transferred up to five years before or after its appointment as receiver.74 Importantly, some of the FDIC’s resolution powers (applicable in bank resolutions) are available, in modified form, in orderly liquidation.75 These and other aspects of the FDIC resolution process are a ractive for the relative flexibility they provide.76 In the case of Islamic banks, receivership powers similar to those of the FDIC, particularly the ability to repudiate contracts, transfer assets to healthy institutions, and establish bridge banks (or bridge frameworks), are important, particularly in cases in which Shari’ah bankruptcy rules might limit a failed or failing bank’s ability to accelerate and recover against counterparties that are in default at or around the time of the bank’s distress or insolvency.77 The ability to transfer assets and liabilities to a healthy Islamic bank or to create a bridge bank is also important given the absence of (demand) deposit insur- 72 The FDIC’s role as receiver, and not as deposit insurer, is discussed in this chapter. 73 See Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation, FDIC Resolutions Handbook 81–88, available at h p://www.fdic.gov/bank/historical/reshandbook/ (accessed May 3, 2013) (hereinafter FDIC Resolutions Handbook). Transfer by purchase and assumption (P&A) is the most used resolu- tion method. Id., at 82. 74 The FDIC’s powers in some regards here are broader than those of a bankruptcy trustee under the Bankruptcy Code (judicially managed); for example, the FDIC may repudiate contracts without regard to type, but a bankruptcy trustee may repudiate only executory contracts. (Id., at 67–83.) 75 In the OLA context, for example, the FDIC has the power to organize a “bridge financial company,” the functional equivalent of a bridge bank. Dodd-Frank, Pub. L. No. 111-203, sec. 210(a)(1)(F) (codified at 12 U.S.C. sec. 5390(a)(1)(D)) (Lexis 2013). 76 Generally, a study of the U.S. experience in supervising and resolving banks is worth re- view, as it reveals lessons learned (even if not always heeded). As the FDIC has stated: “The . . . FDIC learned many lessons about resolving failing financial institutions as it managed the banking crisis of the 1980s and 1990s. The number of failing institutions, their varied businesses, and asset sizes afforded the FDIC a wide range of resolution experiences. Be- cause the crisis lasted a long time, the FDIC had to conduct resolutions at all phases of vari- ous economic cycles.” FDIC Resolutions Handbook, supra note 73, at 81. 77 In addition, prevailing Shari’ah interpretations prohibit the assessment and retention of monetary penalties for delinquency in payment (penalties may be assessed to impose disci- pline but may not be retained by Islamic banks, and thus must be allocated to charity or dis- gorged if reflected as income to a bank). Some Islamic banks use positive incentives, such as rebates, to encourage counterparty discipline. See, for example, Abedfar et al., supra note 12, at 11 & note 9. Specialized Insolvency Regimes for Islamic Banks 145 ance in most relevant jurisdictions and to facilitate the transfer of restricted mudaraba accounts to other institutions.78 In addition to the affirmative powers of the FDIC in resolving deposit- taking institutions (and its similar powers in the OLA context), the FDIC, as a ma er of case law and statute, has the authority to deem “improperly documented agreements” nonbinding on failed banks, an important tool for preserving assets and imposing market discipline.79 In the Islamic banking context, imposition of market discipline through such authority would be par- ticularly helpful in light of some of the suboptimal contracting practices that have become known.80 OLA and SIPA Broker-Dealer Insolvency The orderly liquidation framework encompasses insolvency rules and proce- dures for failed broker-dealers, a relevant element because Islamic banks en- gage in intermediation functions similar to those of broker-dealers that provide full (trade and advisory) and limited (trade and incidental services only) bro- kerage services. Some Islamic banks provide investment advisory, placement, and incidental services in various jurisdictions, including in the capacity of a mudarib and wakeel (agent under a wakala [agency] agreement). To the extent that Islamic banks place client funds and provide advisory services, the treat- ment and disposition of some customer accounts (particularly unrestricted mudaraba and wakala) will be an issue in insolvency. In connection with this, the United States Securities Investor Protection Act (SIPA) is relevant to the extent that it provides for an insurance program that protects the customers of certain insolvent broker-dealers and a specialized bankruptcy procedure for broker-dealers.81 In bankruptcy (only Chapter 7 liquidation is available to broker-dealers), the Securities Investor Protection Corporation (SIPC) is 78 The insurability of PSIA deposits is questionable (risk is borne in principle by PSIA deposi- tors), but some observers have advocated for insuring PSIA depositors in some fashion. As noted below, the SIPC’s (privately funded) insurance fund for broker-dealers is an interest- ing model that might have relevance for Islamic banking where nondemand liabilities (i.e., PSIAs) are concerned. As to the ability of regulators to transfer liabilities and/or assets to healthy firms, regulators must have access to verifiable information about other firms in the market—this is yet another instance in which insolvency considerations highlight pre- insolvency regulatory ma ers that need a ention. 79 This is a special defense of the FDIC to claims on a failed bank’s assets. As the FDIC explains: “Like a bank regulator, the receiver must be able to rely upon the books and records of the failed financial institution to evaluate its assets and liabilities accurately . . . unless an agree- ment is properly documented in the institution’s records, it cannot be enforced either in making a claim or defending against a claim by the receiver.” FDIC Resolutions Handbook, supra note 73, at 74. 80 For a discussion of some representative cases, see, for example, Abdelhady, Islamic Law in Secular Courts (Again), supra note 30; and Abdelhady, The Front Office Generates Revenue, the Back Office Creates Value, supra note 30. 81 The insurance fund, mandated by federal statute and maintained by the Securities Investor Protection Corporation (SIPC) (the SIPC fund) is available only to customers of insolvent SIPC members, who are required to contribute to the SIPC fund. 15 U.S.C.S. sec. 78ddd (2013). 146 The World Bank Legal Review authorized to intervene and initiate (with court approval) a SIPA liquidation.82 In a SIPA liquidation, the trustee (SIPC or a court-appointed trustee) is re- quired to deliver securities (name securities) to customers of the failed broker- dealer, to the extent practicable.83 This feature of SIPA-based insolvency reflects two relevant objectives of the SIPA process: to promote continuity in market activity and to protect consumers. Both the SIPA and the SIPA-specific insolvency procedures for broker-dealers are worthy of consideration in the development of insolvency regimes for Islamic banks as a component of a har- monized resolution regime relevant to their capital market functions. Conclusion The story of the growth of Islamic finance and banking has been recounted many times, with good reason. In a relatively short period, Islamic banking has become an international industry, estimated to control more than $1 tril- lion in assets and with stellar growth projections. The potential of Islamic banks to contribute to economic and financial sector development and finan- cial inclusion is well understood. But the full potential of Islamic banking will not be realized without adequate legal and regulatory support. As Islamic banks continue to expand across borders and in size, the risks associated with Islamic banking will increase as a practicality of doing busi- ness. Islamic banking is too young to absorb the shocks of poorly managed bank failures. But it is sufficiently mature to be understood and effectively regulated, including in insolvency. Owing to the nature of Islamic banking and the need for streamlined, expeditious resolution of failed banks, an ad- ministratively managed insolvency regime that combines laws appropriate to Islamic banks’ various lines of business is desirable. One model for such a substantively harmonized, administratively managed regime is the orderly liq- uidation framework in the United States. Regulators, Islamic banks, standard- se ing bodies, and other interested parties are well advised to undertake a collaborative process to develop and implement an insolvency regime for Is- lamic banks now, rather than to bear the reputational and economic costs of poorly managed bank failures in the future. 82 11 U.S.C. sec. 742 (2013). 83 11 U.S.C. sec. 78fff(1)(b)(1) (2013). The Role of Law in the Green Economy Challenges and Opportunities for the Liberalization of Environmental Goods and Services FABIANO DE ANDRADE CORREA The green economy is a concept developed by the United Nations Environ- ment Programme (UNEP) aimed at fostering a transition to a new kind of eco- nomic growth for both developed and developing countries. It involves the greening of eleven key sectors of the economy toward a less carbon-intensive and more resource-efficient development model. It is thus considered one of the most important economic vehicles for sustainable development and a new paradigm that can drive growth of income and jobs with less stress put on the environment. There are two important legal points related to the promotion of the green economy. First, the lack of a binding definition of this concept raises criticism regarding its scope and objectives. Second, law and regulation have an im- portant role in promoting the implementation of these objectives, at both the national and international levels. The liberalization of trade in environmental goods and services (EGS), for example, is important to the greening of the economy and to the expansion of cleaner technologies worldwide. However, the lack of a legal definition of EGS, and of a binding timetable for their liber- alization, hinders progress in this area. This chapter provides a brief discussion of these issues, first comment- ing on the definition of the green economy and the role that trade plays in promoting it, then examining the legal challenges facing liberalization of EGS. Considering the lack of progress of liberalization of EGS at the multilateral level, the chapter presents examples of forward-moving regional initiatives, such as among the Asia-Pacific Economic Cooperation (APEC) agreement par- ties and in trade agreements signed by the European Union (EU). Any statements of fact, opinion, or analysis expressed herein are entirely those of the author and are not a ributable to the International Development Law Organization. Information contained in this chapter draws partly upon work included in Fabiano de An- drade Correa, “The Implementation of Sustainable Development in Regional Trade Agree- ments: A Case Study on the European Union and MERCOSUR,” Ph.D. thesis defended at the European University Institute, Florence, Italy, in June 2013. 147 148 The World Bank Legal Review The Concept of the Green Economy The green economy was conceived by UNEP as an economic model that would improve human well-being and social equity while also significantly reducing environmental risks and ecological scarcities: In its simplest expression, a green economy is low carbon, resource efficient, and socially inclusive. In a green economy, growth in in- come and employment should be driven by public and private investments that reduce carbon emissions and pollution, enhance energy and resource efficiency, and prevent the loss of biodiversity and ecosystem services. . . . The key aim for a transition to a green economy is to eliminate the trade-offs between economic growth and investment and gains in environmental quality and social inclu- siveness. The main hypothesis . . . is that the environmental and so- cial goals of a green economy can also generate increases in income, growth, and enhanced well-being.1 The green economy agenda implies a departure from many accepted practices in key sectors of the economy, recognizing that “business as usual” economic practices cannot respond to global challenges such as climate change, loss of biodiversity, and the remaining worldwide inequality. The UNEP green economy report thus proposes the greening of eleven key sectors of the economy: agriculture, fisheries, water, forests, energy, manufacturing, waste, buildings and construction, transportation, tourism, and cities. It also proposes innovative solutions to challenges that are fundamentally linked to the manner in which economic development is framed and guided by policy makers. The basic premise is that economic development combined with im- proved human well-being and environmental protection will result in stable economic growth. Numerous actors, especially within the private sector, have important roles in this process of change. Governments and policy makers can play a key role in “kick-starting” financing for the green economy, as well as in creating and implementing laws and policies that will guide and support the transition in each sector.2 The concept of the green economy is both ambitious and promising in its aim to promote sustainable development through a new economic model based on environmental sustainability while still providing livelihood op- portunities. In this regard, a green economy can provide a be er alternative for international cooperation in the pursuit of sustainable development than development aid, because the aim of a green economy is to build an economic system that will work for the sustainable development of all nations. At the same time, the idea of a green economy is controversial for three main rea- 1 United Nations Environment Programme (UNEP), Towards a Green Economy: Pathways to Sustainable Development and Poverty Eradication—A Synthesis for Policy Makers (2011), avail- able at h p://www.unep.org/greeneconomy. 2 International Development Law Organization (IDLO) & Centre for International Sustainable Development Law (CISDL), Green Economy for Sustainable Development: Compendium of Legal Best Practices (2012). The Role of Law in the Green Economy 149 sons: there is no clear definition of what it means, its scope being very broad; its relationship to sustainable development is unclear, and it consequently provokes fears that the international community will return to focusing solely on the economic sphere as opposed to the three-pillar model of the former; and it engenders concern that it might lead to “green protectionism” and new conditionalities in official development assistance trade and investment pa erns.3 Despite the criticism to which it is susceptible, the green economy is a powerful concept that was cited by the United Nations during the Rio+20 summit meeting in 2012 as one of the most important tools in the pursuit of sustainable development. Rio+20 renewed the commitment of the inter- national community to the promotion of an “economically, socially and en- vironmentally sustainable future for our planet and for present and future generations,” acknowledging the need to further mainstream sustainable development at all levels.4 The green economy in the context of sustainable development was one of the two overarching themes of the conference, and the outcome document of Rio+20, The Future We Want, dedicates a section to it. Although the provisions of the document do li le to clarify the contours of the concept of the green economy, they address the two main concerns of most stakeholders: the conceptual ambiguity related to sustainable devel- opment, especially regarding how it is to be a promotional tool and not a replacement of the former; and the economic and commercial implications of the adoption of the green economy as a main policy goal, especially regarding the fear of green protectionism and new green conditionalities. The language used is vague, affirming that “we consider green economy in the context of sustainable development and poverty eradication as one of the important tools available for achieving sustainable development and that it could pro- vide options for policymaking but should not be a rigid set of rules.” Never- theless, it expressly states that green economy policies should be consistent with international law, should effectively avoid unwarranted conditionalities and unilateral actions outside national jurisdiction, and should not constitute a means of arbitrary or unjustifiable discrimination or disguised restriction on international trade (paras. 56‒58). Despite these critical issues, the outcome document supports a less impos- ing and more cooperative approach in implementing green economy policies, which are fundamental for dealing with key issues such as the modification of production and consumption pa erns, the transition to a more sustainable lifestyle, and the participation of all relevant stakeholders from the public, private, and civil society sectors. The main challenge is to put into practice policies and instruments that will facilitate concrete progress toward the goals of the green economy. 3 Holger Bär, Klaus Jacob, & Stefan Werland, Green Economy Discourses in the Run-Up to Rio 2012 (FFU Report 07-2011, Envtl. Policy Res. Ctr., Freie Universität Berlin 2011). 4 The Future We Want, UN Document A/66/L.56, UNGA 66th Session, July 24 2012. (UNCSD outcome document), available at h p://www.uncsd2012.org/thefuturewewant.html. 150 The World Bank Legal Review Trade and the Green Economy Trade is considered one of the main drivers of the world economy.5 Accord- ing to a recent UNEP report examining various trends worldwide, the sum of world exports of goods and commercial services amounted to US$22.3 trillion at the end of 2010, growing at an average annual rate of 5 percent between 2000 and 2011. Merchandise and commercial services exports rose from 14 percent in 1970 to 29.3 percent in 2011. In developing countries, the rate had reached 45 percent before the financial and economic crisis of 2008. Trade between developing countries was the most dynamic segment of global trade in the first decade of the 21st century, increasing from 39.2 percent of total exports in 2002 to 50 percent in 2010. However, despite creating economic growth, increasing volumes of trade put additional stress on natural resources and increased greenhouse gas emissions. Increased demands for natural resources by emerging economies coupled with the already unsustainable levels of re- source consumption in more developed countries led to an unprecedented surge in resource consumption and trade in the period 1995‒2010.6 The UNEP report makes clear that to nurture sustainable development, trade must be accompanied by regulations that can facilitate the transition to a green economy, thereby fostering the exchange of environmentally friendly goods and services (including environmentally sound technologies), increas- ing resource efficiency, and generating economic opportunities and employ- ment. The transition to a green economy, in turn, will have the potential to create enhanced trade opportunities: opening new export markets for EGS, in- creasing trade in products certified for sustainability, promoting certification- related services, and greening international supply chains. The adoption of more resource- and energy-efficient production methods as part of the green economy is important in securing access to and building long-term compet- itiveness in international markets. Consequently, a green economy will in- creasingly be seen as a gateway to new opportunities for trade, growth, and sustainable development.7 Yet, while a shift to more sustainable trade practices may advance eco- nomic and social development, a number of important obstacles remain, such as the lack of or weak regulatory frameworks and enforcement mechanisms. Thus there is a role for law and regulation to play in the implementation of these policies, to be addressed through concerted efforts at the international, national, regional, and local levels. 5 See, for example, Joseph Stigli , Fair Trade for All: How Trade Can Promote Development (Ox- ford U. Press 2005). 6 UNEP, Green Economy and Trade: Trends, Challenges and Opportunities (report prepared by the Trade, Policy and Planning Unit of UNEP, 2013), available at: h p://www.unep.org /greeneconomy/GreenEconomyandTrade. 7 Id. The Role of Law in the Green Economy 151 The Green Economy and the Law The promotion of a green economy requires enabling conditions. Interna- tional law, the international community’s main tool for achieving consensus, determining common paths of action, and establishing national laws and regulatory instruments, is the key component that enables the promotion of a green economy. This chapter focuses on both the international and the regional frameworks related to this issue. The rationale of international law as a body of rules and norms that gov- erns the interaction between states and other international actors has under- gone change.8 This rationale can be explained in three different ways: First, international law works as the law of nations, given their interest in following similar rules or applying like standards in their domestic legal orders, includ- ing, for example, commercial transactions. Second, it is justified due to states’ interest in reciprocally limiting liberties so as to respect sovereignty and jus- tify noninterference in internal ma ers; third, and more important, states have found international law instrumental as a means of achieving common inter- national goals.9 This three-fold justification for the existence of international law parallels the transformations that have occurred in international relations and to which this system of rules a empts to respond. First, international law has changed in regard to the actors to which it a ributes legal personality and which affect its functioning. International law is still made chiefly by states and focuses on states, but it has also evolved from a system that merely safeguards the peace- ful coexistence of states to a system that tries to guide states and other relevant actors toward the different objectives that emerge at the international level. Second, international law has seen a considerable evolution in scope, which has expanded from the safeguarding of coexistence and sovereignty to the regulation of common objectives such as peace, human rights, security, and environmental protection. Third, international law currently not only aims at producing legal rules that create obligations through the traditional form of treaty making with binding power and led by states but also works increas- ingly through “soft law” to codify the conduct or opinion of different actors regarding desirable paths to follow. In such ways, these norms contribute to solidifying the international legal order.10 These observations serve to show that international law is more than ever a vital instrument for the international community in its a empt to regulate the globalized, interdependent international relations that characterize the current international scene. International conferences such as Rio+20, with its soft-law documents and policy concepts such as the green economy, should be seen as part of this process. However, lack of concrete progress on relevant 8 Christopher Joyner, International Law in the 21st Century: Rules for Global Governance (Row- man and Li lefield 2005). 9 Mark Janis, International Law (Wolters Kluwer, 2008). 10 Joyner, supra note 8, at 24. 152 The World Bank Legal Review regimes for the implementation of agreed-on policy goals, including those for the green economy, might hinder the advancement of those goals. One example is the finalization of negotiations on relevant trade law and green economy issues. The Green Economy and International Trade Law The development of new multilateral rules under the World Trade Organiza- tion (WTO) can provide opportunities for effective collective actions to solve global problems. For example, the rules-based multilateral trading system can provide transparency, predictability, and the necessary legal framework for promoting the trade-related aspects of a green economy. However, the lack of progress in the creation of new rules on important sectors within the WTO, such as the stalled Doha negotiations, is creating a barrier for the effective contribution of trade to the green economy. One example is the liberalization of trade in EGS. Liberalizing trade in EGS can create new markets and export opportunities and provide access to “green” goods and technologies at lower costs and with greater efficiency. Increased deployment of cheaper and be er-quality envi- ronmental goods helps countries pursue their national environmental policy objectives and counter environmental degradation and climate change, facili- tating the transition to a green economy. Moreover, EGS represents a significant opportunity for development: in 2006, the global market for the environmental sector was valued at $690 billion. This figure could rise to $1.9 trillion by 2020, with the greatest market potential in developing countries.11 Negotiations on EGS liberalization were part of the WTO Doha Round mandate, and the Doha Declaration, in paragraph 31(iii), called for the “re- duction or, as appropriate, elimination of tariff and non-tariff barriers to envi- ronmental goods and services.” The mandate, however, defined neither EGS nor the speed or depth of liberalization to be achieved, making progress dif- ficult, as no international agreement exists on the definition of EGS. A number of organizations have proposed unilateral definitions; the Organisation for Economic Co-operation and Development (OECD) defined EGS as “activi- ties which produce goods and services to measure, prevent, limit, minimize or correct environmental damage to water, air and soil as well as problems related to waste, noise and ecosystems.” However, the lack of agreement on how to define and categorize EGS at the multilateral level has been one of the main barriers to progress in negotiations on liberalization of trade in such products at the WTO, and much of the debate within the WTO negotiations has centered on the identification of specific environmental goods for liberal- ization. Further, despite the Doha mandate to reduce or eliminate tariff and nontariff barriers to EGS, substantial obstacles remain; it is estimated that the 11 UNEP, International Trade Centre, and International Centre for Trade and Sustainable Development (ICTSD), Trade and Environment Briefings: Environmental Goods and Services (ICTSD Programme on Global Econ. Policy and Institutions, Policy Brief No. 6, ICTSD). The Role of Law in the Green Economy 153 average world tariffs on EGS are bound at a level of 8.7 percent, almost three times higher than the average applied rate for all goods, considering full use of preferences, at 3 percent.12 Regional Initiatives for the Liberalization of EGS Regional trade agreements, if properly designed, can offer significant oppor- tunities to promote sustainable practices and be a driver of policy reforms, increased capacity development, strengthened environmental regulation, and be er cooperation among relevant ministries. In light of the challenges highlighted above, and given the relevance of liberalizing EGS trade for the achievement of green economy and climate change objectives in the context of sustainable development, liberalization of certain EGS through other frame- works, such as regional or bilateral trade agreements, can be an option. Asia-Pacific Economic Cooperation One recent example is the decision to begin liberalizing trade in environmental goods in the Asia-Pacific Economic Cooperation (APEC) agreement. In 2010, APEC members13 adopted the Honolulu Declaration, in which they outlined plans to develop a list of environmental goods that “directly and positively contribute to our green growth and sustainable development objectives.” On September 9, 2012, APEC members meeting in Vladivostok, Russia, agreed to voluntarily liberalize tariffs on 54 environmental goods. The Vladivostok Declaration signatories welcomed and endorsed the APEC list and commi ed to reducing applied tariff rates on the listed goods to 5 percent or less by the end of 2015. The deal has been considered a political breakthrough in that it represents the first international agreement to liberalize trade on EGS. The 54 subheadings identified in the APEC list are subject to further refinement as so-called ex-outs (products that can be further subdivided because they serve two or more functions), based on national tariff classifications. The products will now need to be interpreted in the individual national tariff schedules of member countries because different APEC members may use different tariff codes and different product descriptions for the ex-outs.14 The APEC outcome could also have an important and positive “signal- ing” effect on the WTO as well as on other regional trade blocs that want to undertake similar initiatives. While some observers have been critical of the lack of enforceability of the APEC outcome, the voluntary, nonbinding nature of APEC decisions could have been a factor in ensuring a successful environ- mental goods agreement and likely encouraged members to be bolder than 12 Id. 13 APEC comprises 21 members: Australia; Brunei; Canada; Chile; China; Hong Kong SAR, China; Indonesia; Japan; Malaysia; Mexico; New Zealand; Papua New Guinea; Peru; the Philippines; Russia; Singapore; Republic of Korea; Chinese Taipei; Thailand; the United States; and Vietnam. 14 Mahesh Sugathan & Thomas L. Brewer, APEC’s Environmental Goods Initiative: How Climate- Friendly Is It? 6(4) Bridges Trade BioRes Rev. (Nov. 2012). 154 The World Bank Legal Review they would have been at the WTO. Furthermore, given the political weight behind any APEC ministerial decision, it seems unlikely that members would a empt to raise tariffs once they had been lowered.15 Regional Trade Agreements of the European Union Sustainable development is an important principle in the European Union’s legal framework, and its guiding treaties and policies determine the pursuit of this objective at all levels of activity.16 Based on this framework, the European Union has increasingly sought to integrate sustainable development concerns into its trade policy and has been including the liberalization of EGS in its recent trade agreements, which represent an important incentive for these is- sues to move forward. The European Union currently has a wide array of trade agreements:17 28 in force, 9 completed but not yet in force (5 of which are economic partnership agreements, or EPAs, with African and Pacific countries), and several others under negotiation (with partners such as MERCOSUR, Canada, India, Ma- laysia, and the Gulf Cooperation Council; furthermore, future negotiations are said to be starting soon with the United States, Japan, the Association of Southeast Asian Nations (ASEAN), and Morocco.18 EU trade agreements have 15 Id. 16 The Lisbon Treaty reaffirmed this commitment, and in one of the provisions that it shares with the Treaty on European Union, art. 3(3), states: “The Union shall establish an internal market. It shall work for the sustainable development of Europe.” In addition, regarding the external dimension, art. 3(5) states that in its relations with the wider world, the Union shall uphold and promote its values and in- terests and contribute to the protection of its citizens. It shall contribute to peace, security, the sustainable development of the Earth, solidarity and mutual respect among peoples, free and fair trade, eradication of poverty and the protection of human rights, in par- ticular the rights of the child, as well as to the strict observance and the development of international law, including respect for the principles of the United Nations Charter. (Emphasis added.) Moreover, under Title V, covering the general provisions on external actions, art. 21.2 deter- mines that the Union shall define and pursue common policies and actions, and shall work for a high degree of cooperation in all fields of international relations, in order to: (d) foster the sustainable economic, social and environmental development of developing countries, with the primary aim of eradicating poverty; . . . (f) help develop international measures to preserve and improve the quality of the environment and the sustainable management of global natural resources, in order to ensure sustainable development; . . . and (h) promote an international system based on stronger multilateral cooperation and good global governance. (Emphasis added.) These provisions show that sustainable development became a guiding principle of EU policies in general, being granted a place in the constitutional treaties. Further, a “sustainable development strategy” complements the legal framework, establishing priorities for actions and work plans. 17 Agreements that would require notification under either art. XXIV, GATT, or art. V, GATS. 18 European Commission, The EU’s Free Trade Agreements―Where Are We? (Mar. 25, 2013), available at h p://ec.europa.eu/trade/creating-opportunities/bilateral-relations/agreements/ #_europe. The Role of Law in the Green Economy 155 become not only significant in number but also among the most sophisticated instruments used in advancing trade liberalization, market access, and other policy objectives. This expansion of agreements―in terms of number, depth (i.e., the way in which the European Union seeks to deepen economic integra- tion, to extend beyond the traditional removal of tariff barriers and quotas to regulatory policy, and beyond trade in goods to services and investment), and breadth (i.e., the embedding of economic integration into the wider re- lationship with the partner country or region)―is related to the many goals pursued by the bloc through its trade policy. These agreements can be seen as part of the framework within which countries can move toward accession to the European Union. They provide the core of relations between the European Union and its neighbors who are not candidates or potential candidates; they have become a basic means for pursu- ing EU development policy goals; and they are used for accessing markets.19 This last aspect has been emphasized in Global Europe: Competing in the World, a communication by the European Commission’s Directorate General—Trade, which discusses the external aspects of EU competitiveness in the context of the European Union’s broader competitiveness agenda, presented in the Lisbon strategy for growth and jobs.20 The commission, while claiming that “there will be no European retreat from multilateralism,” argued the value of trade agree- ments in furthering the European Union’s market-opening objectives, pointing out that while the WTO provides the basic ground rules for trade relations as well as a framework for ongoing negotiation, free trade agreements (FTAs) can include issues not yet covered by the WTO, including investment, public procurement, competition, and other regulatory issues. In addition, the com- mission referred to the stalled Doha Round, and while it recognized the prob- lems that FTA proliferation can cause for the multilateral system, it defended the idea that under the right conditions FTAs could “build on” the WTO and “prepare the ground” for multilateral liberalization, acting as a stepping-stone rather than a stumbling block. Furthermore, as sustainable development has become one of the main overarching objectives of EU policy in general, trade agreements have progressively integrated the promotion of this goal, includ- ing green economy‒related issues such as liberalization of EGS. The analysis in this section focuses on four EU agreements that provide an overview of how the above issues have been integrated: (1) the EPA concluded with the Caribbean Forum (CARIFORUM) in 2008, the first such agreement to include a “trade and sustainable development” chapter; (2) the FTA signed with the Republic of Korea, considered the European Union’s flagship agree- ment given its deep level of integration and broad coverage; (3) the associa- tion agreement (AA) signed with the Central American countries, the first and 19 Marise Cremona, The European Union and Regional Trade Agreements, in European Yearbook of International Economic Law, vol. 1, part 2, 245‒268 (Christoph Herrmann & Jorg Philippe Terhechte eds., Springer 2010). 20 Global Europe: Competing in the World: A Contribution to the EU’s Growth and Job Strategy (com- munication, European Commission, Directorate General—Trade, Oct. 4, 2006). 156 The World Bank Legal Review only biregional association agreement concluded thus far and among the most advanced agreements in terms of references to sustainable development; and (4) the FTA concluded with the Andean countries, the latest one to include a “trade and sustainable development” chapter, with innovative references to climate change and biodiversity. These agreements represent an innovative form of integration of sustainable development objectives within a trade in- strument, progressively including positive integration measures, in the sense of using trade to promote important goals of sustainable development such as the transition to a green economy and the fight against climate change. These measures include liberalization of trade in important sectors such as EGS, re- newable energy, transfer of green technologies, support for certification, and labeling schemes aimed at making the supply chain more sustainable, such as “fair trade” certified timber and fishing schemes, among others. The fact that these issues can be included in measures aimed at liberalization within the trade relations of parties represents an important building block for the establishment of a multilateral framework regulating these issues, which is currently lacking. The Economic Partnership Agreement with CARIFORUM. The EU-CARIFORUM EPA21 was signed on October 15, 2008, and was the first to be concluded among the African, Caribbean and Pacific (ACP) Group of States negotiations. One of the main changes introduced by the agreement was the reciprocal grant- ing of preferences by the two sides, instead of the nonreciprocal, preferential (duty-free) market access for ACP states, which encompasses trade in goods, services, trade-related issues, and development cooperation, with strong em- phasis on sustainable development and regional integration. The preamble of the EPA contains several references to sustainable development, including “the need to promote economic and social progress for their people in a man- ner consistent with sustainable development.” These preamble references are reinforced in Part II of the agreement, “Trade-Related Issues,” and chapters 4 and 5 deal with environmental and social issues, respectively. Among the measures included is a commitment to facilitate trade in socioenvironmentally friendly goods. Article 183 provides for the promotion of international trade in such a way as to ensure sustain- able and sound management of the environment, in accordance with other undertakings in this area, including the international conventions to which they are party and with due regard to other respective levels of development. In this regard, the parties undertake “to facilitate” trade in goods and services considered to be beneficial to the environment, such as environmental tech- nologies, renewable and energy-efficient goods and services, and eco-labeled goods. Article 191 recognizes the benefits and importance of facilitating com- merce in “fair and ethical trade” products. 21 Economic Partnership Agreement between the CARIFORUM States and the European Com- munity and Its Member States, OJ L 289/I/3, 30/10/2008. The Role of Law in the Green Economy 157 The Free Trade Agreement with South Korea. The 2006 “Global Europe” strategy mandated the negotiation of a new generation of FTAs focusing on countries with high potential for the EU economy. These FTAs would be ambitious in eliminating tariffs as well as far-reaching in the liberalization of services and investment, and in finding novel ways of effectively tackling nontariff barri- ers. In this context, the negotiations with Korea, the European Union’s fourth- largest trading partner outside Europe, were launched in 2007 and concluded in 2009. The European Union‒Korea FTA22 is considered the most compre- hensive agreement ever to have been negotiated by the European Union in terms of trade issues, with import duties eliminated on nearly all products; far-reaching liberalization of trade in services, including provisions on invest- ments in both services and industrial sectors; and strong discipline applied to the enforcement of regulations pertaining to intellectual property (including geographical indications), public procurement, competition rules, transpar- ency of regulation, and sustainable development. This FTA also includes several provisions on sustainable development. In Article 1, the parties “commit, in the recognition that sustainable develop- ment is an overarching objective, to the development of international trade in such a way as to contribute to the objective of sustainable development and strive to ensure that this objective is integrated and reflected at every level of the Parties’ trade relationship” (emphasis added). In this regard, a chap- ter on “trade and sustainable development” was inserted, featuring, among other provisions, a determination that the parties “shall strive to facilitate and promote trade and foreign direct investment in environmental goods and ser- vices, including environmental technologies, sustainable renewable energy, energy efficient products and services and eco-labelled goods, including through addressing related non-tariff barriers.” The nature of the sustainable development‒related provisions in this agreement were thus very similar to those of the CARIFORUM EPA. The difference here, however, was that all of those measures were condensed into a “trade and sustainable development” chapter, which was more specific in listing socioenvironmental goods whose liberalization was to be facilitated by the parties. The Association Agreement with Central America. The AA between the European Union and Central America (CA) is a particularly relevant agreement for EU external relations because it is the first biregional AA to be finalized within the interregional approach to international relations, which was adopted by the European Union in the 1990s.23 The EU-CA AA24 follows a three-pillar for- mat that includes chapters on political dialogue, cooperation, and trade. The AA also has very comprehensive coverage of sustainable-development issues. 22 Free Trade Agreement between the European Union and Its Member States, of the One Part, and the Republic of Korea, of the Other Part, Off. J. of the European Union (L 127/6, May 14, 2011). 23 See, in this regard, Fredrik Söderbaum & Luk Van Langenhove eds., The EU as a Global Player: The Politics of Interregionalism (Routledge 2006). 24 Agreement Establishing an Association between the European Union and Its Member States, on the One Hand, and Central America, on the Other, Off. J. of the European Union (May 30, 2010). 158 The World Bank Legal Review Among other provisions is the “trade chapter,” featuring “trade and sustain- able development” (Title IV), in which the parties explicitly express their stance on the “benefit of considering trade related social and environmental issues as part of a global approach to trade and sustainable development.” The trade chapter also contains trade-related provisions that go beyond the facilitation of trade in environmental goods and services and “fair trade” and other labeled goods, as in the Korea FTA. Article 288, “Trade Favoring Sustainable Development,” contains recognition by the parties of the value of international cooperation in support of trade schemes and trade practices favoring sustainable development, and determination that the parties “shall endeavor to” (a) facilitate and promote trade and foreign direct investment in environmental technologies and services and renewable-energy and energy- efficient products and services, including through addressing related nontariff barriers; (b) facilitate and promote trade in products that respond to sustain- ability considerations, including products that are the subject of schemes such as fair and ethical trade schemes, eco-labeling, organic production, and those involving corporate social responsibility (CSR) and accountability; (c) facili- tate and promote the development of practices and programs aiming to foster appropriate economic returns from the conservation and sustainable use of the environment, such as ecotourism. Article 289 contains specific provisions on trade in forest products, including a commitment “to work together to improve” forest law enforcement and governance and “to promote trade in” legal and sustainable forest products through instruments such as the use of the Convention on International Trade on Endangered Species (CITES) with regard to endangered timber species; and certification schemes for sustain- ably harvested forest products; regional or bilateral Forest Law Enforcement Governance and Trade (FLEGT) voluntary partnership agreements. Article 290 deals with trade in fish products, addressing particular issues and mak- ing reference to multilateral conventions that the parties undertake to adhere to and effectively implement, such as the agreement for the implementation of the provisions of the UN Convention on the Law of the Sea relating to the conservation and management of straddling fish stocks and highly migratory fish stocks; cooperation to prevent illegal, unreported, and unregulated (IUU) fishing, to exchange scientific and nonconfidential trade data, experiences, and best practices in the field of sustainable fisheries, and, more generally, to promote a sustainable approach to fisheries. Thus, this chapter contains not only the liberalization of EGS but also windows of opportunity to encourage trade in key areas such as fisheries and forestry products, which are of great relevance for the sustainability agenda. This approach has been reproduced and enhanced in the next agreement analyzed. The FTA with Colombia and Peru. The Colombia-Peru agreement is an FTA signed in 2012,25 similar in structure to the Korea FTA, but including deeper sustainability provisions, like those in the Central America AA. A “trade and 25 Trade Agreement between the European Union and Its Member States, of the One Part, and Colombia and Peru, of the Other Part, Off. J. of the European Union (Dec. 21, 2012). The Role of Law in the Green Economy 159 sustainable development” chapter has also been inserted, featuring trade- related provisions that go beyond even those of the Central America AA. Ar- ticle 271, “Trade Favoring Sustainable Development,” contains recognition by the parties of the value of international cooperation in support of trade schemes and trade practices favoring sustainable development, and a deter- mination that the parties “shall strive to facilitate and promote” (a) trade and foreign direct investment in environmental goods and services; (b) business practices related to CSR; and (c) the development of flexible, incentive-based and voluntary schemes. Articles 272‒275 contain specific provisions on (a) trade in biodiversity products (Article 272), with commitments to: endeavor to jointly promote the development of practices and programs aiming to foster economic returns from the conservation and sustainable use of biological diversity; endeavor to create conditions to facilitate access to genetic resources for environmentally sound uses and not to impose restrictions that run counter to the objectives of the United Nations Convention on Biological Diversity (CBD); confirm that access to genetic resources shall be subject to the prior informed consent of any party providing such resources, unless otherwise determined, and to take appropri- ate measures, in accordance with the CBD, to share the results of research and development and the benefits arising from the commercial and other utiliza- tion of genetic resources with the party providing such resources; strengthen the capacity of national institutions in relation to the conservation and sus- tainable use of biological diversity; (b) trade in forest products (Article 273), including a commitment to work together to improve forest law enforcement and governance and to promote trade in legal and sustainable forest prod- ucts through instruments such as CITES, with regard to endangered timber species; the development of systems and mechanisms for verification of the legal origin of timber products throughout the market chain and voluntary mechanisms for forest certification; (c) trade in fish products (Article 274), ad- dressing particular issues and cooperation in the context of regional fisheries management organizations of which they are parties, to revise and adjust the fishing capacity for fishery resources, adopt tools for monitoring and control, to ensure full compliance with applicable conservation measures, and adopt actions to combat IUU fishing; (d) trade and climate change issues (Article 275). The measures would include facilitating the removal of trade and invest- ment barriers to access to innovation, development, and deployment of goods, services, and technologies that can contribute to mitigation or adaptation, tak- ing into account the circumstances of developing countries; and promoting measures for energy efficiency and renewable energy that respond to environ- mental and economic needs and minimize technical obstacles to trade. The provisions contained in these trade and sustainable development chapters have been made as a quasi-soft-law obligation, without a precise definition of modalities or timelines. Thus, while these provisions represent a starting point that can be used to move forward with these novel and im- portant issues, how they will be implemented with this very diverse set of partners remains to be seen. 160 The World Bank Legal Review Conclusion The analysis undertaken in this chapter allows us to conclude that law has a relevant role in the promotion of the green economy. International law rep- resents the instrument for the international community to agree on common goals and paths of action, while regional and national law remain fundamen- tal in the implementation of such goals in a more specific context. One impor- tant area, in this regard, is trade law, given the key role played by trade in the promotion of the green economy. However, considering the stalled negotia- tions at the multilateral level in the WTO, the regional sphere constitutes a valuable means to move forward with the implementation of trade and green economy issues. The liberalization of EGS, for instance, despite being featured as an im- portant point within the Doha negotiations, has not progressed at the multi- lateral level. Thus, any progress achieved in this area in the context of regional trade agreements will represent an important building block for this issue to move forward. The two regional initiatives discussed in this chapter show dif- ferent aspects of this ma er. The APEC list of environmental goods represents a first initiative to es- tablish a timeline for liberalization of EGS. Services, however, are not includ- ed, and will apply only to APEC’s member-state markets. Furthermore, it is hard to assess how significant the eventual tariff reductions will be, as it is uncertain how individual APEC countries will implement the commitment and how they will define the ex-outs for which they decide to reduce applied tariffs in terms of their own tariff schedules. The APEC decision, in any case, remains of high political significance, and lessons learned from this approach can be useful in designing similar initiatives in other regional groupings, and also at the WTO.26 The other initiative analyzed, the EU trade agreements, represent the other side of this issue. The commitments in these agreements are broader and would apply to the markets of both the European Union and the partner, thus fostering the liberalization of EGS in a wider context. However, the measures in the EU agreements are drafted as soft obligations without precise defini- tions of modalities or timelines to “facilitate,” “strive to,” and “incentivize” the liberalization of trade in goods and services that might have a beneficial social and environmental impact, such as EGS, fair trade products, trade in certified timber, and sustainable fisheries. These provisions represent a starting point that can be used to move for- ward with these issues, which are fundamental to the transition to a green economy and sustainable development but are also still left outside a mul- tilateral framework. At the same time, most of these measures are drafted in 26 For more information, see Renee Vossenaar, The APEC List of Environmental Goods: An Analy- sis of the Outcome and Expected Impact (Issue Paper No. 18, Intl. Ctr. Trade & Sustainable Dev., 2013). The Role of Law in the Green Economy 161 “soft” language and open-ended obligations. In this regard, a multilateral framework would still be important to ensure coherence and effectiveness in relation to the wider sphere, and national measures would have an important role to play in assuring the implementation of these provisions in an effective and appropriate way. This page intentionally left blank PART II JUSTICE AND RULE OF LAW REFORM This page intentionally left blank Institutional Responses to Social Demands Enhancing Access to Justice in Colombia DAVID F. VARELA AND ANNETTE PEARSON Over the past 40 years, Colombia has made great strides in addressing is- sues related to access to justice. The impetus for change has been multifaceted: Colombian nongovernmental groups have demanded new social priorities; regional social movements have pushed for improvements in the areas of hu- man rights, land policy, and ethnic issues; international legal and political theories regarding access to justice have come into greater focus. The stron- gest institutional response has come from progressive constitutional devel- opments in the administration of justice. Since the Constituent Assembly ap- proved a new constitution in 1991, Colombia has witnessed groundbreaking progress in jurisprudence and pronounced institutional development in many branches of the justice sector. Long-term strategies for the justice sector, and access to justice in parti- cular, were recently articulated in the government’s Visión Colombia Segundo Centenario: 2019.1 A Commission of Experts subsequently explored these strategies to augment plans for justice reform and issued its final report in June 2010.2 Both of these policy documents focus on reducing the barriers that hinder access to justice, rationalizing the use of justice services, and promot- ing wider use of alternative (nonjudicial) justice mechanisms. 1 Departamento Nacional de Planeación, Visión Colombia Segundo Centenario: 2019; Garantizar una justicia eficiente (2008). This document contains the ground rules, the aspirations, and the guiding principles of the Colombian political system, economic model, and social de- velopments. However, all these achievements are just the base that will enable the country to make a qualitative and competitive leap toward the new economic, political, and social scenarios of the 21st century. To do this, it is necessary that both the state and society take responsibility for undertaking a great, collective planning exercise, both medium- and long- term, that goes beyond four-year development plans. 2 The Commission of Experts for the Reform of Justice (Comisión de Expertos de Reforma a la Justicia), was created by Presidential Decree No. 4932 in December 2009. The commission issued its Final Report in Bogotá in June 2010 (hereinafter, Commission of Experts). The stra- tegic areas for review included structural issues concerning the judiciary; the relationship of the judiciary to the other branches of government and civil society; the functions of the Ministry of Justice and the Office of the A orney General; the national coverage of judicial services; tutela, or constitutional protection order, and other constitutional mechanisms; re- sponsibility and judicial ethics; judicial delays; and the role of jurisprudence, disciplinary regimes, and alternative justice. See h p://www.cej.org.co. 165 166 The World Bank Legal Review This chapter looks at the policy of rationalization from the perspective of access, especially for vulnerable social groups. In the Colombian context, the term rationalization refers to the distribution of public demand for justice services among a wide range of traditional and alternative conflict resolution mechanisms that have been developed since the constitutional reforms of 1991. Following this introductory section, the next two sections of the chapter provide background information on how the concept of access to justice has changed in Colombia since 1991. Changes in the way access to justice was defined led to the creation of wide-ranging programs to combat a number of barriers that reduced access, especially for poor and vulnerable groups. The fourth section introduces the concept of rationalization, underscoring the fact that it must go beyond the simple diversification of formal, informal, and administrative options for resolving legal disputes and social conflicts. A pyramid model of dispute resolution alternatives is presented as a conceptual framework for examining the challenges that this proposal poses for the ar- ticulation of the justice sector in Colombia. National institutions and legislative developments have progressively charged municipalities with tasks that the justice sector previously consid- ered national responsibilities. The fifth and sixth sections identify a number of issues related to the delegation of justice services that are not adequately con- sidered in rationalization policies, as currently proposed by the Commission of Experts. For that ma er, these services are not fully discussed in govern- ment proposals that seek to expand access to justice in general. In short, rationalization of justice services from an institutional point of view fails to consider access barriers from a citizen´s point of view, ignores the very limited national coverage of several significant justice operators, and does not differentiate between those problems that can be addressed fairly by local, informal, or administrative justice alternatives and those problems in which rights are not yet well recognized and for which fast-track access to judicial forums is vital.3 Changes in the Concept of Access to Justice The Right of Access to Justice The Constitution of 1991 represents a critical milestone in Colombia’s trans- formation toward a more just, peaceful, and democratic state—a social state based on the rule of law (estado social de derecho). The constitution not only introduced substantial reforms to overhaul the justice system but also trans- 3 This chapter focuses its discussion of rationalization and access to justice on poor house- holds and vulnerable groups, and in particular on women. In no way is this meant to take away from the significant barriers faced by other vulnerable groups, such as ethnic commu- nities, children and adolescents, people with disabilities, victims of the internal conflict, and the elderly. Institutional Responses to Social Demands 167 formed the concept of access to justice dramatically. Features of jurisprudence under the constitution and subsequent Constitutional Court include • Access to justice as a fundamental right • Legal justification for differential treatment and affirmative action to pro- mote equality for historically deprived population groups • Special jurisdictions providing for community and ethnic-community jus- tice systems • Promotion of alternative dispute resolution mechanisms as options for access to justice This conceptual modification made it unacceptable to define access to jus- tice merely as access to the courts or to legal representation via public defenders and legal aid clinics. Simplified and more user-friendly judicial mechanisms were introduced to safeguard people’s rights and interests: a writ to order administrative officials to fulfill their obligations (acción de cumplimiento); a procedure to protect collective rights (acción popular); another to protect the rights of specific social groups (acción de grupo); and a fast-track, citizen-initiated action to protect fundamental rights (acción de tutela). From the public per- spective, the most important of these measures has been the acción de tutela, which can be availed through less formal proceedings, with minimal legal requirements (e.g., the presence of a lawyer is not necessary), and for which a fast judicial decision is required by law. For instance, in 2001 Decision 1195, the Constitutional Court ruled that the right of access to justice consisted of appropriate and effective procedures to determine legal rights and obligations; timely resolution of controversies without unjustified delays; respect for due process; availability of a broad and sufficient range of mechanisms to resolve conflicts; specific mechanisms to fa- cilitate access for the poor; and national coverage of justice services. New Institutional Actors The Constitution of 1991 broadened the range of institutional and civilian ac- tors involved in the administration of justice and the protection of human rights. New entities and institutions were created, including the Constitu- tional Court, the Public Prosecutor’s Office (Fiscalía General de la Nación; FGN), and the Ombudsman’s Office (Defensoría del Pueblo), which includes the public defenders system. At the community level, equity-based justice ser- vices were created, comprising special jurisdictions for justices of the peace (jueces de paz) and the office of the equity conciliator. Under the Colombian constitution, Special Jurisdictions for Indigenous Communities allowed au- thorities in indigenous communities to have jurisdiction within their terri- tories, in accordance with their “uses and customs.” In addition, executive and local government agencies, in cooperation with some private actors, were charged with justice-sector duties to ensure access to national government- provided alternative and complementary services to the court system. 168 The World Bank Legal Review The Constitutional Court and National Agendas Since the passage of the constitution, the Constitutional Court has become a key proponent of ensuring access to justice. Since its inception, the court has taken groundbreaking and progressive steps in making jurisprudence more accessible for the protection of individual and social rights. It has protected the rights of women, forcibly displaced populations, indigenous and Afro- Colombian communities, children, prisoners, religious minorities, the elderly, and the handicapped. It has upheld such social rights as the right to health and the right to a dignified dwelling. Despite some criticism, the court has as- sumed a role that goes beyond the judicial decision itself, extending to the su- pervision of compliance, such that “effective enjoyment of rights” is realized. Access to justice has also been included in national public policy and sector -specific development agendas. For example, it has been mainstreamed in the National Program to Promote Non-violent Family Relations, known as Haz Paz, which addresses domestic violence issues, and has been incorporated into the objectives of Red Unidos, a social protection network created to reduce ex- treme poverty in Colombia.4 As a product of the 14th Ibero-American Judicial Summit Meeting in March 2008, Colombia signed the Brasilia 100 Regulations Regarding Access to Justice for Vulnerable Groups. Through these actions, the state has recognized the importance of access to justice as a tenet of social inclusion and citizenship. Programs and Services to Address Access Barriers During the past two decades, increased a ention has been placed on reducing the barriers that citizens face, especially the poor, in securing access to justice and pursuing legal recourse and remedies in a variety of se ings. In addition to streamlined instruments to defend fundamental rights (e.g., tutela),5 a sig- 4 Previously known as Red Juntos, this program aims to address the multidimensional nature of poverty and has 45 strategic objectives, 2 of which deal directly with access to justice: (1) household members should know their rights and duties as citizens and be able to identify their legal needs and the appropriate justice institution for resolving disputes (i.e., access to alternative methods of conflict resolution are favored over the court system); and (2) house- hold legal ma ers should receive prompt a ention from justice operators and be considered relevant for alternative conflict resolution mechanisms. The World Bank‒financed Justice Services Strengthening Project is financing the first national survey of unmet basic justice needs. See World Bank, Report No: 47338-Co, Project Appraisal Document on a Proposed Adaptable Program Loan in the amount of US$20 million to the Republic of Colombia for a Justice Services Strengthening Project—Phase I (APL1) in support of the First Phase of the Justice Services Strengthening Program, November 6, 2009, Poverty Reduction and Eco- nomic Management Sector Management Unit, Colombia and Mexico Country Management Unit, Latin Americans and the Caribbean Region. 5 While tutela was never intended to be a grand-scale solution to the larger access to justice problem, its widespread popularity demonstrates that reducing barriers created by judicial procedures, judicial culture, and rules of legal representation can improve access to justice. It may also generate externalities for regular cases that are crowded out by the priority al- located to tutelas. The Commission of Experts for Justice Reform recognized the contribution made by tutelas to access goals and recommended maintaining them, but proposed modi- Institutional Responses to Social Demands 169 nificant number of programs and projects have been developed at the national, departmental, and municipal levels, sometimes in combination with other justice objectives or national goals. These programs address barriers such as costs and delays associated with litigation, excessive procedural formalities, difficulties due to language and cultural differences, lack of information on legal rights, and the need for legal advice and representation. Substantial reforms have been made to civil and criminal justice systems. A public prosecutor’s agency and a public defense system have been estab- lished, and the number of public prosecutors and public defenders has been increased. New administrative and community justice agencies have been set up; the number of conciliation centers has grown; and innovative “one-stop” Box 1. Small Claims Courts Upon the request of the Colombian Judicial Superior Council, the World Bank has been entrusted with the design of a management model for a proposed “small claims court system” with jurisdiction over civil, commercial, and family ma ers. This initiative, a follow-up on previous a empts to address concerns over the in- ability of the current system to serve low-income users adequately, hopes to fill a vacuum that the justices of the peace and other alternative dispute resolution mechanisms have been unable to fill. This initiative is still at the inception stage, making the feasibility of the final proposals unpredictable, but it is worth mentioning that an ambitious participa- tory methodology has been accepted by both the council and the Bank. This meth- odology will allow substantial fieldwork to be conducted to create a blueprint of a proposal that subsequently will be validated by other justice-sector participants. The two main challenges of the design process identified so far are (1) dif- ferentiating these “small claims courts” from the traditional municipal courts while minimizing or eliminating any overlap or duplication; and (2) developing a particular workflow that could provide a “firewall” for these courts, protecting them against the litigious practices common in the rest of the Colombian court system, which can potentially transform even the simplest judicial process into a protracted set of motions and countermotions. The international experience reviewed by the Bank team indicates that one of the most relevant features of “small claims courts” is mandatory pro se repre- sentation (i.e., no a orneys should be allowed to represent either party), which would be fully consistent with the small amounts involved, the low complexity of the issues, the low-income profile of most users, and the zero-cost approach required by these users. The optional pro se representation risks converting small claims courts into another municipal court, as seen in the experience of São Paulo State in Brazil, where lawyers seek to benefit from the addition of a new layer of the court system and perpetuate traditional practices. fications when they were used against decisions made by the highest courts in the judicial structure. 170 The World Bank Legal Review programs―community justice houses and victim assistance centers, for ex- ample―have been created, mainly at the municipal level. New types of judges to deal specifically with small claims, land, agrarian, and other rural ma ers, or who can deal with issues in multiple areas of law, were on the statute books for years before recent developments regarding land restitution and small claims courts with multiple jurisdiction have opened the way to innovation within the judicial branch (see, for example, box 1). Among the various alternative dispute resolution (ADR) methods, concil- iation has become the most popular in Colombia because it provides prompt and effective means for dispute se lement at a relatively low cost. For instance, conciliation can contribute to rapid contract enforcement and help solve minor family and neighborhood conflicts. The private sector considers conciliation a substitute for a slow court apparatus; however, because contract enforcement through the judiciary is not predictable, some companies prefer to use concili- ation even if it involves higher costs in the short term. About three hundred formal conciliation centers operate in Colombia, and independent mediators (most but not all of whom are lawyers) are very active. Conciliation services in Colombia are provided via conciliación en derecho (with lawyers as conciliators operating within the applicable legal framework; see box 2) and conciliación en equidad (with nonlawyer conciliators deciding in equity). In marginal ar- eas, conciliación en equidad may be the most suitable conciliation mechanism Box 2. Conciliación de Derecho “Conciliation based on law” is increasing in importance in Colombia. Concilia- tors work in centers approved and supervised by the Ministry of Justice and Law (Ministerio de Justicia y Derecho) and can be located at universities, chambers of commerce, and centers created by private and public agencies. The number of centers has grown from 11 in 2001 to 345 in March 2011. Between 2002 and 2009, a total of 523,232 conciliations were undertaken in these centers. The distribution of the 25,899 conciliators associated with the centers still privileges larger cities. Area Number of cases Percent of total Civil and commercial 39,711 73.77 Criminal 386 0.71 Family 12,061 22.4 Other special cases 1,672 3.1 Source: Ministerio del Interior y Justicia (MIJ), “Conciliation Based on Law” (2007). Information on the socioeconomic status of the clients of the centers is not available; however, based on the fees charged, it appears that low-income groups and vulnerable sectors of the population do not use this type of mechanism. Each center is responsible for submi ing routine reports to the MIJ on the number of requests, hearings, and cases resolved. Based on the data observed, gender-differentiated data are not collected. Institutional Responses to Social Demands 171 for many disputes. These claims include, for example, noncompliance with payment of debts, rental agreements and other types of contracts, disputes be- tween neighbors, and ma ers related to property boundaries. These reforms and new developments have given rise to a considerable increase in the num- ber of justice operators, both formal and informal (see table 1).6 According to national statistics, the total number of justice-sector operators doubled from 16,073 in 2003 to 32,935 in 2008. Table 1. Increase in the number of formal and informal justice operators* 2003 2004 2005 2006 2007 2008 Judges 3,970 4,073 4,073 4,285 4,479 Public defenders 1,015 1,138 1,369 1,795 2,011 2,257 Public prosecutors 3,638 3,640 3,640 3,640 4,051 Family defenders 513 495 513 497 527 Notary publics 613 613 613 613 856 Labor inspectors 179 179 179 179 328 Municipal personeros 1,098 1,098 1,098 1,098 1,098 Law-based conciliation centers 185 216 236 259 286 310 Potential law-based conciliators (Public officers with conciliation powers) 4,786 5,636 6,486 7,334 14,820 Equity conciliators 823 1,862 2,424 3,365 5,203 Elected jueces de paz ... 834 1,401 1,418 1,054 * Figures for potential law-based conciliator include municipal comisarías de familia and inspectores de policía. Source: Departamento Nacional de Planeación, Visión Colombia Segundo Centenario: 2019; Garantizar una justicia eficiente (2008), p. 7, based on figures from the Ministry of the Interior and Justice, the Public Prosecutor´s Office, and the Judicial Superior Council. Understanding the Legal Needs of the Population: Initial Findings Empirical studies of (unsatisfied) legal/justice needs of the population can significantly improve the design of public policies and the delivery of jus- tice services.7 Legal experts and proponents of access to justice contend that examining the complexity of justice needs helps in determining the level of intervention necessary and contributes to the development of sound poli- cies. A full-fledged national study on the unsatisfied legal/justice needs of the 6 “Formal justice” is the impartial and coherent application of laws and institutional regula- tions; “informal justice” is applied by a variety of voluntary persons who seek to strengthen peaceful coexistence and who have been trained and authorized to assist with the handling of certain types of citizens´ disputes. 7 This section draws on the text of Colombia—Justice Sector: Social Assessment (World Bank Dec. 4, 2008). 172 The World Bank Legal Review population has yet to be conducted in Colombia.8 In the past five years, how- ever, empirical work has taken place in cities and small municipalities that shed light on these issues. The Corporación Excelencia en la Justicia (CEJ) Study CEJ released the first study in Colombia on unsatisfied legal needs of Colom- bian households (June 2008).9 The purpose of the study was to learn about the legal needs of poor households (low to medium-low income groups) in the cit- ies of Armenia and Chía, what they did about those needs, and how satisfied they were with the outcomes.10 Underpinning the rationale of the study is the notion that justice reforms should benefit the poor, and that their needs and preferences should inform the design of interventions. Specifically, the study argues that equal and effective access to justice has the potential to empower disadvantaged groups and reduce their vulnerability. The study’s findings reaffirm the common belief that the court system is profoundly disconnected from the lives of many Colombians. Some of the study’s major findings: • There is a high level of unsatisfied legal needs among poor households. A signifi- cant proportion of poor households facing a situation with a legal dimen- sion did not turn to any part of the justice sector for help. The study asserts that lack of access deepens the vulnerability of poor households. Although the principle of access to justice is reflected in the legal system, in reality, the average citizen faces significant economic, cul- tural, and institutional obstacles that constrain access. Of the households surveyed in the cities of Armenia and Chía, 84 percent stated that they did not turn to the formal court system for help to resolve a legally oriented conflict.11 8 This activity is being supported under the ongoing World Bank‒financed Justice Services Strengthening Project (Loan No. 7824-CO) and should be finalized by the end of 2013. 9 Corporación Excelencia en la Justicia (CEJ), Estudio de necesidades jurídicas insatisfechas en las ciudades de Armenia y Chía (CEJ 2008). The study did not assess the (unmet) legal/justice needs of the rural population, for which poverty levels are higher, or how the presence of armed conflict at the municipal level significantly affects access. 10 The study examined legal/justice needs in 13 areas: labor, family, neighborhood disputes, housing, public services, health, education, criminal ma ers, discrimination, debt, identity ma ers, consumer rights, and civil responsibility. 11 These findings are consistent with justice-sector data. Based on a 1997 justice survey, the CEJ estimated that 63 percent of crimes go unreported and that 40 percent of all reported crimes go unpunished. The 1997 survey indicated that people do not seek judicial relief because of lack of trust in the transparency and effectiveness of the system. The same survey reported that chronic congestion, excessive delays, a complex and cumbersome procedural frame- work, and difficulties in execution of judicial orders contributed significantly to this lack of trust (cited in DPK Consulting, Reforma de la justicia colombiana: Informe final 10, 15 (project report for Judicial Conflict Resolution Improvement Project, World Bank, Aug. 2004) (avail- able in the World Bank project file for closed Loan No. 7081-CO, Judicial Conflict Resolution Improvement Project) (hereinafter, DPK Consulting). Institutional Responses to Social Demands 173 • The reasons people gave to stay away from the court system can be grouped as follows: pervasive distrust in the system, lack of legal empowerment to demand justice remedies, high opportunity costs, insufficient knowledge of the justice sys- tem, and a sense that the problem was best resolved outside the system. In 2008, a second study of unsatisfied conflict resolution needs among poor and nonpoor households12 found that the types of conflicts that most affect poor households are related to housing, health, family, and criminal victimization. Nearly 51 percent of households sampled in Bucaramanga, Buenaventura, and Cienaga did not turn to the justice sector to resolve their conflicts. Of those that did, 27 percent turned to the formal agencies (i.e., the judiciary, the FGN, and the police) and 13 percent to the informal mechanisms (e.g., conciliation centers, elected jueces de paz, equity conciliators, and casas de justicia).13 The majority of family-related and health-related disputes were taken to casas de justicia. Only about 8 percent of the disputants sought judicial reme- dies, of which 50 percent of claims were made through tutelas claims (of which 75 percent were related to health rights); 19 percent of the claims were made through acciones populares, and 6 percent through class action suits. The study compared the conflict resolution needs of poor households with those of nonpoor households, as well as the steps taken to resolve such conflicts. Of those households sampled, the study found that poor households were most likely to suffer from an unsatisfied need, and at the same time the most likely to turn to the formal or informal justice sector, in spite of their lack of confidence in sector authorities. In addition, poor households reported a higher level of vulnerability in terms of crime and victimization than nonpoor households.14 A major source of confusion for users is the classification of particular operators or programs as “formal” or “informal,” because several cross a com- monly held but poorly conceived divider line and thereby play an important bridging or complementary role. Furthermore, such titles imply a separation involving a capacity or quality judgment, which is confusing for the public and counterproductive for the justice system. A second ma er of concern as one considers the growing dimension of the conciliation field is the persistent lack of precision in the number and distribu- tion of active equity conciliators and jueces de paz. The difficulties inherent in sustaining voluntary community justice services and subsidiary responsibili- ties assigned to busy public servants belie what appears to be a very strong 12 Fedesarrollo, desarrollo de una metodología para la identificación de necesidades insatisfechas de reso- lución de conflictos (2008). 13 For a description of each such informal justice mechanism, see Colombia–Justice Sector: Social Assessment, supra note 8. 14 The findings of the two studies coincide with national-level studies conducted by the Na- tional Planning Department that revealed high levels of victimization but low levels of resort to the courts for redress. See DPK Consulting, supra note 11. 174 The World Bank Legal Review presence throughout the country. Indeed, a complete list of justice and conflict resolution instances and operators is not available.15 While there has been a significant increase in the number and the types of justice operators, there has also been significant concentration, principally in the main towns and cities of Colombia. The constitution and legislation guar- antee the presence of basic judicial authorities (judges, public prosecutors, and public defenders) in every municipality; however, budget deficits; numerous, spatially dispersed, smaller towns, with meager populations (which implies a very low cost/benefit ratio); and poor security conditions (due to ongoing armed conflict and organized crime) have led to less than full compliance. To help remedy these problems, the Consejo Superior de la Judicatura has set up Judicial Units for Municipalities, which provide criminal justice services by sharing justice personnel among several towns. Eighty-one such units were operating and were providing services to 251 municipalities in 2008. Other national justice institutions have distributed their human resources based on similar criteria, but these were not necessarily in strict alignment with the ju- dicial capacity. However, entities such as the Forensic Medicine Institute and family defenders are so few in number that there is no alternative but to reas- sign their tasks to other local officials. This creates enormous challenges at the municipal and community levels. Besides the lack of personnel in many parts of the country and the uncer- tainty of the justice services available in any particular place, the absence of an articulated justice-system model hinders effective access to justice. Such a model would identify, connect, and activate the potential of multiple justice operators and programs in any particular location and seek to ensure their interaction in a coherent and collaborative system. Local Justice Services Provision: Two Mechanisms in Need of Rationalization As a result of the constitutional provisions for strengthening local govern- ments, responsibility for the delivery of several types of justice services has increasingly been delegated to municipalities. For example, the Ministry of Justice calls on mayors to promote community conciliator programs, set up municipal conciliation centers, and elect jueces de paz using municipal budgets. Also coming under the responsibility of local governments have been entities that facilitate the initial response (at least) to conflict resolution and peace- ful coexistence requirements in family ma ers, disputes between neighbors, the use of public grounds and facilities, and protection against human rights abuses and environmental problems. These entities include the casas de justicia, centros de convivencia, comisarías de familia, inspectores de policía–personerías. The 15 The World Bank‒financed Justice Services Strengthening Project for Colombia (Loan No. 7824-CO) is also financing regular updates to the Justice Ministry’s “justice map,” which is meant to reflect the full range of providers of justice services. Institutional Responses to Social Demands 175 Box 3. Casas de Justicia The casas de justicia are multiagency venues that provide information on rights, legal advice, and conflict resolution services. A variety of conciliation op- tions are offered, together with administrative and some formal justice services (Decree 1447 of 2000). Since 1995, the Ministry of the Interior and Justice, with sup- port from USAID, has constructed a system of casas de justicia comprising some 81 houses. Originally designed for cities with populations in excess of 100,000, casas de justicia provide rapid solutions to everyday interpersonal disputes and neigh- borhood conflicts. Other issues they address include personal identity verifica- tion, domestic and sexual violence, and criminal cases of lesser gravity. Services for displaced populations are also provided, and ma ers of institutional abuse are considered. Since 2005, a regional model―consisting of a main justice house in a me- dium-sized municipality and satellite houses in neighboring, much-smaller towns― has been developed to reach municipalities in zones severely affected by armed conflict. As many as 20 of the new justice houses have adopted this model, seeking to cooperate with government efforts to reestablish a state presence in such territories. Many of the new facilities will serve Afro-Colombian and indig- enous communities in rural-conflict and post conflict situations, a critical step for achieving peace in Colombia. The purpose of the casas de justicia is to facilitate “one-stop” access to legal help for poor people in marginalized or conflictive neighborhoods, and to pro- mote peaceful-dispute resolution and social cohesion. Although they vary in de- sign, casas de justicia incorporate local prosecutors, public defenders, municipal human rights officers, municipal neighborhood affairs units, comisarías de familia, legal aid specialists, social workers, and psychologists in a variety of conciliation services. Many justice houses also include other entities such as nongovernmen- tal women’s organizations, youth mediation services, children’s playrooms, and university law clinics, and personnel such as forensic doctors, community police officers, and representatives for ethnic-communities. Casas de justicia eliminate or reduce common access barriers and bring justice closer to the people, both physically and culturally. Procedures are free of charge, easy to arrange, and informal. Legal representation (having a lawyer present) is not required. Disputes are resolved in a timely manner. However, the sustain- ability of the houses is dependent on the continued participation of various insti- tutions from the justice sector, some of which have insufficient staff to assign to small town projects; municipal political will to assume justice and conflict resolu- tion commitments;, and municipal budgets for justice services. Unfortunately, all of these factors are compounded when justice houses are located in small, war- torn areas. 176 The World Bank Legal Review Children and Adolescent Code of 2006, for example, requires municipal op- erators to play a subsidiary role in towns where there is no family defender.16 Similar legislation also calls on municipal operators when forensic medical staff and judicial police are not on hand in small municipalities. These municipal-based programs provide access to justice for many peo- ple, but simply calling for an increase in their use, or for an expansion of the programs countrywide, is not a sound measure for improving access. Policy makers must develop a be er understanding of the benefits and current chal- lenges from the perspectives both of the users of these systems and of the local governments in charge of service delivery. By way of example, this section provides an overview of the opportunities and challenges of the national jus- tice houses (casas de justicia) program and equity, or community, conciliators (conciliadores en equidad) (see boxes 3 and 4). Decentralized delivery of justice services can be an important mechanism to expand access, especially in terms of extending national coverage to smaller municipalities and towns located in rural conflict areas. It also can help elimi- nate or reduce barriers to justice by providing services that are culturally and physically accessible and responsive to the needs of the community. How- ever, these benefits are compromised by structural problems that limit impact, such as unclear roles or overlapping jurisdictional responsibilities, insufficient or ineffective institutional coordination, reduced number of professionals pre- pared to live and work in many municipalities, lack of training and opera- tional capacity, absence of quality controls, and undue political influence in appointments, all coupled with severe municipal and departmental budget limitations.17 Can the Use of Justice Services Be Rationalized? The Proposed Strategy to Address Access Issues The Commission of Experts for Justice Reform promoted rationalization as part of a policy approach to deal with the crisis of judicial congestion and case backlogs, which has worsened in the face of increasing demand for court services. Congestion in the system contributes to delays in the se lement of disputes, sluggish response times, higher transaction costs, and widespread dissatisfaction with the delivery of justice services. To deal with this problem, the commission proposed an interlinked strategy that included the develop- ment of a strategic modernization plan, new procedural codes with an urgent 16 Article 98 of the code assigns municipal operators these responsibilities, which normally belong to family defenders. 17 There are exceptions that should be noted, such as the undertakings of the Antioquia state government, 2008‒2011, which has trained community conciliators, supported the creation of municipal family disputes officers (comisarías de familia), and built nine casas de justicia. Efforts made by larger cities such as Bogotá and Medellín are also noteworthy. Institutional Responses to Social Demands 177 Box 4. Equity (Community) Conciliators Conciliación en equidad (equity conciliation) is a community justice mechanism whereby an impartial third party, called the equity conciliator, helps his or her fellow community members solve their everyday types of conflicts. Agreements reached are recorded in a document called the Acta de conciliación en equidad, which has the same effect as a judicial ruling. Both law-based and equity-conciliation options are legally regulated and are recognized as an alternative form of conflict resolution by Law 23 of 1991 and Law 446 of 1998. A network of community mediators and equity conciliators has been established that receives support from civil society organizations such as Red de Justicia Comunitaria (Community Justice Network). Equity conciliation was first created as a tool to reduce the caseload of the judicial sector but has since been appreciated as having an important role in conflict trans- formation and community development, especially in remote geographical areas. In Decision C-893 2001, the Constitutional Court stated, “equity conciliation enhances de- mocracy because it prevents conflict, strengthens the justice system, and allows people to actively participate in the solution of their own conflicts.”18 In certain contexts, the legitimacy of equity conciliators comes from the legal framework, and in other places, from the community itself and community-based conflict resolution practices that are based on community knowledge and traditions. Although more than 5,800 equity conciliators have been trained, an undeter- mined, lower number of those remain active.19 According to a USAID evaluation, the reasons given for these desertions include “displacement by the armed conflict, ab- sence of technical assistance by the Ministry of the Interior and Justice, lack of sup- port by municipal governments, abandonment by NGOs and other supporting institu- tions, low motivation due to the lack of institutional incentives, and poor promotion of the practice in the host communities.”20 In some areas, an additional obstacle to the successful development of a conciliation program is the insufficient integration of conciliation practices with community traditions and practices.21 The community and voluntary nature of the function makes it difficult to adequately monitor and evalu- ate their work. To address this issue, some observers have proposed the use of local coordination points. Such points could include casas de justicia, centros de convivencia, community councils, municipal offices, or any other central point within the commu- nity. A different initiative in this same direction is a national call center in Bogotá that provides advice and information to conciliators and endeavors to obtain copies of the agreements (actas) that result from the conciliators´ activities. 18 For a grassroots analysis of the impact of equity conciliation and challenges faced, see Maria Lucia Zapata, Peacebuilding from the Grassroots: Equity Conciliation and Conflict Transformation in Colombia (Mar. 2008), available at h p://www.beyondintractability.org/casestudy/zapata -peacebuilding. 19 While community conciliators are trained and certified under the supervision of the Minis- try of Justice, it is nearly impossible to know at any given point how many of those trained remain active. In its 2009 report to Congress, the ministry reported that 5,700 community conciliators were present in more than 230 municipalities. See Ministry of Justice, Annual Report to Congress (2009). 20 Checchi and Company Consulting, Inc., Colombia Administration of Justice Program, Final Re- port 16 (Sept. 2006). 21 See Zapata, supra note 18. 178 The World Bank Legal Review focus on the civil procedural code, use of new technologies, rationalization of the use of a wide range of justice services, and a short-term emergency plan to reduce the case backlog.22 The assumption is that rationalization would enable the judicial system to be er respond to demand by, first, filtering certain types of cases to out-of- court forums based on the principle that not all disputes require the interven- tion of a judge and not all clients are best served by judicial procedures, and, second, promoting greater use of alternative justice mechanisms.23 In its re- port, the commission identified two main benefits (outcomes) of such a policy approach: less litigation and consequently a reduction in the number of cases filed; and be er outcomes and access for users because of less delay, cost, and procedural formalities associated with ADR.24 The key aspect of rationalization is greater use of out-of-court ADR fa- cilities. For the commission, this means greater promotion of the benefits of ADR in general, and greater use of conciliation centers; administrative mecha- nisms for dispute resolution, including those available at the Defensoría del Pueblo, the Procuraduría General de la Nación (PGN), the Instituto de Bien- estar Familiar (Law 640, 1991); community-level equity conciliation processes (Law 23, 1991); arbitration; and an expanded use of the notary publics when the ma er at hand is not a dispute or when no legal rights are at stake. In es- sence, the commission envisions an extreme effect of rationalization via ADR with the court system as the last resort for conflict resolution.25 However, while the National Planning Department’s Visión Colombia Segundo Centena- rio: 2019 supports rationalization, it places greater weight on other issues that should be factored into rationalization policies, namely, the need to promote social harmony and peaceful coexistence. Filtering the demand for judicial services can potentially have important efficiency gains, improve access to justice, and support long-term peace build- ing. Rationalization policies, however, must go beyond the simple diversifica- tion and growing national coverage of formal, informal, and administrative options for legal decisions and conflict resolution services. If this is to serve access to justice goals, it must also focus on the conflict resolution needs of people in large cities, small towns, rural areas, and socially disadvantaged groups. The studies by Corporación Excelencia en la Justicia and Fedesarrollo identified five characteristics related to unsatisfied conflict resolution and le- gal needs in Colombian municipalities. First, poorer social classes need in- formation and advice, offered freely, by local institutions to help understand their rights and decide how best to deal with their legal needs and conflicts. 22 Commission of Experts, supra note 2, at 64‒66. 23 L. 446, 1998, art. 65, and L. 640, 2001, art. 19, regulate ma ers amenable to conciliation. 24 Commission of Experts, supra note 2, at 71. 25 Id., at 129. Institutional Responses to Social Demands 179 Second, citizens are more likely to consult lawyers who are part of an institu- tion they trust, especially if this service is free or considered inexpensive. Such consultations occur most frequently in connection with family problems and criminal ma ers. Third, vulnerable population groups living in poverty condi- tions are more likely to seek help in solving their legal problems if the barriers limiting access and procedures prolonging solutions are reduced. Fourth, the judicial system is not a first option for the poor when resolving conflicts, al- though the poor will seek assistance if they know it is available. They look for help most frequently in informal and administrative se ings. Fifth, negative Figure 1. Pyramid model for articulating dispute processing options 180 The World Bank Legal Review perceptions of the justice system are long-standing, as the first National Justice Survey in 1997 demonstrated and more recent studies confirm. Poor citizens are especially dissuaded by these perceptions and avoid using institutional mechanisms to resolve their conflicts. Several experts on access to justice advocate a model known as “the pyra- mid of dispute resolution” (see figure 1).26 The broad base of the pyramid is made up of an array of interpersonal and social options for dealing with dis- putes between equals. Entities such as jueces de paz, equity conciliators, neigh- borhood action boards (juntas de acción comunal), family counselors, church leaders, and community elders are located at this level. As one ascends the pyramid, levels offer processes that become more formal, more grounded in legal precepts, and more institutionally controlled. Comisarías de familia, con- ciliation centers, university law clinics, casas de justicia, local human rights of- ficers (personerías), and administrative agencies are located farther upward in the pyramid. The top tier and more formal levels include the judicial struc- ture, entities responsible for investigation and collecting evidence for victim and witness protection, and arbitration centers. If this pyramid model accurately reflects the desirable distribution of con- flict resolution options in a society that does not give priority to litigation in citizens’ disputes and differences, a great deal more a ention and resources need to be directed by the state toward developing a culture of dialogue and conciliation. The notion of the pyramid and its broad base helps identify many institutional challenges at the informal levels, which are the least consolidated and documented, yet are the preferred choices of many citizens. If the vast majority of conflicts are to be dealt with by community justice processes and equity-based and conciliatory justice services, considerable effort must be made to provide adequate training opportunities, ongoing technical support, basic standards for quality control, and, when necessary, appropriate disci- plinary actions to maintain credibility, fairness, and a sense of justice, The development of an inclusive pyramid model for dispute resolution will require detailed proposals to address the link between ADR mechanisms and community justice options within the judicial system. From an organiza- tional perspective, the model demands a thoughtful and concerted interin- stitutional access to justice policy building and calls for a rethinking of how Colombian justice entities currently envision their role concerning their spe- cific functions in promoting social harmony and peaceful coexistence in mu- nicipalities and certain territorial regions. A major challenge for establishing such a model in Colombia is the weak link between ADR, on one side, and municipal and community justice options and the courts, on the other. Because the success of rationalization rests in large part on a system of nonjudicial mechanisms or ADR, it is critical to ask 26 R. Uprimny et al., Justicia para todos? Sistema judicial, derechos sociales y democracia en Colombia 252 (Grupo Editorial Norma 2006); and B. Sousa Santos & M. Garcia, El caleidoscopio de las justicias en Colombia 123–32 (Siglo del Hombre Editores 2001). Institutional Responses to Social Demands 181 basic questions about ADR itself. Are the different ADR mechanisms meeting the conflict resolution needs of citizens? Are they improving access to justice, particularly for the poor and other vulnerable groups? How can these services ensure follow-up of agreements to verify compliance, and what steps should be taken by whom when this is not the case? Programs such as municipal justice houses provide a venue for integrat- ing legal advice and municipal and community justice services with public prosecutors and public defenders; however, a clear path upward to the courts for cases that cannot be se led or resolved by such entities as justice houses has yet to be traced. Since this program plays a bridging role across alterna- tive and formal justice options, it presents an ideal opportunity to apply the pyramid model and test rationalization approaches. If the Center for Decen- tralizing Judicial Services, a pilot project under way with support from the Colombian Judicial Superior Council in the Ciudad Bolívar section of Bogotá, achieves its goal of linking lower-level courts directly to the justice houses, a breakthrough may be seen. A rationalization policy would need to resolve ambiguities along the spectrum of informal-to-formal and be er develop the roles and responsibili- ties across different levels. To accomplish this, the following issues need to be explored: identifying circumstances that warrant greater legal rigor; develop- ing clearer paths for cases that cannot be se led or resolved through primary justice mechanisms to move upward or across to other options; and improving the quality of and coordination between operators and organizations on the bo om tiers while maintaining people’s direct participation and the inherent organizational flexibility and simplicity that make community options work;27 and arranging appropriate forms of institutional support and oversight. The justice house program would be located midway up the pyramid, in- tegrating lower-level community justice services with municipal admin- istrative options and the first echelons of potential judicial proceedings. Community conciliators, however, are one of the first points of contact for many people, especially in rural and marginalized urban areas. Plo ing their positions on the dispute resolution pyramid immediately suggests necessary lines of articulation, both horizontally and vertically, which presently are not clearly established. Rather, duplication and confusion between the roles of equity conciliators and jueces de paz are common complaints. Interaction of justice houses and conciliators with municipal judges is presently a largely unmapped territory. A plethora of legislation, municipal decrees, and national program regulations have assigned functions, responsibilities, and conditions to an 27 Community options work when they are appropriated from and have direct effect on the community. When “national institutions” want to exercise control, ways must be found to improve quality and coordination at the community level while still maintaining the inher- ent local and voluntary characteristics of the community. Too much vertical institutional control can restrict community justice initiatives to the point that they cease to work. 182 The World Bank Legal Review ever-widening range of new justice operators, as if the policy were “the more the be er.” This situation has given rise to duplication, uncertainty in terms of accountability, and weak controls regarding quality, consistency, and eth- ics. It also has created obstacles for the coordination of services. Justice-sector leaders are aware of these challenges, some of which may be partly inevitable in light of constitutional developments and other ADR initiatives. However, twenty years after the reform of the constitution, there are no conceptual mod- els or operational protocols that integrate the multitude of formal and infor- mal justice innovations to promote user convenience or institutional efficiency. What makes these considerations all the more concerning is the fact that the variety of justice services located along the pyramid model are rarely ac- cessible in the majority of Colombian towns. Citizens must find entry wher- ever they can or travel to larger municipalities to seek other services. New technologies could help to fill the gaps and shorten the distances, since Inter- net access is definitely more widespread than justice operators. Beyond such novel strategies, regenerating a law-based culture, access- ing legitimate administrative justice institutions, and overcoming the popular perception of costly, time-consuming, incomprehensible legal practices that lead to unpredictable judicial decisions call for focused and strong affirmative action by the state to return justice options to war-stricken or otherwise less- than-lawful Colombian municipalities (see box 5). Box 5. Local Justice Systems in Municipalities in War-Torn Areas of Colombia Since 2004, the Colombian national government has strived to regain military con- trol in 11 states seriously affected by the presence, and in some cases dominance, of illegal armed groups. Many of these areas have a history of a very limited state presence, which has been seriously undermined by internal armed conflict. An initial predominantly military intervention in these “consolidation zones” has gradually given way to a wider institutional intervention. In 2013, led by the Presidential Agency for Territorial Consolidation (the Unidad Administrativa de Consolidación Territorial, UACT), 58 municipalities will be involved in the con- solidation efforts. In 2011, the Ministry of Justice and Law funded an analysis of the adminis- tration of justice in these regions, which gave rise to a proposal to develop “local justice systems” that recognize formal, informal, and administrative justice opera- tors in meeting the need to strengthen the presence of these entities. Recognized as part of the UACT´s actions, this justice-strengthening approach has a territorial vision that reaches beyond the urban center and places more importance on rural se lements and populations. This proposal seeks to reduce justice barriers and improve the efficiency of the administration of justice. Initial implementation has begun in the state of Meta. Institutional Responses to Social Demands 183 Women’s Rights and Access to Justice: A Case Study to Illustrate the Challenges of Rationalization Undoubtedly, mechanisms at the community and municipal levels avoid many of the barriers that often limit access to justice, such as physical and cultural distance, legal formalism, and costs. But such mechanisms are often not suitable for enforcing the rights of vulnerable populations when there is a clear imbalance of power between those involved in the conflict. This is the situation in cases of violence against women and other violations of women´s rights. Specialized family affairs offices (comisarías de familia) have been created at the municipal level to provide integrated services for family dispute situa- tions and frequently for victims of domestic and sexual violence.28 Women’s organizations play an integral role in service delivery in main cities, and sev- eral networks have been developed in smaller municipalities, some of which cover extensive regions of the country. Protocols for coordinated a ention have been put in place in larger urban cities of Colombia, but capacity to expand integrated service delivery to all municipalities is greatly limited. National entities working on these issues, such as the Ministry of the Interior, Ministry of Justice, Consejería Presiden- cial para la Equidad de la Mujer (CPEM), and the family justice branch of the Colombian Family Welfare Institute (ICBF), provide directives, formulate policies, and offer assistance. However, the daily responsibility for providing justice services to victims of family violence falls in large part on the shoulders of municipal justice and health and welfare agencies (sometimes combined with nongovernmental actors). At the front line of service delivery, resources, training, coverage, accountability, and institutional capacity are limited and very unevenly spread from one town to the next. The functions of the comisarías de familia have deepened and expanded over time through several reforms in the legal framework and, consequently, they are responsible for “guaranteeing, protecting, reestablishing, and repair- ing the rights of the members of the family affected by intra-family violence” through the provision of integrated and multidisciplinary services.29 As stated in current legislation, town councils are responsible for the establishment and operation of comisarías de familia in all municipalities. Nevertheless, to date, while the number of municipalities that have comisarías has increased, very 28 As in other ma ers, Colombia has moved toward the provision of integrated services rather than relying on judicial remedies alone. An integrated response includes the delivery of so- cial, medical, psychological, legal protection, advocacy, and legal aid/legal defense services. 29 The comisarías de familia were created in 1989 as an innovative mechanism to address family violence. These specialized agencies were first recognized formally in the Codigo del Menor of 1989 and later recognized in the domestic violence laws (L. 294, 1996; L. 575, 2000; & L. 1257, 2008) and the criminal procedure code, and in the recently passed Children and Adolescent Code of 2006. In 2011 a study showed the precarious nature of the majority of the 1,217 comisarías de familia registered in 1,102 municipalities. See Comisarías de Familia—Linea de Base Nacional Primera Parte (Procuraduría General de la Nación (2011). 184 The World Bank Legal Review few have a lawyer specializing in family issues and a multidisciplinary team of psychologists, social workers, doctors, and administrative auxiliaries. For example, in January 2008, only half of the 125 municipalities in the depart- ment of Antioquia had comisarías that were operating, and many of those did not have the required multidisciplinary team. Smaller municipalities―those located in rural areas, and especially those located in areas affected by the armed conflict―find it difficult to comply with the law and set up integrated services for victims of gender-based violence. Smaller towns frequently assign multiple responsibilities to a single municipal officer. Family courts, as such, are few and far between;30 hence coverage limita- tions are dealt with by transferring certain duties from family courts to comi- sarías de familia, mixed courts, or municipal courts. This is a serious concern for women’s rights organizations. The shift has been criticized by many women’s rights advocates and is perceived as an orchestrated move by the judicial ap- paratus to reduce court congestion.31 Women’s organizations argue that shift- ing responsibility from the judiciary and the court system to the comisarías de familia undermines access to the administration of justice for women who are victims of family violence. In addition, they argue that justice operators perceive domestic violence cases as having li le legal importance. Other areas of concern include the use of conciliation in cases of domestic violence, given the typical unequal power between male and female parties, and ineffective procedures to monitor the impact of conciliation procedures on women’s access to justice and judicial remedies. Studies such as the research under- taken on violence against women in Pereira and Bogotá reveal a critical ten- sion between three objectives: the need to provide easy access for women to institutions that are located close to residential areas; the desire to lighten the burden on the judicial system; and the need to respond to the large volume of cases of intrafamily violence.32 Even if coverage is expanded, issues of quality of services and interin- stitutional coordination and standards in delivery, resource availability, and sustainability will need to be addressed. Despite 20 years of activity, a number of institutional ma ers remain unresolved. For example, what agency estab- lishes the standards and characteristics of due process in the comisarías de fa- milia, and who provides oversight? What legal and access to justice principles guide the decisions made by the comisarías? What is the responsibility of the judicial system or the national family welfare system in terms of training, pro- vision of an adequate work environment, and other technical assistance? As 30 The 144 family courts in Colombia are situated in the large cities. For example, there are 23 in Bogotá, 14 in Medellín, and 11 in Cali. 31 See M. Hurtado, Violencias de género y acceso a la justicia (unpublished paper presented as an officer of the Defensoría Pública para los Derechos de la Niñez, la Juventud y la Mujer, Santa Marta, Colombia, June 2007). Hurtado cites statistics of the Consejo Superior de la Judica- tura regarding the tenfold increase in the number of protection orders requested in courts between 1996 and 1998. 32 Corporación Humanas, La situación de las mujeres víctimas de violencias de genero en el sistema penal acusatoria, Bogotá (June 2008). Institutional Responses to Social Demands 185 these issues are sorted out, access to justice for women seeking to resolve the multifaceted problems of family violence remains precarious, especially in municipalities other than the larger cities of Colombia. In very few places be- yond the state capitals do a comisaría de familia with a multidisciplinary capac- ity, a family defender, and a family court come together to address violence, protection orders, child custody, parental visits, matrimonial property, and ongoing victims’ assistance issues. While lower levels of the pyramid undoubtedly avoid many of the barri- ers that inhibit access to justice, they are not suitable for enforcing the rights of vulnerable populations when there is a clear imbalance of power between those involved in the conflict. Be they for dealing with family violence situa- tions, human rights violations, injustices that arise from the armed conflict, or the territorial domination by organized crime, immediate-access channels to higher justice authorities must be open and guaranteed. Highly Vulnerable Groups Demand Special Access Options Highly vulnerable groups, such as women forcibly displaced by internal con- flict, suffer severe discrimination and violence. The Public Defender’s Office conducted a study of 2,200 displaced women who were sexually abused; 8 out of every 10 did not report the abuse because of fear, shame, or lack of ser- vices. As of September 2008, of the total alerts issued by the Sistema de Alertas Tempranas (SAT), 69 percent were related to sexual exploitation and assault. As part of a project to address this issue in Magdalena state, the Procuraduría General de la Nación (PGN) concluded that violence against women is used pervasively as a strategy of war.33 Moreover, local women’s organizations were not aware of the services provided by the PGN, the organizations and officials working on the problem did not have the knowledge or the tools to provide appropriate services, and the organizational demand for increased technical assistance to improve the delivery of services to women victims of violence was high. Statistics provided by government entities and NGOs show that between 40 percent and 50 percent of the total displaced population consists of girls and women. Female heads of households represent between 34 per- cent and 48 percent of all displaced households.34 In addition, the Social Soli- darity Network estimates that in 2002 almost 18 percent of the total number of displaced persons are Afro-Colombians. According to the Human Rights and Displacement Clinic (Spanish abbreviation: COHDES), Afro-Colombians and indigenous groups were the most affected by the armed conflict and dis- placements. The indigenous population represents 8 percent of the displaced, 33 This coincides with the assessments of the IACHR, which found that violence against women is a structural problem in Colombia, where armed actors have used women as pawns. 34 The number of women heads of households increased from 25.8 percent in 1997 to 30.9 percent in 2003, and was higher in some urban areas. The percentage of women heads of low-income households grew from 52 percent to 54 percent between 1992 and 2001 (DANE 2003). 186 The World Bank Legal Review compared to 2 percent of the total population. Afro-Colombians represent 25 percent of the displaced, compared to 9 percent of the total population.35 Though important, explaining the myriad of issues affecting the rights of those displaced by Colombia’s internal conflict is difficult and beyond the scope of this chapter. The barriers to access to justice for many seem insur- mountable. Yet there has been some progress on many fronts. In 2004, for example, some 1,150 families challenged the inefficiency of state programs for displaced people, and the Constitutional Court issued a decision in favor of the rights of displaced people, including the rights of displaced women.36 The decision instructed the National Council for the Integrated Assistance of Populations Displaced by Violence to comply with the law by March 2004. Due to continued violations of the law and frequent injunction orders, the Constitutional Court instructed the Executive to conduct a complete review of the system (within a six-month period), which had to include a differential analysis of gender, age, ethnicity, and race, among other categories.37 Govern- ment agencies have redoubled efforts to comply, though they are often unable to adequately a end to this ever-growing problem, which seriously and dis- proportionately affects women and children. What is even more questionable is that human rights and women’s orga- nizations that have provided legal advice and representation for the displaced population have been the object of criminal threats and actions in an endeavor to further isolate these people from the institutions charged with their protec- tion and the responsibility to address their legal rights and needs. Such access to justice issues cannot be approached with the normal barrier and rational- ization of services analysis and proposals. This is also the case for other vulnerable groups that need affirmative ac- tion efforts from the highest judicial authorities for establishing groundbreak- ing legal concepts and legally binding decisions. The mainstream rationaliza- tion policy proposed by the commission must address such issues and open fast-track measures for exceptional situations. Rationalization will not be an alternative for protecting particularly vulnerable population groups, such as displaced women. Here the tutela and direct access to courts are needed to establish jurisprudence that recognizes rights and explores how they can be implemented. As the discussion above illustrates, delegating to municipal and nonju- dicial actors appears to overcome at least three access barriers by ensuring proximity, access without a lawyer, and specialized family services. But in reality, access to justice for women who are victims of violence is precarious because resources, coverage, and institutional capacity remain uneven and inadequate. If rationalization policies ignore these realities, they face the risk 35 Secretariado Nacional de Pastoral Social, Bogotá, Dec. 2001. 36 Const. Ct. Dec. in a tutela action, T-025, 2004. 37 Const. Ct. Dec. in a tutela action, T-496, May 2008. Institutional Responses to Social Demands 187 of pu ing in place an approach that reinforces inequities. If rationalization is pursued primarily to satisfy the needs of the court system, it will do so at the expense of the citizen/user. More important, the real tension between ef- ficiency and access to justice for vulnerable groups is a theme that will require further dialogue in the context of a rationalization policy for the delivery of justice services. Conclusion The recommendations of the Commission of Experts for Justice Reform should be viewed as a starting point for a national dialogue on access to justice. Rationalization of conflict resolution and justice services will require a thoughtful and concerted interinstitutional policy-building process that in- cludes the participation of civil society organizations. The pyramid model discussed in this chapter offers a systemic view of the different venues for conflict resolution, conflict prevention, and hence peace building in Colom- bia and might serve as a conceptual tool for thinking through the filtering or rationalization proposal. If rationalization is to serve the broader goal of access to justice, it must be adapted to deal with the realities of rural areas and small towns and with the needs of the poor and other socially vulnerable population groups. If the vari- ety of justice services contemplated in the pyramid model only exists in large cities, the rationalization proposal is equally limited and will not provide ac- cess to justice to many critical areas of the country. Does the political will exist to overcome the absence of justice services in small towns and outlying rural areas? Can implementing innovative technol- ogy and affirmative action help the effort to return to legality in the many regions affected by the armed conflict and other lawless conditions? Small towns and rural areas affected by the conflict need a disproportionate amount of a ention to provide legal institutions with the credibility and capacity to offer legitimate conflict resolution and access to justice. Local governments are positioned at a critical juncture of the pyramid model and play an important role in access to justice. Municipal and commu- nity instances provide essential justice services at the grassroots level and are recognized as critical components in long-term peace building efforts; how- ever, they have the least amount of resources and institutional support. This level brings together formal and informal systems of justice, for example, casas de justicia, an instance that could prove to be a key component in experiences to develop and test rationalization approaches. Last, initiatives to improve access have focused on many of the barri- ers that make the justice system inaccessible for everyone, but particularly for poor and vulnerable groups. Yet, access to justice remains a significant challenge in Colombia, which suggests that an exclusive focus on barriers, while necessary, is not sufficient. This makes a strong argument for seeking a 188 The World Bank Legal Review be er understanding of the legal and dispute resolution needs of individuals and groups, and of when and how people turn to formal or informal justice options. With the support of the World Bank‒financed project, the Ministry of Justice and Law, in conjunction with the Bogotá Chamber of Commerce and an expert justice NGO, Dejusticia, has undertaken a justice-needs study in 14 Colombian cities; the final report should be ready at the end of 2013. A demand-focused analysis should help identify the types of cases in which citizens in general, and more vulnerable groups in particular, would be well served by community, administrative, and municipal justice services. The analysis should also provide visibility for those problems that such services are not positioned to deal with adequately. Filtering and rationalizing the use of justice services will be an acceptable access to justice initiative only insofar as it recognizes institutional weaknesses that must be addressed at the lower levels of the pyramid model, with special challenges outside the main cities. In the cases of especially vulnerable popu- lation groups and problems in pioneering legal areas, where rights are not yet well established and there are insufficient resources to exercise them properly, fast-track access to judicial forums is not negotiable. To develop effective justice policies for poor and vulnerable populations, future studies must examine demand for conflict resolution in a differentiated manner. Scholarly consideration must be given to differences between men and women; social variables, such as ethnicity, race, income, and age; and differences across geographical regions (urban/rural) and judicial districts. Careful analysis of the demand for justice can enhance access to justice if the analysis is accompanied by the expressed and clear commitment of the justice sector, with a ention focused on vulnerable groups. Transfer of justice responsibilities to municipal governments has not been accompanied by clear implementation policies, adequate funding, or relevant training. Nor is there national oversight to determine how municipal authori- ties carry out their delegated justice roles. In addition, in some areas where state institutions are present but precariously positioned, the capacity of local government to administer justice is significantly limited due to the presence of illegal armed forces and organized crime groups that exercise control over justice operations.38 Such a situation can prompt doubts about the credibility of the rule of law and reduce respect and reliance on state institutions for per- sonal safety, which accentuates peoples’ extreme social vulnerability. Rationalizing the use of justice services has the potential to achieve impor- tant efficiency gains, improve access to justice, and support long-term peace- building efforts, but realizing these goals will require adjustments at all levels of the justice sector and to specific affirmative action policies in small towns and rural areas, and, particularly, for vulnerable population groups. 38 M. Villegas et al., Jueces sin estado: La justicia colombiana en zonas de conflicto armado (Siglo de Hombres Editores, Dejusticia, Fundación Konrad Adenauer, John Merck Fund 2008). The Role of Access to Information in Promoting Development SEAN FRASER During the past quarter century, the right to development has gained signifi- cant traction in the field of international human rights law. Despite major le- gal advances and growing acceptance of the right to development as a legal principle among scholars, and of development more generally as a pressing political objective among states, the practical impact of this trend has been underwhelming in comparison to its enormous potential. An important precondition to the right to development is the free flow of information that individuals or groups can use to improve the quality of their day-to-day lives. Public authorities often hold this kind of information, and functioning democracies should ensure that their constituents are provided with access to it. The failure to capitalize on the potential benefits of develop- ment initiatives is due, to some extent, to the inefficient flow of information regarding the activities of public officials. This chapter explores the role of access to information in promoting de- velopment. In doing so, it discusses which parties bear the responsibility to implement development initiatives and addresses the nature of the obliga- tions incumbent upon them. Following this analysis, the chapter examines how various courts and human rights bodies have used access to information to encourage public participation, promote efficient democratic governance, and protect human rights, all of which contribute to development. This chap- ter also analyzes the obstacles that inhibit the successful implementation of access to information laws and initiatives and provides recommendations as to how these obstacles may be overcome to increase the flow of information that can improve the lives of individuals and peoples around the world. Development as a Global Legal Issue Development is an increasingly important global legal issue. Over the past quarter century, this issue has been framed as a legal right in international law. The United Nations General Assembly has described the right to devel- opment as “an inalienable human right by virtue of which every human per- son and all peoples are entitled to participate in, contribute to, and enjoy eco- nomic, social, cultural and political development, in which all human rights and fundamental freedoms can be fully realized.”1 1 Declaration on the Right to Development, A/RES/41/28 (Dec. 4, 1986). This definition gains 189 190 The World Bank Legal Review States hold the primary responsibility for promoting development.2 A sig- nificant conceptual divide exists between developed and developing states on the issue of which states bear the obligation to promote development in international law. Developing states often rely on the right to development to advocate for support from the international community in their quest for development. Conversely, donor states prefer to rely on the right to devel- opment to justify their expectations that recipient governments continually improve their domestic governance by protecting human rights and ensuring the rule of law.3 It is obvious that both developed and developing states have a role to play in achieving global development. Although national governments play a role in the progressive development of people within their nation’s borders, it would be perilous to ignore the role played by the international community in expediting human progress.4 Building schools and hospitals, extracting natu- ral resources while respecting environmental obligations, and providing es- sential services such as housing, water, and electricity come at a cost. The states with the greatest need for these facilities and services often do not have the re- sources to provide them. Therefore, foreign donors and international economic cooperation are essential in stimulating development. Furthermore, initiatives such as the Millennium Development Goals illustrate how international co- operation can expedite development by se ing important political objectives.5 support through its inclusion in several major international instruments. See 1992 Rio Dec- laration on Environment and Development; the 1993 Vienna Declaration and Programme of Action; the Millennium Declaration; the 2002 Monterrey Consensus; the 2005 World Summit Outcome Document; and the 2007 Declaration on the Rights of Indigenous Peoples. Another major instrument has adopted a separate definition; see art. 22, African Charter on Human and Peoples’ Rights (hereinafter, African Charter), adopted June 27, 1981, OAU Doc. CAB/ LEG/67/3 rev. 521 I.L.M. 58 (1982), entered into force Oct. 21, 1986. 2 Art. 3, Declaration on the Right to Development. The Declaration on the Right to Develop- ment provides that “States have the primary responsibility for the creation of national and international conditions favourable to the realization of the right to development.” 3 Stephen P. Marks, Poverty, in International Human Rights Law 618 (Daniel Moeckli et al. eds., Oxford U. Press 2010). 4 Report of the High-Level Task Force on the Implementation of the Right to Development on Its Sixth Session, A/HRC/15/WG.2/TF/2/Add.2. The high-level task force on the implementation of the right to development has explained that “the responsibility for the creation of this enabling environment encompasses three main levels: (a) States acting collectively in global and re- gional partnerships (second preambular paragraph and art. 3); (b) States acting individually as they adopt and implement policies that affect persons not strictly within their jurisdiction (art. 4); and (c) States acting individually as they formulate national development policies and programmes affecting persons within their jurisdiction (art. 2).” 5 Millennium Declaration, A/RES/55/2 (Sep. 8, 2000). See also Nico Schrijver, Many Roads Lead to Rome: How to Arrive at a Legally Binding Instrument on the Right to Development? in Imple- menting the Right to Development: The Role of International Law 127–129 (Stephen P. Marks ed., Friedrich-Ebert Stiftung and Program on Human Rights in Development of the Harvard School of Public Health 2008). The Role of Access to Information in Promoting Development 191 The Nexus between Access to Information and Development Access to information is important not merely for its own sake, but for what it can help achieve. As one author has suggested, “In itself, the issue of access to information does not have a natural constituency. What is required is to con- nect the issue with peoples’ daily pressing concerns, and ensure that people see their right to information in the broader context of their right to development.”6 The value of information is derived from its role in facilitating the achievement of other human rights, specifically, those related to development. An informed populace is the backbone of participatory democracy. With- out access to information, this form of governance is not possible. Informa- tion creates the opportunity to discuss a range of available options, to vote in accordance with one’s best interests and beliefs, and to take part in mean- ingful public policy discussions and informed political debate. Information also creates awareness among individuals and peoples of what rights they are entitled to and when these rights are being violated. Information provides for the possibility of evidence-based advocacy to draw a ention to causes that members of a society feel are important. In the event that the rights of a person or a people are infringed, information provides ammunition to present to an independent judiciary that has the power to provide a remedy for the wrong suffered. A society that does not allow the public to access information is one that is ripe for corruption. This situation hinders economic growth by deterring international and domestic investment, as well as foreign aid. Corruption in government takes the greatest toll on a nation’s most vulnerable population by preventing the poorest members of society from helping themselves climb out of poverty.7 Information allows the public to hold a government account- able by creating a public awareness of the government’s conduct. By provid- ing access to reports, policies, and laws that affect the population, not only is the monitoring of performance made possible, but public trust in the govern- ment also grows.8 Each of these consequences of the public’s right of access to information has a significant impact on development. An informed populace that is aware of its rights and the forms of recourse available in the event that those rights are infringed is be er able to hold its government accountable. This reduces incidents of corruption and allows even the most vulnerable members of so- ciety to flourish. When freedom of information is protected, an environment 6 John Samuel, Case Studies in Civil Society Advocacy (paper prepared for the Commonwealth Foundation’s seminar on Civil Society and Government—Partners or Protagonists? Oct. 2002). 7 Lala Camerer, Information and the Quest for Global Accountability, in The Right to Know, The Right to Live: Access to Information and Socio-Economic Justice xi, 139–140 (Richard Calland & Allison Tilley eds., Open Democracy Advice Centre 2002). 8 Samuel, supra note 6. 192 The World Bank Legal Review is created that enables the realization of civil, political, economic, social, and cultural rights for all members of society. How States Have Used Access to Information to Promote Development With information in hand, individuals and peoples are well equipped to de- fend, promote, and exercise their rights, a process that leads to tangible human development. Information plays a key role in determining whether a state has fulfilled its obligations to comply with internationally or constitutionally pro- tected human rights norms. This section addresses the actions taken by states that have fostered development by enhancing access to information through the auspices of the United Nations and regional organizations and domestically. The UN Framework The UN system of human rights protection can be discerned primarily from the work of the bodies that monitor compliance with human rights treaties, the UN Human Rights Council and the Office of the High Commissioner for Hu- man Rights (OHCHR). Each of these bodies has different tools to promote hu- man rights, including the right of access to information. However, each could do more to liberalize access to information that might assist in promoting de- velopment. In addition, treaties that are established under the UN framework that relate to specific subject ma er deliver a unique opportunity to provide the general public with access to information that relates to issues addressed by that treaty. This section discusses various aspects of the UN framework that have specifically tackled the right to information. Mechanisms that do not have an ample body of material available that relates to the right to informa- tion are beyond the scope of this chapter and are not discussed. UN Treaty Bodies Article 19 of the Universal Declaration of Human Rights (UDHR) recognizes the importance of the right to access information when it states, “Everyone has the right to freedom of opinion and expression; this right includes freedom to hold opinions without interference and to seek, receive and impart infor- mation and ideas through any media and regardless of frontiers.”9 When the UDHR was adopted in 1948, the expectation was that further treaties would be required to create binding obligations with respect to the human rights contained therein. Since then, nine core instruments have been adopted. The International Covenant on Civil and Political Rights (ICCPR) addresses the right to access public information in Article 19(2), which provides that “every- one shall have the right to freedom of expression; this right shall include free- dom to seek, receive and impart information and ideas of all kinds, regardless 9 Art. 19, Universal Declaration of Human Rights of the UN General Assembly A/RES/217 A (III) (Dec. 10, 1948). The Role of Access to Information in Promoting Development 193 of frontiers, either orally, in writing or in print, in the form of art, or through any another media of his choice.”10 This discussion addresses the various mechanisms by which UN treaty bodies use Article 19(2) of the ICCPR and other laws that provide for access to information as a means of promoting development around the globe. These mechanisms include general comments of the various treaty bodies, state re- porting obligations, and complaints procedures. Examples of how each of these tools have been used to promote access to information are presented below. General Comments. Most treaty bodies issue general comments, which are ad- opted by consensus and provide guidance on the general treaty obligations of state parties to the relevant instrument and outline the scope of the rights contained therein.11 Although general comments are not legally binding, they are often cited by states and complainants in the context of state reporting ob- ligations, during the applicable complaints process, or even in the judgments of domestic courts.12 The Human Rights Commi ee provided some guidance on the right to information in General Comment No. 34. That document points out that “Ar- ticle 19, paragraph 2 [of the ICCPR] embraces a right of access to information held by public bodies” and that the right of access to such information applies regardless of how the information is stored and impacts private parties that carry out a public function. General Comment No. 34 also states: To give effect to the right of access to information, States parties should proactively put in the public domain Government informa- tion of public interest. States parties should make every effort to en- sure easy, prompt, effective and practical access to such information. States parties should also enact the necessary procedures, whereby one may gain access to information, such as by means of freedom of information legislation.13 General Comment No. 34 also establishes that individuals are entitled to know what personal data are stored by public entities and which individuals or bodies control their files. If those files contain incorrect data or were col- lected in violation of the law, the right to access personal information includes a right to have personal records rectified. In previous general comments, the Human Rights Commi ee has shed light on the kinds of information to which persons accused of a criminal offense are entitled,14 and the entitlement to in- formation about other rights under the ICCPR in general.15 10 Art. 19(2), International Covenant on Civil and Political Rights, A/RES/2200 (Dec. 16, 1966). 11 Markus Schmidt, United Nations, in International Human Rights Law 408–409 (Daniel Moeckli et al. eds., Oxford U. Press 2010). 12 See Secretary of Security v. Sakthevel Prabakar, 1 Hong Kong L. Rpts. & Dig. (2005) 289. 13 General Comment No. 34, CCPR/C/GC/34 (Sep. 12, 2011), at paras. 18–19. 14 General Comment No. 32, CCPR/C/GC/32 (Aug. 23, 2007). 15 General Comment No. 31, CCPR/C/21/Rev.1/Add. 13 (May 26, 2004). 194 The World Bank Legal Review State Reporting Obligations. Parties to the core human rights instruments are required to submit regular reports to the commi ee responsible for oversee- ing the relevant treaty. These reports must outline how the state has imple- mented the treaty nationally and are subsequently examined by the treaty body, which designates a country rapporteur to prepare a list of issues that is addressed by the state in the form of an updated report. The examination of state reports takes place in public and in the presence of a delegation from the state party concerned. The public nature of this ex- amination is beneficial in that it represents a proactive approach by the treaty bodies to disseminating information related to human rights and, thus, de- velopment. Following the examination, the treaty bodies adopt concluding observations or comments that identify areas of progress for the state as well as problems that persist. Specific recommendations as to how these problems may be resolved are made, and follow-up mechanisms monitor whether prog- ress is in fact being made.16 The UN Human Rights Commi ee expressed unease in relation to Iran’s violation of the right to freedom of expression under the ICCPR.17 The com- mi ee was concerned about the government’s efforts to stifle the media and in some instances detain them, particularly following the 2009 presidential elections. These efforts represent an infringement of the right to expression of the various media entities and persons in Iran and a violation of the Iranian population’s right to seek and receive information. In response to these con- cerns, the commi ee recommended: The State party should [. . .] ensure that journalists can exercise their profession without fear of being brought before courts. The State party should release, rehabilitate and provide effective judicial re- dress and compensation for journalists that were imprisoned in contravention of articles 9 and 19 of the Covenant. The State party should also ensure that the monitoring of Internet use does not vio- late the rights to freedom of expression and privacy as defined in the Covenant. Interestingly, the concluding observations of other treaty bodies do not refer to Article 19 of the ICCPR because their assessment of a state report is limited to the provisions of the treaty for which they have assumed responsi- bility. However, various treaty bodies have referred to the need for greater ac- cess to information in their concluding observations, which serves as evidence of the relationship between information and other human rights. 16 Report on the Current Working Methods of the Treaty Bodies, HRI/MC/2009/4 (June 24, 2009), at paras. 75–82. State parties are typically invited to report back to describe what steps have been taken after one year of the examination, and special rapporteurs are routinely appoint- ed for this purpose. 17 Concluding Observations of the Human Rights Commi ee: Islamic Republic of Iran, CCPR/C/ IRN/CO/3, available at h p://iranhrdc.org/files/pdf_en/UN_Reports/CCPR.C.IRN.CO.3.pdf (accessed May 29, 2013). The Role of Access to Information in Promoting Development 195 For example, the Commi ee on the Rights of the Child, in its concluding observations in relation to the state report of Timor-Leste, was encouraged by the efforts of Timor-Leste in cooperating with the UN in disseminating information and providing human rights training relating to children’s rights to government agencies, civil society, teachers, judicial officers, and other relevant professional groups, and recommended that this practice be contin- ued.18 The concluding observations also recommended that the state improve children’s access to appropriate information from a diversity of sources, es- pecially those aimed at the promotion of a child’s social, spiritual, and moral well-being and physical and mental health.19 The Commi ee on the Protection of the Rights of All Migrant Workers and Members of Their Families expressed disappointment in the lack of informa- tion provided to migrant workers in Rwanda.20 The commi ee recommended that Rwanda intensify its efforts to ensure that migrant workers and members of their families have effective access to information about their rights under the convention and under immigration law, in particular their rights to have access to basic social services, to join trade unions, and to the same treatment as nationals of the state party in respect to conditions of work.21 In examining issues relating to women’s health in Paraguay, the Com- mi ee on the Elimination of Discrimination Against Women drew a ention, in its concluding observations, to reproductive rights and the high mortality rate that is a consequence of unsafe abortions in that nation.22 Among other things, the commi ee recommended that Paraguay adopt a patient privacy policy to safeguard doctor-patient confidentiality specifically when treating women for abortion complications, and that it “strengthen institutional health- care capacity and the implementation of programmes and policies aimed at providing effective access for women to health-care information and services, in particular regarding reproductive health and affordable contraceptive methods, with the aim of preventing clandestine abortions.” The process of state reporting is robust but inefficient. It can lead to the implementation of expert recommendations, but both the system and par- ticipating states are overburdened.23 If the system is to operate efficiently, it must have the necessary human resources to do so and would benefit from 18 Concluding Observations of the Commi ee on the Rights of the Child: Timor Leste, CRC/C/TLS/ CO/1 (Feb. 14, 2008), at paras. 22–23. 19 Id., at paras. 37–38. 20 Concluding Observations of the Commi ee on the Protection of the Rights of All Migrant Work- ers and Members of Their Families on the Initial Periodic Report of Rwanda, CMW/C/RWA/CO/1 (Oct. 10, 2012). 21 Id., at paras. 35–36. 22 Concluding Observations of the Commi ee on the Elimination of Discrimination Against Women: Paraguay, CEDAW/C/PRY/CO/6 (Nov. 8, 2011). 23 Schmidt, supra note 11, at 406. Many treaty bodies face backlogs that delay their examination of state reports by up to two years after their submission, and some states are more than a decade behind in their reporting obligations. 196 The World Bank Legal Review implementing a more selective approach toward the information it considers from stakeholders other than the state.24 A streamlined approach to reporting would also assist in this regard.25 There has been progress in the form of treaty body harmonization, which has simplified the process somewhat26 and should be continued to accelerate the process of state reporting that could lead to increased implementation of access to information laws and initiatives on a timely basis. Complaints Procedures through Treaty Bodies. Various human rights treaty bod- ies provide a mechanism that is designed to hear complaints that human rights have been violated. For example, the first Optional Protocol to the ICCPR provides a complaints procedure for violations under the ICCPR.27 This instrument allows both states and individuals to commence claims against parties to the first Optional Protocol before the Human Rights Com- mi ee, although to date, the focus has been almost entirely on individual, as opposed to interstate, complaints. After considering an allegation of the violation of rights, the relevant com- mi ee provides “views” or “opinions” that assess the merits of the complaint. These views have shown that the right to information includes a right whereby the media has access to information on public affairs28 and the right of the general public to receive media output.29 Other views have demonstrated that prisoners are entitled to access their medical records while incarcerated,30 and 24 Id., at 407–408. Notably, the majority of treaty bodies provide for participation of NGOs in the reporting process, which contributes greatly to the quality of the examination. However, the experience of some commi ees is that having too many NGOs with differing points of view can slow the process or lead to inconsistencies in the information provided on a par- ticular issue to the point that no meaningful discussion takes place. 25 Id., at note 11. This is particularly evident when one considers that many states are required to submit reports with overlapping issues to a number of different oversight bodies. In deal- ing with states that have delayed excessively in submi ing their reports, the relevant com- mi ee may conduct a review of the country on the basis of information it has from existing stakeholders. Provisional concluding observations are then prepared and circulated to the state, but the relevant commi ee will only publish its provisional concluding observations in the absence of a response from the state. 26 Id., at 415–417. Unfortunately, the recommendation that a single report be submi ed made by the UN secretary-general in 2002 was rejected on the basis of the logistical challenges it presented to states. (Secretary-General, Strengthening the United Nations: An Agenda for Fur- ther Change, A/57/387 [Sep. 9, 2002], at paras. 52–54.) However, the treaty body reporting requirements did lead to harmonized reporting guidelines under each of the core instru- ments, which are expected to result in be er compliance with reporting obligations of states. (Secretary-General, Effective Implementation of International Instruments on Human Rights, Including Reporting Obligations under International Instruments on Human Rights, A/63/280 [Aug. 13, 2008] Annex, at para. 42(d)). 27 Optional Protocol to the International Covenant on Civil and Political Rights, adopted by UN General Assembly Resolution 2200A (XXI), 21 UN GAOR Supp. (no. 16) at 59, UN Doc. A/6316 (1966), 999 U.N.T.S. 302, (Mar. 23, 1976). 28 See communication no. 633/95, Gauthier v. Canada (May 5, 1999). 29 See communication no. 1334/2004, Mavlonov and Sa’di v. Uzbekistan (Mar. 19, 2009). 30 See communication no. 726/1996, Zheludkov v. Ukraine (Oct. 29, 2002). The Role of Access to Information in Promoting Development 197 that a state’s decisions that may impact the way of life and culture of minori- ties should be accompanied by a process of information sharing and consulta- tion with affected communities.31 These cases demonstrate that the complaints process under the rubric of the UN Human Rights Commi ee has led to useful commentary on the role of access to information in promoting development. Regre ably, several key weaknesses prevent the treaty bodies’ complaints procedures from reaching their full potential. The single greatest problem with treaty bodies’ complaints procedures is that the views or opinions they release are not legally binding and cannot be strictly enforced.32 Although follow-ups conducted by various treaty bodies have been encouraging in some instances, they do not have the effect of a formal judgment that can be enforced against the assets of a perpetrator of human rights violations.33 Access to legal counsel presents another problem in extending the reach of the complaints process to victims. There is currently no requirement that a complainant retain legal counsel, and the procedural intricacies of the complaints process make the process challenging for an individual who does not have representation or who is illiterate. Accordingly, the process is weakened by the absence of a legal aid system that could serve impecunious complainants.34 UN Human Rights Council The primary duties of the UN Human Rights Council are outlined in Gen- eral Assembly Resolution 60/251.35 Among these duties are promoting human rights education and learning, serving as a forum for dialogue on thematic issues, making recommendations to the General Assembly on developing new human rights standards, preventing human rights violations through dialogue and cooperation, and responding promptly to human rights emergencies. Accordingly, the Human Rights Council is positioned to widely circulate in- formation that is useful in promoting development, rather than providing an aggrieved party with a remedy for the violation of its right to information. 31 See communication no. 1457/2006, Poma v. Peru (Mar. 27, 2009). 32 General Comment No. 33, CCPR/C/GC/33 (Nov. 5, 2008) at para. 11. The Human Rights Commi ee has stated that, although its views and opinions are not binding, they do “exhibit some important characteristics of a judicial decision.” Moreover, “cross-fertilization” of hu- man rights jurisprudence has been characterized by the recognition of treaty body case law before regional human rights bodies and domestic courts, and vice-versa (Schmidt, supra note 11, at 415). This development is a positive one in that it avoids legal fragmentation by crafting, albeit slowly, a harmonious body of human rights jurisprudence. (Schmidt, Vers une jurisprudence international en matière des droits de l’homme: L’expérience du Comité des droits de l’homme de l’ONU, in Les juridictions internationales: Complémentarité ou concurrence? 163–168 (Olivier Delas et al. eds., Bruylant 2005). 33 Schmidt, supra note 11, at 413. With the exception of in Colombia, no enabling legislation has been passed that would allow the views or opinions of a UN treaty body to be treated similarly to domestic judicial decisions. 34 Id., at 410–411. 35 UN General Assembly Resolution A/RES/60/251 (Apr. 3, 2006), at para. 5. 198 The World Bank Legal Review The Universal Periodic Review. The Human Rights Council is obligated to un- dertake a universal periodic review (UPR), a peer review mechanism that addresses each state’s fulfillment of its human rights obligations to ensure universal coverage and equal treatment.36 The UPR has been the source of cau- tious optimism by human rights experts in that it has shown positive results in terms of implementing change.37 Since 2008, the UPR has been used by re- viewing states to make recommendations to improve access to information on at least 28 occasions. The UPR has led to recommendations that states “intro- duce and seek prompt passage of access to information legislation”;38 “strictly uphold freedom of the press, including public access to information, and en- sure that the complaints made in this regard are properly investigated”;39 and “take measures to guarantee effective access for women and girls to informa- tion and services regarding sexual and reproductive health.”40 Twenty-seven of the 28 states in receipt of such recommendations have supported the recom- mendation provided.41 Special Procedures. The Human Rights Council also provides for certain special procedures that are designed to address either “country specific situations or thematic issues that concern all states.”42 Mandate holders, such as special rapporteurs, undertake country visits and fact-finding missions and examine complaints, report to the media, and publish their findings. The special rap- porteur on the promotion and protection of the right to freedom of opinion and expression released a report on the “right of individuals to seek, receive and impart information and ideas of all kinds through the Internet.”43 This report outlines the importance of Internet access in spreading infor- mation that promotes human rights, including the right to development, and stated in its recommendations: Unlike any other medium, the Internet enables individuals to seek, receive and impart information and ideas of all kinds instantaneously and inexpensively across national borders. By vastly expanding the 36 Id., at para. 5(e). 37 Elvira Dominguez Redondo, The Universal Periodic Review of the UN Human Rights Council: An Assessment of the First Session, 7(13) Chinese J. of Intl. L. 721–734 (2008). 38 Report of the Working Group on the Universal Periodic Review: Vietnam, A/HRC/12/11 (UPR 2009), at para. 99. 39 Report of the Working Group on the Universal Periodic Review: Georgia, A/HRC/17/11 (UPR, 2011), at para. 105. 40 Report of the Working Group on the Universal Periodic Review: Bosnia and Herzegovina, A/ HRC/14/16 (UPR, 2010), at para. 106. 41 Report of the Working Group on the Universal Periodic Review: Serbia Addendum, A/HRC/10/78 Add.1 (UPR, 2009), at para. 9. Only Serbia refused to support such a recommendation, but it did not reject it outright. 42 Schmidt, supra note 11, at 398. 43 Report of the Special Rapporteur on Key Trends and Challenges to the Right of All Individuals to Seek, Receive and Impart Information and Ideas of All Kinds through the Internet, A/HRC/17/27 (May 16, 2011). The Role of Access to Information in Promoting Development 199 capacity of individuals to enjoy their right to freedom of opinion and expression, which is an “enabler” of other human rights, the Internet boosts economic, social and political development, and contributes to the progress of humankind as a whole.44 The report also discusses many of the challenges faced in widely dissemi- nating information online as a result of certain states actively taking steps to restrict information. For example, the special rapporteur found that “China, which has in place one of the most sophisticated and extensive systems for controlling information on the Internet, has adopted extensive filtering sys- tems that block access to websites containing key terms such as ‘democracy’ and ‘human rights.’ ”45 The Human Rights Council has created a significant awareness of human rights issues, including access to information, among various stakeholders, which has led to valuable changes in policy, adoption of legislation, and increased protection of human rights. Office of the High Commissioner for Human Rights The UN Office of the High Commissioner for Human Rights (OHCHR) has the responsibility of promoting and protecting the effective enjoyment by all of all human rights.46 This body cooperates with other UN entities and issues recommendations on how to be er promote and protect human rights and improve the UN mechanisms relating to human rights. Among the priorities of the OHCHR is the coordination of UN education and public human rights information programs and the promotion of the realization of the right to development. Knowledge of human rights is an essential precondition to their effective exercise, yet many developing countries have problematic rates of illiteracy, and individuals in all states remain unaware of international human rights standards.47 These phenomena make the exercise of human rights difficult and necessitate the dissemination of information. It is in this regard that the UN human rights education program seeks to assist. The OHCHR contributes sig- nificantly to UN educational activities. It publishes various materials about human rights, including the right to development, and disseminates these publications widely by paper and by electronic means. The OHCHR relies on its many field offices for the production, translation, and distribution of mate- rials and information in furtherance of human rights education initiatives and in training local officials and members of civil society. Although these educational and training initiatives contribute to a gen- eral trend of human rights awareness, measuring their influence is challeng- ing because the initiatives are rarely tied to specific measurable outcomes. 44 Id., at para. 67. 45 Id., at para. 29. 46 General Assembly Resolution on the High Commissioner for the Promotion and Protection of All Hu- man Rights, A/RES/48/141 (Jan. 7, 1994). 47 Schmidt, supra note 11, at 420. 200 The World Bank Legal Review Moreover, their effectiveness is largely dependent on a cooperative local government that is not opposed to the promotion of human rights within its borders. The affiliations that the OHCHR has with domestic human rights bodies around the world are helpful in this respect, although these relation- ships cannot completely address, for example, access to information in a state where the reigning government does not have the political will to implement meaningful human rights initiatives. Issue-Specific Conventions The adoption of international treaties that deal with specific subject ma er is another tool that can be used to liberalize access to information laws under the UN framework. The Aarhus Convention is one such example; it creates a linkage between the substantive right to a clean environment and proce- dural rights, including a right to information.48 The convention entitles the general public to information regarding the state of the environment, public health, and other factors impacting the environment. The convention codifies the right to request and receive information49 and imposes a duty on states to collect and disseminate information.50 The right to information under this convention has been widely implemented by its parties.51 The drafting and adoption of treaties on specific topics and issues is bound to continue, and the UN framework provides states with a forum for doing so for the foreseeable future. States should take the opportunity that these instruments provide to bolster the public’s right of access to informa- tion in relation to issues that impact the public interest. Doing so would allow groups and individuals who are affected by the issues dealt with in a given treaty to protect their own rights or seek help in doing so. This would be a significant step in expediting development initiatives, as the stakeholders on a given topic would be be er able to take part in informed debate on ma ers of public importance. Regional Organizations The American Convention on Human Rights (ACHR),52 the European Con- vention on Human Rights (ECHR),53 and the African Charter54 protect the right to information. These instruments have established human rights bodies 48 United Nations Economic Commission for Europe Convention on Access to Information, Public Participation in Decision-Making and Access to Justice in Environmental Ma ers (June 25, 1998). Approved by Council Decision 2005/370/EC (Feb. 17, 2005). 49 Id., at art. 4. 50 Id., at art. 5. 51 Malgosia Fi maurice, Environmental Degradation, in International Human Rights Law 637 (Daniel Moeckli et al. eds., Oxford U. Press 2010). 52 Art. 13, American Convention on Human Rights (1969). 53 Art. 10, European Convention on Human Rights (1950). 54 Art. 9, African Charter, supra note 1. The Role of Access to Information in Promoting Development 201 that issue wri en decisions involving the role of access to information in pro- tecting human rights and thus promoting development. In addition, regional bodies can assist in the development of access to information legislation by adopting conventions or model laws that increase public participation, im- prove efficiency in government, and assist in protecting human rights. Jurisprudence of Regional Human Rights Bodies The case of Claude Reyes and Others v. Chile was the first holding by an interna- tional tribunal that the right to freedom of expression includes a right to seek and receive information held by the government.55 The applicants in this case re- quested information regarding a deforestation project on the Rio Condor from Chile’s Foreign Investment Commi ee. The Chilean courts provided no accept- able reasons for the commi ee’s refusal to release the information, so the Inter- American Court found that the applicants’ right to information under Article 13 of the ACHR was violated. In the wake of this decision, Chile ad- opted access to information legislation and began training public officials in how to properly administer access to information requests pursuant to the Inter-American Court’s direction and supervision. K.H. and Others v. Slovakia was the first in a series of cases before the Eu- ropean Court of Human Rights that involved the issue of forced sterilization of Roma women from Slovakia.56 Eight women suspected that they were ster- ilized without their consent while in Slovakian hospitals to give birth. The women sought copies of their medical records to determine their health status and to protect the integrity of the evidence contained therein for the purpose of potential litigation. The European Court of Human Rights found that Slo- vakia’s refusal to provide access to medical records constituted a violation of the ECHR. The court took the view that Article 8, which deals with the right to respect for one’s private and family life, includes informational rights related to health and health status. In addition, the court found that Article 6, which provides a right of access to justice, was violated as a result of the failure to share the information in question. In Társaság a Szabadságjogokért (Hungarian Civil Liberties Union) v. Hungary, the European Court of Human Rights dealt with a request by the Hungarian Civil Liberties Union, a civil rights NGO, to access a copy of a complaint filed with the Constitutional Court by a member of Parliament.57 The complaint sought a review of amendments to national drug legislation, which was an area of interest for the NGO. The Constitutional Court denied the NGO’s re- quest to access the complaint on the basis that it contained personal data and could only be shared with the consent of the author. The court found that the activities of NGOs are essential contributions to an informed public debate 55 Claude Reyes and Others v. Chile, IACtHR Series C No. 151 (Sep. 19, 2006). 56 K.H. and Others v. Slovakia, ECHR 2009/13 (Apr. 28, 2009), no. 32881/04 (4th sec.). 57 Társaság a Szabadságjogokért (Hungarian Civil Liberties Union) v. Hungary, App. No. 37374/05, judgment of Apr. 14, 2009. 202 The World Bank Legal Review and warrant similar protection as that afforded to the media. The court ruled that by interfering with the NGO’s ability to gather information on ma ers of public importance, Hungarian authorities violated the applicant’s right of access to information. In SERAC and Others v. Nigeria, the African Commission examined a case involving the exploitation of Ogoniland in Nigeria by a subsidiary of Shell Oil Co. and the Nigerian National Petroleum Company.58 The exploitation was done in a manner that caused significant degradation of the environment, as well as harm to the health of local residents. A group of local and inter- national NGOs launched a complaint to the African Commission, claiming that the Nigerian government was responsible for human rights violations. In rendering a decision, the commission highlighted the importance of infor- mation in promoting the right to a healthy environment by finding that the government should have afforded the public an opportunity to participate in decision making through a public consultation process before commencing the project.59 Among other things, the commission ordered the government to conduct environmental and social impact assessments and to provide infor- mation on health and environmental risks to communities that are likely to be affected by oil operations in the future.60 Regional Instruments and Model Laws In addition to the dispute resolution mechanism for international human rights bodies, the political organs of regional organizations can improve the flow of information by adopting conventions that guarantee access to informa- tion. The Council of Europe did precisely that when it passed the Convention on Access to Official Documents.61 This is the first binding international legal instrument that recognizes a general right of access to official documents held by public authorities. In summarizing the treaty, the Council of Europe stated: Transparency of public authorities is a key feature of good gover- nance and an indicator of whether or not a society is genuinely dem- ocratic and pluralist, opposed to all forms of corruption, capable of criticising those who govern it, and open to enlightened participa- tion of citizens in ma ers of public interest. The right of access to official documents is also essential to the self-development of people and to the exercise of fundamental human rights. It also strengthens public authorities’ legitimacy in the eyes of the public, and its con- fidence in them.62 58 The Social and Economic Rights Action Center and the Center for Economic and Social Rights v. Nigeria, African Commission on Human and Peoples’ Rights, Communication No. 155/96 (2001). 59 Id. 60 Id. 61 Council of Europe Convention on Access to Official Documents, CETS No. 205 (June 18, 2009). 62 Summary available at h p://www.conventions.coe.int/Treaty/EN/Summaries/Html/205.htm (accessed May 29, 2013). The Role of Access to Information in Promoting Development 203 The instrument establishes a right of access to official documents and sets out certain permissible limitations on the disclosure of information. It is designed as a set of minimum standards to be applied in the processing of requests for access to official documents and allows for states to build on its contents by passing domestic laws that provide more robust access to official documents. The African Charter establishes a right of access to information63 that is elaborated on by the Declaration of Principles on Freedom of Expression in Africa.64 These instruments guarantee “the right of access to information as a fundamental inalienable human right and as an indispensable component of democracy and development, including socio-economic development.”65 Notwithstanding the recognition by African states that access to informa- tion can lead to extensive development, there is a dearth of domestic legisla- tion that provides substance or procedure to the right to information on the continent.66 In response to the need for implementation of domestic legislation in Af- rica, the African Commission adopted the Model Law on Access to Informa- tion in Africa.67 The model law is formulated “as a guide for the development, adoption or review of access to information legislation by African states.”68 The African Commission, as well as civil society organizations that contributed to the effort, should be commended for their work in adopting this model law, which is an important development that other regional human rights bodies should note. Not only African states suffer from an absence of access to information legislation or lack of effective legislation. Other regional or- ganizations should take steps to offer similar guidelines to states that wish to implement or improve legislation on access to information by adopting a model law or convention that is tailored to the needs of member states. These documents should be regularly reviewed and kept up-to-date. 63 Art. 9, African Charter, supra note 1. 64 Declaration of Principles on Freedom of Expression in Africa, African Commission on Hu- man and Peoples’ Rights, 32nd session (Oct. 17–23, 2002). 65 Preamble, Model Law on Access to Information for Africa, African Commission on Human and Peoples’ Rights, 53rd session (Apr. 11, 2013) (hereinafter, Model Law). 66 As of 2013, only 11 states had adopted access to information legislation: South Africa (Pro- motion of Access to Information Act in 2000); Angola (Freedom of Information Law in 2002); Zimbabwe (Access to Information and Protection of Privacy Act in 2002); Uganda (Access to Information Act in 2005); Ethiopia (Freedom of Information and Mass Media Law in 2008); Liberia (Freedom of Information Act in 2010); Guinea (Organic Law on the Right of Access to Public Information in 2010); Nigeria (Freedom of Information Law in 2011); Tunisia (Decree on Access to the Administrative Documents of Public Authorities of Tunisia in 2011); Niger (Charter on Access to Public and Administrative Documents in 2011); and Rwanda (Law Relating to Access to Information in 2013). 67 Model Law, supra note 65. 68 Id., at 14. 204 The World Bank Legal Review Domestic Access to Information Legal Regimes Aside from any obligations that arise in international law, the right to freedom of information is embedded in the constitutions of many states and given con- tent in legislation in at least 95 states around the world.69 When addressing freedom of information in domestic jurisdictions, the relevant legal regimes are typically characterized by the guarantee of access to data held by the state, and on occasion by private bodies, subject to certain classes of exemptions that justify the government’s refusal to disclose information to the requesting party. This form of access to information is important in the context of the right to development because it promotes transparent and accountable governance, which is essential to a functioning democracy. In discussing the essential components of domestic access to information legislation, the UN Human Rights Commi ee’s General Comment No. 34 pro- vides a description of appropriate legislation on access to information when it states: The procedures should provide for the timely processing of requests for information according to clear rules that are compatible with the Covenant. Fees for requests for information should not be such as to constitute an unreasonable impediment to access to information. Authorities should provide reasons for any refusal to provide access to information. Arrangements should be put in place for appeals from refusals to provide access to information as well as in cases of failure to respond to requests.70 In some circumstances, where public officials refuse to provide informa- tion through the process contemplated by law, a requester can seek recourse through the courts, which determine whether the relevant legislation prohib- its the disclosure of information. This section draws on the decisions of vari- ous domestic courts to illustrate how a constitution or legislative regime pro- vides a right of access to information that can enhance development within national borders. Domestic Jurisprudence on Access to Information CCII Systems Ltd. v. S. A. Fakie NO and Others was the first major case decided by the courts under the South African Promotion of Access to Information Act.71 It involved the acquisition of a strategic defense package for approximately R 30 billion (approximately US$3 billion). This arms deal has been tarnished by allegations of corruption and secrecy that continue today. A private company that provides defense-related software and computer systems sought access to the draft version of a report that was subsequently altered and accepted by Parliament. The complainant wished to use the report to determine whether 69 Art. 19, Freedom of Information, available at h p://www.article19.org/pages/en/freedom-of -information-more.html (accessed May 1, 2013). 70 General Comment No. 34, supra note 13, at para. 19. 71 CCII Systems Ltd. v. S. A. Fakie NO and Others, High Court of South Africa, Case No.4636/2002. The Role of Access to Information in Promoting Development 205 it had been unfairly excluded from the transaction due to political pressure or impropriety, as opposed to the merits of its bid. The court ordered that a vari- ety of documents relating to the arms deal, including the draft report, must be produced. In this case, access to information legislation was used to promote transparency in government, which is essential to development because of the role transparency plays in preventing corrupt practices. In Union for Civil Liberties (PUCL) and Another v. Union of India and Another, the Supreme Court of India dealt with an a empt by the government to over- rule one of its prior decisions by implementing legislation.72 The prior decision held that Indian citizens are entitled to know certain information about public officials and candidates for public office, including their assets, criminal rec- ords, and educational backgrounds, as a result of the constitutional right to freedom of expression.73 Subsequently, the Indian Parliament amended the Representation of the People Act such that candidates would not be required to make information available that related to their educational qualifications or assets “notwithstanding anything contained in the judgment of any court or directions issued by the Election Commission.”74 The Union for Civil Lib- erties challenged the constitutionality of the legislation, and the court held that the right to freedom of expression includes voters’ “fundamental right to know relevant antecedents of the candidate contesting the elections”75 and deemed the relevant portions of the legislation to be “illegal, null and void.”76 In Greenwatch (U) Ltd v. A orney General of Uganda and Uganda Electric- ity Transmission Co. Ltd, an environmental NGO used Uganda’s constitutional right of access to information to prevent the construction of the World Bank– funded Bujagali dam.77 Greenwatch Ltd. had requested documents relating to the project that both the Ugandan government and the World Bank ini- tially refused to release. The government alleged that the documents being sought did not exist, and later it argued that the disclosure of the requested records would threaten national security. The Uganda High Court did not accept these submissions and concluded that the records being sought were public documents to which Ugandan citizens were entitled access. Although the documents were not released to Greenwatch Ltd. on the basis that it had not adduced evidence as to its status as a citizen, the documents were subse- quently made public and were reviewed by the International River Network, which concluded that Ugandans would pay excessive costs if the dam project 72 Union for Civil Liberties (PUCL) and Another v. Union of India and Another, AIR [2003] SC 2363. 73 Union of India v. Association for Democratic Reforms and Another (2002), AIR 2112; 2002 (3) SCR 294. 74 S. 33(b) of Amended Representation of the People Act. 75 Union for Civil Liberties, supra note 73, at 9. 76 Id., at p. 41. 77 Greenwatch (U) Ltd v. A orney General of Uganda and Uganda Electricity Transmission Co. Ltd (2002), HCT-00-CV-MC-0139, High Ct. of Uganda. 206 The World Bank Legal Review were to proceed according to the plan at the time.78 Moreover, it was revealed that a government minister had received a payment from the subsidiary of the project’s main contractor.79 This led the World Bank to suspend its payments for the dam project, which avoided the consequence of excessive payments from Ugandan citizens. Obstacles to and Recommendations for Promoting Development through Domestic Access to Information Legislation The Information Abyss: An Absence of a Legal Regime Governing Access to Informa- tion. Although many states have implemented legal regimes that govern ac- cess to information,80 the majority have not adopted similar legal frameworks. The absence of a legislative framework that regulates access to information presents obvious problems for the achievement of freedom of information. To begin with, without explicit implementation of legislation or a constitutional provision that confirms the existence of a right of access in a given state, indi- viduals seeking information have li le legal authority on which they can rely that would persuade a government that is reluctant to share what is being sought. Additionally, where a right to information is protected in a state’s constitution or bill of rights, there may be no procedure for accessing public records to provide the scope of the right’s content. Without a legal process that provides for the means to access information, it can be extremely challenging to identify when a violation of the right occurs or to seek recourse if a violation is established. The obvious solution for states without a legal regime that governs ac- cess to information is to adopt one. However, for most states, that is no small task and cannot be achieved without serious political will.81 As discussed previously, some institutions have produced model laws or binding interna- tional covenants that can serve as guidelines when it comes to creating or improving legal regimes on access to information that would be of assistance to states without appropriate legislation. It is essential to recognize that even without freedom of information laws, information can be used to promote development. While a government is taking steps toward the implementation of appropriate legislation, it can disseminate information to the public. For example, a government that does not have access to information legislation may provide public access to libraries, work toward increasing enrollment in schools, protect freedom of expression in the media, expand Internet access to 78 Transparency International Kenya, FOI in Kenya: The Value of the Right to Information, 58 Adili Newsle er (2004). 79 D. Pallister, Africa Dam’s Passage “Eased by Bribes,” The Guardian (Nov. 3, 2003), available at h p://www.guardian.co.uk/uk/2003/nov/03/davidpallister. 80 Art. 19, Freedom of Information supra note 69. 81 See h p://www.globalintegrity.org/node/512 (accessed May 1, 2013). Global Integrity, an NGO based out of South Africa and the United States, has reported that Ghana’s failure to present the access to information bill to parliament, a bill that has been pending since 2002, is due to a lack of political will on the part of the government. The Role of Access to Information in Promoting Development 207 areas that do not have it, or implement any one of a number of other measures that improve the circulation of human knowledge. Insufficient or Inappropriate Domestic Legal Regimes. Access to information re- gimes may hamper freedom of information, either by having insufficient pro- visions that regulate the entitlement of the public to information or through the presence of legislation that is specifically designed to limit the spread of information. Assessing the adequacy of an access to information regime on an ongoing basis is as important as ensuring that the framework is appropri- ate at the time of adoption. Without continually improving the legal regime governing access to information, even states that were once praised for their progressive legislation will eventually be left with archaic laws. On some occasions, the problems with existing laws are not limited to the inadequacy of the legislation governing access to information but pertain to instances where the law may have come into existence with the goal of limit- ing the public’s access to information.82 When seeking to improve access to in- formation legislation, states should look to existing model laws, conduct wide public consultations in good faith, and seek input from other stakeholders or experts, including the media, interested NGOs, and academics. By gathering input from these parties on an ongoing basis, states can ensure that the needs of their population are best served by the laws in place. Good Law Gone Bad: Insufficient Implementation of Existing Legal Regimes. The failure, or inability, to implement access to information laws that are other- wise commendable is a significant problem that stifles the flow of information and represents a disservice to the population that is subject to the law. One source of this problem is the insufficient number of personnel in government departments who are allocated to work in freedom of information. Solving the dilemma of insufficient human resources requires a rebalancing of the priori- ties of government departments. It is not enough to say that more funds must be allocated to freedom of information without recognizing that those funds must be taken from another area. Identifying which department’s funds must be cut in order to boost the capacity for compliance with freedom of infor- mation laws must be the prerogative of the individual government, which is in a position to understand the most pressing priorities of its constituency. 82 The Commonwealth Human Rights Initiative, an international NGO that seeks to ensure the protection of human rights within the commonwealth, has been critical of Zimbabwe for this reason. This NGO explained that although Zimbabwe’s constitution protects the right to receive and impart ideas and information (Art. 20, Constitution of Zimbabwe, published as a schedule to the Zimbabwe Constitution Order 1979 [S.I. 1979/1600 of the United King- dom] and as amended to No. 19 of Feb. 13, 2009), the Access to Information and Protection to Privacy Act in that country “provides only very limited provisions on access and privacy, and the main thrust of the Act is to give the government more powers for media censor- ship and control.” See h p://www.humanrightsinitiative.org/programs/ai/rti/international /laws_&_papers.htm (accessed May 1, 2013). Furthermore, under the Official Secrets Act, any communication of official information is unauthorized, unless disclosure to the person seeking the information is explicitly authorized. 208 The World Bank Legal Review However, a dedicated portion of a government’s budget must be assigned to comply with freedom of information legislation.83 An additional problem associated with implementing good law is poor record keeping. Although this may be a consequence of inadequate funding, it also may be due to the absence of an effective system. Establishing effec- tive record-keeping systems is important for every government department and would dramatically reduce the number of mysterious disappearances of government records. It is important to recognize that different government departments deal with different kinds of records. Thus, the system ought to be tailored to the needs of the relevant department. As technology increasingly infiltrates all aspects of human life, it would be preferable, where possible, to include an electronic record-keeping system that complements the use of hard copies. Electronic records would also promote efficiency within the gov- ernment department by making the search for, and production of, requested documents less complicated. The lack of adequate training provided to government officials is a ma- jor hurdle for the improvement of access to information. Training must be provided to employees who are designated to work in access to information as well as front-line employees. The information provided to government employees in training of this kind, including the up-to-date contact informa- tion of the relevant person within departments, should be consolidated in a manual that is made readily available to all employees. A final consideration that detracts from the successful implementation of an otherwise impressive legislative regime is the lack of a capacity to make requests by groups that could benefit most from information. There are many reasons why this problem may arise. For example, a group may not be aware of its right to access to information. In situations where there is an awareness of a right to information, the group may not understand the connection be- tween holding information and bringing about tangible benefits to personal lives or the community, or there may not be an understanding of the process of filing a request. In some situations, the requester may understand the pro- cess completely, but due to other considerations, such as the lack of an Inter- net connection or financial constraints, the requestor may not be able to file the request in the method contemplated by the legislation. Civil society organizations have a significant role to play in assisting with these issues. By providing training to community leaders or representatives from other sectors of the population, groups can be educated on their right to know, the process through which they can exercise that right, and the benefits associated with obtaining information. As well, civil society organizations can 83 The Open Democracy Advice Centre has recommended that 0.5 percent of an information holder’s annual budget be dedicated to implementing South Africa’s access to information legislation. See PAIA Civil Society Network Shadow Report 2011, available at h p://www.saha .org.za/news/2011/September/paia_civil_society_network_releases_shadow_report.htm (accessed May 1, 2013). The Role of Access to Information in Promoting Development 209 assist by providing the capacity to file requests to the appropriate government bodies on behalf of the person or group seeking information. Conclusion Development is a major issue on the global political and legal landscape and is being increasingly recognized and implemented by states as they strive to provide citizens with the opportunity to lead meaningful and fulfilling lives. Despite the increasing recognition of development as a legal right and political goal, much of the world remains plagued by poverty, disease, illiteracy, and other indices that suggest that development initiatives have not reached their potential. A major stumbling block in implementing de- velopment programs has been the failure to effectively disseminate informa- tion that would allow groups and individuals to meaningfully participate in democratic governance. Information allows individuals and groups a full measure of participation in public life, promotes efficient democratic governance, and protects human rights. Although a significant number of states have taken steps to implement the public right of access to information, many have no law that gives con- text to the international or constitutional legal right to seek and receive public information. Given that freedom of information is inextricably linked to the promotion of human rights, including the right to development, the failure to implement freedom of information laws at either the international or the domestic level is unacceptable. The United Nations, regional organizations, and many national govern- ments have taken steps to increase the flow of information, which is a laudable objective, although the results have been mixed. There has been significant progress in raising awareness of the right to information and drawing a en- tion to violations of that right. In addition, dispute resolution mechanisms have been established that provide remedies for the victims of a violation of their right to information. However, the systems that deliver the benefits are often inefficient and their reach is not universal. If states, acting collectively or unilaterally, can muster the political will to continually monitor and improve access to information by global citizens, they can expect to witness expedited progress as a result of investments in development initiatives. This page intentionally left blank The Search for Opportunity and Inclusion Insecurity and Migration EMILIO C. VIANO In the aftermath of the terrorist a acks that shook the United States on Sep- tember 11, 2001, and then Spain, the United Kingdom, India, many Middle Eastern countries, and many other places worldwide, extraordinary measures have been taken to control and limit migration. Migration has become strong- ly “securitized.” Among other things, this means that the perspectives, analy- ses, policies, and legislation related to migration are now mostly framed from the point of view of the security of the state and not so much in terms of the security of the migrants. Indeed, the security of many migrants is endangered from the moment they decide to migrate, and that danger grows more acute as they take a perilous journey that may lead to their victimization, enslave- ment, and even death. Even prior to migration, the decision to migrate is often related to the insecurity of their environment, racked by conflict, ethnic or religious strife, economic crisis, criminal violence, and fear.1 In many developing countries, the violence of development itself is at the root of a score of insecurities that cause people to move away, because they are forced, at times at gunpoint, to leave, or because they are in search of a more just and favorable environment. In a special issue of the journal Development, Arturo Escobar2 underlines the point that violence is essential to development and strongly connected to displacement, an aspect of modernization that has become so common that it is taken for granted and overlooked.3 One of the many glaring current examples of this dynamic is the construction of the Belo Monte Dam on the river Xingu in the state of Parà in Brazil. This massive proj- ect involves the building of water deviation canals, the flooding of thousands of acres of Amazonian forest, and the creation of a lake of some 500 square kilometers (50,000 hectares), making it very difficult and at times impossible for the indigenous populations to use altered fluvial routes for fishing and navigation in a region without roads. The project will uproot and displace indigenous tribes from their tribal lands and have serious negative effects on flora, fauna, and the climate of the region. Violence and the heavy intervention of the Brazilian military police to forcibly remove indigenous tribes accompany 1 Ibrahim Sirkeci, Conflict, the Environment of Human Insecurity and Migration in Iraq in the Af- termath of 2003, in Rethinking Global Migration: Practices, Policies and Discourses in the European Neighbourhood 161‒175 (H. Ri ersberger-Tilic ed., KORA 2008). 2 Arturo Escobar, Development, Violence and the New Imperial Order, 47(1) Dev. 15‒21 (2004). 3 Marianne Marchand, The Violence of Development and the Migration/Insecurity Nexus: Labour Migration in a North American Context, 29(7) Third World Q. 1375‒1388 (2008). 211 212 The World Bank Legal Review the construction of Belo Monte, along with drug and human trafficking, pros- titution, land grabs, and the uprooting of the existing communities. Similar events are taking place in the Omo River region, one of Africa’s― and the world’s―last, great undiscovered places, home to the so-called van- ishing tribes of Ethiopia. The massive Gilgel Gibe III Dam is scheduled to begin operations several hundred miles upriver from where the tribes live. While the controversial project will more than double electrical output in Ethi- opia, it will destroy a fragile environment and displace as many as 200,000 indigenous people who rely on the Omo’s natural flood cycles to produce their crops, and whose land may now go dry. Not only were the tribes not consulted; most locals are reportedly unaware that these changes are coming. The dam will have catastrophic consequences for the eight different tribes of the Omo River, who already live a marginal life in this dry and very challeng- ing area. That the end is near in a region once inhabited by some of our earliest ancestors (Australopithecus walked these very river banks) not only is sad but also points out the violent displacement and life-threatening insecurity that “development” engenders. The same is true with farmers forced off their land in various parts of China; with fishing communities losing their livelihood because of devastat- ing pollution affecting marine life in the Great Barrier Reef area of Australia due to massive mining and shipping of minerals and the concomitant port construction and expansion of ship traffic; with other indigenous people los- ing their land and way of life to powerful and well-connected entrepreneurs expanding their landholdings to raise ca le or to engage in open-air mining in the “Triple Frontier” region shared by Brazil, Paraguay, and Argentina, an area until recently considered impenetrable. Some 20 indigenous groups in the area, including a totally isolated group in Paraguay believed never to have had contact with “modern” people, have been abused, forcibly displaced, and reduced to a life of homelessness, poverty, begging, alcoholism, and resort- ing to prostitution and pe y crime for survival.4 The Mapuche in southern Chile and the descendants of the Maya in Chiapas, Mexico, have faced and are still confronted with similar depredations, displacement, and insecurity, often with the connivance of the state and the weight of the law. The insecurity at the root of migration and the violence that accompanies it are different in nature, intensity, and aftermath, depending on the gender of the migrant. Although often unrecognized, there are diverse types of insecu- rity and violence for men and women that stem from their different social and economic status, their access to power and control, and the equation of power between them.5 4 Sentencia Final, Tribunal del Juicio Ético a las Transnacionales (Nov. 11, 2011), available at h p://juicioalastransnacionales.org/2011/11/sentencia-final-del-tribunal-del-juicio-etico-a -las-transnacionales/. 5 Marchand, supra note 3; and Ibrahim Sirkeci, Jeffrey Cohen, & Pinar Yazgan, The Turkish Cul- ture of Migration: Flows between Turkey and Germany, Socio-economic Development and Conflict, 9(1) Migration Le ers 33‒46 (2012). The Search for Opportunity and Inclusion 213 Security for the State or for the Migrant? Since the terrorist a acks in the United States and various other countries, the issues of migration and security have become inextricably linked in current political theory and debate. What “security” means varies largely, of course, depending on who is using the term and why. A framework for envisioning the relationship between cross-border mi- gration and security, developed by Fiona Adamson,6 posits three central areas in which migration and the interests of the state may intersect: the sovereignty of the state, the balance of power among the states, and the nature of violent conflict in the international system. One could add other key areas such as the social, cultural, or religious identity of the core inhabitants; the ultimate control over natural, human, and cultural resources, including the language spoken; and the social mores, customs, and legal tenets steeped in a particu- lar tradition and understanding of reality. While migration is generally con- nected to the security of the state, it is less often linked to individual or human security. Adamson7 also stresses the fundamental difference in perspective, and therefore in analysis, when one links migration to national security or to human security. While “not necessarily . . . diametrically opposed,” the per- spectives represent different analytical lenses through which one can assess the security impact of international migration.8 Thanks to today’s wide and live coverage of world events, there is con- siderable awareness and appreciation of the hardships and perils of all stages of migration. The migrants themselves recounting their experience; the visual documentation of their suffering made possible by widely available filming technology; the scholarly and action-oriented analysis of what the migrants went through―all these sources support viewing migration as presenting considerable, and at times lethal, challenges to human security. Moreover, the policies and actions taken, mostly by the state, but at times also by indi- viduals, vigilantes, or nonofficial groups, constitute an additional major threat to migrants. Consequently, it seems correct to “[reconceptualize] security in multidimensional and multilevel terms.”9 In other words, given the plight of many migrants, and the policies and actions of the countries and people they may encounter on their journey or upon reaching their destination, it is justified, indeed necessary, to view the relationship between migration and security above and beyond the dangers that migration may generate for the state, including those stemming from the state’s response to it. This change of the lens through which migration is seen 6 Fiona Adamson, Crossing Borders: International Migration and National Security, 31(1) Intl. Sec. 165‒199 (2006). 7 Id. 8 Id., at 167. 9 J. Ann Tickner, Gender in International Relations 128 (Columbia U. Press 1992). 214 The World Bank Legal Review provides considerable advantages for a realistic understanding of what “mi- gration and security” means “from below,” for those directly involved in it and who, most often, are not asked.10 This applies especially to the dynamics and relations of cultural, linguistic, legal, and financial dominance and con- trol. The resulting chasms and insecurities need to be recognized and stressed. Shining a light on contextually dependent interactions, relationships, and ac- tions is very helpful in analyzing and understanding migration. Recognizing, valuing, and analyzing how marginalized people live and what they experi- ence, especially women and children, is indispensable to gaining a deeper un- derstanding of the connection between apparently common daily events and experiences and the seemingly far-distant issues of international politics and economics.11 For example, there are strong commonalities between the experi- ences of Sub-Saharan migrants a empting to get to Europe through North Af- rica and those trying to get to the United States through Mexico, to Australia through Indonesia and Timor, to Malaysia through Thailand from Myanmar/ Burma, and so on, worldwide. There is no question that migration is a major political, human, and finan- cial challenge facing especially the developed countries today but affecting almost every country, offering a glimpse of hope and a be er life to those who live generally in more desperate situations. Poverty, after all, is a relative con- cept. Even a slight improvement in earnings, obtaining employment, receiv- ing be er health and education services, or providing a springboard to a yet be er country is enough of a reason for people to face countless hardships to move, at times just “next door.” Technology, the Economy, and the Ebbs and Flows of Migration The technological advances that make it so much easier and cheaper to travel internationally, communicate with visual contact (e.g., through Skype), send and receive money, move back and forth depending on needs and on the sea- son, and maintain linguistic, religious, cultural, and affective ties have led to an unstoppable surge of migratory movements that characterize much of the international political, labor, and financial sectors of the world today. This surge is most visible where there are land bridges that permit easier contacts, such as between Mexico and Central America and the United States or be- tween western and eastern Europe. The continuous and unabated series of armed conflicts in the world, whether international or domestic, has also gen- erated in many parts of the world massive movements of people seeking to escape mayhem, death, and destruction. From the mass migrations of princi- pally Eastern Europeans after World War II, which led to the creation of the United Nations High Commission for Refugees (UNHCR), to those fleeing 10 Gunhild Jorgensen & Kirsti Stuvoy, Gender, Resistance and Human Security, 37(2) Sec. Dia- logue 207‒228 (2006); Jane Freedman, Analysing the Gendered Insecurities of Migration, 14(1) Intl. Feminist J. Pol. 36‒55 (2012). 11 Jorgensen & Stuvoy, supra note 10, at 223; Freedman, supra note 10, at 38. The Search for Opportunity and Inclusion 215 conflict related to the partition of India and other episodes of decolonization in Asia and Africa, to people escaping war, killings, and destruction in South Asia, Central America, East Timor, Darfur and South Sudan, Liberia, Sierra Leone, the Democratic Republic of Congo, Iraq, Afghanistan, Turkey, Burma, and most recently Syria, one can clearly correlate insecurity at home with the quest for security elsewhere.12 Even in the case of financial and political turmoil, which does not nec- essarily involve armed conflict, the ease and low cost of communications awareness of other lifestyles and opportunities abroad through the media, and historical and cultural ties can spur considerable emigration. Thus, many people from South American countries undergoing deep political change and economic uncertainty―such as Argentina, Peru, Bolivia, Ecuador, Venezuela, Nicaragua, Honduras, and El Salvador―migrated during the past 20 years, especially to countries such as Italy or Spain. They have now begun to return to their original countries in response to the economic turmoil and downturn experienced in those European (and other) nations to which they emigrated. Ironically, their countries of origin now offer increased opportunities and at- tractive possibilities. And even some of the European natives from those same emigrant-destination countries might now migrate abroad. Thus, a country of immigration can become quite rapidly a country of emigration, and vice versa. For example, recent data show that in 2011 the number of Spanish citi- zens leaving Spain to reside abroad grew 8.2 percent and in 2012 6.3 percent (in 2012, the number was 114,413 persons, 44,000 of them born in Spain). The majority of Spanish citizens living abroad reside in South America, especially Argentina and Brazil, and in Cuba. In relative terms, the countries that in 2012 experienced the most significant increase of Spanish immigrants were Ecua- dor, Chile, and Peru.13 Most of the migrants from Spain are naturalized immi- grants who are returning to their country of birth.14 Ireland, too, can be seen as a country where immigration and emigration fairly often and quickly change direction. Since 1700, and especially because of the Great Famine of 1840, Ireland has been an exporter of millions of emi- grants, creating what is called the Irish Diaspora. Presently, it is estimated that 80 million people worldwide could claim some Irish descent, with 50 million of them resident in the United States. Ten percent of British citizens have at least one Irish grandparent.15 In the 1990s, however, Ireland’s economic boom transformed the country into one of “net immigration,” with significant num- bers of immigrants arriving from outside the European Union. Many Irish 12 Sirkeci, supra note 1. 13 20minutos.es, El numero de españoles en el extranjero crece un 6.3% en un año y roza los dos millones (Mar. 20, 2013). 14 RTVE.es, El numero de españoles residentes en el extranjero creció en más de 114.000 en 2012 (Mar. 20, 2013). 15 Owen Bowco , More Britons Applying for Irish Passports, Guardian (Manchester, Sept. 13, 2006). 216 The World Bank Legal Review nationals also returned to Ireland from abroad. The enlargement of the Euro- pean Union to encompass eastern European countries generated a major im- migration wave from those countries into Ireland as recently as 2004‒2008.16 Now, with the economic crisis and unemployment hovering around 15 per- cent, Ireland is once more a country of emigration. Reportedly, between April 2011 and April 2012, 87,000 people left the country looking for a job elsewhere. The data on emigration from Ireland in 2012 show a 240 percent increase from the low number of 2002. The concurrent moving in and out of Ireland by mi- grants during the past 10 years or so is a dramatic and vivid testament to the unprecedented fluctuations that can take place today at short notice.17 These drastic changes reflect, and in turn generate, strong feelings and a reality of insecurity and vulnerability. Additionally, the fact that wealth inequality is falling in most of the world, but rising in the West, foretells new tides of migration, away from the tradi- tional countries of immigration and toward the countries once considered the major source of emigration. Not only is extreme poverty disappearing but also the world as a whole is being transformed into a more equal place, with the developed countries actually going against that trend. This will no doubt profoundly affect current pa erns of dominance and of perceived superiority, and alter worldwide migratory currents. Migration, Terrorism, and Securing the Border Making migration, and particularly irregular migration, a priority policy is- sue, especially in the European Union and the United States, is no doubt re- lated to the vast effort to “securitize” it. The expression “irregular migration” mostly covers the cross-border movement of people who enter a country lack- ing that country’s permission to do so. A “regular” or “legal” migrant can become “irregular” as well; for example, the migrant might violate the terms of her visa, overstay his visa, or commit a crime. There is an ample vocabulary referring to this phenomenon. In English, the most common term is “illegal” migrant, while, for example, in French, it is “irregular” migrant or “sans pa- piers.” For many reasons, including disagreements on its definition, there are no firm data on irregular migration. Because it is an underground phenome- non, it is not recorded. Consequently, it is not possible to measure it accurately or reliably. It is estimated. Irregular migration is increasingly seen as primarily a security problem. For this reason, current efforts to reform immigration laws in the United States, for example, are prefaced, first and foremost, by “securing the border” 16 Martin Ruhs, Ireland: From Rapid Immigration to Recession (country profile, Migration Info., Source, Migration Info. Inst., Sept. 2009). 17 Mary Gilmartin, The Changing Landscape of Irish Migration, 2000‒2012 (Working Paper No. 69, Natl. Inst. for Regl. & Spatial Analysis, Natl. U. of Ireland); Ibrahim Sirkeci, Philip L. Martin, & Eugen Stark, Editorial: Migration and Development: Comparing Mexico‒US and Turkey‒Eu- rope, 9(1) Migration Le ers 1–10 (2012). The Search for Opportunity and Inclusion 217 to make the subject politically palatable. Among the most salient measures taken to demonstrate the government’s commitment to security are the con- struction of a wall hundreds of kilometers long; the use of increased land and air patrols; the deployment of drones to patrol the border nonstop; the use of sensory and night-vision devices to detect movement in remote areas, especially at night; the enlistment of locals to help patrol, spot movement, and report it, and even confront irregular migrants; and making it a crime to pro- vide assistance, food, or water to irregular immigrants crossing the vast des- ert between Mexico and the United States.18 In the United States, sealing the border is considered an indispensable prerequisite to regularizing the status of the irregular immigrants who are already in the country, as if this would be a permanent solution and the end of the irregular immigration for years to come. “Irregular” immigration has been seen and depicted as a threat to the na- tional economy, to the labor market, to decent wages, to gains in compensa- tion and benefits, and to the national heritage, culture, religion, and language. Above all, it has been tied to the menace of international terrorism.19 Irregular immigration is considered by many to be the major method of entry for for- eign terrorists, who can then take advantage of the weaknesses of the system and infiltrate the nation, establishing criminal and terrorist cells in neighbor- hoods dominated by their ethnic group, and subsequently create havoc and destruction. This perspective has gained a lot of currency, especially after the a acks in Madrid in March 2004 and in London in July 2005; the failed a acks against U.S. airlines by the so-called shoe bomber, Richard Reid, in 2001 and by the so-called underwear bomber, Umar Farouk Abdulmutallab, in 2009; and the continuing perceived threat posed by some immigrant militants in EU countries.20 Terrorism, Securitization, and the European Union In Europe, these terrorist or a empted terrorist events have been used to justify an increased securitization of migration, especially from Africa. The continuing arrival of migrants from Africa has been described as a crisis that must be controlled. This perception was considerably strengthened when thousands of Libyans, Tunisians, and Sub-Saharan Africans arrived on the shores of Italy and Spain in the aftermath of the so-called Arab Spring in 2011. The small Italian island of Pantelleria has been virtually overrun by large groups of mi- grants faced with a bleak situation upon arrival because of lack of resources 18 In France, for example, according to a law approved on December 27, 1994, it is illegal to help or assist an irregular or undocumented immigrant, for example, by providing shelter or food. 19 Derek Lu erbeck, Policing Migration in the Mediterranean, 11(1) Mediterranean Pol. 59‒82 (2006); Freedman, supra note 10, at 39. 20 Hein De Haas, The Myth of Invasion: Irregular Migration from West Africa to the Maghreb and the European Union (research report, Intl. Migration Inst., Oxford U. Oct. 2007). 218 The World Bank Legal Review on the island and the distance from the mainland. From August 1, 2012, to Au- gust 10, 2013, 24,227 immigrants arrived on this tiny island, which until then had a permanent population of 7,679. The same happened in the Canary Islands off the coast of the Western Sa- hara, Morocco, and Mauritania. Greece’s porous frontiers have also been used by thousands of migrants from Africa, the Middle East, and points beyond to easily enter the European Union. The lack of a coherent and unified policy and the nonexistence of a federal enforcement agency or group protecting the borders of the European Union have allowed this vast movement of people to continue unabated. The Cotonou Agreement of 2000 between the European Union and various African countries requires, in its Article 13.5, countries of the ACP (Africa, Ca- ribbean, and Pacific) region to take back their citizens caught residing illegally in the European Union, along with other nationals who crossed those countries on their journey toward the European Union. Since the 1990s, a readmission clause has been routinely included in partnership and cooperation agreements between the European Union and various countries, including Ukraine, Mol- dova, and Kazakhstan, and in the Euro-Mediterranean association agreements of 2000 with Morocco, Algeria, and Tunisia. In June 2002, the European Union began requiring the readmission clause to be included in any cooperation, as- sociation, or equivalent agreement that it signs with any country. Linking economic and trade policies with developmental assistance and trying to control migration flows through bilateral agreements is practiced not just by the European Union. Member states of the European Union have en- tered into similar bilateral agreements with Mediterranean countries: France, Italy, and Spain in particular have bilateral agreements to control migration flows. There have been several expulsions also between Mali and Algeria, Mali and Mauritania, Morocco and Algeria, Morocco and the Western Sahara. Moreover, the EU member states closest to North Africa have increased their naval patrols, even beyond territorial waters, and new border control mea- sures have been steadily introduced by the European Union’s External Bor- ders Agency. The European Union has also used “the carrot” to motivate African countries to control migration. Considerable amounts of funds for development in the countries of origin of the migrants and for migration-re- lated programs have been made available. Also, a new thematic program on migration and asylum has been funded.21 However, it is actually estimated that there are about 4 million irregular migrants in the European Union, with the United Kingdom and Italy having the largest number.22 As a consequence of the turmoil in the Islamic world, especially the wars in Iraq and Afghani- stan, and in the aftermath of the Arab Spring, in the first quarter of 2011 there 21 European Commission, Migration and Asylum (2012), available at h p://ec.europa.eu/europe aid/what/migration-asylum/ . 22 Anil Dawar, Scandal of UK’s 863,000 Illegal Immigrants, One in Four of the EU’s Total, Daily & Sunday Express (Dec. 18, 2012), available at h p://www.express.co.uk/news/uk/365637 /Scandal-of-UK-s-863-000, citing the 2008 European Union study, Clandestino. The Search for Opportunity and Inclusion 219 was a significant increase in known illegal crossings of the sea frontiers of the European Union, the largest number of any first quarter in recent years.23 Thus, all these EU approaches and policies have not succeeded in diminishing or stopping irregular migration into the European Union. Increased State Controls and Increased Journey Insecurity The most immediate effect of efforts to control and discourage migration is to make it more difficult and dangerous for regular migrants to reach their des- tinations. Put differently, the insecurity of the migrant journey has increased considerably. More rugged, more isolated, less patrolled routes, or less guarded points of entry must be chosen to reach the desired destination. This increases the cost of the journey, leading to increased indentured servitude on the part of the migrant, who often must pay back those costs with the meager earnings of his or her work abroad. It also increases the possibility of injury or death, given the more inhospitable terrain or longer route; the potential of experienc- ing violence along the way; and dependency on the guides leading the group, with consequent increased fees, exploitation, and mistreatment. Ironically, the countermeasures adopted by the European Union, the United States, and other countries have increased the market for, and the im- portance of, smugglers and traffickers, thus making the migrants more vulner- able and more insecure. These increased power imbalances are often opera- tionalized in the form of financial or sexual exploitation carried out by various actors, ranging from the “coyotes” or “snakeheads” guiding the group, to fel- low travelers, to border patrol agents or police, to vigilantes capturing the migrants.24 Migration increases and strengthens power differentials―often linked to gender, status, national origin, or race―that already existed and functioned before the migration took place. Thus the state’s enhanced policies and interventions, meant to discourage and eliminate irregular migration, not only fail to mitigate or discourage it but also often have the negative effect of increasing it, and magnifying the violence and exploitation that accompany it. Amnesty International’s report In Hostile Terrain: Human Rights Violations in Immigration Enforcement in the US Southwest25 examines the human rights violations associated with immigration enforcement at the border and in the interior of the United States. Among its findings is that recent immigration policy in certain border areas has pushed undocumented immigrants into us- ing dangerous routes through Mexican and U.S. deserts. Hundreds of people die each year as a result. 23 Christal Morehouse & Michael Blomfield, Irregular Migration in Europe 6 (Transatlantic Council on Migration 2011). 24 De Haas, supra note 20. 25 Published Mar. 28, 2012; available at h p://www.amnesty.org/en/library/asset/AMR51 /018/2012/en/4905b8cd-8d5b-41b9-a301-3121fca2e1cd/amr510182012en.pdf. 220 The World Bank Legal Review The Feminization of Migration and Insecurity Migration is becoming increasingly feminized. In the classic model of migra- tion, the migrant was a man, leaving behind his family for his wife to care for, until his return. Traveling in the company of Algerian lawyers in late 1980s from Batna, Algeria, to an oasis in the Sahara, we passed a mountain range with small villages carved out on ledges. The guide pointed them out and mentioned that those villages were full of “white widows,” women left be- hind by emigrating husbands. That pa ern has changed considerably in the past 20 years. While the percentage of women among migrants has always been significant, the number of women migrants has increased steadily since 1965 and they presently constitute about half of all international migrants, or an estimated 100 million international migrants.26 By 2005, with the exception of Asia and Africa, women migrants slightly outnumbered men.27 The most dramatic change in female migration has been that women are increasingly emigrating on their own in search of work, instead of moving abroad with their husbands or reuniting with them there.28 A major reason for the growth of the woman migrant on her own has been the increased prosper- ity in the world, which has generated a growing demand for services, the field in which the majority of women migrants find employment. For example, the growing wealth of Brazil means that fewer Brazilian women need to work in private homes as maids and caretakers with low pay and long hours. This eventually generates a demand for irregular immigrants from neighboring South American countries to take over those jobs, most often at even lower wages and with no benefits. Also important has been the aging of the developed countries versus the youthfulness of the developing ones. Increasing employment opportunities and the availability and low cost of transportation and communication (e.g., Internet, cell phones, and Skype) are other important factors behind the seem- ingly unstoppable flow of migrants. Eastern European women, especially Romanians, are a good example. Many Romanian women have emigrated on their own, often leaving behind children and husbands, to enter the service sector in Italy, especially caring for the elderly, children, and the sick. In a country like Italy, where the family has traditionally taken primary responsibility for caring for the elderly parent or the infant, la badante (“the helper” or “the a endant”) has now become a fixture in the socioeconomic life of Italians. 26 United Nations Population Division, Human Development Report, Overcoming Barriers: Human Mobility and Development (Palgrave McMillan 2009). 27 United Nations Population Fund, A Passage to Hope: Women and International Migration 23 (State of World Population series, 2006). 28 Gloria Moreno-Fontes Chammartin, Female Migrant Workers’ Situation in the Labour Market (paper presented at the Thematic Rev. Seminar of the Mutual Learning Programme of the European Empl. Strategy, Brussels, Apr. 29, 2008); Reflections on Domestic Work and the Femi- nization of Migration, 31(1) Campbell Law Review 67 (Fall 2008). The Search for Opportunity and Inclusion 221 The feminization of migration is also fueled by two other major recent so- cioeconomic pa erns: the feminization of poverty and of work.29 Other causes range from economic and social crises in particular regions of the world to employment and career discrimination against women in general but espe- cially against divorced and widowed women, single mothers, and unmarried women past a certain age.30 The Woman Migrant and Her Security Until the end of the 20th century, migration studies by and large overlooked the woman migrant. Women were invisible. The assumption was that all mi- grants were men and that women were simply “dependents” who, if they left home, followed their husbands or fathers. Thus, if women were discussed, they were included only as wives, daughters, and dependents of the male em- igrant. However, this was not always so. Especially during the past 30 years, women have started to be recognized as migrants on their own, as breadwin- ners, and as the principal providers for the economic needs of their families. There is no question that men and women relate to migration in very dif- ferent ways: they exhibit different pa erns and behaviors, they react differently to diverse opportunities, they face disparate obstacles and challenges, and they have to deal with different security issues. In human health issues, it has been found that studying only men and extrapolating the findings to include wom- en does not work. That same knowledge should apply to migration and secu- rity issues related to women. Like health, diet, exercise, and almost every other issue, migration is not gender neutral. Women face their own, very specific rea- sons to leave, their own risks, challenges, and vulnerabilities, such as violations of their human rights, discrimination, exploitation, and health-related issues. The migration-insecurity link can be at work in all stages of migration.31 From a security standpoint, women very often decide to migrate to escape situations of abuse, denigration, and exploitation. Child abuse, sexual abuse, spouse abuse, forced marriages, servitude, and financial exploitation are often at the root of a woman’s decision to leave. In regard to health issues, women choose to leave for various reasons, including being subject to female genital mutilation, child marriage, early sexual activity and pregnancies, overall pow- erlessness in sexual relations leading to multiple pregnancies, risk of contract- ing HIV/AIDS and other sexually transmi ed diseases, and early aging due to serial pregnancies and backbreaking, incessant work. 29 Sally Baden & Kirsti Milward, Gender Inequality and Poverty: Trends, Linkages, Analysis and Poverty Implications (unpublished report, BRIDGE 2000); BRIDGE Development—Gender, Briefing Paper on the “Feminization of Poverty” (Sussex Inst. Dev. Stud. Apr. 2001); Fiona Adamson & Sally Baden, Gender, Governance and the “Feminisation of Poverty” (unpublished report, 2nd version, BRIDGE 1999). 30 Jeffrey Cohen & Ibrahim Sirkeci, Centuries of Migration: The Global Nature of Contemporary Mobility (U. of Texas Press 2013). 31 Freedman, supra note 10. 222 The World Bank Legal Review These concerns can be exacerbated by patriarchal values and power hier- archies that deny women basic freedoms, important choices, and a minimum of autonomy. It must not be overlooked that women are also discriminated against financially: in earnings, in their capacity to support and maintain their families, and in starting or managing a business. Thus, a woman’s decision to migrate is usually rather complex rather than simple, stemming from a variety of factors, many of them gender specific. Poverty results not just from limited or no income but also from lack of or restricted access to opportunity and choice.32 Unfortunately, the values and a itudes mentioned above often accom- pany women when they finally migrate. The risk of violence is high for all migrants but more so for women, especially when it comes to sexual violence. In many cultures, a woman’s appearance in a public space is such a depar- ture from accepted norms that it is often considered equivalent to availability for and even an invitation to a sexual encounter. The men interacting with a woman traveling by herself see her being there without male protection as an invitation, a statement of availability, a permission to approach her for sexual activity or force her into it. These values surfaced recently in March 2013 in the context of the gang rape of a Swiss woman tourist traveling by bicycle and camping overnight with her husband in Central India. According to the BBC, local officials reportedly questioned why the woman, even though with her husband, would make herself vulnerable to the point of “asking for it” by camping overnight in a dense forest. Thus, her being there, camping in the open, was seen as her implicitly giving permission for, even inviting, the group of men to a ack her sexually. The same a itude was apparently at work when, in March 2013, a British woman tourist in Agra, India, decided to jump out of the second-floor window of her hotel room to escape an a empted rape by the hotel owner and another employee who entered her room at 3:45 a.m. as she was sleeping. A group of Japanese tourists had previously complained that the same hotel’s staff had behaved obscenely toward the women in their group.33 Women migrants know only too well that they are often seen as re- sponsible and guilty for men’s violent sexual behavior. Women’s dependence on a male guide during some migration journeys also makes them vulnerable to violent a acks, exploitation, and rape. During a journey, while crossing a desert or unknown territory, the threat of being left behind or excluded from the group can be used to force a woman into unwanted sexual activity with the guide or other men on the journey. Thus, sexual violence against migrant women becomes “normalized”; it becomes part of the journey.34 This reality is frequently experienced by women who do not have the financial resources to pay the high fees asked by smugglers. 32 Sylvia Chant , Gender, Generation and Poverty: Exploring the “Feminisation of Poverty” in Africa, Asia and Latin America (Edgar Elver 2007); Freedman, supra note 10. 33 British Woman Jumps off Hotel Room to Escape Rape Bid; Hotel Owner Held, Times of India (Mar. 20, 2013). 34 Freedman, supra note 10, at 46. The Search for Opportunity and Inclusion 223 Moreover, once the journey is under way, the smuggler may extort more mon- ey from everyone because the migrants are now under his control and highly dependent on him for their survival. For some women, agreeing to sexual activity may be the only way to meet aggressive demands for more money.35 This “sexual-economic” type of transaction is reportedly quite frequent and “normal” in irregular migration. This so-called survival sex on the migrants’ route is similar to that of displaced women in refugee camps where sexual favors or agreeing to prostitution may be extorted if a woman wants to obtain food, water, or some measure of protection for herself and her children in chaotic and mob-like situations.36 Other Aspects of Insecurity for Women Migrants It goes without saying that other serious aspects of insecurity are present in these situations when the woman has very li le, if any, power to control the situation, negotiate compensation, or control the type and manner of sexual encounter, including whether safe sex will be practiced.37 Insecurity, especially for women, also arises if a traveling group is a acked by one of the bands that regularly prey on irregular migrants making their way through isolated areas. These violent groups rob migrants of their valuables, at times beat or even kill some of them, steal their food, and often rape women or abduct them and hold them for forced labor, including sexual services. In the vast, lawless, and isolated no-man’s land that some migrants must cross, anything can happen, especially to a woman. It has been reported that at times even a woman’s intimate parts may be searched for hidden cash be- fore she is raped. In an a empt to protect themselves from a ack, migrant women may be under pressure to find a male as a travel companion and tra- ditional protector. The outcome may unfortunately be for the woman to find herself in an insecure situation at the hands of the male she thought would protect her, but who, instead, is violent and exploitative, taking advantage of the uneven power situation. Thus, sexual assault and exploitation are frequent ingredients in the dy- namics of domination by one gender, most often male, over the other, the 35 Joe Doezema, Forced to Choose: Beyond the Voluntary v. Forced Prostitution Dichotomy, in Global Sex Workers: Rights, Resistance and Redefinition (Kamala Kempadoo & Joe Doezema eds., Routledge 1998). 36 Freedman, supra note 10, at 46; U.N. General Assembly, Investigating into Sexual Exploitation of Refugees by Aid Workers in West Africa, Note by the Secretary General, A/57/465 (Oct. 11, 2002); and U.N. General Assembly, A Comprehensive Strategy to Eliminate Future Sexual Exploitation and Abuse in U.N. Peacekeeping Operations, Le er dated 24 March 2003 from the Secretary General to the President of the General Assembly, A/59/710 (Mar. 24, 2005). 37 Diane O o, Making Sense of Zero Tolerance Policies in Peacekeeping Sexual Economies, in Sexual- ity and the Law (Vanessa Munro & Carl Stychin eds., Routledge Cavendish 2010); Melissa Petro, Selling Sex: Women’s Participation in the Sex Industry, in Sex Work Ma ers: Exploring Money, Power and Intimacy in the Sex Industry 155‒170 (Melissa Ditmore, Antonia Levy, & Alys Willman eds., Zed 2010). 224 The World Bank Legal Review migrant female in a vulnerable situation. Like rape in war, forced or exploit- ative sex in irregular migration is used to express and reinforce a general cul- ture and pa ern of domination to frighten and demean women and to impose male superiority and exercise the so-called man’s privilege. It must be stressed that it is not only men who are involved in irregular migration, especially in the trafficking of women for sexual and labor exploita- tion abroad. For example, in Nigeria, women manage the process of recruiting Nigerian women for exploitation. They recruit the young victims in Nigeria and also control them once they reach their country of destination. However, men generally supervise and control transporting the “goods” from one coun- try to another and delivering them to their destination.38 The State’s Use and Abuse of Power: More Insecurity for Migrants As mentioned previously, the state can make irregular migration much more insecure when it takes more measures to combat, deter, and stifle it. Doing so makes it much more difficult and perilous to migrate, in that migrants must take alternative out-of-the-way routes, often more rugged, arduous, and iso- lated, with considerable obstacles. The increased “security” measures by the state often also mean more aggressive enforcement, raids, roundups, arrests, incarceration, deportations, human rights abuses, use of excessive force, po- lice abuses, and even death or injury. Thus, one could say that the state and its officials often become more visible and prominent as agents of insecurity for the irregular migrant. Here, too, women bear the brunt of the state’s inter- vention. Women migrants are often treated differently than their male coun- terparts. Moreover, the failure of the state to recognize and acknowledge the special situation of women in regard to lack of equality and security―treating women in the same manner as men―adds to the difficulties and challenges that women migrants face. It actually exacerbates their precarious situation and exposes them to the danger of continued humiliation, exploitation, and victimization. There are no provisions in place for taking into account the special concerns for their health and the special need that they have to be protected from predatory and exploitative behavior. Children and pregnant women are treated no differently than other irregular migrants; they must en- dure the same level of brutality and aggression as others. Pregnant women at times even lose their baby due to the rough and uncaring treatment by border protection forces.39 The establishment and activities of groups that target undocumented migrants, both during their journeys and afterward, seem to be encouraged and even justified by the enactment of laws that criminalize the daily lives of 38 Eugenia Bone i, The Strength of Networking between Countries of Origin and Destination (paper presented at “Consultation against Commercial Sexual Exploitation” conference, Winnipeg, Nov. 3‒5, 2006). 39 Mehdi Lahlou, Claire Escoffier, & Najia Hajji, Evaluation de la situation de la mobilité et du VIH au Maroc (UNAIDS & Ministère de la Santé Publique 2007). The Search for Opportunity and Inclusion 225 migrants. Such laws discourage irregular migrants from reporting their vic- timization and seeking justice. Even worse is the situation of those migrants and trafficked or enslaved persons who go to the police to seek protection and justice and are instead returned to their victimizer and exploiter. Hardened immigration and border control policies do have an impact, increasing the risks that irregular migrants must deal with on their journey and after arrival. They also make it much more difficult and dangerous for community-based networks to provide support and ensure safe journeys. For example, the criminalization of Latinos and Latino migrants by the state of Arizona through its law SB1070 has had a dramatic effect on the exer- cise of human and civil rights in that state, especially in the case of communi- ties along the U.S.-Mexico frontier.40 The expansion of police powers to stop and search people in public places under numerous laws and court decisions is especially connected to the search for irregular migrants and is often driven by racial and socioeconomic stereotyping. The use of these powers is often disproportionate and is a clear expression of unlawful racial and ethnic dis- crimination, often affecting U.S.-born and naturalized citizens as well, simply because of their appearance. It is clearly a form of institutional racism justified by concerns about irregular migration.41 In mid-March 2013, ten lawsuits were filed in the United States alleging unlawful conduct by Customs and Border Protection (CBP) in northern and southern states of the country. The cases filed are meant to demonstrate how CBP agents routinely overstep their statutory mandate by conducting enforce- ment activities outside border regions, making racially motivated arrests, em- ploying derogatory and coercive interrogation tactics, and imprisoning arrest- ees under inhumane conditions. The cases include claims of unlawful search and seizure, false imprisonment, intentional infliction of emotional distress, assault, and ba ery. These cases also highlight the culture of impunity that permeates the behavior of law enforcement officers, vigilantes, and other anti- immigration groups.42 Amnesty International’s In Hostile Terrain report43 highlights the link be- tween violations of immigrants’ rights in the southwestern states of Texas and 40 For an archive of articles, commentary, and information related to law SB1070 in Arizona, see Times Topics at the New York Times website, available at topic.nytimes.com/top/reference/… /Arizona…sb_1070. See also Mike Sacks, On SB 1070: Supreme Court Appears to Favor Arizona on Controversial Immigration Law, Huffington Post (Apr. 25, 2012), available at h p://www .huffingtonpost.com/2012/04/25/sb-1070-supreme-court-arizona-immigration-law_n _1451622.html; Mary Romero & Gabriella Sanchez, Critical Issues Faced by Latino Defendants,” in Hispanics in the U.S. Criminal Justice System: The New American Demography (Martin Urbina ed., Charles C. Thomas 2012) 41 Anna Souhami, Institutional Racism and Police Reform: An Empirical Critique, Policing & Socy. 1‒21 (2012). 42 Northwest Immigrant Rights Project, Widespread Abuse by U.S. Customs and Border Protection Documented in National Wave of Complaints (Mar. 13, 2013), available at h p://www.nwirp .org/news/viewmediarelease/54. 43 Supra note 25. 226 The World Bank Legal Review Arizona and the failure of federal, state, and local authorities to enforce immi- gration laws on the basis of nondiscrimination. The report shows that commu- nities living along the border―particularly Latinos and individuals perceived to be of Latino origin, and indigenous communities―are disproportionately affected by a range of immigration control measures, resulting in a pa ern of human rights violations. These unlawful practices are not limited to the United States. Canada, which is often seen as a global leader with respect to refugee protection, is, like many other countries, creating more barriers for people seeking safety and security. The Protecting Canada’s Immigration System Act (Bill C-31) received Royal Assent on June 29, 2012. This new law presents a significant change for people who come to Canada in search of safety. The law includes a policy of long-term detention with inadequate review for des- ignated persons, based solely on the manner in which they arrive in Canada. It allows for the creation of “safe countries of origin” and bars access to the Refugee Appeal Division for some groups of refugees. The law also allows for the detention of children and their families and creates barriers to the timely reunification of families, even for some individuals who are found to be refu- gees according to the 1954 UN Convention Relating to the Status of Refugees as amended by the 1967 Protocol.44 Research shows widespread abuse of police powers in other jurisdictions, such as the United Kingdom,45 the Netherlands,46 and Japan,47 and globally.48 There is no doubt that immigration enforcement has become an often-used justification for expanding police powers to “stop and search” in the United States and elsewhere.49 Various countries are trying to apprehend and expel ir- regular immigrants, often within a framework of racism, discrimination, and stereotyping. 44 See Refugees and Migrants section of the Canadian Amnesty International website, available at h p://www.amnesty.ca/our-work/issues/refugees-and-migrants. 45 Ben Bowling & Core a Phillips, Disproportionate and Discriminatory: Reviewing the Evidence on Police Stop and Search, 70(6) Modern L. Rev. 936‒951 (2007); Rebekah Delson & Michael Shiner, Regulating Stop and Search: A Challenge for Police and Community Relations in England and Wales, 14(3) Critical Criminology 241‒263 (2006); Jenny Bourne, The Life and Times of In- stitutional Racism, 43(2) Race & Class 7‒22 (2001). 46 Joanne P. Van der Leun & Maartje A. H. van der Woude, Ethnic Profiling in the Netherlands? A Reflection on Expanding Preventive Powers in Arizona, 21(4) Policing & Socy. 480‒488 (2011). 47 Mitsuru Namba, “War on Illegal Immigrants,” National Narratives, and Globalisation: Japanese Policy and Practice of Police Stop and Question in Global Perspective, 21(4) Policing & Socy. 432‒433 (2011). 48 Ben Bowling & Leanne Weber, Stop and Search in Global Context: Overview, 21(4) Policing & Socy. 480‒488 (2011). 49 A federal judge ruled on August 12, 2013, that the stop-and-frisk tactics of the New York Police Department violated the constitutional rights of minorities in the city. The judge, Shira A. Scheindlin, found that the Police Department resorted to a “policy of indirect racial profiling” as it increased the number of stops in minority communities. That has led to of- ficers’ routinely stopping “blacks and Hispanics who would not have been stopped if they were white.” See New York Times, August 13, 2013, N.Y./Region. The Search for Opportunity and Inclusion 227 Unlawful and Excessive Force by Law Enforcement Practices that are unlawful or unconstitutional, or that exceed what is allowed or authorized by law, often stem from a variety of factors. Among these are police practices inimical to immigrants and racial minorities, such as profil- ing and stereotyping;50 shrill political discourse and scare tactics; the federal or central government’s deportation efforts; and a generalized fear of crime and disorder that leads many people to blame “outsiders” for troubles. These factors make possible and legitimize enforcement policies and practices that “(1) blend techniques of control used on the border with those used in interior enforcement; (2) mix criminal and administrative approaches to apprehen- sion, detention and deportation; (3) invoke national security as a rationale for strict, uncompromising enforcement; and (4) hype the violence aspect of bor- der crossing to support more aggressive interior enforcement.”51 The resulting law enforcement way of operating is thus characterized by ethnic and racial profiling, aggressive surveillance, intrusive stops, excessive searches, unjusti- fied detention of those suspected of being irregular immigrants, and frequent violation of human and civil rights.52 These overly aggressive, humiliating practices are incarnated in Arizona in the policies and actions of Sheriff Joe Arpaio, who, since 1992 has been elected and reelected sheriff of Maricopa County, which includes Phoenix, the capital and largest city of Arizona. Maricopa County has almost 4 million inhabitants. Arpaio often conducts sweeping and abusive searches for irregular immi- grants on the streets of certain neighborhoods in the county. People arrested are often housed in a controversial jail in the desert where inmates sleep in tents and males are required to wear pink underwear, an obvious a empt to denigrate and humiliate them. Arpaio recently offered to detain in his tent jail irregular immigrants to be released in Arizona by the federal government be- cause of budget problems.53 The negative effect of Arpaio’s pronouncements and practices on the irregular immigrant community is substantial and makes it very difficult, if not impossible, for these immigrants―especially abused, trafficked, and raped women―to seek justice.54 50 Id. 51 Doris Marie Provine & Gabriella Sanchez, Suspecting Immigrants: Exploring Links between Ra- cialized Anxieties and Expanded Police Powers in Arizona, 21(4) Policing & Socy. 468‒479 (2011). See also Doris Marie Provine & Roxanne Lynn Doty, The Criminalization of Immigrants as a Racial Project, 27(3) J. Contemporary Crim. Just. 261‒277 (2011). 52 Amnesty International’s report Jailed without Justice exposes the immigrant detention system in the United States as broken and unnecessarily costly. The report focuses on the human rights violations associated with the dramatic increase in the use of detention by the United States as an immigration enforcement mechanism. According to the report, in just over a de- cade, immigration detention tripled. In 1996, immigration authorities had a daily detention capacity of less than 10,000. Ten years later, more than 30,000 men, women, and children were detained by U.S. immigration authorities each day. The 2009 report is available at h p:// www.amnestyusa.org/pdfs/JailedWithoutJustice.pdf. 53 Kevin Cirilli, Sheriff Joe Arpaio Offers to Detain Illegal Immigrants, Politico (Feb. 28, 2013). 54 For an archive of articles, commentary, and information related to Sheriff Joe Arpaio, see Times Topics at the New York Times website, available at h p://topics.nytimes.com/topics 228 The World Bank Legal Review It is hard to envision exploited and mistreated irregular workers seeking redress from the police and the government when a itudes, pronouncements, and practices similar to Sheriff Arpaio’s permeate the official justice system. These practices confirm to the immigrant that the police in their “new” coun- try are no be er than the vicious, corrupt, and abusive police they tried to escape from in their country of origin. Also, the exploitation and maltreat- ment of domestic workers in various forms are not uncommon and often go unreported or ignored, especially when profound socioeconomic, religious, and racial differences play a role in fueling prejudice and lack of caring and basic respect for the immigrant.55 Reports of women who have escaped from situations of slavery and exploitation and who have sought refuge at police stations only to be returned to their exploiters and tormentors instead of re- ceiving help are sadly not rare in the anecdotal and research literature.56 Conclusion Although the word “security” is frequently mentioned when countries de- velop policies, laws, administrative rules, and enforcement practices to keep migrants out, the security of the migrants is often overlooked and not even considered an issue.57 Ironically, stronger and tougher security measures adopted by a country often make the journey of irregular migrants more dan- gerous, costly, and open to exploitation and victimization. Migrant insecurity continues and even increases after arriving in the destination country. Even in the best of circumstances, when police are trustworthy and not corrupt, the irregular migrant—quite possibly a victim of exploitation or enslavement— finds it very difficult to seek protection and receive justice because of a lack of training for police; language barriers; cross-cultural problems, even with face recognition and identification; poor communication between local law enforcement and victim assistance organizations; and the hidden nature of the crime. The threat of deportation, at times considered a solution to the situ- ation, is an added obstacle to the migrant seeking the security that should be provided by the state. The ubiquitous discourse on security and the policies enacted to enhance the security of the state need to take into account the security of migrants as well. The best approach to addressing the link between migration and insecu- rity would be, first, to recognize the existence of the problem, and then to com- mit to addressing and remedying it. Steps to protect women migrants and to /reference/…/a/Joseph…arpaio/Index/html. 55 Human Rights Watch, Swept under the Rug: Abuses against Domestic Workers around the World (2006). 56 Jackie Sheehan, Human Trafficking between China and the UK (Discussion Paper No. 54, China Policy Inst., U. of No ingham 2009); and Robert Moossy, Sex Trafficking: Identifying Cases and Victims, 262 (Natl. Inst. of Just. J. 2009). 57 Jef Huysmans, Security: What Do You Mean? From Concept to Thick Signifier, 4(2) European J. Intl. Rel. 226‒255 (1998). The Search for Opportunity and Inclusion 229 help them protect themselves are especially important. In a male-dominated world, it is vital to make women aware of their rights, help them strategize how best to assert those rights, and provide an effective network of assistance and support. Human rights and gender-sensitive training for border guards, police, and security personnel should be offered and required. Securing bor- ders and developing effective control approaches while minimizing the mi- grants’ exposure to risk58 also requires taking into account gender differences in vulnerability and potential for victimization and exploitation. Unless it takes such measures, the state will be unable to safeguard both its own secu- rity and the security of migrants. 58 Jørgen Carling & María Hernandez-Carretero, Protecting Europe and Protecting Migrants? Strategies for Managing Unauthorised Migration from Africa, 13 British J. Pol. & Intl. Rel. 42‒58 (2011). The World Bank’s copyright over this chapter is limited to English language only. See the copyright page for more information. This page intentionally left blank Toward a National Framework Law on Water for India N. R. MADHAVA MENON The existing method of water resource management in India is unsystematic at best. In early 2012, the Ministry of Water Resources of the Government of India published a policy document on water that highlights concerns regard- ing the management of water resources and seeks the adoption of a compre- hensive, coordinated national framework law containing principles binding on central, state, and local governments.1 At the same time that this report was being prepared, a Working Group appointed by the Planning Commission for preparing the XIIth Five-Year Plan came up with a Draft National Water Framework Bill for water governance in India.2 In 2010, the Commission on Centre-State Relations3 had recommended a decentralized, participative legal regime in view of the size of the country, the multiple stakeholders involved, and the constitutional scheme on water use and regulation.4 This report pre- sents a consensual policy model on water to guide both the central government and the states in legislating water management. It recommends that state acts reflect national policy. Following these initiatives of three different ministries, the Ministry of Water Resources constituted a commi ee in 2012 to prepare a legislative proposal at the national level incorporating the binding principles and developing institutional mechanisms for management of water resources in the future.5 This chapter argues that a national water policy informed by scientific data and measurable outcomes can sustain the availability of water for life, livelihood, and food security in India. Given the division of legislative and ad- ministrative powers among the three levels of government in respect to water use and management, the only way to avoid conflicts, costs, and inefficiency is to mandate that all levels of government be obliged to abide by a national framework law. Integrated watershed management is the best strategy to ad- vance such a policy in a cost-effective and efficient federal arrangement. The chapter explores the principles, concerns, and functions of a national frame- work law on water management in India. 1 Ministry of Water Resources, Government of India, Draft National Water Policy (Jan. 2012). 2 Planning Commission, Draft National Water Framework Act: An Explanatory Note (2011). 3 Ministry of Home Affairs, Government of India, Report of the Commission on Centre-State Rela- tions, vol. 6 (Mar. 2010). 4 Draft National Water Framework Act, supra note 2. 5 The commi ee submi ed its report in May 2013. The author is a member of this commi ee. 231 232 The World Bank Legal Review Facts and Figures in Perspective Water is a fundamental element of life on earth. Despite the fact that more than 70 percent of the planet’s surface is covered by water, only 3 percent is non- saline—that is, distributed in glaciers, rivers, and lakes and as groundwater. According to an Asian Development Bank study, the quantity of water avail- able per person in South Asia has declined by more than 80 percent between 1951 and 2011.6 India has access to one-eighth of the average amount of fresh water available per capita globally each year and is thus near the threshold of a chronic water shortage. In other words, India is a water-stressed nation, with per capita availability of water falling from 5,177 cubic meters in 1951 to 1,544 cubic meters in 2011. According to the State of the Environment Report—India, the repository of surface water in India is the 12 major river systems that cross the subconti- nent.7 These form a catchment area of 253 million hectares. Almost half the an- nual rainfall in India occurs during a period of two to three weeks, and almost 90 percent of river flows (i.e., the total quantity of water flowing through the rivers) occur in four months. More than 70 percent of the water in the rivers drains into the Bay of Bengal, and 20 percent drains into the Arabian Sea. Only 10 percent drains into interior basins and a few natural lakes. The esti- mated utilizable surface water is 690 billion cubic meters. With the annually replenishable groundwater potential,8 the total available is 1.122 trillion cubic meters. Indians are unable to conserve water for the off-season because water conservation methods and techniques have not been adequately adopted in India, allowing most of the rainwater to flow into the water basins and the sea. In terms of water use in India, agriculture receives the largest share— 92 percent—most of it in the form of irrigation. Of this, groundwater accounts for 39 percent. Unfortunately, up to 63 percent of the water used in agriculture is lost through evaporation or runoff. The demand for industrial and energy production, which is 63 billion cubic meters, is expected to grow at 4.2 percent per year. Domestic demand, which is 25 billion cubic meters, is also expected to grow with the projected increase in population. It is estimated that by 2025, the total annual water demand of 1.050 trillion cubic meters will be close to the utilizable potential of 1.122 trillion cubic meters. With 70 percent of surface water contaminated by biologic, toxic, organic, and inorganic pollutants, the challenge India faces is how to meet demand in terms of quantity and quality given the constraints of geography and rainfall pa erns.9 6 Tomislav Delinic & Marcel Schepp, Water for South Asia 110 (Intl. Reports 28, Konrad- Adenauer-Stiftung, 2012), available at h p://www.kas.de/wf/doc/kas_32769-1522-2-30 .pdf?121116134456. 7 Ministry of Environment and Forests, Government of India, State of Environment Report— India (2009) (hereinafter State of Environment Report). 8 Replenishable groundwater is essentially a dynamic resource that is replenished annually or periodically by precipitation, irrigation return flow, canal seepage, tank seepage, influent seepage, etc. 9 Report of the Commission on Centre-State Relations, supra note 3, at 32. Toward a National Framework Law 233 on Water for India The State of the Environment Report—India concludes that “the core chal- lenge of water resources development and management in India is one of governance.”10 The focus of governance, the report proposes, should be in- tegrated water resource management, or the quantitatively and qualitatively sustainable management of interlinked surface waters, aquifers, and coastal waters in a manner that supports social and economic development and strengthens the efficiency of the ecosystem. The core idea of integrated water resource management is that water supply is not an isolated problem but an issue embedded in a larger political, economic, and social context. The main criteria for water use should be the requirements of nature and people as well as the inclusion of affected stakeholders at all levels. Water and Human Rights Jurisprudence In 1992, the Dublin International Conference on Water and the Environment stated the core principle on water supply as follows: “The use of water, un- derstood both as a finite resource and an economic asset, inevitably has to be managed by means of a participatory and inclusive approach to ensure a sustainable supply for the entire world population.”11 The idea of the right to water is included in a variety of international agreements, including the Convention on Women’s and Children’s Rights and the Convention on Eco- nomic, Social, and Cultural Rights approved by the UN General Assembly in December 1966, which states: “The human right to water is indispensable for leading a life in human dignity. It is prerequisite for the realization of other human rights.” The Supreme Court of India has interpreted the fundamental right to wa- ter as part of the right to life that is enshrined in Article 21 of the Constitution of India.12 This interpretation puts an obligation on each state to provide un- polluted drinking water to the people. Many states do have legislation regard- ing water supply to urban areas, and government schemes acknowledge this right in relation to rural areas.13 In the 2000 judgment on the Sardar Sarovar project, in supporting the construction of the dam, the Supreme Court relied on the fact that the dam would contribute to meeting the water needs of indi- viduals residing in the area.14 Yet, there is no explicit legislation at the central or state level that gives content and meaning to the right to water. Even policy declarations are vague in this regard. 10 State of Environment Report, supra note 7, at 112. 11 International Conference on Water and the Environment, The Dublin Statement and Report of the Conference, Dublin 4 (World Meteorological Org. 1992). 12 Subhash Kumar v. State of Bihar, AIR (1991) SC 420. 13 The Accelerated Rural Water Supply Programme declared 40 liters per capita per day as the basic minimum level of water for an individual. 14 Narmada Bachao Andolan v. Union of India, AIR (2000) SC 3751. 234 The World Bank Legal Review The Expert Commi ee of the Water Resources Ministry revisited the Draft National Water Framework Bill, prepared by the Working Group on the XIIth Five-Year Plan. The Expert Commi ee has proposed recognizing the right to water in the following words:15 (i) Every individual has a right to a minimum quantity of potable water for essential health and hygiene and within easy reach of the house- hold at an affordable price. (ii) The minimum quantity of potable water shall be prescribed by the appropriate government after expert examination and public consul- tation, provided that the minimum quantity of potable water shall not be less than 25 liters per capita per day. (iii) The right to water for life shall take precedence over water rights, if any, for other uses including agricultural, industrial, and recreational uses. (iv) The state’s responsibility for ensuring people’s right to water shall remain despite corporatization or privatization of water services. (v) The appropriate government shall specify the quality standards of water supply specified for different uses, such as drinking, other do- mestic uses, livestock, irrigation, industries etc., and shall ensure that these standards are fully complied with. Realization of the right to water as a universal entitlement in India will require legislative and administrative measures at all levels of government (federal, state, and local), for which a national framework law binding gov- ernments at all three levels is necessary. In a fundamental rights context, the right to water is par with the right to education. This argument is used to resist privatization and corporatization in India and to maintain management of the water supply in the public sector. Because universal entitlement translates into a claim for universal free water, economic reform should not dictate the shape of the right to water.16 In a study of how the right to water has developed in India, Philippe Cullet concludes:17 The government is under an obligation to ensure either by itself or through legislation that water laws reflect and conform to the fun- damental right. Indeed, one of the important issues that arises in the context of water law is the sectoral manner in which it has devel- oped, thus ensuring that there is not even a common set of principles governing all of water uses and all water bodies. In addition, there is only limited integration of water law with legislation related, for in- stance, to the environment, food and health. . . . The legislation will 15 Unpublished draft proposals under consideration of the Expert Commi ee. 16 Philippe Cullet, Rethinking the Right to Water to Ensure Its Realization for All, 54 J. Indian L. Intl. 38 (2012). 17 Id., at 42. Toward a National Framework Law 235 on Water for India also need to address the question of the responsibility of the various actors involved in water supply. . . . The Constitution provides for devolution of water supply to Panchayats and Municipalities at [the] local level. Water jurisprudence in India has thus changed drastically since the Su- preme Court elevated the right to water to a constitutionally guaranteed fun- damental right in 1991. Because the right to clean drinking water is part of the right to life and liberty under Article 21 of the Indian Constitution, the state has no choice but to ensure by legislation or executive schemes that water is available to every citizen in the country irrespective of economic or other dis- abilities. However, at present, clean water is a statutory right only for citizens who live within municipal or corporation bounds and who therefore must pay charges fixed by the municipality for that right. The 1991 interpretation of wa- ter as a human right put distinct responsibilities on all levels of governments to take water justice seriously; the Supreme Court can intervene if the govern- ment does not ensure the right to water when petitioned by aggrieved citizens. To ensure access to water as a fundamental right, a common legal framework must enunciate principles for central, state, and local governments to follow. Water Resource Management and Center-State Relations The Commission on Centre-State Relations examined the issue of the division of legislative powers in relation to water and integrated water resource man- agement. The commission reported:18 The constitution provides a role for the Centre, States and Local Bodies in the management of water. However it is apparent that the primacy in the ma er is accorded to the States. Entry 17 in List II— State List of the Seventh Schedule states as follows: “Water, that is to say, water supplies, irrigation and canals, drainage and embankments, water storage, and water power subject to the provisions of entry 56 of List I.” Entry 56 of List I of the 7th Schedule of the 1950 constitution provides that “regulation and development of inter-State rivers and river valleys to the ex- tent to which such regulation and development under the control of the Union is declared by Parliament by law to be expedient in the public interest.”19 Stem- ming from this entry, and recognizing that disputes may arise in the use, dis- tribution, or control of waters of an interstate river or river valley, Article 262, provides for parliamentary law in the ma er of adjudication of such disputes. Article 262 also states that if Parliament so enacts a law, then neither the 18 Report of the Commission on Centre-State Relations, supra note 3, at 33–35. 19 The entries are part of the 1950 Constitution of India, which, as of now, has 12 schedules, the seventh of which contains three lists: a Union List, a Concurrent List, and a State List, each containing several entries. The Union has the power to legislate on the entries in the Union and Concurrent Lists; the State has the power to legislate on the State and Concurrent Lists. 236 The World Bank Legal Review Supreme Court nor any other court may exercise jurisdiction in respect to any dispute or complaint. This central role in water management has evolved over the past century. In preindependence India, the government centralized control over irriga- tion projects, and the credo was optimum utilization irrespective of political boundaries. The Montague-Chelmsford Reforms of 1919 classified irrigation as a provincial subject, but it was placed in a category “reserved” for central government legislation; hence, there was a measure of control. However, the Government of India Act of 1935 handed control over to the provinces, except in the ma er of interstate disputes for which there was a provision to resolve disputes through the aegis of expert investigatory commissions and central executive decisions. As a consequence of the 73rd and 74th Constitution Amendment Acts and the insertion of the 11th and 12th Schedules, panchayats and municipalities are now empowered with the management of water. Item 3 of the 11th Schedule speaks of a role for panchayats in “minor irrigation, water management and watershed development.” Item 11 confers on them responsibilities for “drink- ing water,” Item 13 speaks, inter alia, of “waterways” as a means of communi- cation, and Item 29 mentions the “maintenance of community assets.” In the case of municipalities, the 12th Schedule includes under Item 5, “water supply for domestic, industrial, and commercial purposes,” and under Item 8, inter alia, the “protection of the environment and promotion of ecological aspects.” The central government exercised its jurisdiction in the ma er of inter- state rivers by enacting the River Boards Act of 1956, under which central management of any interstate river basin is accomplished either through spe- cific legislation for that basin or by se ing up a board to oversee it. In practice, however, the central government has not exercised either route to create a specific river basin organization. (It is interesting to note that the Ganga Basin Authority was set up in 2009 under the Environment Protection Act.) The reasons for this have generally been ascribed to the reluctance of states to politically come to agreement in this regard. In addition to constitutional provisions, central intervention in issues con- cerning water has been the result of court rulings. In 1977, the Supreme Court directed the central government to set up an authority at the central level to deal with indiscriminate extraction of groundwater.20 The central government set up the Central Groundwater Authority and prepared draft model ground- water bills in 1970, 1972, 1992, 1996, and 2005. The court upheld this author- ity’s legitimacy under Section 3(2) of the Environment Protection Act of 1986. Similarly, under the Coastal Regulation Zone notification of 1991, harvesting of groundwater within 200 meters of the high-tide line is prohibited. Consid- ering that the Environment Protection Act was passed by virtue of Article 253,21 20 M. C. Mehta v. Union of India (1977) 11 SCC 312. 21 Article 253 of the Constitution of India reads: “Legislation for giving effect to international agreements Notwithstanding anything in the foregoing provisions of this Chapter, Parlia- Toward a National Framework Law 237 on Water for India many scholars question the way that central government jurisdiction has been expanded in what essentially is a state jurisdiction. Similarly, the courts have directed the central government and states about the interlinking of rivers (which in effect means the transfer of water from one basin to another).22 Central government initiatives regarding the management of water have resulted in the establishment of a National Water Resources Council in 1983 and a National Water Policy in 2002 and 2012. The council is presided over by the prime minister and includes chief ministers and union ministers as its members. The 2012 National Water Policy Statement calls for the establish- ment of a National Water Informatics Centre to collect and collate hydrologic data from all over the country to facilitate the development of a database for informed decision making in the management of water. It lays down certain essential principles based on equity and sustainability for water governance employing the public trust doctrine. The National Water Policy Statement pri- oritizes the uses of water, recognizing the essential needs of all citizens by giving primacy to drinking water. It proposes enhancing the water available for use by promoting watershed development activities, practicing water sav- ing in irrigation use, adopting flood control measures, conserving water, and encouraging stakeholder participation in the management of water resources. The 2012 National Water Policy Statement also proposes institutional arrange- ments such as a water regulatory authority at the state level, a permanent water dispute tribunal at the central level, and an integrated water resources management system based on river basin‒subbasin as the unit for the plan- ning, development, and management of water resources. The 2012 National Water Policy Statement envisaged a national water framework law that estab- lishes general principles on a statutory basis and decentralizes water gover- nance in every state to the lower tiers of government. Besides the policy on internal waters, the central government must enter into international agreements with neighboring countries regarding interna- tional rivers (Ganga, Brahmaputra, Indus) not only in the utilization of such waters but also for exchange of hydrological data of international rivers. To that end, treaties have been entered into with Pakistan, Bangladesh, and Nepal and memorandums of understanding (MOUs) have been signed with China. ment has power to make any law for the whole or any part of the territory of India for imple- menting any treaty, agreement or convention with any other country or countries or any decision made at any international conference, association or other body.” The Environment Protection Act of 1986 was passed in lieu of the decisions made at the UN Conference on Hu- man Environment, held at Stockholm in 1972, to which India was a participant. 22 Networking of Rivers in re (2004) 11 SCC 360. 238 The World Bank Legal Review States and Water Management States have enacted laws regulating surface water and groundwater, with em- phasis on irrigation and other economic activities. The Northern India Canal and Drainage Act of 1873, the Bengal Irrigation Act of 1876, and the Bombay Irrigation Act of 1879 guided the irrigation legislation of most states. Farm- ers’ right to water is not legally recognized under these laws. These acts do not provide for farmer participation in irrigation management or for transfer of funds to water users for undertaking repairs. Farmers remain dependent on state governments and the irrigation bureaucracy for supply and mainte- nance. The canal officer, an office created under the Indian Irrigation Act, has all the power, and departmental officers are not accountable to water users. There is a lack of transparency and participation in the management of irriga- tion systems. The Irrigation Acts continue to regulate the development and use of sur- face water within state territories. Rules govern cropping pa erns, be erment levies, water charges, and schedules when water will be made available. Out- side the Irrigation Acts, the Indian Easements Act of 1882 links land owner- ship and the regulation of groundwater use. Of late, some states have passed legislation to regulate the use of groundwater and thus control overexploita- tion and misuse. The jurisdiction of panchayats and municipalities to deal with water-related issues is not enshrined in the 11th and 12th Schedules of the constitution. Pan- chayats and municipalities are dependent on the enactment of legislation by states on the devolution of functions through executive action. Most preinde- pendence legislation listed water supply as an obligatory function of munici- palities. However, today water supply is regarded as a function delegated from state governments to parastatals. In some local body legislation, water supply in municipal area limits is treated as an obligation of the local body. However, legislation permits local bodies to provide this service on payment of reason- able cost, fixed under municipal regulations. Most municipal acts have made it obligatory for the harvesting of rainwater as part of a building plan. The empowerment of local bodies is envisaged in Article 243-ZD of the constitution, relating to district planning commi ees, and Article 243-ZE, re- lating to metropolitan planning commi ees. In both these articles, it is obliga- tory for local bodies to prepare draft plans with regard to “sharing of water and other physical and natural resources.” However, the only constitutional provision that has the potential of enabling water to be viewed as a common resource in a coordinated manner, albeit at local levels, has not been given due a ention.23 In 1999, Integrated Water Resource Development: A Plan of Action recom- mended that all state Irrigation Acts be amended to incorporate provision for the formation of farmers’ associations to take responsibility for the manage- 23 Report of the Commission on Centre-State Relations, supra note 3, at 37. Toward a National Framework Law 239 on Water for India ment of water.24 As a result, several states amended these Acts to accommo- date farmers’ participation in water management. Water commi ees, water users’ associations, and beneficiary farmers associations have been included in canal commi ees and command area development programs. A people-oriented participatory irrigation management scheme is slowly but steadily evolving in the states. Andhra Pradesh passed a Farmers’ Man- agement of Irrigation Act of 1997, providing for a three-tiered system of water management and distribution. The first level is at the primary level (minor canal level). A distributory commi ee represents the secondary level, and a project commi ee is the third level. Water user associations are entrusted with preparing a plan of action for maintenance of the system, carrying out the maintenance works in their area of operation, regulating the use of water ac- cording to a schedule, monitoring the flow of water, assisting the revenue department in preparing the demand and collection of water rates, and even resolving disputes between members. At least half the states have either enacted exclusive legislation or amended the Irrigation Acts to provide for participation, though the new regimes vary widely in structure and function. These laws provide for overall control by the state either directly or through regulatory authorities. State authorities deter- mine the command area and can change the jurisdiction of various water user associations (WUAs). In spite of the beneficial effects of such arrangements, criticism has been leveled that WUAs are gender discriminatory and not rep- resentative of the entire community. Although women have played a crucial role in household water management and participate in all agricultural activ- ity, they have li le say in WUAs, which are male dominated. Membership rules that provide for landholders or heads of households preclude women from becoming members. The relationship between WUAs and panchayati raj institutions (PRIs) is not clear. They exist alongside each other, and their powers overlap. The devolution of power to PRIs is tardy, due to states’ reluc- tance to part with powers to panchayats, and the constitution of WUAs fur- ther complicates the issue of local management of water resources. The PRIs are more inclusive (with mandatory inclusion of women, Scheduled Castes and Scheduled Tribes), whereas WUAs represent only landholder interests. These inclusionary differences have raised issues regarding the institutional inability of WUAs to be instruments for equitable use of the water resources of the community. A marriage of sorts between PRIs and control over water resources oc- curred with the provisions of the Panchayats (Extension of Scheduled Areas) Act of 1996. This Act gives powers to gram sabhas and panchayats in respect to minor water bodies, especially access to and control over them by tribal communities, as minor water bodies are considered (along with forests) a nat- ural resource base on which people depend for sustenance. 24 Ministry of Water Resources, Government of India, Integrated Water Resource Development: A Plan of Action, vol. 1 (Sept. 1999). 240 The World Bank Legal Review Thus, the water management scenario in states is a complex institutional arrangement in which the central government, the state, the PRIs, the WUAs, civil society, and the private sector are all involved in the use and manage- ment of water resources. Although the Gujarat Infrastructure Act of 1999 pro- vides for private sector participation in water supply and sanitation projects, the Karnataka Municipal Corporation’s (Water Supply) Rules give a role to the private sector in urban water delivery systems. If water is managed in terms of watersheds, then the implication is that the legal regime must facilitate a decentralized and participative arrangement for the management of water. However, considering the size of the country and the presence of multiple stakeholders, the issues in India are so complex that it is not possible for any one tier of government to manage water resources, and a joint effort is the only feasible way forward. “The management of eq- uitable distribution and proper use of this natural resource,” the Report of the Commission on Centre-State Relations observes, by a large population in a country, where rainfall is largely seasonal (with most of the precipitation in a limited number of days), and whose geography is characterized by varied topographical, geologi- cal and ecological features is a very complex task. . . . What is ground water at some stage becomes surface water at another and vice versa. . . . In such diverse forms water is not a mere economic resource which can be allocated unidimensionally. It has a societal relevance much beyond the economic, and is a ma er of life, livelihood and cultural pa erns. Since the stakeholders are so many a legalistic ap- proach to conflict resolution is difficult. . . . It is now acknowledged by most experts that water harvesting and land management be- come key elements of water management and that these can be most efficiently performed by adopting the watershed approach. If water has to be so managed in terms of watersheds then it follows that the legal regime must facilitate a decentralized and participative regime considering the size of the country and multiple stakeholders.25 No one model can satisfy all the demands for this scarce resource in In- dia. Stakeholders need to agree on principles based on equity and inclusion, conservation, and participation. On the basis of these principles, flexibility needs to be given to local administration to manage water use from all avail- able sources. This pa ern of decentralized governance is consistent with the federal formula of subsidiarity and efficiency. A template to refer to is the management of forests that has been adopted by Parliament. However, while states without forests can be equal participants in federal governance, states without sufficient water resources cannot survive unless their needs are met from states that have water. This is where the federal government can play a role, using a framework law. 25 Report of the Commission on Centre-State Relations, supra note 3, at 42–43. Toward a National Framework Law 241 on Water for India In recent years, there has been a concerted move to a unified and planned approach to conserving all available sources of water and managing the rivers to maximum benefit under the control of the central government. The inter- linking of interstate rivers was recommended by technical commi ees and the judiciary.26 However, because of opposition from the states, the initiative was abandoned, and it is unlikely that a constitutional amendment on this topic would get the necessary parliamentary support any time soon. Expressing its disagreement with the view that water should be shifted from the State List (List-II) to the Concurrent List (List-III) the Commission on Centre-State Relations observed that nothing in the present arrangement prevents the central government or the states from doing what they need to do to promote a participatory approach. The constitution gives a direct re- sponsibility to the states to legislate on the subject of water, and through parts IX and IX(A) enjoins the states to proceed with a further set of devolutions to local bodies. This, the commission concluded, is the appropriate path to a decentralized management of water resources. According to the Commission on Centre-State Relations, the Constitutional provisions as they stand are sufficient to address the issues of water use and management. A national consensus must emerge on water policy and this in turn should guide the legislations of the Centre under Entry 56 of List-I and those of the States under Entry 17 of List-II. . . . A hierarchical but co-ordinated set of water- shed agencies need to be set up by joint action of the Centre and States and participation of local bodies with inter-State basins as the focus. The concept of River Basin Organizations has been tried out suc- cessfully in several countries including neighbouring China. . . . The European Union has issued the Water Framework Directive which aims at sustainable management of water. It requires all member States to establish water laws conforming to common hydrological principles, which need to be applied on a river basin basis with the active participation of citizens. . . . In India, although no River Board or River Basin Organization has been constituted under the River Boards Act, 1956, a success story is available in the form of planning of the Damodar River system and operation through the Damodar Valley Corporation. Similarly, Bhakra-Beas Management Board, although set up for the limited purpose of power generation, also provides a successful example of integrated management. Similarly, the limited role of maintenance and regulation of the Tungabhadra Reservoir by the Tungabhadra Board for operation and maintenance of Dam and regulation of the flow, establishes the efficiency of inte- grated management.27 26 See Irrigation Commission, Report of the Irrigation Commission, 1972 (Ministry of Irrigation and Power 1972); Ministry of Irrigation, National Perspective for Water Development (1980). 27 Report of the Commission on Centre-State Relations, supra note 3, at 45. 242 The World Bank Legal Review In short, the scheme of integrated water management proposed by the 2010 Centre-State Relations Commission involves the following: • The development of a national water policy containing principles and di- rectives for all stakeholders to follow in legislative and administrative ac- tion and including watershed management. • Both the central government and state agencies will follow the mutually agreed-to provisions of the national water policy, which includes inte- grated watershed management. • All states will establish river basin organizations for the planned develop- ment and management of a river basin as a whole or subbasins wherever necessary. The scope and powers of the river basin organizations will be decided by the basin states themselves. • The central government will create interstate river basin authorities, whose responsibilities will be to oversee major engineering issues and al- locations, and not the implementation of schemes or user participation. • Local bodies, such as of civil society (as in watershed management), us- ers associations (as in irrigation), and joint management groups (as in forestry) will play an active role in all water-related initiatives. This proposal represents a major shift from an a empt at coordination through a large number of schemes implemented by numerous departments covering large areas (but not necessarily identified watersheds) to a legisla- tively ordained integration of coordinating authorities responsible for the in- terstate river basins and identified watersheds, set up by the central, state, and local authorities. The overall responsibility for coordination would be that of the interstate river basin authority set up by the central government under the River Boards Act. Conclusions Between 1976–80 and 2001–03, subsidies to agriculture grew from 3 percent of farm output to 7 percent. Over the same periods, government investment in farming was reduced from 4 percent to 2 percent of agriculture GDP. Most of the subsidies are for fertilizers, power, and irrigation water, and these have contributed to the degradation of natural resources.28 The costs of the monsoons in India are well-known. The average drop in grain output in a drought year is 11 percent. India’s experience with drought is a set of ready policy responses in which the first approach is to draw down grain stocks to feed the poor, lower taxes on food imports, pay more for farm produce, and ensure the availability of power for irrigation. An alternate ap- proach involves rehabilitating water delivery systems; this approach is not popular with the political class or the bureaucracy. Overexploitation of wells 28 Eleventh Five Year Plan (2007–2012), Agriculture, Rural Development, Industry, Services and Phys- ical Infrastructure, vol. 3, 7 (Plan. Commn., Govt. of India). Toward a National Framework Law 243 on Water for India and excessive use of groundwater for irrigation supported by a policy of sub- sidizing power and diesel for farmers’ water pumps are leading to distortions in water delivery systems and their sustainability. Nothing short of a national consensus on integrated water management supported by a participatory le- gal regime can prevent a catastrophe that is waiting to happen. This page intentionally left blank Targeting Justice Sector Services to Promote Equity and Inclusion for the Poor in Jordan PAUL PRETTITORE The justice sector provides a number of direct services to citizens. Those ser- vices implemented by governments are frequently focused on court proceed- ings involving criminal, civil, and family law cases. As with other public sec- tor services, services in the justice sector are often difficult for poor persons to access. Obstacles include a lack of awareness of available services and the pro- cedures to access them, overly complicated procedures for proving eligibility and accessing services, and the relatively high costs of fees. Far too often, ser- vices, especially those targeted to the poor, exist on paper but not in practice. Efforts to develop policy to improve services are undermined by a lack of data on demand, as well as on the extent and quality of existing service provi- sion. The lack of a comprehensive policy leads to contradictory approaches to reform; for example, at the same time that enhanced access for the poor is prioritized, fees associated with court procedures are raised and lawyers are required for cases with smaller financial value. When designed and implemented effectively, justice sector services can play a role in promoting equality and inclusion for poor communities. They can provide mechanisms for individuals to exercise their fundamental rights, thus promoting equality, and for individuals to challenge detrimental govern- ment actions or inactions, thus promoting greater inclusion. When targeted properly to the poor, services can provide tools to ensure that the poor are aware of the rules that affect them and are able to enforce these rules in an efficient and effective manner.1 Such services may include legal aid (informa- tion, counseling, and representation), waiver or deferment of court fees, and special procedures to simplify and expedite services that have a significant impact on the poor, such as alimony and child support. Legal aid itself is a “gateway” service, ultimately allowing beneficiaries to access other vital ser- vices, for example, court proceedings or entitlements such as social protection benefits. 1 The World Bank has advocated for more than a decade for reforms in the justice sector as a means to address poverty. The World Development Report 2000/2001: A acking Poverty (World Bank 2000) associates the rule of law, of which the justice sector is a key component, with cre- ating a predictable and secure environment for economic transactions and leading to be er overall economic performance and poverty reduction. The rule of law has been defined as an environment in which the formal rules are publicly known and enforced in a predictable way through transparent mechanisms, such that rules apply to all persons as well as to the state. 245 246 The World Bank Legal Review Jordan, like other countries in the Middle East, has struggled with the de- sign and implementation of services directed at the poor, namely legal aid ser- vices and deferment of court fees. The result is that these services are highly underutilized. The government of Jordan has taken steps to improve service delivery, which could positively impact on equality and inclusion for poor communities. Through a series of legislative amendments, existing services have been improved and new ones have been introduced that, if not aimed di- rectly toward the poor, should benefit them nonetheless. These reforms have focused on key issues such as alimony, child support, and inheritance. The government of Jordan has also provided space for civil society organizations (CSOs) to develop legal aid services in a comprehensive manner. The first widespread survey focusing solely on justice sector issues was conducted by the Department of Statistics in 2011, and the resulting data provide a basis for policy development and reforms that will benefit poor users of court, lawyer, and legal aid services in that country. Policy Development in the Justice Sector to Promote Equity and Inclusion Issues of poverty reduction, equity, and inclusion have been addressed in nu- merous policies and strategies developed by the government of Jordan. How- ever, the justice sector has rarely been linked to efforts in these areas. Past justice sector reform strategies focused on the institutional development of justice sector bodies and the improvement of general service delivery, which, if implemented adequately, would benefit all users of justice sector services but leave many of the unique obstacles faced by the poor in accessing services unaddressed. At present, there is no single entity in Jordan responsible for developing, coordinating, and implementing policy to improve services most impacting the poor. In this vacuum, the development of services will continue in an ad hoc manner, with limited ability to consolidate and build on specific improvements. Policy development needs to be more comprehensively linked to data and analysis concerning the quality and extent of current delivery of services, as well as the demand side from poor communities. Recent reforms in the justice sector commenced with the establishment of the Royal Commi ee for Judicial Upgrading, mandated with assessing the justice sector and developing recommendations to build capacity to reflect in- ternational good practices. This commi ee made recommendations on a num- ber of reforms, focused primarily on court administration.2 The Ministry of Justice subsequently launched the Jordan Judicial Upgrading Strategy (JUST) 2004–2006 as a follow-up to the work of the royal commi ee. JUST 2004– 2006 focused on improving general service delivery and capacity building for 2 The recommendations of the Royal Commi ee for Judicial Upgrading included increasing the number of judges; automating case management procedures; amending legislation to accelerate and simplify court proceedings; and establishing a division within the courts to supervise management of civil cases. Targeting Justice Sector Services to Promote Equity 247 and Inclusion for the Poor in Jordan justice sector stakeholders, including the ministry itself, the Jordan Bar As- sociation, and law faculties.3 Due to the limited monitoring and evaluation of strategy implementation, the impact of these strategies is not well understood. More recently, strategies have shifted to focus on issues of equality and social justice and have begun to link these issues with justice sector reforms. The We Are All Jordan strategy issued in 2006 promoted enhanced social justice,4 whereas the National Agenda (2006–2015) promoted the achievement of justice and equality.5 The concepts of equality and inclusion were linked with the justice sector through the Judicial Upgrading Strategy launched in 2010 (JUST 2010–2012). This strategy included the enhancement of access to justice as a component of the overall plan.6 In combination, these strategies have led to a number of achievements in the past decade, including the automation of case management procedures in civil and criminal courts (Mizan); the development of the Ministry of Jus- tice website to provide information to the public on services, procedures for accessing services, and relevant legislation; the automation of functions of the Ministry of Justice (Masaq); the introduction of legislative amendments to streamline procedures (Landlord-Tenant Law, Criminal Procedure Code, Court Formation Law, misdemeanor cases); the introduction of the e-clearance certificate; and the establishment of specialized judicial chambers for the civil and criminal courts to promote the specialization of judges. A number of spe- cialized judicial chambers were also established, including those covering in- tellectual property, companies, bankruptcy, commercial agencies, contracts, le ers of credit, and maritime law. These achievements should improve the quality of services for the general population, but they are unlikely to translate into enhanced equity and inclu- sion for poor communities if they are not linked with be er-targeted services. For example, although JUST 2010–2012 referenced access to justice, no con- crete activities were implemented and no real resources were made available to pursue this policy objective. Although a number of special court chambers were established that will likely benefit the private sector, none were estab- lished that cover the types of cases most likely to impact the poor, such as landlord-tenant disputes, consumer complaints, and disputes involving small 3 The recommendations of JUST 2004–2006 included improving service delivery, with a focus on efficiency and streamlining procedures; reducing demand for court services; strengthen- ing inspection and monitoring; improving court infrastructure; automating judicial proceed- ings; improving efficiency of human resource systems; and enhancing service delivery of the public prosecution, notary public, and execution and notification departments. 4 The We Are All Jordan policy initiative promoted the principles of enforcing the rule of law and ensuring social justice. 5 The National Agenda (2006–2015) promotes the aims of enhancing the judicial and legisla- tive systems to improve the rule of law and institutions, achieve justice and equality, and ensure fundamental freedoms, human rights, and democracy. 6 JUST 2010–2012 built on the priorities of JUST 2004–2006, focusing on improving court auto- mation, information technology development, and court infrastructure, and enhancing the services of the execution and notary departments. 248 The World Bank Legal Review financial claims. Most reforms implemented with donor funding, including the case management automation programs, were not extended to cover the sharia courts, which have jurisdiction over family-related cases, which are of prime importance to the poor. And lowering the monetary threshold above which a lawyer must represent the parties in court could result in the exclu- sion of poorer persons from pursuing such cases, especially because access to legal aid remains a serious problem in civil cases.7 Targeting Services Based on Demand Understanding the demands and priorities of poor communities is vital to effectively targeting services. The government of Jordan took a considerable step in defining needs through a household survey on the justice sector—the first of its kind in Jordan. In 2011, the Department of Statistics conducted the Statistical Survey on the Volume of Demand for Legal Aid (Justice Sector Household Survey), a survey of 10,000 households administered in rural and urban areas throughout the country. The survey covered a number of key issues important to assessing access to justice, including the most common types of legal cases; the costs of accessing courts and lawyers and knowledge of services provided; access to and familiarity with legal aid services; and the economic characteristics of families and individuals with legal disputes. Data based on gender and the monthly expenditure levels of respondents provide valuable information on the types of issues most affecting poor women and the steps they take to address them. In assessing access to services for the poor, it is important to consider the role of gender, given the unique obstacles faced by poor women, as identified in the Justice Sector Household Survey, and the fact poor women seem to need considerable assistance in accessing courts and lawyers, as demonstrated by an analysis of the caseload of the Jus- tice Center for Legal Aid, which shows women account for nearly 70 percent of legal aid beneficiaries. But data gaps on demand and the extent of service delivery remain. At- tempts to be er understand demand through analysis of existing service de- livery are limited, despite the availability of basic data from key institutions such as the Ministry of Justice, the Ministry of Interior, the Ministry of Labor (Labor Courts), and the Complaints Management Unit of the Ministry of Pub- lic Sector Development. These data are not routinely compiled into usable formats or analyzed to shed light on demand and inform service delivery im- provement in terms of access to justice for women. Public sector data are not routinely made available to other stakeholders, such as CSOs and academics. Nor are they easily available through the access to information framework currently in place, which suffers from a weak administrative framework. 7 In civil cases worth more than JD 1,000, parties are required to be represented by a lawyer; Law of Peace Courts No. 15 (1952) (Qanoun Mahakem al-Solh), art. 9, para 2. Targeting Justice Sector Services to Promote Equity 249 and Inclusion for the Poor in Jordan Analysis of the Justice Sector Household Survey Justice Sector Services and Poverty The Justice Sector Household Survey provides valuable data on the types of disputes encountered by poor persons and how they address disputes through formal institutions. An analysis of that data (undertaken by the au- thor) reveals several significant features of the ways in which the poor use justice sector services. Higher Demand, but More Limited Access. The families more likely to report ac- tionable legal issues—68 percent of respondents—fall into the two lowest cat- egories of expenditure levels (less than JD 250 per month and JD 250–499 per month),8 with only 6 percent falling within the highest expenditure category (more than JD 1,000 per month). Yet, poorer families are more likely to avoid court procedures when they have a dispute, and when they do go to court, they are less likely to have the assistance of a lawyer due to financial restraints (see figure 1). Forty-one percent of families that reported an actionable legal issue and are recipients of the National Aid Fund went to court without a law- yer because they could not afford one.9 Of those respondents reporting a dis- pute but not accessing courts because of a lack of financial resources, a large majority reported willingness to file complaints in court if they could receive the following support: lawyer fees, court fees, and associated expenses such as transportation (87 percent); lawyer and court fees (85 percent); and lawyer fees (83 percent). Figure 1. Use of courts and lawyers, by percentage                            8 The categories of expenditure levels per month used in the survey are less than JD 250; JD 250–499; JD 500–999; and more than JD 1,000. 9 National Aid Fund Law of 1986 (Qanoun Sandouk al-Maoune al-Watanie li-sanet). The Na- tional Aid Fund, under the authority of the Ministry of Social Development, administers a number of programs to support vulnerable persons. Its largest program, in terms of scope, provides cash support to the poor and others in need. Thus, its beneficiaries represent some of the most vulnerable persons in Jordan. 250 The World Bank Legal Review Different Priorities. The most frequent types of cases reported vary by the expen- diture levels of respondents. Poorer persons are more likely to be involved in personal-status disputes than in criminal disputes, while the reverse is true for those with higher expenditure levels. The greatest variation between respon- dents of different expenditure levels is observed in the category of personal- status cases (see the right-hand column in figure 2). Figure 2. Frequency of case type by expenditure category                            This trend is also reflected in an analysis of the caseload of the legal aid centers of the Justice Center for Legal Aid (JCLA), a Jordanian CSO that is the largest single provider of legal aid services in Jordan. In 2012, JCLA car- ried out 1,419 consultations and 1,014 legal representations for poor persons. Seventy-one percent of cases involved personal-status issues (see table 1). Table 1. JCLA caseload analysis, 2012* Case Type Legal Consultations Legal Representations Personal status 1,008 71% 719 71% Civil 254 18% 106 11% Criminal 111 8% 103 10% Noncourt procedures 46 3% 86 8% (administrative)† Total 1,419 1,014 * Assessment of cases by the six legal aid centers of the Justice Center for Legal Aid in Amman, Madaba, and Zarqa. † For example, drafting contracts and powers of a orney and filing administrative paperwork. Targeting Justice Sector Services to Promote Equity 251 and Inclusion for the Poor in Jordan Within the category of personal-status issues, there is additional varia- tion in terms of the most common types of cases (see figure 3). Alimony and inheritance cases are of more importance to poorer persons, whereas divorce and access to dowries are more important for persons with more resources. Figure 3. Breakdown of personal-status cases, by expenditure level "!!+ *!+ )!+ (!+     '!+      &!+   %!+    $!+  #!+ "!+ !+  #&! #&!%** &!!*** "!!! Overall, poorer persons form the bulk of respondents affected by legal disputes involving personal-status cases (see figure 4). There are several pos- sible reasons for this trend. Economic assets falling under personal status— alimony, inheritance, child support, and dowries—may constitute a consider- able portion of the overall assets of poor persons, particularly poor women, and are therefore worth fighting for. For those with more financial resources, the obstacles associated with court proceedings may outweigh the financial rewards. They may also have greater access to noncourt procedures such as negotiation through lawyers and mediation. Figure 4. Frequency of personal-status case categories, by expenditure level &! %& %! $&    $!    #&   #!      "&   "! & !  #&! #&!%'' &!!''' "!!! 252 The World Bank Legal Review Lack of Knowledge of, and Access to, Special Services. Individuals who did not access courts because of costs expressed willingness to do so if they could receive assistance in covering certain costs, for example, through legal aid ser- vices. However, 98 percent of survey respondents were unaware of existing legal aid providers. And of the 2 percent who were aware of services, only 17 percent had tried to access them. The primary reasons for not accessing legal aid services were lack of knowledge of how to reach service providers (35 percent), not actually needing legal aid assistance (33 percent), and com- plicated procedures for securing services (27 percent). Of those a empting to access legal aid services, 78 percent were able to secure them. The survey did not measure awareness of, and access to, services covering the deferment of court fees for poor persons involved in court proceedings. But anecdotal evidence suggests these services are rarely provided, primarily due to the lack of awareness of services by poor persons and justice sector of- ficials, as well as complicated procedures for accessing them. Justice Sector Services and Gender There are no legislative or regulatory impediments to women bringing dis- putes to courts or other dispute resolution bodies in Jordan. However, anec- dotal evidence suggests that women face societal pressures to avoid pursu- ing disputes, particularly in relation to personal-status issues and domestic or sexual violence. Social pressure may also steer women away from initiating claims directly with formal institutions—according to the JCLA, more than 70 percent of requests for assistance come from women. The household sur- vey sheds light on the types of disputes women and men report and how they use court and lawyer services to address disputes. The survey found that men were much more likely to report having had legal disputes. As individuals, men were three times as likely as women (75 percent for men versus 25 percent for women) to report having had a legal dispute in the past five years. Of the households reporting disputes, 92 per- cent were headed by men and 8 percent were headed by women. The extent to which men, in general, have more legal disputes or are simply more likely to report them is unclear. The reality is likely a combination of both, given the traditional and legal role of men as family guardians, requiring them to undertake more transactions and exposing them to more potential disputes, and the societal pressures on women to avoid raising disputes through formal mechanisms. Women tend to experience different types of disputes than men do. Personal- status issues are of prime importance. Of respondents claiming to have experi- enced a legal dispute, women were nearly four times as likely as men to have an issue related to personal-status law—41 percent of women versus 11 per- cent of men. Women were less likely than men to report legal disputes related to criminal or civil law (see figure 5). Targeting Justice Sector Services to Promote Equity 253 and Inclusion for the Poor in Jordan Figure 5. Categories of reported disputes, by gender                          There are variations in the types of disputes men and women will bring to court (see figure 6). Women are more likely than men to avoid going to court for criminal and civil disputes, but not for personal-status cases, which suggests that personal-status issues are viewed by women as more critically impacting their lives. This might be partly explained by the fact that personal- status cases involve access to economic assets that are exclusively available to women (alimony and child support) or primarily available to women (dow- ries) and represent a considerable source of economic interests for women with limited access to assets (inheritance). Figure 6. Respondents with actionable disputes who do not bring cases to court, by case type                           254 The World Bank Legal Review Access to financial resources for addressing disputes is more of a con- straint for women than for men, and even more so for female-headed house- holds. The data from the survey demonstrate that women and female-headed households are more likely to avoid filing claims in court because of lack of financial resources and are more likely to proceed to court without a lawyer because of an inability to pay lawyer fees (see figure 7). Thus, the lack of ef- fective systems for providing free legal representation and waiving of court fees has a considerable negative impact on poor women who wish to enforce their rights. Figure 7. Nonuse of courts and lawyers due to financial constraints, by gender                                                    What State-Sponsored Services Are Targeted to the Poor? Legal Aid Services Legal aid services encompass information and counseling activities and le- gal representation by a lawyer. In addition to being services themselves, they serve as gateway services that ultimately allow beneficiaries to access other services, for example, court proceedings and entitlements such as alimony, child support, and social welfare benefits. Legal aid can provide tools to en- sure that poor persons are aware of the rules that affect them and aid them in enforcing these rules in an efficient and effective manner. Not only can such an approach help address poverty—as recommended by the World Bank10—it can also aid in promoting equity and inclusion for poor communities. 10 See supra note 1, which associates the rule of law, of which the justice sector is a key compo- nent, with be er overall economic performance and poverty reduction by creating a predict- able and secure environment for economic transactions. Targeting Justice Sector Services to Promote Equity 255 and Inclusion for the Poor in Jordan The government of Jordan has focused resources on legal representation, which can be provided through the courts,11 the Jordan Bar Association,12 or CSOs. Lawyers are paid to provide legal aid services when appointed through the courts or CSOs, although at a rate lower than they would normally be paid. Legal assistance through the Jordan Bar Association can involve pay- ment from the government or be provided by the lawyer on a pro bono basis. Deferment of Court Fees Poor persons involved in court proceedings can request deferment of court fees until the case is resolved. Given the relatively high court fees, including fees for official stamps, this service could provide considerable relief for those unable to afford court proceedings.13 However, the associated procedures are overly complicated. Applicants must provide numerous documents in a mo- tion to the chief judge of the court for which fees would be deferred.14 They must also produce witnesses or certification from local officials to a est to their poverty, although there are no set criteria for ascertaining poverty. Col- lecting numerous documents is burdensome for poor applicants, and review of documents is not the most effective use of the time of senior judges. If the party for whom the fees have been deferred wins the case, fees must be paid at the time the decision is issued, not when it is enforced. Thus, persons are required to pay fees before receiving a financial award. Specialized Services for Personal-Status Cases Personal-status cases in Jordan involve family law issues, including mar- riage, divorce, alimony, child custody and support, inheritance, and dow- ries. They affect a large segment of the population and, as demonstrated by the Justice Sector Household Survey and the analysis of the JCLA case- load, are of considerable importance to the poor. For example, alimony, child support, and inheritance may be the only considerable economic as- sets of a poor woman. Personal-status issues are under the jurisdiction of religious courts—sharia courts for Muslims and ecclesiastical courts for Christians—which form part of the formal judicial system but are admin- istered separately from the civil and criminal courts. The National Agenda (2006–2015) includes a recommendation to develop the work of the sharia 11 Code of Civil Procedure of 1988 (Qanoun Ousoul Mohakamat Madanie li-sanet). 12 Law of the Regular A orneys Association of 1972 (Qanoun Nakbaet al-Mohameen al- Nizamieen li-sanet). 13 Based on the indicator “enforcement of contracts” in the World Bank’s Doing Business Report 2012: Doing Business in a More Transparent World (World Bank 2011). The court costs, as a per- centage of the value of the claim, are as follows: Jordan, 8 percent; Syria, 4.5 percent; Leba- non, 3 percent; Iraq, 2.3 percent; West Bank and Gaza, 2.2 percent; and Egypt, 1.3 percent. 14 The required documentation includes certificates from the Department of Land and Survey, stating the applicant does not own land; the Department of Vehicles and Licenses, stating the applicant does not own a vehicle; and the Department of Social Security, stating the ap- plicant has a limited salary or no salary. The chief judge of the relevant court can request additional documentation. 256 The World Bank Legal Review courts, which has led to a strategy on reform developed by the Supreme Judicial Council of the sharia courts. Courts were requested to establish guidelines, including outlining the procedures and documents required for each service, with the guidelines to be posted prominently within court facili- ties. The sharia courts have also begun work on a strategy to automate proce- dures of the Supreme Judicial Council and courts. In 2010, major revisions were made to the Personal Status Code that re- sulted in the enhancement of existing services and the introduction of new services in the sharia courts.15 These new services include expedited alimony and child support procedures, direct alimony payments made through an ali- mony fund, and protections related to the inheritance rights of women (see table 2). They were designed to address current gaps in service delivery. Al- though not necessarily directly targeted to poor persons, these reforms, if im- plemented properly, should provide additional tools for the poor to level the playing field in using court services to exercise their rights and access benefits to which they are entitled. Table 2. Improving services for personal-status issues Expedited alimony/child support payments • Alimony can be requested • Addresses the fact that divorce proceedings can at the time of filing take years to finalize, during which time women did for divorce, rather not have access to alimony payments, which has a than waiting for the particularly negative impact on poor women. finalization of the divorce. • Alimony can be paid • Addresses the fact that divorce proceedings can take immediately upon request years to finalize, which has a negative impact on poor rather than waiting for a women. court decision awarding alimony—“expedited • Two conditions must be met: a guarantor is provided alimony.” to guarantee repayment of alimony sums if the subsequent court decision does not provide for alimony; and a witness states that the applicant is able to repay alimony payments if necessary. Similar procedures allow for expedited child custody. Alimony fund • Alimony is paid directly • Enforcement of judicial decisions remains by the sharia courts to problematic; ensuring payment of alimony from women in cases in which courts directly to women will aid poor women for husbands fail to pay whom alimony is a considerable economic asset. alimony according to court decisions. • Poor women will not incur the added expense of repeatedly requesting courts for enforcement of alimony decisions. • Sharia court personnel are responsible for initiat- • Payments will be made electronically to bank ing proceedings against accounts, instead of forcing women to report to court husbands who fail to monthly to receive payments. make alimony payments. 15 Provisional Law No. 36/2010, issued by the Council of Ministers (Sept. 26, 2010). Targeting Justice Sector Services to Promote Equity 257 and Inclusion for the Poor in Jordan Access to inheritance • Revisions of the process • Address the societal pressure women face in of takharoj so that a renouncing inheritance rights in favor of male female heir must wait relatives, which has a particularly negative impact on 12 months after being poor women, because inheritance may be the primary awarded inheritance means of transferring wealth. rights before such rights can be renounced and transferred to other heirs. • Alternatively, rights to land can be transferred through the Department of Land and Survey after rights have been registered in the name of the female heir, so that a female heir is aware of her rights before renouncing them. Are State-Sponsored Services Targeted Accurately and Delivered Effectively? There are a number of gaps in service delivery related to the provision of ser- vices targeted to the poor. Legal Aid Services There are a number of weaknesses in the targeting of legal aid services. The right to legal aid services exists only for serious criminal cases involving capi- tal punishment or life imprisonment. Yet, data from both the Justice Sector Household Survey and the analysis of the JCLA caseload demonstrate that poor persons have considerable need for assistance related to personal-status and civil cases, a finding consistent with demand globally. Nearly 80 percent of those reporting personal-status disputes fell into the two lowest quartiles of expenditure levels in the Justice Sector Household Survey. And more than 70 percent of cases involving legal consultations and representation by JCLA in- volved personal-status issues, whereas 18 percent of counseling services and 11 percent of representation services involved civil law issues. Criminal issues accounted for less than 10 percent of services. Extending state-supported legal aid services to personal-status and civil issues would benefit women, who were four times as likely to report personal-status disputes and less likely to have access to a lawyer than men, according to the household survey. Legal aid services are heavily focused on legal representation by lawyers. However, analysis of the JCLA caseload shows that legal representation is necessary only in about 30 percent of their cases. The vast majority of cases can be addressed through information and counseling. Yet, the government of Jor- dan has not initiated any comprehensive plan to support public information 258 The World Bank Legal Review and awareness, leaving it up to CSOs to a empt to fill the gaps. There is no publicly funded counseling mechanism regarding legal issues. Providing such services to the poor serves a number of purposes. Both public information and counseling can reach a larger number of beneficia- ries than legal representation can because they require less time from service providers per beneficiary and can be targeted to communities or groups as opposed to individuals. They are also cheaper to provide per beneficiary be- cause they require li le to no time on the part of lawyers. Establishing public information kiosks or desks or information hotlines could help address needs. There are numerous gaps in the effective delivery of legal aid. The system for implementing state-sponsored legal aid remains ineffective and underuti- lized, with very few instances of legal aid granted through either the courts or the bar association. Each mechanism for delivering services faces shortfalls. The process for assigning lawyers by courts is not always clear, and there is no established list of eligible lawyers kept by the court from which assignments can be made. Instead, judges might assign a lawyer present at the courthouse and pay fees that are too low to ensure quality. There are no wri en proce- dures for the Jordan Bar Association to follow in assigning lawyers to provide pro bono services, nor is any training or oversight provided to lawyers. Al- though CSOs have begun to fill the gap in legal aid services, their activities are highly dependent on funding from foreign donors, and the government of Jordan has not yet acted to integrate services. There is limited use of nonlawyers (local experts, law students, appren- tice lawyers) who could provide assistance on legal awareness, information and counseling, or development of pro bono programs for lawyers to provide representation when needed. Monitoring and evaluation of what services are provided are lacking, further negatively impacting the quality of services. For example, an impact evaluation of a legal aid program in Ecuador found posi- tive correlations between the provision of legal aid and access to child support payments and reductions in domestic violence.16 Experimenting with unbun- dling services so that lawyers are hired only for the procedures for which they are necessary, and developing pro se representation mechanisms, such as online information and self-help desks, could improve the quality and reach of services. The la er may be particularly beneficial in sharia courts, where parties are not required to have legal representation, and a model may already exist with the informal kiosks established outside court facilities to provide information on forms and procedures for small fees. Determining eligibility for services is also inefficient, with no clear criteria for determining poverty and cumbersome procedures placed on applicants 16 See World Bank, Impact of Legal Aid: Ecuador (Rpt. No. 26915, Feb. 2003). For a broader dis- cussion of the economic impact of legal aid services, see Bruce M. Owen & Jorge Portillo, Legal Reform, Externalities and Economic Development: Measuring the Impact of Legal Aid on Poor Women in Ecuador (Stanford Inst. for Econ. Policy Research Discussion Paper No. 02-32, May 2003). Targeting Justice Sector Services to Promote Equity 259 and Inclusion for the Poor in Jordan and officials responsible for reviewing applications. Eligibility guidelines de- veloped by CSOs could serve as a model. Due to institutional weaknesses, there is limited ability to provide services outside Amman, especially to poor, rural areas. And funding for legal aid services is not yet sustainable, with the majority of funding provided by international donors. Development of a le- gal aid fund, as is under discussion to cover criminal cases, or a sliding scale of payments for services could help address financial sustainability issues. A longer-term strategy for provision of services that balances needs with re- sources could enhance sustainability. Deferment of Court Fees Deferment of court fees is perhaps be er targeted to the needs of the poor than state-sponsored legal aid services. Given that court costs in Jordan are relatively high, providing deferment of fees in civil cases will benefit the poor facing cases involving issues such as employment, housing, and consumer af- fairs, as well as social benefits. If fees are deferred for a party, they are required to be repaid only if the party wins the case. But repayment is supposed to be made at the time the judgment in the case is issued, not upon enforcement. This in particular presents a considerable burden for the poor because they are required to make a payment before receiving their financial award, especially considering the weakness in enforcement of judicial decisions in Jordan and the length of time that might be required for enforcement procedures. There are no available data on the frequency with which deferment of court fees is requested and awarded, but anecdotal evidence suggests it is provided only rarely. This is due to several factors. There is a general lack of awareness among the public, and even among judges and court staff, that this service exists. Although the Justice Sector Household Survey did not measure the awareness of deferment of court fee services, it did show that roughly 98 percent of respondents were unaware of legal aid services in general; simi- lar findings would likely apply to deferment services. When there is aware- ness, there is often limited knowledge of the relevant procedures, and po- tential beneficiaries may be deterred by the overly complicated nature of the procedures. The process for proving eligibility and implementing relevant procedures requires assembling a number of official documents from different government agencies and the production of witnesses, providing a consider- able disincentive for intended beneficiaries to apply. Special Services for Personal-Status Issues Recent legislative and regulatory amendments have reformed existing services and introduced new services related to several personal-status issues that are of prime importance to the poor, including access to alimony, child support, and inheritance. Based on the findings of the Justice Sector Household Survey and the analysis of the JCLA caseload, these reforms should result in more ac- curate targeting of services to the poor, especially poor women. These reforms also have the potential for positive impacts on social and economic develop- ment by increasing the economic assets of poor women, which can in turn 260 The World Bank Legal Review improve women’s agency.17 The results could be be er equity and inclusion, particularly for poor women. A number of policy initiatives are aimed at improving the targeting to poor users of court services and promoting greater equality and inclusion, es- pecially for poor women. Expedited alimony and child support services have been introduced to address the fact that divorce proceedings can drag on for years, during which women may not receive any support. For poor women, given the low rates of female labor force participation, this time lag may mean the elimination of the sole means of financial support.18 Direct alimony pay- ments by the sharia courts through an alimony fund are designed to compen- sate for the overall poor enforcement of judicial decisions. Special protections for inheritance rights of women are meant to provide a means for women to counter societal pressure to renounce inheritance rights guaranteed them by law in favor of male relatives. Traditionally, sharia courts have been more financially accessible to poor persons than criminal and civil courts because court-related costs, such as fil- ing fees and fees for powers of a orney, are lower or nonexistent and parties are not obligated to be represented by a lawyer, thus reducing legal costs. Un- fortunately, the same cannot be said for the ecclesiastical courts, where proce- dures and costs are not clearly framed in legislation and regulations, resulting in ad hoc service delivery.19 The Justice Sector Household Survey found that average lawyer costs for personal-status issues—roughly JD 542—are consid- erably lower than for civil (JD 902) and criminal (JD 958) cases. However, navigation through issues and procedures related to disputes over alimony, child support, and inheritance are complicated, and legal ad- vice may be necessary in order for parties to make informed decisions. For example, division of inheritance is set in law, but the amounts awarded for alimony and child support are negotiable and need to be firmly established through court procedures. Sixty-four percent of household survey respon- dents found the presence of a lawyer useful for their case. Mediation services, which for many disputes are obligatory as a first step, are offered free of charge and provide another lower-cost mechanism for the poor. Regulations that support implementation of the alimony fund have been drafted, and once adopted by the Council of Ministers and implemented effectively, the fund could have considerable impact on the social and eco- 17 For a more thorough discussion of the agency, access to justice, and development for women in Jordan, see World Bank, Agency, Equality and Access to Justice, in Hashemite Kingdom of Jor- dan, Jordan Country Gender Assessment: Economic Participation, Agency and Access to Justice in Jordan, ch. 3 (Report No. ACS5158, July 2013) (hereinafter, Jordan Country Gender Assessment). 18 For an assessment of women’s labor force participation, see Jordan Country Gender Assess- ment, ch. 2, Women’s Economic Participation. 19 See Amal Haddadin, Good Practices and Lessons Learned in Realizing Women’s Rights to Produc- tive Resources: The Case of Jordan (Jordanian Natl. Commn. for Women, June 2012), available at h p://www.unwomen.org/wp-content/uploads/2012/07/EP-Good-practices-and-lessons -learned-in-realizing-womens-right-to-productive-reources-the-case-of-Jordan.pdf. Targeting Justice Sector Services to Promote Equity 261 and Inclusion for the Poor in Jordan nomic development of poor women by providing them access to an important economic asset. Conclusion Literature on the impact of justice sector services in the promotion of equity and inclusion is minimal. Instead, analytical work has focused primarily on economic impacts without necessarily drawing on links to improved equity and inclusion. Anecdotally, the links seem strong. Equality is a constitutional right in Jordan, and the justice sector plays a role in ensuring that this right can be exercised by vulnerable groups most likely to be faced with inequality, including the poor and women. Improving service delivery to the poor will help level the playing field in the justice sector, which is often tilted in favor of those with more financial resources. If the poor have greater recourse to the justice sector, they will have increased ability to hold public sector entities accountable for nondelivery of services and nonenforcement of rights, which can translate into greater inclusion. The government of Jordan’s approach to improving delivery of justice sector services to the poor has thus far demonstrated mixed results. Justice sector services are underutilized by the intended beneficiaries for a myriad of reasons related to the lack of comprehensive policy, institutional weaknesses, and legislative gaps. Targeting of legal aid services, in particular, is not con- sistent with the priorities of the poor. Targeting of court deferment services in civil cases is more accurate in terms of addressing an obstacle faced by the poor in accessing courts, but lack of awareness and burdensome procedures to prove eligibility leave the majority of the targeted beneficiaries outside the scope of these services. Special services related to personal status are well tar- geted to the priority needs of the poor, but because the services have only re- cently been introduced, it remains to be seen how effective they are in practice. The Justice Sector Household Survey and the analysis of the JCLA case- load provide three key conclusions in terms of gaps in targeting and imple- menting services in Jordan: • Poor persons are more affected by legal disputes, but are less able to access services provided by courts and lawyers, than those with more resources. • Poor persons are primarily affected by a different set of issues than per- sons with more resources—poorer persons are disproportionately affected by personal-status cases. • State-sponsored services that focus on criminal issues and court proceed- ings are not well aligned with the needs of poorer persons, and awareness of services among targeted beneficiaries remains weak. Other sources of data can be developed, including the automated case management system of the Ministry of Justice and the Public Sector Com- plaints Hotline of the Ministry of Public Sector Development, as well as the caseloads of the Ombudsman Bureau, the Anticorruption Commission, and 262 The World Bank Legal Review the National Aid Fund. Together, these data could serve as the basis for data- informed reforms to services. At present, it is difficult to measure the effect of justice sector services on equity and inclusion. Thus, determining the impact of services on the promo- tion of equity and inclusion of the poor, perhaps complementing a system for measuring impact on poverty, is an important next step for the government of Jordan. Such an assessment will aid in the regular monitoring and evalu- ation of the quality and reach of existing services, which will guide reforms of existing services to ensure more accurate targeting to poor beneficiaries, in particular in regard to legal aid services. It will also, in combination with data on the demand side of services within poor communities, inform the develop- ment of new services aimed at addressing the priorities of the poor within the justice sector. And it can aid in filling a data gap in linking the justice sector with improved equity and inclusion outcomes for the poor. Serving the Justice Needs of the People Adopting an Access to Justice Approach in Somalia’s Rule of Law Reform NICHOLAS JOSEPH Access to justice has gained predominance in rule of law reform efforts in postconflict societies and countries transitioning from authoritarian to demo- cratic rule. Since Western nations began to engage in major rule of law in- terventions, scholars and practitioners have focused their efforts on under- standing and implementing the most appropriate ways to make the law serve the needs of the people, to enable the people to enforce and uphold their hu- man rights, and to ensure that the law advances people’s economic and social development. Since the adoption of the Provisional Constitution on August 1, 2012, So- malia has embarked on its own rule of law reform process. Having learned from the lessons of previous rule of law reform efforts, as well as more nu- anced and innovative approaches to justice development and reform, the cur- rent Somali government and justice institutions can implement rule of law reforms that contribute directly to the empowerment and economic develop- ment of the people of Somalia. This chapter maps the history of access to justice theory from early inter- ventions in the la er half of the 20th century to current theories and practice aimed at furthering people’s access to their legal systems. It then traces the legal, social, and political context of Somalia from the beginnings of postco- lonialism to the present. In doing so, it illustrates how justice has interacted with the ordinary citizen in Somalia, presenting evidence that the law has extensively failed to serve Somalis’ needs throughout history. Based on this examination of previous rule of law reform in Somalia, the final section of this chapter draws on lessons learned from innovative practices of rule of law reform in recent years and proposes ways in which decision makers can effec- tively influence the trajectory of Somalia’s law reform, to ensure that people are aware that they can avail their rights and know how to do so; and to en- sure that there are adequate channels for citizens to seek justice and find rem- edies for any wrongs they have suffered. Any statements of fact, opinion, or analysis expressed herein are entirely those of the author and are not a ributable to the International Development Law Organization. The author would like to thank Ilary Ranalli for her valuable thoughts and comments on this chapter. 263 264 The World Bank Legal Review Access to Justice and Rule of Law Reform It can be asserted that, regardless of the methodology of law reform, all efforts led by international interventions have been for a single purpose: “a commit- ment to increasing access to legal institutions and the quality of ‘justice’ deliv- ered by those institutions.”1 Whether through traditional rule of law efforts, which center on the capacity development of lawyers and judges, or the more innovative approaches that emphasize the empowerment of the people to bet- ter their lives through the law, all efforts converge on the single aim to enable the “ability of people to seek and obtain a remedy through formal or informal institutions of justice, and in conformity with human rights standards.”2 The best way to analyze the evolving methods of ensuring access to justice is to understand the context in which individual citizens struggle to gain ac- cess to justice in the formal justice systems. Wojkowska3 and Barendrecht et al.4 list several problems that limit access to formal justice systems: nonexist- ing procedures for the protection of specific rights, limited resources available to the claimants to access expensive services, mistrust of the law, intimidation by authorities and resulting fear among claimants, language difficulties, lack of understanding of formal procedures and court atmosphere, unequal power relations, and lengthy periods for handling cases. In addition, formal systems may lack legitimacy if they have previously created conflict and/or been per- ceived as corrupt. Most people in poor countries do not seek justice from for- mal courts because of these barriers.5 With the above contextual understanding, this section will next look at the evolution of rule of law reform, from the earliest tradition of reform in the 1970s, which focused on institutional strengthening of the state justice infra- structure, to the emergence of legal empowerment theories, which place the impoverished directly at the center of rule of law reform considerations. Early Rule of Law Reform Projects In the earliest rule of law reform projects, the emphasis was on improving the quality and competency of the judiciary and the legal profession through training for judges and improved legal education for lawyers. The theory be- hind supporting this “top-down” approach to rule of law reform was pre- 1 Byron M. Sheldrick, Access to Justice and Legal Empowerment as Vehicles of Poverty Alleviation: Governance Challenges to Linking Legal Structures to Social Change 2 (Legal Working Paper Se- ries on Leg. Empowerment for Sustainable Dev., Ctr. for Intl. Sustainable Dev. L., 2012). 2 Programming for Justice: Access for All—A Practitioner’s Guide to a Human Rights–Based Approach to Access to Justice 5 (UNDP, Bangkok 2005). 3 Ewa Wojkowska, Doing Justice: How Informal Justice Systems Can Contribute (UNDP, Oslo Governance Ctr. 2006). 4 Maurits Barendrecht, José Mulder, & Ivo Giesen, How to Measure the Price and Quality of Access to Justice? (working paper, 2006), available at h p://papers.ssrn.com/sol3/papers .cfm?abstract_id=949209. 5 Dan Banik, Rights, Legal Empowerment and Poverty: An Overview of the Issues, in Rights and Legal Empowerment in Eradicating Poverty 15 (Dan Banik ed., Ashgate 2008). Serving the Justice Needs of the People 265 mised on the belief that with the establishment of a functioning, competent, and independent judiciary and legal profession, individual citizens within the country would have an incentive to use formal channels of justice to avail their rights. In socioeconomic development thinking, the use of the courts and the formal legal system leads to efficient and effective business and thus pro- motes business within the country and increases the appetite for international investors to invest and operate within the jurisdiction. Rule of law theorists believed that, in turn, a trickle-down effect would bring economic prosperity to others within the country, even though they were not necessarily direct users of the reformed justice system. The problems of this theory, however, were evident after the first wave of large-scale law reform efforts concluded. Building effective, efficient, and uncorrupt legal and judicial systems from the ground up―or worse, trying to challenge the entrenched practices and pro- cedures of a largely inept judicial corps―was a task more difficult than origi- nally fathomed. Although millions of dollars were poured into legal educa- tion and training programs, judiciaries are still seen as lacking independence and largely biased.6 It could be said that the initial efforts of law reform did benefit some― mainly the elite. However, although measures of GDP or other indicators may have shown a positive correlation in rule of law reform efforts, the multiplier effect originally envisioned, whereby ordinary citizens would see their own economic and social development through reformed judicial infrastructure, was largely unfounded. For many people in these countries, the courts con- tinue to be viewed with distrust and suspicion, and therefore it is fair to con- clude that these traditional interventions have not raised the developmental well-being of the many they were intended to serve.7 As the global neoliberal agenda grew throughout the 1980s, and with the collapse of the Soviet Union beginning at the end of that decade, rule of law reform efforts moved toward trade liberalization and developing domestic commercial laws capable of bringing a country’s economic, and therefore le- gal, regime into line with the global economic expansion under way in much of the Western world. The successes of such efforts were limited and, again, served the interests of the economic elite. In addition, a global shift to discon- tent of neoliberal policies meant that elected officials and development agen- cies were increasingly under a ack to change their approaches to the treat- ment of developing countries in the globalized world.8 The Emergence of the Legal Empowerment Paradigm A new thinking was needed for various governments’ approaches to interna- tional cooperation in the field of rule of law reform. The Commission on Legal 6 Sheldrick, supra note 1, at 3. 7 Brian Tamanaha, The Primacy of Society and the Failures of Law and Development (Leg. Stud. Research Paper No. 09-0172, St. John’s U. School of Law, July 2009). 8 Sheldrick, supra note 1, at 3. 266 The World Bank Legal Review Empowerment of the Poor (CLEP) was launched in 2005, comprising mem- bers from Denmark, Finland, Iceland, Norway, Sweden, Canada, Egypt, Gua- temala, Tanzania, and the United Kingdom.9 Headed by economist Hernando de Soto and former U.S. secretary of state Madeleine Albright, the commission emphasized the importance of various elements vital to successful law reform for economic development. Property rights, access to justice and the rule of law, and business and labor rights were high on the agenda. More important for the discussion in this chapter, the commission paid due regard to bo om- up and pro-poor approaches. In addition, the commission recognized that the informal and customary justice mechanisms present within countries could act as enablers for access to justice for ordinary citizens.10 Legal empower- ment was aptly defined by the commission as a process of “systemic change through which the poor and excluded become able to use the law, the legal system, and legal services to protect and advance their rights and interests as citizens and economic actors.”11 An interesting point to note regarding legal empowerment theory is that it focuses on the “legal,” that is, the codification and promotion of individual property rights, business rights, and employment rights. However, in addi- tion to the need to ensure the reform of laws adequate to protect the funda- mental rights of individuals and their economic interests, the concept of legal empowerment also emphasizes the importance of the “nonlegal.” This is in the sense that the nonlegal recognizes “related activities”12 that complement legal services but that in themselves are not inherently law oriented. These related activities include community organizing, group formation, political mobilization, and use of the media. Legal services can, in and of themselves, constitute and produce legal empowerment, although the greater efficiency of the use of the law is often improved when tied with these related activities. Historical Perspectives of Justice in Somalia In proposing solutions to the appropriate rule of law reform program that Somali decision makers and international donors might consider, it is neces- sary to look at the history of the legal, political, and social context of Somalia. In keeping with the legal empowerment theory, it is necessary to understand how power dynamics affect legal reform efforts and give some insight into the success of any proposed intervention and the obstacles that a rule of law 9 Making the Law Work for Everyone, vol. 1: Report of the Commission on Legal Empowerment of the Poor (Commn. on Leg. Empowerment of the Poor, UNDP 2008) (hereinafter, CLEP Report). 10 Id., at 21. 11 Banik, supra note 5, at 12; CLEP Report, supra note 9, at 3. 12 Stephen Golub, Beyond Rule of Law Orthodoxy: The Legal Empowerment Alternative 26 (Carnegie Endowment Working Paper No. 41, R. of L. Ser., Democracy and R. of L. Project 3, Carnegie Endowment for Intl. Peace 2002). Serving the Justice Needs of the People 267 intervention may face. As Michael Anderson states: “Constitutionalism and the rule of law depend upon sustained political support.”13 This section highlights how the political, social, and legal context of So- malia has enhanced or hindered people’s access to justice. Such a sociopoliti- cal background will provide further insight into how to incorporate various access to justice and legal empowerment approaches into proposed solutions to Somalia’s rule of law reform efforts over the coming years. This section addresses three issues that, it can be argued,14 have hindered access to justice up to the present. The first issue regards how the plurality of legal systems― civil and common statutory law, customary xeer law, and sharia law―have brought about a tangle of legal systems offering varying degrees of access while simultaneously creating winners and losers in terms of providing ac- cess; among the la er: women, minority groups, and the impoverished. The second issue is Somalia’s fallout with colonialism and its struggle to imple- ment effective law reform efforts. The third issue is Somalia’s period of dicta- torship under the Siad Barre regime, the regime’s approach to the rule of law, and the authoritarian and autocratic regime’s role in depleting the culture of justice and the rule of law among elites and ordinary citizens in Somalia. Background of Somalia Somalia has lacked an effective national government since 1991, when the gov- ernment collapsed following the ousting of President Mohamed Siad Barre. Over the past two decades, various armed groups have vied for political dom- inance in South Central Somalia, the most recent of which is Al Shabab, an Al Qaeda‒linked armed group that has opposed the federal government and its efforts to put in place a new provisional constitution for Somalia. However, the situation in Somalia has been improving from both a political and a secu- rity perspective. A relatively peaceful political transition took place alongside the adoption, on August 1, 2012, of the Provisional Constitution of Somalia, the first official new national constitution in 52 years, which currently awaits a popular referendum. Furthermore, Mogadishu is now under the direct con- trol of the Somali government, with assistance from African Union troops. Major cities in the south of Somalia, including Kismayo, have been recovered from Al Shabab control. Justice and security are also necessary for Somalia’s economic and social development, and vital for the protection of human rights. The current insti- tutions and organizations that make up the security and justice sectors (such as the police, armed forces, and judiciary) are often unable to provide people with adequate services. In the past two decades, donor investment in the area 13 Michael R. Anderson, Access to Justice and Legal Process: Making Legal Institutions Responsive to Poor People in LDCs 12 (IDS Working Paper No. 178, Inst. of Dev. Stud. 2003). 14 Much of the primary research to find this evidence was undertaken by the Centre for Hu- manitarian Dialogue in partnership with the UNDP Rule of Law and Security (ROLS) project and is presented in a report: Andre Le Sage, Stateless Justice in Somalia: Formal and Informal Rule of Law Initiatives (Ctr. for Humanitarian Dialogue 2005). 268 The World Bank Legal Review of justice has been minimal, which has led to a paucity of qualified justice professionals in the three zones of Somalia: Somaliland, Puntland, and South Central Somalia. The la er zone receives less investment than the other two areas, which currently enjoy relative peace. The Plurality of Legal Systems Xeer Given the total collapse of the state in the early 1990s, it is perhaps not surpris- ing that traditional forms of dispute resolution have flourished and are now the primary form of justice in Somalia. Somali customary law, xeer, covers issues ranging from clan relations to personal injuries, including the spectrum from death to minor injuries, penalties for which are paid in livestock. It also covers issues relating broadly to property ma ers, family law, and territory. The sys- tem is not simple or arbitrary. Community elders, charged with adjudicating to reach conclusions over any given case, use procedures and rules of precedent. Xeer has been highly successful, for example, in se ling land disputes and returning property to persons displaced during Somalia’s wars. Nonetheless, the system has flaws, including potentially unfair or discriminatory results, in which clans are judged as unequal in standing, and the rejection of clan laws by returning expatriates, among other issues. Perhaps most problematic is the treatment of women under xeer. Forced marriage is one of the issues facing women, including the possibility of forcing a rape victim to marry her a acker. Women are also forbidden by xeer to inherit certain capital assets.15 Sharia Sharia has historically been applied in Somalia by the civil courts of first in- stance, particularly regarding issues of family law and inheritance. With the collapse of the state, however, sharia courts began to appear throughout the country and began to focus on both criminal and civil cases, including the apprehension and detention of criminals. These courts also dealt extensively with commercial disputes. The use of sharia law has a number of benefits, most notably the fact that its jurisdiction is unquestioned by all Somalis. How- ever, most of the judges in the sharia courts lack formal training, and religious leaders within clans have tended not to support them.16 Statute-Based Justice System The legislatively mandated structure of the judiciary in Somalia is well de- fined on paper.17At the apex of the formal judiciary is a Judicial Service Coun- 15 Id., at 32‒38. 16 Id., at 38‒47. 17 Two enactments govern the details of the Somali formal judiciary: Law No. 3, June 12, 1962, and Law No. 34, Aug. 11, 1974. Available at h p://www.so.undp.org/docs/Somali%20 %20Judiciary%20Organization%20Law%20No%203%20of%2012%20June%201962.pdf. Serving the Justice Needs of the People 269 cil, which supervises the entire judiciary. Legislation to date has established a Supreme Court, constituted as the Constitutional Court or High Court of Justice.18 Beneath the Supreme Court, there is a Court of Appeal,19 and beneath that, two courts of first instance, the District Court20 and the Regional Court.21 The district courts are further divided into criminal (for minor offenses)22 and civil divisions;23 and the civil divisions are further divided into family and ordinary sections.24 The regional courts are also divided into civil and criminal sections, with the civil section further subdivided into ordinary, administra- tive, and labor sections. 25 The current statutory justice system, however, lacks qualified legal profes- sionals. Courts are largely based solely in regional capitals, leaving the rural poor li le access to these systems due to economic and logistical constraints. Judges and lawyers lack sufficient knowledge of existing laws. The weakness of the legislatures across the regions of Somalia indicates that there are not enough laws enacted to deal with changing social conditions. Physical infra- structure and resources are dilapidated, such that even if there were lawyers and judges sufficiently trained to present and adjudicate on a case, the lack of resources could cause severe delays for the claimants or keep the case from being concluded.26 Depleted Culture of Justice Owing to Somalia’s history of colonialism under British and Italian rule and the law reform initiated by Siad Barre in the la er years of his administration, Somalia and Somali people are faced with a number of laws and legal systems that have li le resonance with their day-to-day lives, their historical and cul- tural background, and their entrenched beliefs and values. At independence in 1960, when British Somaliland and Italian Somalia were united to form the Somali Republic, four distinct legal traditions―Brit- ish Common Law, Italian (Continental) law, Islamic sharia, and Somali cus- tomary law―were in simultaneous operation.27 To simplify this amalgam of Much of this section is based on Tahlil Haji Ahmed, Follow-Up Assessment of TFG Judiciary in Mogadishu, secs. 1.6.1‒1.6.4 (UNDP, Somalia 2011). 18 Law No. 3, June 12, 1962, arts. 5‒6. 19 Id., at art. 4. 20 Id., at art. 2. 21 Id., at art. 3. 22 Id., at art. 2(4). 23 Id., at art. 2(3). 24 Id., at art. 2(3), which details the District Court’s jurisdiction over sharia and customary law. 25 Id., at art. 3(3)(a), which confers jurisdiction to the Regional Court concerning all ma ers not conferred to district courts. 26 Le Sage, supra note 14, at 32, and evidenced in the Somalia Justice Sector Action Plan, 2013‒2015, on file with the author. 27 Id., at 18. 270 The World Bank Legal Review laws, the Somali government established a Consultative Commi ee for In- tegration of the Legal Systems to recommend how to create a unified justice system. The Law on the Organization of the Judiciary was the outcome of the deliberations, and in 1962 the Somali Parliament enacted the law, with civil and penal codes based on the Italian legal system, and criminal procedure based on the Indian Code.28 Despite these reforms, or perhaps due to the lack of clarity on jurisdictional issues that this very law was supposed to provide, judges and lawyers continued to apply laws in accordance with their region’s legal history. Shortly after the military coup initiated by General Mohamed Siad Barre, the regime sought swiftly to reform the Somali legal system to reflect the re- gime’s political alignment with the Soviet Union. The regime made a series of changes that largely eliminated the legal provisions or jurisprudence of the sharia and xeer legal systems. In addition, the regime significantly modified existing Italian codes to suit the requirements of authoritarian rule. Law No. 1 (October 21, 1969) prescribed authority for all judicial functions, as well as absolute executive and legislative powers, to the regime. In addition to this, Barre operated beyond the rule of law and issued decrees beyond the confines of any legal mandate. The corruption and repressive practices of the dictator- ship left negative public perceptions of the formal legal and judicial systems that persist to this day.29 Going Forward: Somalia’s Rule of Law Reform Applying contemporary thinking to rule of law reform on the global scale, this section proposes access to justice approaches and innovative legal empower- ment processes for Somalia. Noting Stephen Golub’s theory of the “nexus”30 approach that legal empowerment adopts, this section draws on opportuni- ties in which Somalia can look beyond the traditional rule of law approaches to more innovative solutions that put the ordinary citizen―the poor, the dis- advantaged, or the minority individual―at the center of such rule of law re- form efforts. As noted in the original definition of access to justice, the “ability of peo- ple to seek and obtain a remedy through formal or informal institutions of justice, and in conformity with human rights standards,”31 the options pro- posed highlight the use of mechanisms that directly target enhancing the abil- ity of individuals to find a remedy for their grievances. This section first looks at contemporary models used in the formal justice system. The International Development Law Organization (IDLO), under its land-titling initiative, ex- perimented with a number of models to support different communities’ ef- 28 Id. 29 Id., at 20. 30 Golub, supra note 12, at 27. 31 UNDP, supra note 2. Serving the Justice Needs of the People 271 forts in legally titling their land. Of importance for the discussion here was the effective use of paralegals in reaching this goal. Second, a ention will be given to the use of civil society as an agent of change, to be able to build the rule of law among communities and to bring about a culture of justice. Third, the re- port of a recent IDLO study on the involvement of customary and traditional justice in bringing about improved access to justice for rural communities will be assessed. Law reform is also a vital component of improving individuals’ access to justice. This section illustrates how the review of the Somalia Provi- sional Constitution over the next term of Parliament could provide an oppor- tunity to strengthen the law-making process and to ensure that constitutional and legislative reform and implementation comply with the principles of ac- cess to justice, primarily that individuals be adequately equipped and have the incentive to seek remedy for wrongs commi ed against them. Paralegals Paralegals signify the opportunity to provide innovative bo om-up ap- proaches to rule of law reform. Paralegals are not trained lawyers, but one of their strengths is that they are often drawn from the very community they are intended to serve. Following their recruitment, they receive specialized legal training and they are then charged to return to their communities to provide civic awareness and education on various rule of law issues, legal advice, and legal assistance to those in need. The benefits of using this approach, as op- posed to the traditional top-down development of lawyers and the traditional legal profession, are severalfold, as illustrated by the work of IDLO and the NGO Namati, discussed below. In response to the injustices associated with national governments of de- veloping countries granting vast amounts of land to domestic and interna- tional investors, recent moves have been made in various countries to enable rural communities to legally title their land and protect it from being sold. In 2009, IDLO and Namati, an organization with its mandate focused specifically on legal empowerment, supported the implementation in these nations of the laws passed to enable rural communities to register their lands as a single le- gal entity and act as decentralized land administration and management bod- ies.32 The Community Land Titling Initiative, which launched a randomized, controlled trial in Liberia, Uganda, and Mozambique to support the commu- nities’ efforts, produced a number of lessons learned that can be applied to the current context of Somalia’s rule of law reform. The experimental trials adopted for the initiative tested three models for facilitating community land protection: a full legal services approach, in which communities had direct assistance from lawyers; a pared-down rights- education approach, where information was provided and li le else; and a middle-path, community-paralegal approach, in which a community 32 Executive Summary, in Protecting Community Lands and Resources: Evidence from Liberia, Mo- zambique and Uganda 3 (Rachel Knight et al. eds., Namati & Intl. Dev. L. Org. 2012). 272 The World Bank Legal Review representative was trained and supported in driving the process forward. What proved interesting in the findings of this experiment was that commu- nities receiving full legal services tended to rely on the outside professionals to be able to undertake the land registration process, while communities with paralegals tended to take greater ownership over the process. Additionally, the paralegals’ inside knowledge of community issues enabled them to be er assist community members in successfully completing the land registration process and securing rights over their communal land. In contrast, state law- yers’ lack of understanding of local dynamics largely resulted in their add- ing li le value to the process.33 The evidence, although directly linked to land registration processes, serves as a valuable tool to scale up and transpose onto other areas of rule of law reform. Considering the deep distrust of the traditional formal justice system, mentioned earlier in this chapter, the positive effects of using paralegals to serve the justice needs of rural communities, the socially and culturally dis- advantaged, and the poor could be put to good use in Somalia. The Somali people have long been at the hands of top-down, or externally driven, legal regimes and have often been at the mostly disadvantaged, receiving end of legal processes. The use of paralegals in law reform efforts in Somalia presents an innovative opportunity to take ownership of legal reform processes. In ad- dition, the fact that paralegals are drawn from the local community―unlike lawyers, who are sent from regional capitals―to provide legal representation indicates that paralegals will be be er equipped to navigate through localized political and social obstacles to reach the desired legal outcome. Civil Society It has been noted that civil society plays a central role for legal empowerment in rule of law reform processes.34 In practice, civil society organizations under- take the most detailed research in acute and nuanced areas of law and justice and are thus equipped with the knowledge and capacity to devise a number of innovative reform and development programs. This is in addition to the traditional roles of awareness and advocacy played under past and present rule of law programs, such as the ongoing initiatives under the USAID Gover- nance and Democracy program.35 Civil society should act as the driving wheel of advocating for appropriate and effective justice reform because it is placed more centrally to those reform processes, being the implementer of justice re- form itself. Although a large-scale civil society community in Somalia is a recent phe- nomenon, there have been a number of successful projects carried out by the 33 Main Report, in Protecting Community Lands and Resources: Evidence from Liberia, Mozambique and Uganda 10 (Rachel Knight et al. eds., Namati & Intl. Dev. L. Org. 2012). 34 Golub, supra note 12, at 28. 35 See, generally, h p://www.usaid.gov/democracy/index.html. Serving the Justice Needs of the People 273 NGO community in Somalia.36 If empowered to act as the representative of community interests in advocating for change in government, civil society could become strong enough to lead the agenda in analyzing, researching, and devising rule of law reform projects within Somalia. In Somalia’s upcom- ing justice reform efforts, actors should pay due regard to allocating sufficient time and financial investment to the development of civil society. Customary and Traditional Justice As noted previously in this chapter, traditional justice has become the pre- dominant justice mechanism for individuals to address their interests and grievances in Somalia. The xeer system is a developed system, is cost-effective, and is the most logistically accessible form of justice for the vast majority of So- malis. Other reform efforts may have placed minimal emphasis on traditional systems of justice, yet these few efforts rarely if ever succeeded in displacing traditional dispute resolution mechanisms for more formal, statutory systems in serving the justice needs of the majority population.37 As noted in a Depart- ment for International Development report, “in many developing countries, traditional or customary legal systems account for 80% of total cases.”38 There have been some engagements with traditional justice systems in So- malia, most notably by the Danish Refugee Council (DRC) in 2003. The DRC was engaged by elders of a rural community in the Togdheer region in So- maliland seeking support in their a empts to gain insight into how xeer might be revised to align more closely with both sharia and human rights standards. A series of dialogues was initiated with 100 elders from five clans of the Togd- heer region, in which elders were asked to identify pressing issues and dis- putes and to come to a unified and workable agreement between the clans. The substantive issues raised in the dialogues included the protection of the accused by community elders; ensuring the statutory prosecution of violent crimes; fair treatment of women, orphans, and minority groups; ensuring that victims of gender-based violence received adequate redress; problems associ- ated with diya, or “blood-money,” payment and collective punishment; and property rights. The decisions regarding the issues raised were subsequently formulated into an agreement between the elders, or the “National Declara- tion,” as it was called, which was disseminated by the members throughout their communities. 36 Such projects are detailed in Le Sage, supra note 14, at 51‒53. 37 Afghanistan neither incorporated nor prohibited customary law in its 2004 national con- stitution. For a critique of formal rule of law reform, see Kirsti Samuels, Rule of Law Reform in Post-conflict Countries: Operational Initiatives and Lessons Learnt (Soc. Dev. Papers: Conflict Prevention & Reconstruction, No. 37, World Bank 2006); and Laurel Miller & Robert Pertito, Establishing the Rule of Law in Afghanistan (USIP Special Report, United States Institute of Peace Mar. 2004). 38 Department for International Development, Safety, Security and Accessible Justice: PuĴing Policy into Practice 58 (July 2002). 274 The World Bank Legal Review The outcomes of the initiative undertaken were assessed by IDLO in 2011.39 It was found that removing the traditional protection of the accused was re- solved as the elders’ views of the practice were challenged and perceptions of how to deal with the accused were improved. IDLO reported that elders understood that serious criminal offenses should be referred to the statutory courts. However, achieving the fair treatment of women and resolving gender- based violence through statutory court systems were less successful. Another important lesson learned was that the elders and the statutory judiciary began to work together to assist in implementing each other’s respective tasks and re- sponding together to the challenges faced by the justice system in responding to the people’s needs. Additionally, community elders themselves were placed at the center of any reform or harmonization of customary law with the statu- tory system and international human rights standards. As the linking point between the formal justice system and the customary system, through which most people gain access to justice, the elders were made agents of change in the process and took ownership of the change rather than opposing another form of top-down imposition of reform of the traditional justice system. From the evidence gained in IDLO’s report on engaging with traditional justice systems in Somalia, it is evident that undertaking bo om-up approaches to reforming justice systems serves the needs of the Somali people in a more effective way. Interveners in the Somali rule of law reform process will be able to see how this approach of engaging with nonstatutory forms of justice is an effective tool in serving the access to justice agenda in Somalia while ensuring that the state has sufficient monitoring and intervention capacity when the traditional justice mechanism may serve as an injustice to select individuals. Constitutional and Legislative Reform As the constitutional review process continues over the first term of Parlia- ment, and perhaps in future terms,40 and as the legislative implementation of a number of provisions in the new constitution takes place, an access to justice approach can be adopted with regard to future decision making by the bodies charged with carrying out these functions. Unlike the constitutions that were built in Europe or the United States, whereby the articles are largely a list of rules and principles for legislators to abide by when enacting new laws, modern constitutions, designed after the fall of authoritarian regimes or after transitions from conflict to peace, tend to provide more detailed pre- scriptions for the conduct of social affairs under the law.41 In keeping with this modern approach to constitution making, the Somali constitution, through 39 Maria Vargas Simojoki, Unlikely Allies: Working with Traditional Leaders to Reform Customary Law in Somalia (IDLO Working Paper Series: Enhancing Leg. Empowerment: Working with Customary Justice Systems: Post-conflict & Fragile States, Intl. Dev. L. Org. 2011). 40 The constitutional review process is detailed in ch. 15 of the Provisional Constitution. 41 For example, the U.S. constitution lists only seven articles, while the South African constitu- tion lists 243 articles. Serving the Justice Needs of the People 275 subsequent iterations over the coming years, could ensure that any legislation implementing its provisions will comply with the theories of access to justice. At the core of the legislators’ thinking should be the consideration of how such a law can serve the needs of the individual seeking justice. Referring back to the original definition of access to justice,42 the constitution could pre- scribe checks to ensure that laws provide incentives for individuals to access the justice system. There should be real remedies for claimants addressing the courts. For example, criminal laws that emphasize sanctions for the perpetra- tor but offer no remedy for the victim will result in apathy on the part of the victim with regard to accessing a court. Legislators must also consider the priority laws required to be put in place. The Somalia Justice Sector Action Plan, presented at the Somalia Conference in London on May 7, 2013, em- phasizes the necessity to implement priority laws that will serve the needs of access to justice. The plan looks at the reform of criminal and civil codes, legal aid laws, and police and prison laws, among other instruments. However, it must be emphasized that policy making and legislating do not prioritize haste over comprehensiveness. Reforms of civil codes should be citizen focused and enabled for the poor to use the law to serve their development needs, and should incorporate the specific justice needs of women, socially and culturally marginalized groups, and minority groups. Conclusion Somalia’s rule of law reform over the coming years will be an ambitious and challenging experience. The country’s long-standing history of conflict and its experience of top-down, authoritarian, and abusive legal regimes have fueled a lack of trust in statutory justice systems. Furthermore, individuals lack the awareness or ability to avail their rights or seek remedies for wrongs that they have suffered. This chapter addresses the newly emerging fields of law reform, which are designed to put the individual citizen―including the poor and margin- alized―at the center of rule of law reform efforts, and offers opportunities that Somali reformers can adopt and incorporate into future reform programs. The bo om-up approaches detailed in this chapter, as well as the evidence displayed in several successful rule of law reform efforts within Somalia and abroad, can be adopted to increase individuals’ belief, trust, and ability to ac- cess formal and informal legal systems to find solutions to their justice needs, uphold their individual rights and freedoms, and be er their social and eco- nomic situations. 42 UNDP, supra note 2. The International Development Law Organization has copyright over this chapter. Not- withstanding, the World Bank has permission to include this chapter in the book and make it available under the CC BY license. See the copyright page for more information. This page intentionally left blank PART III ENVIRONMENTAL AND NATURAL RESOURCES LAW This page intentionally left blank The Challenges of Reforming the Urban Legal Framework A Critical Assessment of Brazil’s City Statute Ten Years Later EDESIO FERNANDES Legal scholars and urban researchers are increasingly acknowledging that the dominant pa ern of combined sociospatial segregation and informality that marks urban development globally has resulted from the exclusionary nature of the urban legal systems prevailing in most developing and transitional countries. Indeed, the legal order has been one of the main factors determin- ing urban informality.1 In this context, policy makers, urban managers, and social movements commi ed to the urban reform agenda have been asking a fundamental ques- tion: What does it take to turn national and local urban legal systems into ef- fective factors of sociospatial inclusion? A growing international sociopolitical movement has vigorously argued that the promotion of legal reform is nec- essary to support any significant a empts at urban reform. As a result, new urban laws governing land rights and management, territorial organization, planning, and housing have been enacted in several countries and cities in recent years, and a serious investment has been made by several nongovern- mental and governmental institutions in formulating inclusive legal systems in rapidly urbanizing countries.2 But what, exactly, can be expected of these new urban laws? What is required for them to be fully enforced and socially effective? What are the nature, possibilities, and constraints of progressive urban laws vis-à-vis the broader sociopolitical process? This chapter discusses such general questions through a critical assess- ment of Brazil’s national urban policy law—the 2001 City Statute—which is regarded as a groundbreaking effort to conceive a regulatory framework conducive to providing adequate legal support to governmental and social 1 See, among other sources, the general analyses and national case studies collected in Edesio Fernandes & Ann Varley eds., Illegal Cities: Law and Urban Change in Developing Countries (Zed Books 1998) (hereinafter, Illegal Cities). 2 Several of the national laws recently enacted in Latin American countries have been dis- cussed in three special issues of Revista Fórum de Direito Urbano e Ambiental, coedited by Edesio Fernandes & Betânia Alfonsin. See Revista Fórum de Direito Urbano e Ambiental, 9(54) (2011); 10(57) (2011); and 11(61) (2012) (hereinafter, Revista Fórum). 279 280 The World Bank Legal Review a empts to promote urban reform. The City Statute was approved following 12 years of intense discussion and fierce disputes within and outside the Na- tional Congress. Since its adoption, it has been acclaimed internationally, and in 2006, Brazil won UN-HABITAT’s Scroll of Honour for having approved it. Envied by policy makers and public administrators in several countries, the ambitious City Statute has been proposed by the Cities Alliance as a paradigm to be considered internationally. However, more than 10 years since its approval, there are significant de- bates about its efficacy. This chapter provides a critical assessment of the con- ditions of its enforcement as the basis for a more general discussion on the growing expectations around newly approved urban laws in other countries. A New Urban Land Governance Framework The 2001 federal law was largely the result of a nationwide process of social mobilization. The City Statute regulated the urban policy introduced by the 1988 federal constitution, which had itself been preceded by an unparalleled process of sociopolitical mobilization, especially through the formulation of the Popular Amendment on Urban Reform, the document produced as a re- sult of a national popular movement that defined the main elements of the debate on urban reform to be considered by the Constituent Assembly.3 Both the constitutional chapter and the City Statute are discussed in detail elsewhere;4 for the purposes of this paper, the main dimensions of the City Statute are as follow: • It firmly replaced the traditional legal definition of unqualified individual property rights with the notion of the social function of property so as to support the democratization of access to urban land and housing. • It defined the main articulated principles of land, urban, and housing pol- icy to be observed in Brazil. • It created several processes, mechanisms, instruments, and resources aimed at rendering urban management viable, with emphasis placed on capturing for the community some of the surplus value generated by state actions that had been traditionally fully appropriated by land and prop- erty owners. • It proposed a largely decentralized and democratized urban governance system in which intergovernmental institutions as well as state partner- 3 For an analysis of the law-making process, see José Roberto Bassul, City Statute: Building a Law, in The City Statute of Brazil: A Commentary (Celso Santos Carvalho & Anaclaudia Ross- bach eds., Cities Alliance 2010). 4 See especially Edesio Fernandes, Law and Urban Change in Brazil (Avebury 1995); Edesio Fer- nandes, Constructing the “Right to the City” in Brazil, 16 Soc. & Leg. Stud. (2007); Edesio Fer- nandes, Implementing the Urban Reform Agenda in Brazil: Possibilities, Challenges, and Lessons, 22 Urb. Forum (2011); Revista Fórum, supra note 2; and Edesio Fernandes & Raquel Rolnik, Law and Urban Change in Brazil, in Illegal Cities, supra note 1. The Challenges of Reforming the Urban Legal Framework 281 ships with the private, community, and voluntary sectors are articulated with several forms of popular participation in the decision- and law-mak- ing process. • It recognized the collective rights of residents in consolidated, informal se lements to legal security of land tenure as well as to the sustainable regularization of their se lements. These intertwined dimensions of the City Statute constituted a new urban land governance framework in Brazil. Given the highly decentralized nature of the Brazilian federative sys- tem, the materialization of this legal framework was placed in the hands of the municipal administrations through the formulation of Municipal Master Plans (MMPs). Prior to the enactment of the new law, the vast majority of municipalities did not have an adequate regulatory framework in place to govern the processes of land use, development, preservation, construction, and regularization. Most towns and cities also lacked basic information such as maps, photos, and other relevant materials. Of 1,700 municipalities that had a legal obligation to approve such MMPs to apply the City Statute, a remark- able 1,450 had done so by 2013. However, since the enactment of the City Statute, Brazilian cities have undergone significant changes. Rates of urban growth have decreased, but they are still relatively high, especially in midsize and small cities, which has led to the formation of new metropolitan regions—30 such regions have been officially recognized. Economic development and the emergence of a so-called new middle class, or precarious working class, have aggravated the long- standing urban problems of transportation, mobility, environmental impact, and violence. Infrastructure and energy-provision problems have increased, and the public administration fiscal crisis is widespread, especially at the mu- nicipal level.5 Above all, the long-existing land and housing crisis has escalated. The housing deficit is still enormous (between six and seven million units), and, despite the impressive number of units already built or contracted, the My House, My Life national housing program has not fully reached the poorest families and has been criticized for reinforcing long-standing processes of so- ciospatial segregation. Although the levels of land, property, rental apprecia- tion, and, especially, speculation have broken historical records, there is an enormous stock of vacant serviced land, abandoned or underutilized proper- ties (calculated as 5.5 million units), and public land and property without a social function.6 5 Detailed official data on urban realities and processes in Brazil are regularly provided, or- ganized, and analyzed by IBGE Cidades, available at h p://www.ibge.gov.br/cidadesat /topwindow.htm?1, and IPEA, available at h p://www.ipea.gov.br/portal/. 6 For official information on the housing program, see h p://www.cidades.gov.br/index.php /minha-casa-minha-vida. 282 The World Bank Legal Review Informal development rates are still high, with the densification and ver- ticalization of old se lements and the formation of new se lements, usually in peripheral areas; development also has taken new shapes, in the form of backyarders and informal rental transactions, for example. The proliferation of gated communities in peripheral areas and other metropolitan municipali- ties means that for the first time rich and poor are competing for the same space. Urban development in new economic frontiers—especially in the Ama- zon—has largely taken place through informal processes, which have been accompanied by a growing number of land disputes and socioenvironmental conflicts throughout the country. Over the past two decades, an enormous amount of public resources— land, fiscal incentives, all types of credit, tax exemptions, building, and de- velopment rights—has been given to land developers, urban promoters, and builders, usually within the context of urban renewal or revitalization pro- grams; rehabilitation of downtown areas or historic centers; large-scale proj- ects; modernization of harbors, ports, and infrastructure; and global events such as the World Cup and the Olympic Games. The number of resulting forced evictions is staggering, not only in Rio de Janeiro and São Paulo but in municipalities such as Belo Horizonte and Porto Alegre, which had long been commi ed to the urban reform process. This urban reform process, which was highly visible in the 1980s and 1990s, and was instrumental in the enact- ment of the 2001 City Statute, seems to have lost momentum; stakeholders have been asking, “Which cities, and for whom?” and have demanded to know who has actually benefited from the enormous transfer of public resources. What has happened to the City Statute, then? Has it failed, as a growing number of skeptical groups seem to believe? Rather than contributing to the promotion of sociospatial inclusion, has it perversely contributed to the esca- lating commodification of Brazilian cities—and to the further peripheraliza- tion of the urban poor—as some have argued? More than 10 years since the City Statute was enacted, a comprehensive and critical assessment of the urban land governance framework that it pro- posed, and especially of the municipal initiatives aimed at implementing it— is urgently needed. This is a moment for reflection, which requires reassessing the main ideas, debates, and experiences around the enactment of the federal law, as well as reaffirming the law’s historical principles and objectives. Pro- moting a critique of the role of all involved stakeholders is fundamental to cor- recting mistakes, changing courses, and advancing the urban reform agenda. Some important surveys and comparative studies have already been published.7 There are also several published case studies, and a “Bank of 7 See especially Renato Cymbalista & Paula Freire Santoro eds., Planos diretores: Processos e aprendizados (Instituto Polis 2009); Orlando Alves Santos, Jr. & Daniel Todtmann Montandon eds., Os planos diretores municipais pos-estatuto da cidade: Balanco critico e perspectivas (Obser- vatorio das Metropoles/Letra Capital 2011); and Sandra I. Momm Schult, Claudia Silbert, & The Challenges of Reforming the Urban Legal Framework 283 Experiences” has been created by the Ministry of Cities.8 Still, more critical assessment is necessary: to determine if and how the generation of MMPs has effectively translated the general principles of the City Statute into rules and actions, and to identify the main legal and social obstacles to the full implementation of the national law. In addressing these issues, this chapter discusses if and how Brazilian society has made effective use of the many legal possibilities available for recognizing the range of social rights created by the new legal-urban order. Growing Gaps between the Progressive New Legal Order and the Exclusionary Urban and Institutional Realities The City Statute—Federal Law 10.257/2001—belongs within the context of a broader legal-urban reform process that has been taking place in Brazil for three decades. Its main direct antecedents were Federal Law 6.766/1979 (ur- ban land subdivision); Federal Law 7.347/1985 (civil public action); the 1988 Federal Constitution (especially Articles 182 and 183, on urban policy); Fed- eral Law 9.790/1999 (civil society organizations of public interest); and Consti- tutional Amendment 26 (recognizing the social right to housing). Since the City Statute was enacted, the federal legal order has been com- plemented by several other important laws: Provisional Measure 2.220/2001 (special concession of use for housing purposes); Federal Law 11.079/2004 (public-private partnerships); Federal Law 10.931/2004 (land and property credit and registration); Federal Law 11.107/2005 (public consortia); Federal Law 11.124/2005 (passed by popular initiative, it created the National Fund for Social Interest Housing); Federal Law 11.445/2007 (sanitation); Federal Law 11.481/2007 (federal land and property); Federal Law 11.888/2008 (techni- cal assistance to communities); Federal Law 11.977/2009 (My House, My Life national housing program and regularization of informal se lements); Fed- eral Law 11.952/2009 (“Legal Amazon”); Federal Law 12.305/2010 (solid-waste control), and Federal Law 12.608/2012 (national policy for civil protection).9 All of these federal laws are currently in force, as well as several interna- tional conventions and treaties signed and ratified by the National Congress (notably on housing rights) and federal laws on the environment, national heri- tage, expropriation, and registration. Bills being discussed include one on land subdivision and one known as the “Metropolitan Statute”; white paper topics include the resolution of land conflicts. Also under consideration are countless decrees and resolutions of the National Council of Cities and the National Luiz Alberto Souza eds., Experiencias em planejamento e gestao urbana: Planos diretores participa- tivos e regularizacao fundiaria (Edifurb 2010). 8 See h p://www.cidades.gov.br/index.php/planejamento-urbano/392-banco-de-experiencias. 9 For the texts of the federal laws, see http://www2.camara.leg.br/atividade-legislativa /legislacao. 284 The World Bank Legal Review Environmental Council, as well as numerous directives of the public bank Caixa Econômica Federal. A new legal-urban order—sophisticated, articulated, and comprehen- sive—has thus been established, bolstered by constitutional recognition of ur- ban law as a field of Brazilian public law, replete with its own paradigmatic principles: the socioenvironmental functions of property and of the city, and the democratic management of the city. The collective right to sustainable cit- ies has been explicitly recognized, reflecting the legal system’s clear commit- ment to the urban reform agenda. These significant and structural legal changes have been expanded at all government levels—in the federated states and, especially, in the municipali- ties, particularly through the approval of more than 1,400 MMPs. This comprehensive new legal-urban order has been supported by the creation of a new institutional order at the federal level. The Ministry of Cit- ies was created in 2003; national conferences have been held every two years since then. The National Council of Cities meets regularly; Caixa Econômi- ca Federal—the world’s largest public bank—has promoted several federal plans and projects, especially the Plan to Accelerate Growth (PAC) and the My House, My Life national housing program (the PMCMV), which, combined, amount to the largest social programs in the history of Latin America.10 These changes in the legal and institutional orders are fundamentally so- cial conquests, having largely resulted from a historical process of sociopo- litical mobilization involving thousands of stakeholders―associations, non- governmental organizations (NGOs), churches, unions, political parties, and sectors of land and property capital—which, since the late 1970s, have worked for the constitutional recognition of land, urban, and housing issues, as well as for the decentralization and democratization of, and popular participation in, law- and decision-making processes.11 At the same time, however, over the past decade, several stakeholders have increasingly denounced the growth of property speculation in Brazil; the elitist utilization of the enormous amount of financial resources gener- ated, especially through the sale of building and development rights in pub- lic auctions; the manner in which the so-called unlocking of land values by large projects and events has reinforced sociospatial segregation; the recurrent abuse of legal arguments based on public interest and urgency; and the huge socioenvironmental impact of federal and other programs.12 10 For detailed official information on PAC, see its website, h p://www.pac.gov.br/. 11 For an analysis of the sociopolitical process, see Evaniza Rodrigues & Benedito Roberto Bar- bosa, Popular Movements and the City Statute, in The City Statute of Brazil: A Commentary (Celso Santos Carvalho & Anaclaudia Rossbach eds., Cities Alliance 2010). 12 For a critical assessment of the broader context in which the City Statute was enacted, see Erminia Maricato, The Statute of the Peripheral City, in The City Statute of Brazil: A Commentary (Celso Santos Carvalho & Anaclaudia Rossbach eds., Cities Alliance 2010). The Challenges of Reforming the Urban Legal Framework 285 Growing land conflicts, rental prices, urban informality, evictions and re- movals; the worsening of transportation, mobility, and sanitation problems; and especially the increasing commodification of Brazilian cities as they have become at once both the venues and the objects of postindustrial capitalist production, now at the global level given the aggressive penetration of inter- national land and property capital. Such is the new stage of urban develop- ment in Brazil, a stage that has required the strengthening of the individualist and patrimonial legal culture that had long prevailed prior to the enactment of the City Statute: property viewed merely as a commodity; consideration of exchange values but not of use values; the right to use, enjoy, and dispose of property, which often means the right not to use, enjoy, or dispose of—in other words, to freely speculate. What has happened to the urban reform process? How can the enormous legal and institutional gaps existing in Brazil be explained? Indeed, there is an enormous gap between the legal-urban order and urban and social realities. The legal-urban order is still largely unknown by jurists and society when not the object of legal and/or sociopolitical disputes. Imple- menting this order, and thereby giving it legal and social efficacy, amounts to a massive challenge. There is also a huge gap between the institutional order and urban and social realities. The Ministry of Cities has often been emptied of money and power or bypassed by the federal budget or by other ministries; the National Council of Cities has often been emptied or bypassed by the Ministry of Cities or other ministries, having had difficulties renewing levels of social mobiliza- tion. When there is not a lack of projects, duplicity, inefficiency, waste, lack of continuity, and especially bo omless corruption have marked Brazil’s frag- mented urban management at all government levels. It is in this context that skepticism regarding the City Statute has grown among planners, managers, academics, and, most of all, society.13 The 2001 federal law has been demonized by those who have blamed it for the recent occurrence of sociospatial segregation. In fact, new urban management tools have been appropriated by conservative sectors, and new forms of old pro- cesses of socialization of costs and privatization of benefits have emerged with the reconcentration of public services and equipment. Is the Critique Legitimate? Any fair assessment of the City Statute requires rescuing the historical prin- ciples and objectives of the legal-urban order that it consolidated. 13 For a discussion on the disputes regarding the City Statute, see Raquel Rolnik, Ten Years of the City Statute in Brazil: From the Struggle for Urban Reform to the World Cup Cities, 5(1) Intl. J. of Sustainable Dev. (2013). 286 The World Bank Legal Review First, the City Statute fully embraced a new paradigm on the ma er of property rights; the fulfillment of a social function was to be a primary condi- tion for the recognition of private property rights. Social functions were to be determined by master plans and other urban and environmental laws―espe- cially those formulated at the local level―with clear definitions not only of individual but also of collective and social rights, as well as of social responsi- bilities and obligations that result from land and property ownership. While the City Statute affirmed the separation between property and building rights, the legal-urban order it symbolized held that the principle of social functions entailed not only administrative restrictions to property rights but also the le- gal power of public administrations to oblige individual and collective behav- iors, especially through compulsory orders. More than discussing property rights, then, the City Statute addresses the right to property, as property has no predetermined content and comprises both exchange and use values. Second, the City Statute clearly expressed the notion that land and prop- erty ma ers are fundamentally ma ers of contemporary public law, with the “public order” being larger than the “state order.” The legal order has incorporated a set of collective rights to territorial organization, environmen- tal preservation, participation in decentralized processes, and the regulariza- tion of informal se lements. It has also recognized the social right to adequate housing. Access to the judicial system, to defend collective rights and diffuse interests, has been opened to individuals, groups, NGOs, and the Ministerio Publico. To date, a solid discussion has not been promoted in Brazil on the legal meaning and implications of the constitutional expression “social func- tions of the city,” and only recently has the debate begun to discuss the need for a fourth dimension, territorial responsibility, to be added to the tradition- ally accepted forms of legal responsibility―political, administrative, and fiscal ―of public administrations. Third, the City Statute gave a profoundly different meaning to the legal nature of territorial and urban planning, which is no longer merely a discre- tional policy but an obligation of public authorities, with the failure to act leading to legal liability. Consequently, some Brazilian mayors have already lost their jobs. Together with its traditional regulatory power, urban planning also involves powers to intervene directly in the dynamics of land and prop- erty markets, especially to enable vacant land and underutilized properties to serve a social function. It should also recognize all forms of legal tenure and possession, not just of individual property, as well as affirm the social function of public property. Fourth, as a direct consequence of this socially oriented approach to prop- erty rights, the City Statute confronted a long neglected question: who pays the bill and how is it paid for the financing of urban development? Based on the principle of the fair distribution of costs and benefits of urbanization, the City Statute determined the onerous granting of use and building rights; recognized different categories of expropriation; allowed for the capture of The Challenges of Reforming the Urban Legal Framework 287 surplus value and the social management of land and property value appreci- ation; and proposed that there should be no acquired rights on urban ma ers. Fifth, the nature of urban management was also significantly altered, with the requirement of popular participation as a criterion of legal validity of ur- ban laws and policies, and not merely as a stamp of sociopolitical legitimiza- tion. Some MMPs, including São Paulo’s, have been annulled due to lack of adequate participation. It should be stressed that all the new tools, mecha- nisms, and processes should be used within the context of a clearly defined “sociopolitical project for the city,” with the city viewed as the sociospatial expression of a sociopolitical pact. For that reason, the Ministry of Cities has launched and promoted a Campaign for Participatory Master Plans. All in all, law and planning, under the new legal-urban order consolidated by the City Statute, were placed where they had always been: in the heart of the sociopolitical process, especially at the local level. Consequently, it is the very quality of this sociopolitical process that will both determine the mean- ing of and give concrete meaning to the notion of the social function of prop- erty at both the national and municipal levels. It is unquestionable that, for all its sophistication and successive devel- opments, the legal-urban order still has significant limits: there are several bo lenecks in the judicial system, including the length and cost of judicial procedures; difficulties with the registration system remain challenging; MMPs have not been articulated with an adequate urban management sys- tem; municipalism in Brazil is exaggerated and often artificial, and there is not a properly defined metropolitan/regional dimension; the different realities of middle-size and small municipalities, and especially the different realities of north and northeast, have not yet been properly contemplated by the legal order. Nonetheless, the progress of the legal-urban order is undeniable. It is in this context that one should ask: Is the federal law the real prob- lem shaping the current urban development processes? Or perhaps, instead, one should ask if there has been an adequate understanding of the new legal- urban order by lawyers, urban planners, public managers, and, of course, society. Have the newly created legal and politico-institutional spaces been occupied? Have the new legal principles been translated into urban policies? Have the new legal rights been claimed by the population? Have the new legal principles been defended by the judicial courts? Before going any further, it is important to stress that there are many deeply ingrained cultural, sociopolitical, and historical factors influencing the growing skepticism surrounding the federal law that deserve proper a ention and in-depth analyses, but for the purposes of this study will only be briefly mentioned: • There is in Brazil a strong cultural perception of the law―and the legal system―that borders on the messianic, with the law viewed merely as a 288 The World Bank Legal Review technical instrument to resolve conflicts and the legal system as objective, neutral, and ahistorical, not as an open-ended sociopolitical process/arena where diverging claims can be disputed, compared, and discussed. • Critics of the federal law are often moved by a sense of “short-termism,” which is understandable when one considers the volume and gravity of the accumulated urban problems in the country but which ignores the long history of neglect of the urban question and the need for more time― and continuity of public actions―to confront such accumulated urban problems. • There is a traditional perception of the state throughout Brazilian soci- ety―resulting from the dominant culture of representative democracy, le- gal positivism, and excessive formalism―which among other effects has fueled a tradition of patronage, clientelistic sociopolitical dynamics, and excessive dependence on state action, and reduced the “public sphere” to the “state sphere.” • There is a dominant technocratic perception of urban planning as the sole spatial narrative, expressing a technical, apolitical rationality, and as such unrelated to the dynamics of land and property markets. An Assessment of the MMPs What has actually happened, then, with the new generation of MMPs? The existing studies, mentioned earlier in this chapter, have clearly shown that there has been progress on many fronts: • The general discourse of urban reform has been adopted by most MMPs. • Specific sectors―the environment and cultural heritage, for example― have been addressed. • There has been a widespread creation of “special zones of social interest” corresponding to the areas occupied by existing informal se lements. • Whatever the variations, which naturally express the different political realities in Brazilian municipalities, the participatory nature of the discus- sion of the MMPs has been remarkable. Perhaps, though, the main achievement has been the unprecedented pro- duction of data and a wide variety of information about Brazilian cities. Still, there are several problems of legal efficacy undermining the new MMPs: • Excessive formalism and bureaucracy of municipal laws still exist. • Further regulation, in the form of subsequent laws, is needed for full en- forcement. The Challenges of Reforming the Urban Legal Framework 289 • Punctual changes have been promoted without participation. • Obscure legal language and imprecise technical legal writing (urban laws are rarely wri en by legal professionals) have widened the scope for legal and sociopolitical disputes. There are also several problems of social efficacy undermining the new MMPs: • Most plans remain traditional plans―that is, they are merely technical and regulatory―and often fail to territorialize proposals and intentions, and to intervene in the land structure and land and property markets. • The emphasis placed on the new tools created by the City Statute lacks a clearly defined project for the city. • The vast majority of MMPs have failed to recapture any surplus value resulting from state and collective action, and when this has happened, there has been limited or no social redistribution of the newly generated financial resources. Furthermore, most MMPs have placed limited or no emphasis on social housing in central areas, having failed to earmark central, serviced vacant land for social housing. Generally speaking, there are no specific criteria for the expansion of urban zones, public land and property have not been given a social function, and there has been no clearly articulated socioenvironmen- tal approach. Large projects have often bypassed the MMPs, and presumed collective eviction. Most importantly, policies dealing with land, urban is- sues, housing, environmental conditions, and fiscal and budgetary ma ers have not been integrated, and the regularization of informal se lements is still largely viewed as an isolated policy, with most MMPs imposing enormous technical difficulties on the legalization of informal se lements. Bureaucratic management and technical complexity have also meant that there has been a widespread lack of administrative capacity to act at the municipal level. Many MMPs are mere copies of models promoted by an “industry” of con- sultants. Obscure planning language has been as problematic as obscure legal language. At the other government levels, the precarious institutional systems have experienced several problems. At the federal level, sectoral policies have not been integrated, within or outside the Ministry of Cities; urban policy has not been articulated with environmental policy; and there is no national urban-metropolitan policy or system of cities, and no national territorial pol- icy generally, but especially in regard to the Amazon. The institutional and legal actions of the federated states have been very limited. Eminently, at all government levels, there is a profound lack of under- standing that cities should be concerned about not only social policy and in- frastructure for economic development but also the economy itself. 290 The World Bank Legal Review Conclusion Plus ça change, plus c’est la même chose? The analysis of the Brazilian case shows that the long-standing disputes leading to the sociopolitical mobilization calling for the approval of the new law have not been automatically abolished by the mere formal enactment of the law. If anything, the disputes have worsened and taken on new dimen- sions, resulting in a new phase for interested stakeholders, that of disputes over the enforcement of the law. The rules of the game have been fundamentally altered, but the game is still being played according to the old, elitist, and exclusionary rules. There are many reasons for this development, but only through the promotion of significant changes in the country’s legal and planning culture will further progress be possible. The reaffirmation of old sociospatial segregation processes by all levels of the Brazilian government has occurred despite the legal possibilities for signif- icantly changing the course of things through the formulation of profoundly different and inclusive MMPs. Instead, the events that have unfolded seem to demonstrate that―with the support of lawyers―urban planners and pub- lic managers remain, seemingly to a greater extent, hostages to exclusionary land and property markets that they created and developed, and continue to provoke segregation through the public policies that they have implemented. To break with this perverse logic, and put an end to the renewed legal and political disputes over urban land and property ma ers, a concentrated ef- fort urgently needs to be promoted to provide more information to planners, legal professionals, and society as a whole on the nature and possibilities of the new legal-urban order symbolized best by the City Statute. The education and training of planners, as well as of legal professionals, judges, prosecutors, and registry officers, is of utmost importance. If judicial courts need to follow public law‒urban law principles when interpreting property-related conflicts, rather than embracing obsolete unqualified private law ideas, Brazilian civil society needs to call for more recognition of social and collective rights. Brazil’s legal-urban order has significantly changed, but have the jurists understood that? Has the nature of urban planning been changed accordingly? Have urban managers assimilated the new principles? Has civil society awak- ened to the new legal realities? To play the game according to the new rules is a fundamental step in the collective construction of sustainable and fairer cities for the present generation and for future ones. In this context, all things considered, a very cautious optimism can be pro- posed. Even with due consideration given to its shortcomings and constraints, the law is not the problem. The City Statute has created the most appealing, enabling environment policy makers and managers could dream of in their a empts to promote urban reform. The Challenges of Reforming the Urban Legal Framework 291 That said, in the last analysis, to advance urban reform nationally, the fu- ture of the City Statute and the new urban-legal order it symbolizes urgently need a thorough renewal of sociopolitical mobilization centered on land, ur- ban, housing, and environmental ma ers. It is the task of all progressive stakeholders to defend the City Statute from the proposed (essentially negative) changes being discussed in the Na- tional Congress, to overcome the existing obstacles and improve the legal or- der, and, above all, to fight for the full implementation of the City Statute. The Brazilian case makes it clear that “bad laws” can make it difficult to obtain collective and social rights and to formulate inclusive public poli- cies. It follows, then, that “good laws” per se do not change urban and social realities, even when they express principles of sociospatial inclusion and so- cioenvironmental justice, or even, as is the rare case of the City Statute, when the legal recognition of progressive principles and rights is supported by the introduction of the processes, mechanisms, tools, and resources necessary for their materialization. If decades of sociopolitical disputes were necessary for the reform of the legal-urban order, and for the enactment of the City Statute, a new historical phase has been open since, namely, that of sociopolitical disputes at all govern- ment levels, within and outside the state apparatus, for its full implementation. The fact is that Brazil, and Brazilians, have not yet done justice to the City Statute. There are many important lessons here for scholars, policy makers, man- agers, and activists. This page intentionally left blank Innovative Legal Measures for Climate Change Response in the Green Economy Integrating Opportunity, Inclusion, and Equity MARIE-CLAIRE CORDONIER SEGGER AND YOLANDA SAITO There is a pressing need to respond more effectively to the growing impacts of climate change, and to the opportunities of climate finance. This response takes place in the context of a global transition to a new “green economy,” a transition that holds great potential to achieve the sustainable development goals of many countries. However, critics have expressed concern that the emerging green economy agenda fails to ensure respect for human rights and social development goals and may undermine the rights of poor and margin- alized communities. How to respond to climate change and facilitate access to the benefits of a greener economy―for poverty eradication and sustainable development―in a manner that is truly inclusive and equitable? What is the role of legal and institutional reform in facilitating these important objectives? As noted in the Stern Review, the potential costs of climate-related dam- age, globally, are likely as high as 20 percent of the world’s GDP, while the costs of mitigation and adaptation might be as low as 2 percent.1 At national and international levels, countries continue to struggle to develop adequate responses to the challenge of climate-compatible development. International efforts are guided by the 1992 United Nations Framework Convention on Climate Change (UNFCCC)2 with its 1997 Kyoto Protocol3 and many other related arrangements, some of which are still under negotiation in the Dur- ban Plan for Enhanced Action. Under the UNFCCC, states commit to both environmental protection and sustainable development objectives.4 The treaty regime consistently emphasizes the importance of opening new opportu- nities for sustainable economic development, especially for the more than Any statements of fact, opinion, or analysis expressed herein are entirely those of the authors and are not a ributable to the International Development Law Organization. The authors would like to thank Patrick Reynaud, Caroline Haywood, and Daniela Cuellar for their valu- able insights and assistance. 1 Nicholas Stern, Stern Review on the Economics of Climate Change (Cambridge U. Press 2007). 2 United Nations Framework Convention on Climate Change (May 9, 1992), 31 I.L.M. 849 (hereinafter, UN Framework Convention on Climate Change). 3 The UNFCCC Kyoto Protocol Status of Ratification can be found at h p://unfccc.int/files /essential_background/kyoto_protocol/application/pdf/kpstats.pdf. 4 Marie-Claire Cordonier Segger & Ashfaq Khalfan, Sustainable Development Law: Principles, Practices and Prospects (Oxford U. Press 2004). 293 294 The World Bank Legal Review 140 developing countries that are parties to UNFCCC.5 Under the UNFCCC, a complex matrix of international rules has emerged to guide policies to miti- gate climate change in this direction, encouraging the development of sustain- able practices in the energy, forestry, transportation, industrial, food and ag- riculture, housing, and infrastructure sectors; assisting adaptation for coastal, desert, rural agricultural, and other vulnerable people; and supporting new carbon markets and climate finance.6 However, a great deal remains to be done, especially at the national and local levels.7 The Outcome Document of the 2012 Rio+20 United Nations Conference on Sustainable Development (UNCSD), “The Future We Want,” calls for bold action toward a transition to a new green economy.8 Global action toward the green economy is intended to improve resilience to climate change and other threats; secure sources of food, water, and energy; enhance the natural resource base; contribute to poverty eradication; and support be er livelihood options. Growth in a green economy must be “sustained, inclusive and equita- ble,” prioritizing the need to be “people-centered and inclusive, providing op- portunities and benefits for all citizens and all countries.”9 Essentially, coun- tries have agreed―in global “soft law”―that responses to climate change and the green economy should be an opportunity for all and a threat to none.10 In spite of these nuanced and incremental global law and policy develop- ments, concerns remain. The emerging green economy agenda, if it fails to en- sure respect for human rights and social justice, for equity and inclusion, may in fact undermine the development process for the poorest and most margin- alized communities.11 In essence, climate change law and policy initiatives, even those taken in the context of building a global green economy, may have important human rights implications. Realizing a just, equitable, and sustain- able green economy will require international commitment to the balanced integration of the social, economic, and environmental aspects of sustainable 5 Malcolm Dowden, Climate Change and Sustainable Development: Law, Policy and Practice 56 (EG Books 2008). 6 David Freestone & Charlo e Streck eds., Legal Aspects of Implementing the Kyoto Protocol Mechanisms: Making Kyoto Work (Oxford U. Press 2005) (hereinafter, Legal Aspects of Kyoto Protocol Mechanisms); David Freestone & Charlo e Streck eds., Legal Aspects of Carbon Trad- ing: Kyoto, Copenhagen, and Beyond (Oxford U. Press 2009) (hereinafter, Legal Aspects of Carbon Trading). 7 United Nations Environment Programme (UNEP), 10 Years after Rio: The UNEP Assessment (UNEP 2002). 8 United Nations Conference on Sustainable Development, The Future We Want, UN Doc. A/66/L.56, UNGA 66th Session, July 24, 2012, para. 12 (hereinafter, 2012 UNCSD Declara- tion), available at h p://www.uncsd2012.org/thefuturewewant.html. 9 Id., at para. 25. 10 Id. 11 See, for example, Statement of Indigenous Peoples at the UN Conference on Sustainable Development, May 18, 2010, available at h p://www.indigenousportal.com/Economic-Development/1st -UN-Conference-on-Sustainable-Development-A-Green-Economy-in-the-Context-of-Sustain able-Development.html. Innovative Legal Measures for Climate Change Response 295 in the Green Economy development. The post-2015 sustainable development agenda provides an im- portant opportunity to link sustainable development with global justice.12 Its call for a green economy represents a call for change, however, and this im- plies risk.13 Many countries are debating new regulatory measures: to reduce the greenhouse gas emissions that cause climate change; to encourage adapta- tion, as part of a broader commitment to adopt new laws to promote the green economy; and to foster more sustainable development.14 Both the 1992 UN- FCCC, through a series of Conferences of the Parties (COPs),15 and the 2012 UNCSD Declaration16 encourage countries to ensure inclusiveness and trans- parency in the design of climate and green economy measures and to enact complementary measures that protect poor and vulnerable groups. However, li le concrete guidance is available on how this can actually be done. This chapter suggests that many developing countries are already leading the way, designing and implementing domestic laws, institutions, and strate- gies to successfully transition to a green economy that respects human rights for equity and inclusion. Examples of good practice can build confidence and spur innovation, showing that the green economy can be and, in fact, is being built through bold actions by commi ed nations. Such national policy mea- sures and regulatory and institutional innovations are key to ensuring that, in accessing the benefits of a growing green economy, responses to climate change are both inclusive and equitable, contributing more broadly to just and sustainable development outcomes. Motivated by the enormity and significance of this global challenge, and by these inspiring national practices, this chapter provides an overview of the legal aspects of the green economy, discusses their human rights implica- tions, and highlights innovative legal practices that respond to climate change while contributing to the sustainable development of a global green economy through equity and inclusion.17 12 Keynote address by Elizabeth Thompson at the International Development Law Organiza- tion (IDLO)–UN Department of Economic and Social Affairs (DESA) high-level event Contri- butions of Law to the Rio+20 Agenda, held April 19, 2012, at UN Headquarters in New York. 13 Id. 14 IDLO/CISDL, Compendium of Legal Best Practices on Climate Law and Policy (IDLO 2010). See also UNFCCC COP 19, The Doha Climate Gateway, 2012. 15 UNFCCC COP 19, The Doha Climate Gateway, 2012; UNFCCC COP 18, Durban Outcomes, 2011; UNFCCC COP 17, Cancun Agreements. 16 2012 UNCSD Declaration, supra note 8, at para. 76. 17 Id., as envisioned in para. 4. This analysis builds on outcomes of the IDLO–UN DESA Legal Experts Panel held at the UN Headquarters in New York, on April 19, 2012 (see note 12), and the IDLO Side Event on Legal Preparedness for the Green Economy at the Rio+20 UNCSD in Rio de Janiero on June 18, 2012, as well as subsequent legal research and analysis. 296 The World Bank Legal Review Climate Change, the Green Economy, and Sustainable Development To date, multilateral efforts to reduce global greenhouse gas emissions and to facilitate a global economy have proceeded largely along separate tracks.18 The international economic system is defined by the treaties establishing the World Trade Organization (WTO), the treaties’ annexes, and other arrange- ments under negotiation since the 2001 Doha Round was launched, as well as over 3,500 regional and bilateral trade and investment treaties.19 The global cli- mate regime is shaped by the 1992 UNFCCC, its 1997 Kyoto Protocol, and nu- merous related arrangements. Although these systems of international rules share a sustainable development objective, the relationship between the two has been fraught with challenges.20 In the context of a global green economy, international climate and eco- nomic instruments might be mutually supportive instead, if rule of law can assure equity and inclusion. As noted in Article 3(4) of the UNFCCC, each party, when considering which policies would be appropriate for protecting the climate system, should “tak[e] into account that economic development is essential for adopting measures to address climate change.”21 Further, in the UNFCCC, parties commit to “cooperate to promote a supportive and open international economic system,” which, it was believed, would “lead to sus- tainable economic growth and development in all Parties, particularly devel- oping country Parties, thus enabling them be er to address the problems of climate change.”22 While climate laws and policies might restrict or constrain certain kinds of economic development, they can also provide incentives for new kinds of development. Indeed, many innovative national climate change measures can be characterized as economic laws themselves. For instance, new policies and regulations are being set in place to establish emissions trading schemes (ETSs), which aim to reduce greenhouse gas emissions by stimulating trade in emission reduction units (ERUs), supporting adoption of and transfer to renewable-energy technologies, and encouraging investment 18 Steve Charnovi , Trade and Climate: Potential Conflicts and Synergies, in Beyond Kyoto: Advanc- ing the International Effort against Climate Change 141 (Joseph E. Aldy et al. eds, policy report, Pew Ctr. on Global Climate Change, Dec. 2003). See also Markus Gehring & Marie-Claire Cordonier Segger, Trade and Investment Implications of Carbon Trading for Sustainable Develop- ment, in Legal Aspects of Carbon Trading, supra note 6. 19 See also General Agreement on Tariffs and Trade (adopted Oct. 30, 1947, provisionally en- tered into force Jan. 1, 1948), 55 U.N.T.S. 194, C.T.S. No. 31 (1948) (GATT); General Agreement on Trade in Services (adopted Apr. 15, 1994, entered into force Jan. 1, 1995) 1869 U.N.T.S. 183; Michael Trebilcock & Robert Howse, Regulation of International Trade 336 (3d ed., Routledge 2005); Markus Gehring, Jarrod Hepburn, & Marie-Claire Cordonier Segger, World Trade Law in Practice 17 (Globe Law & Business 2006). 20 Christina Voigt, Sustainable Development as a Principle of International Law: Resolving Conflicts between Climate Measures and WTO Law (Martinus Nijhoff 2009). 21 UN Framework Convention on Climate Change, 1771 U.N.T.S. 107 (UNFCCC), art. 3(4). 22 Id., at art. 3(5). Innovative Legal Measures for Climate Change Response 297 in the Green Economy in firms adhering to more-sustainable, low-carbon-producing standards.23 In certain circumstances, an ETS may even provide incentives for the transfer of new sustainable development technologies to developing countries―if an emission rights purchase agreement (ERPA) provides for such transfer―in the context of global carbon markets or climate finance. And in Article 2(3), Annex I (developed country) parties agree to “strive to implement policies and measures . . . in such a way as to minimize adverse effects, including the adverse effects of climate change, effects on international trade, and social, environmental and economic impacts on other Parties, especially developing country Parties.”24 This recognizes that states may need to balance their adop- tion of new measures to respond to climate change with economic and social imperatives. Indeed, participants in international climate change negotiations have made strong political commitments to the green economy, including fi- nancing25 and programming initiatives.26 This global focus on the opportunities inherent in a new green economy, particularly in the context of the response to climate change, is not surprising. Awareness has grown of the link between the environment and development goals, as well as between ecosystem health and the economy.27 The 2008 global financial crisis triggered reconsideration of traditional growth models, and the G20 in 2009 reaffirmed a commitment to “move toward greener, more sus- tainable growth.”28 The concept of a green economy has emerged as a means 23 Legal Aspects of Kyoto Protocol Mechanisms, supra note 6, at sec. 7. 24 Kyoto Protocol to the UNFCCC (adopted Dec. 10, 1997, entered into force Feb. 16, 2005), 37 I.L.M. 22 (Kyoto Protocol), art. 2(2). 25 COP 16 (the 16th session of the Conference of the Parties) proved to be a real culmination of the increasingly robust discussions that began with the Bali Action Plan, which established pillars for the implementation of the UNFCCC, and were scheduled to conclude with the Copen- hagen Accord. Most notable was the binding pledge from developed nations of US$30 billion for the period 2010‒2012 and of US$100 billion per year by 2020 for climate financing. 26 In addition, the parties came to new agreements, collectively known as the Cancun Agree- ments, on nationally appropriate mitigation actions (NAMA): the reduction of emissions from deforestation and forest degradation (REDD+); the Clean Development Mechanism (CDM); the Cancun Adaptation Framework (CAF); the Technology Mechanism; and the Green Climate Fund. These initiatives all have hallmarks of green economy initiatives. REDD+, for example, “a empts to create a financial value for the carbon stored in forests, offering incentives for developing countries to reduce emissions from forested lands and in- vest in low-carbon paths to sustainable development” while also encouraging conservation, sustainable management of forests, and enhancement of forest carbon stocks. 27 The concept was introduced in the book Blueprint for a Green Economy, popularly known as “The Pearce Report.” One of the key underlying themes in the early years was that the price systems of the day were resulting in an allocation of resources in the economy that was biased against the environment. Environmental assets and services, which were supports for economic and social systems but also inputs in production, were being undervalued. This would result in inefficient consumption of resources and, ultimately, environmental degradation. David William Pearce, Anil Markandya, & Edward Barbier, Blueprint for a Green Economy (Earthscan 1989). See also David LeBlanc, Introduction, 35(3) Natural Resources Fo- rum 151, 151 (2011). 28 Steven Stone, UNEP chief of the Economics and Trade Branch, The Role of the Green Economy in Sustainable Development (presentation, Ad Hoc Meeting on the Green Economy: Trade and 298 The World Bank Legal Review to achieve such growth by establishing the environment and social develop- ment as determining factors, rather than externalities, of economic produc- tion, value, stability, and long-term prosperity.29 Several leading texts released in recent years have made significant strides in moving the green economy concept from theory into practice. The 2008 Green Jobs Report, released by the International Labour Organization (ILO) and partners, identified strategies for “greening jobs” across several sec- tors, including forestry, food and agriculture, and industry.30 The 2010 TEEB (The Economics of Ecosystems and Biodiversity) reports focused on build- ing a business case for biodiversity and ecosystem services and defining how such natural assets contribute to national economic bo om lines.31 The 2011 United Nations Environment Programme (UNEP) report, “Towards a Green Economy,”32 emphasized the need for strong, enabling frameworks to achieve the integrated human rights, social equity, and environmental objectives of the green economy.33 The 2012 UNCSD Declaration states that a green economy should be “people- centered and inclusive, providing opportunities and benefits for all citizens and all countries.”34 A people-centered approach cannot be achieved without proper human rights frameworks in place. A rights-based approach to devel- opment is one that is participatory, empowering, accountable, nondiscrimi- natory, and based on universal, inalienable human rights and freedoms.35 It must be tailored to the individual situation of each nation to ensure that the unique needs of all people―especially members of oppressed and marginal- ized groups―are taken into account and addressed in a meaningful way. Sustainable Development Implications, Palais de Nations, Geneva, Oct. 7–8, 2010). 29 See Frequently Asked Questions, at the UNEP Green Economy website, h p://www.unep.org /greeneconomy/AboutGEI/ FrequentlyAskedQuestions/. 30 International Labour Organization et al., Green Jobs: Towards Decent Work in a Sustainable, Low-Carbon World (report prepared with the cooperation of UNEP, Intl. Org. Employers, & Intl. Trade Union Confederation, Sept. 2008), available at h p://www.unep.org/labour _environment/features/greenjobs.asp. 31 See the TEEB in Business and Enterprise Report and the TEEB Synthesis Report, Mainstreaming the Economics of Nature, available at h p://www.teebweb.org. 32 UNEP, Towards a Green Economy: Pathways to Sustainable Development and Poverty Eradica- tion―A Synthesis for Policy Makers (UNEP 2011) (hereinafter, UNEP Green Economy Report), available at h p://www.unep.org/greeneconomy. 33 The UNEP Green Economy Report defines the green economy as “one that results in im- proved human well-being and social equity, while significantly reducing environmental risks and ecological scarcities. In its simplest expression, a green economy can be thought of as one which is low carbon, resource efficient and socially inclusive . . . [in which] growth in income and employment is driven by public and private investments that reduce carbon emissions and pollution, enhance energy and resource efficiency, and prevent the loss of biodiversity and ecosystem services.” Id., at 2. 34 2012 UNCSD Declaration, supra note 8, at para. 56. 35 United Nations Office of the High Commissioner for Human Rights, Development and Rights: The Undeniable Nexus (speech delivered on June 26, 2000, by Mary Robinson, UN High Com- missioner for Human Rights) (hereinafter, Development and Rights). Innovative Legal Measures for Climate Change Response 299 in the Green Economy Green economy initiatives can not only respect human rights and the en- vironment but also contribute to their strengthening and growth.36 Unfortu- nately, however, human rights have not always been at the forefront in dia- logues on economic development.37 And in relation to environmental law and policy, human rights have not always received the a ention warranted, often being relegated to vague generalities and conditionalities.38 The Cancun Agreements heralded a step forward for the synergy between human rights and development by recognizing, for the first time, that par- ties should fully respect human rights in all climate change‒related actions.39 Pressure from civil society and forward-looking UNFCCC parties continues to ensure that the momentum from the human rights acknowledgment in the Cancun Agreements is not slowed. Initiatives such as green jobs, sustainable procurement, payment for ecosystem services, internalization of ecological externalities, elimination of perverse subsidies, creation of new carbon taxes, and measures to support trade and investment in green goods and services all trigger important human rights and environmental implications. There is an inherent recognition that the green economy can have an impact on a full range of human rights, including the rights to life, health, food, water, hous- ing, and culture.40 International debates on climate change are now clearly recognizing certain key human rights in relation to sustainable development and related green economy initiatives. For example, the right to consultation for indigenous communities was clearly recognized in the Cancun Agreements in relation to REDD+.41 This formal notice is based on ILO Convention 169 and the United Nations Declaration on the Rights of Indigenous Peoples, which seek to protect the culture, prop- erty, and land rights of indigenous peoples, including the right not to be forc- ibly removed from lands or territories.42 It follows from Principle 22 of the Rio Declaration, which recognizes the vital role indigenous people have in 36 See Sébastien Jodoin, Rights-Based Frameworks for Climate Finance (Leg. Working Paper, Ctr. Intl. Sustainable Dev. L., 2010), available at h p://www.idlo.int/Publications/4_JodoinS %C3%A9bastien%20_RightsBasedFrameworksforClimateFinance.pdf. 37 Develoment and Rights, supra note 35. 38 See, for example, Sébastien Jodoin, From Copenhagen to Cancun: A Changing Climate for Human Rights in the UNFCCC?; see also Development and Rights, supra note 35. 39 Cancun Agreements, para. 8. Jodoin notes, however, the stronger “shall” was dropped from the negotiating text and replaced with the lesser “should.” See Jodoin, supra note 38, at 4. 40 Alyssa Johl & Yves Lador, A Human Rights Based Approach to Climate Finance, in Dialogue on Globalization 2 (Friedrich-Ebert-Stiftung ed., Friedich-Ebert-Stiftung 2012), available at h p://www.ciel.org/Publications/ClimateFinance_Feb2012.pdf. 41 Appendix I. Parties are called to promote and support “respect for the knowledge and rights of indigenous peoples and members of local communities, by taking into account relevant international obligations, national circumstances and laws, and noting that the United Na- tions General Assembly has adopted the United Nations Declaration on the Rights of Indig- enous Peoples,” as well as the full and effective participation of relevant stakeholders, in particular indigenous peoples and local communities. 42 Lee Swepston, New Step in the International Law on Indigenous and Tribal Peoples: ILO Conven- tion No. 169 of 1989, 15 Okla. City U. L. Rev. 677 (1990). 300 The World Bank Legal Review environmental management and development, and also in the UNFCCC “companion treaty,” the 1992 United Nations Convention on Biological Di- versity (UNCBD). This treaty specifically compels parties to respect, preserve and maintain knowledge, innovations and prac- tices of indigenous and local communities embodying traditional lifestyles relevant for the conservation and sustainable use of biolog- ical diversity and promote their wider application with the approval and involvement of the holders of such knowledge, innovations and practices and encourage the equitable sharing of the benefits arising from the utilization of such knowledge, innovations and practices.43 Similarly, in terms of livelihood and labor rights, there are inherent synergies. Green economy initiatives necessarily mean “green jobs,” which engage live- lihood and labor rights not only for new employment opportunities but also in the context of jobs and methods of livelihood that may be displaced. The International Covenant on Civil and Political Rights recognizes the right to self-determination, including the ability for peoples to pursue their economic, social, and cultural goals, and to manage and dispose of their own resources. In addition, it recognizes a negative right not to be deprived of means of subsistence.44 The International Covenant on Economic, Social and Cultural Rights also recognizes that negative right, as well as, inter alia, labor rights.45 In addition, rights to participation, access, and benefits sharing may be directly relevant for climate change responses in the context of the green economy. Tangible principles and mechanisms to secure access to information and pub- lic participation are perhaps best reflected in the terms of the Aarhus Conven- tion, which guarantees access to information, public participation, and justice in environmental ma ers.46 In climate change debates, the right to information and equitable participation, as well as access to justice and tangible remedies, has also been recognized as applicable not only to indigenous groups but to all affected stakeholders.47 Equity and inclusion rights are, perhaps, most clearly noted in the 1992 UNCBD, with its third objective concerning the fair and equitable sharing of the benefits arising out of the utilization of genetic resources.48 Access to genetic resources, where granted, shall be on mutually 43 United Nations Convention on Biological Diversity (UNCBD), 1760 U.N.T.S. 79; 31 I.L.M. 818 (1992), art. 8(j), available at h p://www.cbd.int/doc/legal/cbd-un-en.pdf. 44 Id., at art. 1.2. 45 Id. at arts. 1.2, 6, 7, 8. 46 Svitlana Kravchenko, The Aarhus Convention and Innovations in Compliance with Multilateral Environmental Agreements, 18(1) Colo. J. Intl. Env. L. & Policy (2007). 47 Jodoin, supra note 38, at 4. See also Alyssa Johl & Yves Lado, A Human Rights–Based Approach to Climate Finance, Friedrich-Ebert-Stiftung, available at h p://www.ciel.org/Publications /ClimateFinance_ Feb2012.pdf. Also, the Cancun Agreements have recognized this to some extent, requiring that REDD+ programs now be implemented in phases, beginning with the development of national action plans and capacity building. These action plans must ad- dress substantive legal issues such as land tenure, forest governance, gender considerations, and the rights of indigenous peoples and ensure full stakeholder input. 48 UNCBD, supra note 43, at art 1. Innovative Legal Measures for Climate Change Response 301 in the Green Economy agreed-on terms and shall be subject to prior informed consent of the contract- ing party providing the resources.49 For climate change and the green econo- my more broadly, these concepts have very important implications, especially for any initiatives that involve the use of natural resources, such as forestry, fishing, and mining. However, explicit recognition of other key human rights remains sparse in international texts related to sustainable development, and li le practical guidance is available on ways to respect and protect human rights.50 National Legal Frameworks for Green Economy Initiatives While international instruments provide important guidance, rights-based frameworks need to be implemented effectively on the ground at the national and local levels. A purely top-down approach will not be effective; human rights must be maintained by national and subnational frameworks that ad- dress the specific situations of individual states. Well-designed regulatory frameworks can not only protect and foster human rights but also create in- centives for individual groups that “drive green economic activity, remove barriers to green investments, and regulate the most harmful forms of un- sustainable behavior, either by creating minimum standards or prohibiting certain activities entirely.”51 The establishment of these frameworks often would require not a com- plete overhaul but rather a realignment of existing laws, regulations, and stan- dards to be er promote and maintain rights within green economy initiatives. Coordination and cooperation across public, private, and government sectors will be necessary to ensure a cohesive approach that does not see the policies and programs of one area contradict or undercut those of another.52 Innova- tions can be found in all sectors, and therefore states may also look to nongov- ernmental organizations and private actors for collaboration in developing innovative legal practices. The 2012 UNCSD encourages states to develop their own green economy strategies through “a transparent process of multi-stakeholder consultation” and recognizes that “strong governance at local, national, regional and global 49 Id., at art. 15. 50 Jodoin, supra note 38, at 4. 51 UNEP, Enabling Conditions Supporting the Transition to a Global Green Economy 20 (UNEP Green Economy Report 2011). 52 See, for example, IDLO-FAO (Sarah Mason-Case), Legal Preparedness for REDD+ in Zambia: Country Study (2011), which discusses, inter alia, Zambia’s governance framework and exist- ing laws and institutions and highlights the challenges that the country faces in implementing REDD+ initiatives. It also focuses on innovative legal and institutional reforms that will di- rectly and indirectly affect REDD+ in Zambia. Available at h p://www.idlo.int/Publications /LegalPreparednessREDDZambiapdf. 302 The World Bank Legal Review levels is critical for advancing sustainable development.”53 In order to build capacity in these areas, states need more guidance about how to promote na- tional and subnational legislative efforts. The challenge lies not in establishing the principles but in implementing them on the ground to ensure that the needs of all groups, particularly the most poor and vulnerable, are taken into account.54 Country Innovations: Human Rights Principles in Practice Several innovative nations are leading the way in implementing green econ- omy initiatives that incorporate the recognition of human rights despite the lack of concrete guidance from international texts. A study of the leading le- gal best practices can provide a framework from which means and indicators for transitioning to a just, inclusive, and equitable green economy can be dis- cussed and defined in the Rio+20 negotiations. The government of Vietnam has pioneered the application of free and prior informed consent (FPIC) as a prerequisite for the implementation of its REDD+ climate-finance pilot projects and is the first country to pilot FPIC.55 The FPIC pilot projects involve a nine-step process that includes awareness raising, recruitment and training of interlocutors, preparing and conducting village meetings, recording decisions on consent, documenting decisions, and independently evaluating and verifying the FPIC process.56 The process is cru- cial in safeguarding human rights and prioritizes the rights of participation and inclusion as guiding principles in green economy projects. Uganda has taken steps in the past five years to transform conventional agriculture production into an organic farming system as a means not only to combat climate change but also to eradicate poverty among the nation’s small- scale farmers. In 2009, the government released the Draft Uganda Organic Agriculture Policy. The strategy put in place to implement this policy focuses on nine key areas, including the generation of information, knowledge, and skills through education and training and the participation of special interest groups such as women, youth, and the poor and vulnerable.57 The Mexican government has passed the Ley General de Desarrollo Fo- restal Sustentable (Ley General),58 which will inform the country’s approach 53 2012 UNCSD Declaration, supra note 8, arts. 38, 44. 54 Jodoin, supra note 38. 55 IDLO-FAO, Legal Preparedness for REDD+ in Vietnam: Country Study (2011). 56 RECOFTC, Evaluation and Verification of the Free, Prior and Informed Consent Process un- der the UN-REDD Programme: Lam Dong Province, Vietnam (2010); see also IDLO/MONRE, Legal Preparedness for Climate Change in Vietnam (MONRE/IDLO 2013) 57 UNEP, Green Economy: Developing Countries Success Stories 12–13 (UNEP 2010) (hereinafter, Green Economy: Success Stories). 58 General Law on Sustainable Forest Development. Innovative Legal Measures for Climate Change Response 303 in the Green Economy to climate change and, more specifically, to REDD+ initiatives.59 The Ley Gen- eral declares that the conservation, protection, and restoration of forest eco- systems, as well as the development of environmental goods and services, are of public benefit and specifically states as an objective the respect and right of use and preferential benefit of forest resources by indigenous communities.60 This recognition, coupled with awareness and institutional strengthening pro- grams and access to climate finance, holds potential to provide greater equity and inclusion for indigenous peoples in voluntary and government-led cli- mate mitigation activities.61 The municipal government in Dhaka, Bangladesh, has established a com- posting market financed through public-private partnerships and carbon credits through the Clean Development Mechanism.62 The municipal govern- ment granted a concession to a private company―WWR Bio Fertilizer Bangla- desh Ltd.―to collect and process organic waste and sell the compost for profit. Community members benefit not only by being able to purchase the cheaper, high-quality compost for their fields but also by having new livelihood op- tions that respect their labor rights. New entrepreneurship opportunities are available for community members to negotiate with fertilizer companies to purchase the bio-fertilizers and market them nationally, opening the potential for inclusion in the green economy.63 Community-based resource management (CBRM) laws and policies have been implemented in Botswana to promote sustainable tourism business within local populations.64 Legally recognized community-based organiza- tions (CBOs) can apply for a permit to engage in commercial activities. This permit grants the CBO control over the natural resources, and the authority to negotiate hunting contracts and other tourism activities. The program of- fers incentives for communities to implement sustainable-use practices in a communal fashion while providing important locally generated resources to support efforts to adapt to climate change and other vulnerabilities.65 59 For a more in-depth discussion of Mexico’s approach, see Frederic Perron-Welch, Reducing Emissions from Deforestation and Forest Degradation, Forest Biodiversity Conservation and Respect for Human Rights: Mexico’s Approach (Sustainable Dev. L. on Climate Change Working Paper No. 10, IDLO, Mar. 2011). 60 Ley General de Desarrollo Forestal Sustentable, at art. 2(V), available at h p://www.diputados .gob.mx/LeyesBiblio/pdf/259.pdf. 61 OECD, OECD Environmental Performance Review: Mexico 2013, available at h p://www.oecd .org/env/country-reviews/mexico2013.htm. 62 IDLO, Compendium of Legal Best Practices on the Green Economy (forthcoming). 63 UN-HABITAT, Solid Waste Management in the World’s Cities: Water and Sanitation in the World’s Cities 2010, available at: h p://www.unhabitat.org/pmss/listItemDetails.aspx?pub licationID=2918. 64 Id., at 60. 65 Bruce Campbell, Eva Wollenberg, & David Edmunds, Devolution and Community-Based Natu- ral Resource Management: Creating Space for Local People to Participate and Benefit? (Overseas Dev. Inst. 2002). 304 The World Bank Legal Review The Brazilian National School Feeding Programme was decentralized and localized in an effort to increase food security and improve the nutritional quality of school meals. Underpinning this movement was the promotion of the procurement of local produce, with each municipality obliged to spend 30 percent of its budget for the program on produce grown by family-based farmers. This entire process, made possible because of the belief that good- quality food is a basic right, has encouraged a wider national debate on food security and agrarian development, which is connected to the current promo- tion of food sovereignty in sustainable agricultural interventions.66 In terms of adaptation to climate change, food security is one of the most serious concerns for developing countries. Programs addressing this concern, backed by local regulations, can make a significant contribution to human rights and dignity, meeting basic needs of smallholder famers and the urban poor.67 The primary goal of India’s National Rural Employment Guarantee Act is to supplement wage employment in impoverished areas, but it has the secondary benefit of strengthening resource management by financing rural projects that address causes of drought, deforestation, and soil erosion, “thus restoring the natural capital base on which rural livelihoods depend.”68 The act has aided in increasing the average wage of agricultural laborers by 25 percent over a three-year period, thereby empowering poor and margin- alized groups while also promoting the restoration of ecological infrastruc- ture.69 Such measures hold the potential to assist in improving resilience and adapting to climate change and contribute to a broader green economy in a way that respects equity and inclusion.70 Conclusion The green economy has emerged from theory to become policy and prac- tice. With strong international support, the green economy can be a means to achieve the goals of sustainable development. New climate change response measures, in the context of building a green economy at the local and global levels, must inherently recognize and preserve human rights and social devel- opment goals. Making this a reality, however, will require more than a mere recognition of human rights in international texts. Practical policy and guide- lines for regulatory and institutional reforms, built on the actual experiences 66 Kei Otsuki, Sustainable Partnerships for a Green Economy: A Case Study of Public Procurement for Homegrown School Feeding, 35(3) Natural Resources Forum 213, 220 (2011). 67 Leah M. Ashe & Roberta Sonnino, At the Crossroads: New Paradigms of Food Security, Public Health Nutrition and School Food, 1(1) Pub. Health Nutrition 1‒8 (2012). 68 Green Economy: Success Stories, supra note 57, at 17. 69 Id. 70 Pradosh K. Nath & Bhagirath Behera, A Critical Review of Impact of and Adaptation to Cli- mate Change in Developed and Developing Economies, 13(1) Env., Dev. & Sustainability 141‒162 (2011). Innovative Legal Measures for Climate Change Response 305 in the Green Economy and successes of leading countries, are necessary for countries to accomplish their capacity building goals. This chapter has outlined how many developing and developed nations are leading the way in defining national and subnational innovations for incorporating human rights principles into climate change policies, laws, and programs for a more inclusive and equitable green economy. The chapter has briefly surveyed leading legal innovations that respond to climate change and build on green economy opportunities that also provide for equity and inclusion. Beyond examples, tailored legal, regulatory, and institutional assess- ments; capacity building; and technical assistance are also needed to aid coun- tries as they develop new regulatory frameworks and implement changes in legal practice on the ground. Monitoring and sharing of legal innovations will contribute to the achievement of sustainable development goals. But a start has been made, and it should be encouraged to grow. From national legislation down to programming at the local level, inspiring examples of the synergy between climate change, green economy measures, and meaning- ful human rights frameworks have begun to emerge. These initial innovative legal practices show country efforts moving away from commonalities and platitudes about human rights and instead undertaking tangible regulatory reforms, inspiring new practices toward an equitable, inclusive, and funda- mentally more-just green economy. The International Development Law Organization has copyright over this chapter. Not- withstanding, the World Bank has permission to include this chapter in the book and make it available under the CC BY license. See the copyright page for more information. This page intentionally left blank The Constitutional Basis of Public Participation in Environmental Governance Framing Equitable Opportunities at National and County Government Levels in Kenya ROBERT KIBUGI The journey to a ain effective public participation in Kenyan governance gained traction when democratic space was cut back shortly after the 1982 failed military coup. The public interest and (negative) landmark 1989 judicial decision in Wangari Maathai v. Kenya Times Media Trust,1 a dispute over the il- legitimate annexation of a public open space in Nairobi, marked a dark phase, but also the beginning of the end of political repression. The constitutional court then ruled that only the a orney general could represent the public in- terest in court. This was reversed through Section 3 of the 1999 Environmen- tal Management and Coordination Act (EMCA), which created liberal legal standing (access to justice) for anyone bringing an environmental action. The heterogeneous concept of public participation, however, extends beyond lib- eral judicial standing to include public representation and consultation dur- ing decision making, access to information, and civic education to enhance public awareness on environmental decision making. The EMCA provides for public consultation as part of its environmen- tal impact assessment (EIA) procedures.2 Many natural resource‒sector laws have followed this lead, internalizing various forms of public participation, especially consultation and representation. The Forests Act permits participa- tory forestry management, wherein forest communities constitute community forest associations (CFA) and engage in economic and conservation activities This chapter is builds on an earlier (2012) research report by this author entitled “Ensuring Effective Public Participation in Natural Resources Management through Devolved Gov- ernments in Kenya.” It was a part of a cluster of research themes under a general heading, “Pu ing People at the Centre: Enhancing Public Participation in Decision Making,” com- missioned by the Institute for Law and Environmental Governance (ILEG). This chapter has been adapted with the consent of ILEG. The author wishes to thank Kevin Mugenya and Mary Ondiek, who were part of the research team, and Pauline Makutsa, who managed the research. Great thanks also to the peer reviewers and participants in the various review and validation workshops. 1 Kenya Law Reports (Env. & Land) 166‒171 (2007). 2 See The Environmental (impact assessment and audit) Regulations (2003). 307 308 The World Bank Legal Review in protected forests.3 The 2002 Water Act provides for the creation of water resource users associations by residents in river catchments; these associations engage in water resource management, which includes taking a role in the ap- proval of surface water abstraction permits.4 These legal mechanisms, although restricted in the scope of public partici- pation, have magnified the equitable role of citizens in environmental decision making. They could set the pace for further innovative legal and practical mech- anisms. Such an opportunity for Kenya has been availed by the 2010 Const- itution of Kenya. This basic law, promulgated on August 27, 2010, if interpreted innovatively, will expand the space for public participation in environmental decision making for Kenya. This chapter examines this possible outcome. In undertaking this analysis, the chapter adapts as a normative framework the principles of international environmental law found in Principle 10 of the 1992 Rio Declaration, which identifies the basic concepts for subsidiarity in performance of environmental functions. The conclusion suggests a number of possible legal and/or administrative steps that could further enhance the equitable role of public participation. Tracing the Constitutional Basis of Public Participation in Kenya Provisions of the 2010 constitution clearly show that any role citizens may play in governance is based on the sovereign power that citizens hold, both as individuals and as a collective group. This sovereign power may be exercised directly or through elected representatives; in Kenya, it is delegated to the various organs of government at the national and the county levels.5 The pre- amble reflects how the sovereign power of the people of Kenya was exercised at the time the constitution was adopted—by emphasizing the firm basis of public participation in governance: We, the People of Kenya . . . exercising our sovereign and inalienable right to determine the form of governance of our country and having participated fully in the making of this Constitution . . . adopt, enact and give this Constitution to ourselves and to our future generations. Article 10 of the Kenyan constitution identifies specific national values and principles of governance that are binding to every state organ, state officer, public officer, and all other persons engaged in applying or interpreting the constitution, in enacting or applying any law, and in making any public policy or decision. These governance values and principles include democracy, public participation, sustainable development, the sharing and devolution of power, transparency, and accountability. Constitutionally, it is apparent that public participation and sustainable development form the backbone of governance 3 Forests Act 7 (2005). See part IV, Community Participation. 4 Water Act, sec. 15(5) (2002); see also Water Resource Management Rules, sec. 10 (2007). 5 Kenyan Const. (2010), art. 1 (hereinafter Kenyan Const.). The Constitutional Basis of Public Participation 309 in Environmental Governance in Kenya. Constitutional fundamental rights frame further bases of public par- ticipation; these include the right to make political choices and to participate in free and fair elections based on universal suffrage.6 The procedural rights of access to justice, to fair administrative action,7 and to information8 comple- ment the realization of environmental, economic, and social rights. The 2010 constitution introduced a system of devolved government, where- by Kenya has a national government that shares functions with 47 distinctive county governments. Each level of government has functions that are defined in the fourth schedule to the constitution. Public participation is a principal object of devolution, as articulated in Article 174, “(c) to give powers of self- governance to the people and enhance the participation of the people in the exercise of the powers of the State and in making decisions affecting them.” Article 174 further suggests that devolution is intended to realize the prin- ciple of subsidiarity, akin to similar provisions in Principle 10 of the Rio Dec- laration, by recognizing “the right of communities to manage their own af- fairs and to further their development.” These provisions are the basis for the enhanced role of the public; they reinforce the need to innovatively interpret constitutional provisions to ensure that all elements of public participation play an effective role on the threshold of environmental decision making. International Law and the Normative Content of Public Participation in Environmental Governance Treaty law and soft law have set the basis for general and specific elements of public participation in environmental decision making, as seen in the soft law principles in various environmental law declarations and publications. The 1972 Stockholm Declaration called for the “acceptance of responsibility by citizens and communities and by enterprises and institutions at every level, all sharing equitably in common efforts”9 to achieve environmental goals. It stated that individuals and organizations in all walks of life would shape the world environment of the future, both by their values and by the sum of their actions. In 1987, the report of the World Commission on Environment and Development, entitled Our Common Future,10 concurred, arguing in part that the law principally needs community knowledge and support, which entails greater public participation in the decisions that affect the environment. 6 Id., at art. 38. 7 Id., at arts. 47‒48. 8 Id., at art. 35. 9 Preamble to the 1972 Stockholm Declaration on the Human Environment, UN Doc. A/Conf.48/14/ Rev. 1(1973), para. 7. 10 World Commission on Environment and Development, Our Common Future (Oxford U. Press 1987) (hereinafter Our Common Future). 310 The World Bank Legal Review The ideal object of public participation in environmental decision making would be the a ainment of sustainable development. Defined as “develop- ment that meets the needs of the present without compromising the ability of future generations to meet their own needs,”11 sustainable development con- cerns the welfare of both the people and the environment. An imperative in practical implementation of sustainable development through law and policy is the concept of integration.12 Integration necessarily implies having a legal basis or process that requires and facilitates consideration of socioeconomic (developmental) and environmental factors to secure a balance of interests.13 To secure this balance of interests, it is necessary to fulfill the socioeconomic needs of the people and to protect the environment, for both ecological and human benefit. Integration, or the balance of interests, therefore confers a re- sponsibility on people to participate in making decisions in the management of natural resources. Public participation in environmental governance is a well-articulated general concept in environmental law treaties, conventions, and protocols. Kenya is party to various international treaties that elucidate public participa- tion in environmental governance. These include the United Nations (UN) Convention to Combat Desertification,14 which stipulates obligations for affected-country parties to “promote awareness and facilitate the participa- tion of local populations, particularly women and youth, with the support of nongovernmental organizations, in efforts to combat desertification and mitigate the effects of drought.”15 The UN Framework Convention on Climate Change, dealing with the very complex challenge of adapting to and mitigat- ing climate change, calls on all parties to “promote and cooperate in educa- tion, training and public awareness related to climate change and encourage the widest participation in this process, including that of non-governmental organizations.”16 Principle 10 of the Rio Declaration, as earlier pointed out, provides useful guidance on a normative content of public participation, stating that “envi- ronmental issues are best handled with participation of all concerned citizens, at the relevant level.”17 This principle instructively breaks down elements of 11 Id., at 43. 12 Id., at para. 48. 13 See Dire Tladi, Sustainable Development in International Law: An Analysis of Key Enviro-Economic Instruments (Pretoria U. L. Press 2007). 14 See United Nations Convention to Combat Desertification, 33 Intl. Leg. Materials 1328 (1994). 15 Id., at art. 5(d). 16 See art. 4, United Nations Framework Convention on Climate Change, 31 Intl. Leg. Materials 849 (1992). 17 The normative content set out in Principle 10 of the Rio Declaration amounts to soft interna- tional law for lack of binding character on states, as opposed to when the same normative content is crystallized within binding obligations through treaty law, as evident through the Aarhus Convention, in infra note 19. The 2006 East African Community Protocol on En- vironmental and Natural Resource Management, to which Kenya is a state party, similarly The Constitutional Basis of Public Participation 311 in Environmental Governance public participation that are key to developing a normative content for practi- cal implementation through national law in Kenya. The four elements of pub- lic participation in environmental governance are outlined below. Public Opportunity to Participate in Decision-Making Processes This element suggests that the public should participate in all phases of de- cision making, from designing environmental law, to implementing legal provisions, to ensuring that the intended objectives are fulfilled through the representation, consultation, and actions of all individuals.18 The nature of this public participation in the environmental decision- and policy-making process is, for instance, exhorted in the Aarhus Convention.19 This treaty, al- though not applicable to Kenya, illustrates various platforms through which meaningful participation can be realized. These include public involvement in decision making on specific projects requiring permits, such as public consul- tations during EIAs; participation in the development of programs and plans affecting the environment; and participation in the development of regula- tions, policy, or laws.20 This “participation of the public in decision-making on ma ers with a potentially significant environmental impact” is also framed as a procedural right by the 2003 African Convention on the Conservation of Nature and Natural Resources.21 Access to Information Concerning the Environment The right of people to access information that is held by public authorities and private entities makes it easier for the public to participate in administra- tive and judicial processes. It helps promote more rational, informed decision making and it fosters transparent and accountable decision making.22 Effec- tive access to meaningful information is the first step in empowering citizens to exercise a degree of control over resources and institutions.23 This right to access information draws its legal foundation from, among other instruments, crystallizes elements of public participation in environmental management into hard law. Both soft and hard international law play significant roles in conceptual justifications and content of municipal laws. 18 Sally Eden, Public Participation in Environmental Policy: Considering Scientific, Counter-Scientific and Non-scientific Contributions, 5 Pub. Understanding Sci. 183, 184 (1996). 19 See Aarhus Convention on Access to Information, Public Participation in Decision Making and Ac- cess to Justice in Environmental Ma ers, 38 Intl. Leg. Materials 517 (1999) (hereinafter Aarhus Convention). 20 Id., at arts. 6‒8. 21 See African Convention on the Conservation of Nature and Natural Resources (Revised) (July 11, 2003), reprinted in Compendium of Key Human Rights Documents of the African Union 95 (Chris- topher Heyns & Magnus Killander eds., Pretoria U. L. Press 2010). 22 Benjamin Richardson & Jona Razzaque, Public Participation in Environmental Decision-Making 181 (Benjamin Richardson & Stepan Wood eds., Hart 2006). 23 See Christoph Schwarte, Access to Environmental Information in Uganda Forestry and Oil Pro- duction (Intl. Inst. Env. & Dev. 2008). 312 The World Bank Legal Review the International Covenant on Civil and Political Rights (ICPR).24 The ICPR provisions on freedom of expression include the freedom of everyone to seek, receive, and impart information and ideas of all kinds, regardless of frontiers, either orally, in writing, in print, in the form of art, or through any other me- dia of choice.25 This right to receive information is similarly guaranteed by the African Charter,26 which is binding on Kenya. Obligation to Facilitate and Encourage Public Awareness In 1987, Our Common Future expressed its concern with people and changes in human a itudes, noting that these changes depend on an urgent and vast campaign of education, debate, and public participation.27 This view is rein- forced by the 1992 Agenda 21, a nonbinding action plan on sustainable devel- opment agreed on by UN member states during the Conference on Environ- ment and Development in Rio de Janeiro, Brazil. In Chapter 36, Agenda 21 makes provisions for education and public awareness, and training with re- gard to implementation of sustainable development. Education, including formal education, public awareness, and training are highlighted as critical for achieving environmental and ethical awareness; for developing values, at- titudes, skills, and behaviors consistent with sustainable development; and for encouraging effective public participation in decision making.28 Education is therefore a foundational element of public participation, and through training and public awareness it can enhance public sensitivity to environment and development problems. It also can strengthen public involvement in seeking solutions and, particularly, foster a sense of personal environmental responsi- bility and commitment toward sustainable development.29 Formal and nonformal educational systems stand to play a key role. For- mal education implies school- or institution-based education, ranging from basic primary education to tertiary institutional or university training. Public awareness of formal education is particularly important because achievement of universal primary education is the second Millennium Development Goal. Enrolling and retaining children in primary schools to receive a basic educa- tion was enacted as a special basic right for every child in Kenya by Article 53 of the constitution. Kenya has had a system of universal and free primary school education since 2003. Using formal primary-, secondary-, and tertiary- level education to impart values, knowledge, and awareness of sustainable development is instrumental in realizing intergenerational equity, enabling 24 International Covenant on Civil and Political Rights, 6 Intl. Leg. Materials 368 (1967). 25 Id., at art. 19. 26 Id., at art. 9. 27 Our Common Future, at para. 107. 28 See Report of the United Nations Conference on Environment and Development, Rio de Janeiro, 3‒14 June 1992, vol. 1: Resolutions Adopted by the Conference, res. 1, annexes I and II, para. 36.3 (UN, Sales No. E.93.I.8 and corrigenda) (hereinafter UN Conference on Environment and Develop- ment). 29 Id., at para 36.8. The Constitutional Basis of Public Participation 313 in Environmental Governance younger generations to internalize these values. The concept of education for sustainable development (ESD) provides a ready-to-use mechanism. With Resolution 59/237, the UN General Assembly adopted the Decade of Education for Sustainable Development (DESD), which extends from 2005 to 2014. The resolution called on national governments to “consider the inclu- sion . . . of measures to implement the Decade in their respective educational systems and strategies and, where appropriate, national development plans.” According to UNESCO, the basic vision of ESD rests on the principle of using education―formal, nonformal, and informal―as an effective vector to bring about change in values, a itudes, and lifestyles to ensure a sustainable fu- ture.30 The objectives of the ESD program are to improve access to quality basic education, reorient existing education programs, develop public under- standing and awareness, and provide training.31 These are reiterated as the key strategic objectives for implementing the ESD strategy for Kenya,32 which is discussed later in this chapter. Access to Judicial and Administrative Proceedings, Including Redress and Remedy Access to justice, according to Connie Ngondi-Houghton,33 is conceptualized not as an end result but as a continuum that begins with inclusion of rights in the law, awareness of and understanding of the law, easy availability of information pertinent to one’s rights, the right to the protection of one’s rights by the legal enforcement agencies, easy entry into the judicial justice system, a conducive environment within the judicial system, timely processing of claims, and timely enforcement of judicial decisions. Principle 10 of the Rio Declaration calls on states to provide effective access to judicial and admin- istrative proceedings, including redress and remedy. In this sense, the legal system of any country should ensure that judicial institutions and any ad- ministrative mechanisms are effective in order to enhance access to environ- mental justice for the public.34 Any proceedings in these mechanisms should be expeditious and inexpensive, and the rules on legal standing should be liberal, with the objective of giving the public concerned wide access to jus- tice.35 Additionally, the outcomes of the access to justice mechanisms should be binding on public authorities. 30 UNESCO, The UN Decade of Education for Sustainable Development (DESD 2005‒2014): The First Two Years 5 (UNESCO 2007). 31 Id., at 6. 32 Kenya: Education for Sustainable Development